summaryrefslogtreecommitdiff
path: root/42956-8.txt
diff options
context:
space:
mode:
Diffstat (limited to '42956-8.txt')
-rw-r--r--42956-8.txt11120
1 files changed, 0 insertions, 11120 deletions
diff --git a/42956-8.txt b/42956-8.txt
deleted file mode 100644
index f0a9057..0000000
--- a/42956-8.txt
+++ /dev/null
@@ -1,11120 +0,0 @@
-The Project Gutenberg EBook of The Story of the Zulu Campaign, by
-Waller Ashe and E. V. Wyatt-Edgell
-
-This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
-almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
-re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
-with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
-
-
-Title: The Story of the Zulu Campaign
-
-Author: Waller Ashe
- E. V. Wyatt-Edgell
-
-Release Date: June 15, 2013 [EBook #42956]
-
-Language: English
-
-Character set encoding: ISO-8859-1
-
-*** START OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK THE STORY OF THE ZULU CAMPAIGN ***
-
-
-
-
-Produced by Steven Gibbs, Stephen Blundell and the Online
-Distributed Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-
-Transcriber's Note:
-
- Minor spelling and typographical errors have been corrected without
- note. Variant spellings, mostly proper nouns, have been retained:
- _Inyezane_, _Inyesani_, _Inyezani_, _Ingesani_, etc. The oe ligature
- is represented by [oe].
-
-
-
-
- THE STORY
- OF
- THE ZULU CAMPAIGN.
-
-
- BY
-
- MAJOR ASHE (LATE KING'S DRAGOON GUARDS),
- AUTHOR OF "THE MILITARY INSTITUTIONS OF FRANCE," ETC.
-
- AND
-
- CAPTAIN THE HON. E. V. WYATT-EDGELL
- (17TH LANCERS, KILLED AT ULUNDI).
-
-
- _DEDICATED BY SPECIAL PERMISSION TO HER IMPERIAL MAJESTY_
- THE EMPRESS EUGÉNIE.
-
-
- WITH MAP.
-
-
- London:
- SAMPSON LOW, MARSTON, SEARLE, & RIVINGTON,
- CROWN BUILDINGS, 188, FLEET STREET.
- 1880.
-
- [_All rights reserved._]
-
-
-
-
- LONDON:
- Gilbert and Rivington, Printers,
- St. John's Square.
-
-
-
-
-TO HER IMPERIAL MAJESTY
-
-THE EMPRESS EUGÉNIE
-
-_THIS RECORD OF THE ZULU WAR IS, BY GRACIOUS PERMISSION, HUMBLY
-DEDICATED, AS A POOR TRIBUTE AND OFFERING_.
-
-
-In Memoriam.
-
-Worthy of the Race of Guzman, and of the soldier of Lodi and Arcola,
-while recalling memories of him who gave to the gods of the Tiber the
-gift most precious to Rome--Human Valour--PRINCE LOUIS NAPOLEON'S name
-will live in the hearts of all his English comrades, as a type of pure
-chivalry, of knightly generosity, and as a rainbow of Hope over two
-great western powers, for centuries at war, but now allied in
-friendship.
-
-
-
-
-PREFACE.
-
-
-Some apology or explanation may be deemed requisite, for delaying the
-publication of this "Story of the Zulu War" for more than a year after
-its conclusion. The little book itself was written very shortly after
-the capture of the king, Cetywayo, and the tardiness of its appearance
-has been, to a certain extent, intentional on my part.
-
-Although it may seem ungracious and, perhaps, ungrateful to cavil at the
-war criticisms and descriptions which, by every post and telegram, adorn
-the pages of contemporaneous journalism, I would submit that the
-practice of writing _ex cathedrâ_ on war topics the day after an
-engagement, is too early to allow us to examine motives as well as
-facts, so that we may form conclusions to which we can only justly
-arrive, when "Time, the corrector, where our judgments err," has
-softened prejudice and exposed partisan feeling. The worst and most
-valueless criticisms on Waterloo were given to the world immediately
-after the fight of Mont St. Jean. The most unreliable, and indeed
-erroneous, opinions in regard to the splendid errors of Inkerman and
-Balaklava, appeared before the Crimean war was ended, and many a hero,
-elevated by the verdict of contemporaneous eulogy to a temporary
-pedestal in the Temple of Fame, has since been dethroned by the calmer
-and more honest judgment of a later generation. When the Emperor
-Napoleon called us a "nation of shopkeepers," he, perhaps,
-intentionally, paid us a compliment; for peace, commerce, and
-prosperity, have, as a rule, I venture to hold, been more regarded in
-our islands than projects of violence, warfare, or conquest; and this
-with us has ever been an honourable characteristic of the Spirit of our
-present Age.
-
-But as Sir Bartle Frere, one of England's greatest, wisest, and most
-humane administrators, was well aware, the great and time-honoured law
-of self-defence sometimes compels a State, like an individual, to resort
-to arms, and the Appeal of Battle, when all peaceful modes of
-arrangement have been vainly tried, becomes occasionally unavoidable.
-Then, and perhaps only then, we may be allowed, even by the Peace
-Society and the Acolytes who trim the lamps for Mr. John Bright, to take
-an interest in and feel proud of the disciplined courage, the love of
-honour, and the sense of duty of which we read in the campaigns, where
-those who are near and dear to us have fought and fallen under the
-British flag. Then the commanders we may have known as subalterns, but
-whose names are now in all circles as veritable "Household Words;" whose
-careers we have watched with proud, yet kindly sympathy, and whose
-triumphs we have seemed as countrymen to share; whose powers of
-intellect and prescience array, regulate, and wield at will the grim and
-stern materials at command; whose daring, and yet coolness in the midst
-of death, acts like a talisman upon the rank and file--whose
-providence, when one path fails, is ever ready for fresh resources and
-designs--are not these the men of whom we may say with Tacitus,--
-
- _"Ratio et consilium propriæ Ducis artes"?_
-
-and of this class, I venture to think, were Lord Chelmsford and his
-lieutenants. And when we are ourselves in the "sere and yellow leaf," or
-have joined, mayhap, that "larger majority" which Gladstonian tactics
-and energy cannot hope to rival, our children and children's children,
-when they read of such names as Bartle Frere, Chelmsford, Wood, Pearson,
-Buller, and Piet Uys, may look back to English History and see that our
-"island mastiffs" have not become degenerate, either in courage or
-generosity, since the days of Harold, the Black Prince, or that knightly
-Sydney who fell at Zutphen!
-
-Some experience of the Kaffir tribes and their characteristics, of the
-physical and geographical difficulties which attend upon a campaign in
-South Africa,--dating, indeed, as far back as a score of years ago, and
-the interest which I have since taken in colonies where, as an Adjutant,
-I passed some very happy years among Boers, Bôk, and Kaffirs, had at the
-commencement of the late war prompted me to follow its various phases,
-with a view to write the story of the campaign. In this purpose I was
-encouraged by the offers of many old comrades who were about to start
-with their regiments for the seat of war, and who promised me by each
-available opportunity the assistances of their several journals, notes,
-and sketches.
-
- "But one I would select from that proud throng,
- · · · · ·
- And partly that bright names will hallow song,
- And his was of the bravest."
-
-And to those who have known that most accomplished gentleman and gallant
-soldier, young, brave, cheery, and _débonnaire_, Edmund Wyatt-Edgell, I
-need not say how delighted I was at his undertaking to correspond with
-me, and, as far as time and opportunity permitted, to keep me _au
-courant_ with the march of events. From the time of his arrival at Natal
-to the fatal day on which he fell, he fulfilled that promise, and if any
-merit be due to the narrative I now present to public notice, it will, I
-believe, come through those descriptions which I received from my dead
-comrade and friend--_Sit tibi terra levis!_
-
-Another motive, or perhaps more than one, "pricked the sides of my
-intent," and invited me to wield the pen upon a soil where erst I had
-drawn a "regulation" sword. In the "unvexed silence of a student's
-cell," i.e., London chambers, I could only watch the progress of the
-campaign, without hoping to share in its toils or its dangers. I might
-envy, but I could not participate--
-
- "For who can view the ripen'd rose, nor seek
- To wear it?"
-
-In default of this, I could, however, follow in spirit the adventures,
-by flood and field, of more than a score of old comrades and companions
-in arms, who were winning honour and renown in a land not unfamiliar to
-me. In the hasty and, with all deference I say it, somewhat ignorant
-criticism of those amateur mentors who tell us how battles ought or
-ought not to be won, and who, from the calm solitudes of Fleet Street,
-would make or mar a military reputation, I venture to believe, was much
-injustice done to the Commander-in-chief of our forces in South Africa.
-
- "A man must serve his time to every trade
- Save censure. Critics all are ready made."
-
-And I was the more convinced of this partisan and hostile feeling from
-the knowledge that, west of Temple Bar, and especially in the regions
-where veterans do most congregate, in the clubs and haunts alike of
-_vieilles moustaches_ and military neophytes, from the "Senior" to the
-"Naval and Military," criticism was far less pronounced, and experience,
-as it invariably is, was more moderate in stricture and charitable in
-argument than elsewhere.
-
-Lastly, the tragic fate of England's young chivalrous and knightly
-guest, which formed such a terrible episode of the war and draped our
-colours with mourning, even in the hour of victory, made a deep
-impression upon my mind, and caused me insensibly to marvel at the
-unworthy sentiments to which a large portion of the English public and
-the English press at that time gave utterance. Political feeling seemed
-then, as it now seems in poor Ireland, to override all sense of manly
-honour, generosity, hospitality, or common decency. The slaughter, for
-it was nothing less, of the princely and noble lad, who came to the
-shores of his country's hereditary foe, as a messenger of hope, alliance
-and future friendship, who had been taught by his father to love and
-study our English laws and customs, and who, in his abandonment in that
-fatal donga, must have felt shame for the comrades to whom his safety
-was entrusted; the sacrifice, I say, of this pure and devoted spirit,
-seemed to me to call for some record, less evanescent than a passing
-note or a newspaper article. If I have spoken strongly of the living in
-my sorrow for the dead, as a soldier I can but plead in vindication,
-that, in all my remembrance of the records of our English army I can
-recall no instance, save the one I have quoted, where an officer wearing
-our royal uniform and holding a royal commission, galloped away in front
-of his escort, and allowed a comrade to be done to death in unknightly
-fashion!
-
-In conclusion I may say that this little work, although written _con
-amore_ and from details furnished to me by my friend, Captain the Hon.
-E. V. Wyatt-Edgell, and others, lays no claim to historical value, but
-assumes to be merely the _impressions de voyage_ of those who were
-actors in the scenes described.
-
- WALLER ASHE.
-
- Hare Court, Temple,
- _Nov. 1880._
-
-
-
-
-CONTENTS.
-
-
- CHAPTER I.
- PAGE
-
- Origin of Zulus--Their tribes--Senzagacone--Chaka--His
- wars--Innovations--Administration--Standing
- army--Death--Position of Zulus amongst kindred tribes--First
- contact with whites--The Boers--The English--Panda--His reign
- and death--Accession of Cetywayo--His promises to the
- English--Breaches of faith--The boundary question--Its origin
- and nature--The case of Sirayo--Its history--The Middle Drift
- affair--Other causes of war--The Ultimatum sent--Official
- declaration of war--State of the British forces--Cetywayo's
- army and its organization--Their tactics. 1
-
-
- CHAPTER II.
-
- Plan of campaign--Native levies--Special service officers--The
- advance--Pearson's column--Glyn's column--Wood's
- column--Utrecht--First brush with the enemy--Difficulties of
- transport--Action on Inyezani--Pearson at Ekowe--Glyn's
- advance--Durnford's failure--Isandhlwana--Description of
- camp--The battle--Details--Reconnaissance and return of Lord
- Chelmsford--Rorke's Drift--Causes of Isandhlwana--Remarks. 24
-
-
- CHAPTER III.
-
- Ekowe described--The fort--Guard for the frontier--Raid on
- Dabulamanzi's Kraal--Another raid--Life in Ekowe--Wood at
- Potter's Kraal--Capture of Baglusini--Skirmish and capture
- of cattle--Destruction of Manyanyoba Kraal--Colonel
- Rowlands--Capture of Makatees Kop--Junction with Wood--Camp
- at Kambula--Coming in of Oham--Disaster at Intombi
- Drift--Death of Moriarty--Rescue of Oham's wives and
- people--Events that led to the attack on Umbelini--The
- Zlobani--The attack--Details--Death of Campbell--Narrow
- escape of Wood--Death of Weatherly--St. Helena and H.M.S.
- "Shah." 67
-
-
- CHAPTER IV.
-
- Effects of Zlobani--Description of Kambula Camp--Desperate Zulu
- attack thereon--Description of the battle--Deaths of
- Lieutenants Bright and Nicholson--Gallant rescue by Captain
- Woodgate--Force and commanders of the Zulu attack--Their
- losses--The English losses--Fortifications at Kambula
- Kop--Block House--Arrival of despatches--Exciting scene. 132
-
-
- CHAPTER V.
-
- Organization of column for relief of Ekowe--The
- march--Heliographic signals--Camp at Ginghilovo--Disposition
- of the troops--Zulu advance--The battle--English
- victory--Death of Colonel Northey--English losses--Zulu force
- and loss--Relief of Ekowe--Meeting of Pearson and
- Chelmsford--State of Ekowe garrison--Barrow's cavalry raid on
- Dabulamanzi's kraal--British sentry firing on British troops. 156
-
-
- CHAPTER VI.
-
- End of first period of the Zulu war--Organization of fresh
- advance--Reinforcements from England--Scene in
- Durban--Disembarkation of troops--Cavalry camp at Berea--Lord
- Chelmsford's arrival at Durban--His reception--Review of
- Lancers and King's Dragoon Guards at Cato Manor--Plan of new
- campaign--Composition of No. 1 column--Composition of No. 2
- column--Cask bridge over Amatikula--Forts Crealock and
- Chelmsford--Wood's reconnaissance to Blood River--Description
- of Blood River and its scenery--Appearance of Buller's Light
- Horse--Removal of Wood's Kambula camp--Grandier's capture and
- escape--His tale--Description of Dabulamanzi and
- Cetywayo--Death of Dabulamanzi. 184
-
-
- CHAPTER VII.
-
- Lord Chelmsford with Wood at Kambula--Patrol by Buller--Capture
- of cattle--Scene from Kambula Kop--Zulu attack on
- patrol--Removal of Wood's camp to Mayegwhana--Wood's
- force--Scarcity of drivers and voorlopers--Newdigate at
- Conference Hill--Fort and depôt at Conference Hill--Work of
- No. 1 column--Exciting incident with a convoy--Distribution
- of troops--Forts on the Tugela, Inyezani, and at
- Ginghilovo--System of guards and precautions against
- surprises--All ready for the advance--Recapitulation of
- military situation--Newdigate's forts at Landsman's
- Drift--Arrangements for garrisons in rear of advance--The
- Lower Tugela command--Patrol by Wood and Buller in direction
- of Isandhlwana--Second patrol by Buller--Zulu attack--The
- Prince Imperial on patrol--Reconnaissance in force to
- Isandhlwana and burial of the dead. 221
-
-
- CHAPTER VIII.
-
- Advance of the 2nd column--Landsman's Drift to Kopje
- Allein--Description of camp--Plan of campaign--Discovery of
- Port Durnford--It becomes the base of 1st division--Troops
- composing 1st column--Crealock's journey to Durnford. 256
-
-
- CHAPTER IX.
-
- Death of the Prince Imperial--Lieutenant Carey's
- account--Discrepancies in and comments thereon--Feeling in
- the camp--Expedition under General Marshall to search for the
- body--Description of the spot--Recovery of the
- body--Court-martial on Carey. 268
-
-
- CHAPTER X.
-
- March of the 2nd column--Kopje Allein--Climate of the
- locality--Sickness among the troops--Evil effects of
- Cardwell's system--Embassy from Zulu chiefs--Cavalry
- skirmish--Death of Adjutant Frith--Difficulties of
- transport--Reinforcement of Wood--Appointment of Sir Garnet
- Wolseley--Opinion of the troops thereon--Alleged
- inhumanities--The helioscope. 295
-
-
- CHAPTER XI.
-
- Advance of 1st column--Description of route--Forts Crealock and
- Chelmsford--Causes of delay--Sickness of troops and its
- origin--Capture of cattle--Proposals for peace by
- Umsintwanga--His interview with Crealock--Surrender of
- Umguelumgwizi--Advance of 2nd division--Details of troops
- composing it--A fortified kraal--Fort built by Wood on the
- Umlatoosi--Patrol by Buller--Burning of five kraals in the
- Usipexi district--Amhlabatini--Depôt there described--Envoys
- from Cetywayo--Advance to White Umvolosi--Wood's camp--Lord
- Chelmsford's ultimatum to Cetywayo. 311
-
-
- CHAPTER XII.
-
- Raid across the Umvolosi by Buller--Gallant rescue of a
- sergeant by Lord William Beresford--Buller's losses--Umvolosi
- crossed by the main body--Formation of troops into
- square--Total numbers--Firing of kraals--Advance of Zulus
- from Ulundi--The Zulu attack--Repulse of Zulus--Pursuit by
- Cavalry--Death of Wyatt-Edgell--Losses of both
- sides--Withdrawal of English army--Effects of the battle of
- Ulundi--Surrender of 700 Zulus to Crealock--Cause of retreat
- after Ulundi--Resignation of Lord Chelmsford--His farewell
- parade--Epitome of work done by 1st column, and why it was
- not present at Ulundi--Ondini burnt by Barrow. 337
-
-
- CHAPTER XIII.
-
- Arrival of Sir Garnet Wolseley--Reception at Durban--Changes
- made by Wolseley--His plans for the future--Attempt to land
- at Port Durnford and its failure--Sir Garnet at St.
- Paul's--Grand council of Zulu chiefs--Resignation of General
- Crealock--His farewell to his troops at Camp Umlalasi--Fêtes
- in honour of Lord Chelmsford--Wolseley at
- Pietermaritzburg--Disturbances in Pondoland and
- Transvaal--Wolseley at Rorke's Drift--McLeod and the
- Swazis--Their appearance and habits--Wolseley at
- Intanjaneni--Surrender of guns by Mbelebele--Adhesion of
- various chiefs. 359
-
-
- CHAPTER XIV.
-
- Plans for the capture of Cetywayo--The Jantjis--Vijn's
- appearance at Victoria--His narrative--Its
- consequences--Despatch of Major Barrow and Lord Gifford in
- pursuit of the king--Their march--Description of country
- traversed--Gifford and Maurice sent on by Barrow--Marches and
- countermarches--Physical characteristics of country; its
- flora and fauna--Visit to kraal of friendly Zulus--Capture of
- two of the king's attendants--Women of the king's household
- captured--Captain and twenty Basutos join Lord
- Gifford--Gifford's stratagem to obtain information of the
- king's hiding-place--Cetywayo's refuge discovered--Forced
- night-march--Message to Major Marter--His arrival on the
- scene--Capture of the king. 379
-
- * * * * *
-
- NOTES 406
-
-
-
-
-THE STORY OF THE ZULU CAMPAIGN
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER I.
-
- Origin of Zulus--Their tribes--Senzagacone--Chaka--His
- wars--Innovations--Administration--Standing army--Death--Position of
- Zulus amongst kindred tribes--First contact with whites--The
- Boers--The English--Panda--His reign and death--Accession of
- Cetywayo--His promises to the English--Breaches of faith--The
- boundary question--Its origin and nature--The case of Sirayo--Its
- history--The Middle Drift affair--Other causes of war--The Ultimatum
- sent--Official declaration of war--State of the British
- forces--Cetywayo's army and its organization--Their tactics.
-
-
-The Emashlabatini country was originally occupied by a small tribe
-called the Abanguni; of its more ancient kings little is known beyond
-that they seem to have been of peaceful habits, making no wars, but
-breeding cattle; also that the name of one was Zulu. In their own
-country the appellation of Abanguni in course of time died out, though
-still used by their neighbours, and for it was substituted Abakwa-Zulu
-(sons of Zulu), Zulu and Undabezita. The tribe was composed of several
-families or clans, each having its own chieftain. In the time of
-Cetywayo's reign the names of these clans and their respective chiefs
-were as follows:--The Uhutilezi, a family having two branches; Umnyama,
-Cetywayo's prime minister, was chief of one, and Umtyubane of the other;
-the Ubixela and Umgazi, who were divisions of one family, the former
-owning Umvumhlana as chief, the latter Sigodi--subsequently slain at
-Isandhlwana--whose predecessor was Panda's prime minister Masipula, and
-his successor Mapoko; the Umtombelo and Umblalosi, also two branches of
-one family, whose respective chiefs were Mabanda and Segetwayo; the
-Uquabe, whose chief was named Rouhlo; the Uzimgu, whose chieftain
-rejoiced in the appellation of Unfanawenklela; the Fakazi, whose chief
-was Umkasana; the Umtanzi, with a chieftain Umbono by name; and the
-Igazi, whose head was Umkanyile; the Amagungebe, their chief was the
-notorious Sirayo; the Ukanyile, whose chief was Upagatwayo; the Ulanga,
-their chief Umhlaka; the Umpingose, whose chief was Ganse; and the
-Umhloben, a scattered family having no head.
-
-The word Zulu, or Undabezita, was invariably employed in addressing any
-member of these families, whatever his rank or station might happen to
-be.
-
-The first king of whom any particulars are known was Senzagacone, son of
-Ufaina. When this king began to reign he had no legitimate offspring: he
-had, however, a natural son by Unamdi, daughter of Umkeki, chief of the
-Langmene tribe, named Chaka (the bastard). He afterwards married this
-Unamdi, by whom he had a daughter Nuncoba, but no sons. She being his
-favourite wife, the king, according to the custom of the country, "gave
-her for a son," his natural son Chaka, thus legitimating him. When Chaka
-was fifteen, his father, thinking he might become troublesome, sent to
-kill him; but Chaka, being warned, fled to Dingiswayo, chief of the
-Umtwetwa, where he remained until the king's death, though on the
-occasion of his legitimation an invitation was given him to return to
-the paternal kraal.
-
-Meanwhile Chaka had become an Induna of great influence and popularity
-in the land of his refuge; so when on the death of Senzagacone the Zulu
-tribe sent to him requesting him to be their king, and he consented, all
-the tribes through which he passed on his way to the Zulus accompanied
-him; and the whole of the Zulu clans assembled to meet him, and he was
-made king with great rejoicings. In the interim between Senzagacone's
-death and Chaka's accession, Umkaibye (paternal aunt of Chaka) ruled the
-Zulus and arranged for Chaka's return. It was now that the jealousy long
-smouldering between the Umdwandwe and the Umtwetwa, the two most
-powerful tribes in that part of Africa, broke into an open quarrel.
-Uzwidi, chief of the former, attacked and utterly routed the latter,
-killing their chief, Dingiswayo, Chaka's friend and protector. The
-worsted tribe naturally applied to Chaka for help. Thereupon Uzwidi
-immediately marched to attack the Zulus, and a great battle ensued on
-the south of the White Umvolosi. The result was that the left wing of
-either army was victorious; but both lost so heavily that they retired
-to their respective countries.
-
-On his retreat, Chaka was attacked by the Langmeni, but failing in their
-assault, this tribe then deserted their own country and joined the
-Umdwandwe. Having defeated another coast tribe which assailed him, Chaka
-occupied both these countries, leaving the Emashlabatini district waste
-and uninhabited.
-
-Uzwidi had now gathered a fresh army, which Chaka, by a night march,
-surprised and defeated between Kwagmagwasa and the Umhlatuzi river. He
-then retreated, but was rapidly followed up by Uzwidi, who had soon
-regathered his forces, and who succeeded in capturing much Zulu cattle
-and slaying a number of men, women, and children, surprised in their
-kraals by the swiftness of his advance. He then again retreated. Uzwidi
-now made a great and final effort to crush his adversary. All the tribes
-around were pressed into his service, and the result was that he soon
-had an army--collected from ten tribes--far superior in point of numbers
-to the Zulu force, which represented only two tribes. Chaka therefore
-retreated before Uzwidi's advance, and eventually occupied a strong
-position on the Inkankla range. Here he awaited his opponent's onset. In
-place of the old missile weapon, Chaka had armed his men with a shorter
-and stronger assegai, intended for use at close quarters; he therefore
-gave them strict orders not to throw their assegais but to charge the
-foe and fight them hand to hand. He also skilfully placed his force
-amidst broken ground, so that it was impossible for the enemy to attack
-in a compact and organized body. The battle, as usual, began in the
-early morn and continued till after midday. The Zulus, carrying out
-their leader's instructions, waited till the assault was delivered, and
-then charged so vigorously on the foe that they swept everything before
-them. Chaka following up this defeat utterly dissipated the Umdwandwe
-army. Uzwidi fled beyond his own country, which Chaka annexed, and thus
-became the chief potentate in that part of Africa, levying tribute from
-all the tribes around him. Chaka now waged several wars. First he
-attacked and despoiled the Mangwani, a tribe on the Drakenberg; then he
-fell upon and extirpated the clan of Zulukanafu, a chief residing to the
-north of that range. Soon after he sent an army against the Pondos,
-which captured a considerable amount of cattle and then retreated.
-Again, in the following year, there was a similar expedition, and the
-Pondos sued for peace, which was granted. By this time Chaka claimed to
-rule over the entire country, from the sea to the Pondola, to the
-Drakenberg, and to the land of the Pondos. His next object was to
-consolidate his power. Accordingly, the petty kings under his rule were
-no longer recognized as such, but became tributary chieftains; if any
-one of these was remiss in payment of his tribute, an "impi" was sent
-"to eat him" up. From time to time Chaka would also call up these chiefs
-to his royal kraal, where he would receive them with marks of
-distinction, and ask their advice on state matters. Another important
-step to weaken the power of the chiefs, and at the same time to augment
-his own, was the establishment of a standing army. Military service was
-made compulsory on all males, each being told off to a certain regiment
-according to his age. Thus a man ceased to serve under the chief of his
-own clan, but belonged to a king's regiment, which was composed of men
-of all tribes. Similar divisions were also made amongst the females,
-who had to marry into regiments at the king's commands, though on a
-marriage cattle was still handed over to the bride's father or brother.
-Furthermore, regiments were not allowed wives till they were entitled to
-wear "head-rings," and this did not occur till men had reached forty
-years of age. Chaka's next war was against the Swazis, whom he defeated
-and made to pay tribute.
-
-In the following year an immense expedition was despatched against the
-Sotshangana, a people dwelling across the Somba Mountains, beyond
-Delagoa Bay.
-
-So large was this army that Zululand was almost denuded of warriors, an
-event which was taken advantage of by Dingaan and five more of the
-king's brothers, to treacherously fall upon Chaka, whom they slew,
-together with his chief councillor, Umxamana.
-
-The benefits conferred on his people by Chaka can hardly be
-over-estimated; he had raised them from a small tribe to a nation, and
-that nation a dominant one. As the Quirites were amongst the component
-tribes of the earlier Roman kingdom, so were the Zulus or Undabezita
-amongst the various tribes subject to the central Zulu authority, and
-curiously enough this resemblance extends still further; the Quirites
-were subdivided into gentes, or families, each with a distinctive name,
-and in a precisely similar manner, as has been before stated, the
-Undabezita were divided into sub-tribes or clans, each with its own
-gentile or family name. Nor were his people ungrateful to the memory of
-their first great king, for after the time of Chaka, the bastard, that
-name was never employed in its original signification, but to the
-present day a substitute, "Umlandhwana," is always used by a Zulu to
-express that idea.
-
-That Chaka was not averse to civilization and white men was evinced by
-his treatment of Fynn and five others who were rescued from a shipwreck
-in St. Lucia Bay. He even went so far as to accompany Fynn the whole way
-to Durban, to see him embark on a ship sent round from Cape Town for
-him, and to send at considerable expenditure in the shape of cattle two
-envoys to England, which he contemplated visiting himself, if their
-report should prove favourable. But this latter project failed in
-consequence of the king's murder, and the messengers got no further than
-Cape Town.
-
-A year or two after his departure Fynn returned, and with Chaka's
-sanction established a trading-station at Durban (1824). Once Fynn and
-some white men, being called upon for aid, assisted Chaka to punish a
-refractory tribe. When Chaka's army for the second time invaded the
-Pondos, it was through Fynn's representations that they would come into
-collision with the white men that the army proceeded no further.
-
-On the army returning from the Sotshangana expedition, Panda, a brother
-of Chaka, was requested to assume the chief authority, but he declined,
-so Dingaan became king. Dingaan commenced his reign by killing all his
-brothers, except Panda, and all the late king's most trusted ministers.
-This caused great uneasiness amongst the chiefs, one of whom named
-Umquetu wishing therefore to withdraw from Dingaan's rule, departed with
-all his clan and cattle to the south. Coming into collision with the
-Pondos they were extirpated; hereupon Dingaan despatched an army to
-recover the cattle, which he regarded as his, from the Pondos. About the
-same time another chief, Umzilikazi, also revolted, and withdrew himself
-to the spot where Pretoria now stands. An expedition was in a similar
-manner despatched against him, and after capturing nearly all his
-cattle, returned therewith to the king.
-
-Meanwhile the Boers had appeared on the scene at Natal, and they now
-claimed from Dingaan a considerable quantity of the cattle captured from
-Umzilikazi, alleging it had been originally stolen from them. To this
-Dingaan replied by bidding them recover some cattle that a petty chief
-had taken from him. Having done this and imprisoned the captured chief
-at Maritzburg, the Boers again applied for their own cattle, and a party
-under the command of one Peter Retief was sent to Dingaan. There now
-ensued a game of "diamond cut diamond," the Boers trying to outwit the
-king and capture him in his kraal, and Dingaan acting in much the same
-way to the Boers. The exact course of events is unknown, but for certain
-in the result Retief and his party were surprised and slain (Feb. 5th,
-1838). Dingaan then invaded Natal, slaughtered many of the Boers, and
-captured much cattle. His forces penetrated as far as Ladismith, whence,
-after a heavy repulse in an attack on the Dutch laager, they retired
-home. Encounters from time to time continued to occur between the Zulus
-and the Boers with varying success to either side, till at length a
-peace was patched up. Panda showed himself so active in this war as to
-excite Dingaan's jealousy, in consequence of which he, with all his
-people went over and joined the Boers. Soon after this (Jan. 1840) the
-Boers, in conjunction with Panda, invaded Zululand. The great fight
-occurred at Magongo, on the Umkusi river. Dingaan was utterly defeated,
-and retiring with a few attendants beyond the Bomba range, was killed by
-the Swazis. Panda now became king, and peace was made between the Zulus
-and Boers, the former ceding to the latter the Natal territory as far as
-the Tugela.
-
-It was about this time that there occurred a struggle at Natal between
-the English and Dutch, in which the latter, being worsted, retired to
-the Utrecht district, where they received permission from Panda to
-dwell; Utrecht, it is said, being assigned as their outside limit.
-
-Panda waged no more external wars, but lived peaceably in his kraal,
-breeding cattle. Most conspicuous amongst the sons of Panda were
-Cetywayo and Umbulazi; these two, having quarrelled, waged a sort of
-civil war one against the other, and in the result Umbulazi was defeated
-and killed. Amongst the army of Umbulazi were John Dunn and about thirty
-other white men armed with rifles. Cetywayo then quarrelled with another
-brother, and the same state of disorder continued till Panda's death,
-which occurred in October, 1872.
-
-Cetywayo being thereupon accepted as king by the Zulu nation, applied to
-the English Government to recognize him. Accordingly, Sir
-Theophilus--then Mr.--Shepstone was sent as envoy, and publicly crowned
-Cetywayo at the Umlambongmenya kraal, on which occasion he spoke thus to
-the assembled Zulus: "Here is your king. You have recognized him as
-such, and I now do also, in the name of the Queen of England. Your kings
-have often met violent deaths at the hands of their people, but if you
-kill this one, we shall surely require his blood of you." He then went
-on to say, "that as the English had recognized him as king, they would
-expect him to give all men a fair trial before condemnation. Even a
-witch should be let off, and merely sent away to another district." To
-this the Zulus returned that they would kill any man who went with the
-king's women, any man who ran away with another's wife, any thief of
-cattle, royal or otherwise; that a witch should not be put to death on a
-first accusation, but should any persist in witchcraft, he should be
-killed. And to this Shepstone signified his assent. The chiefs then rose
-in a body and said, "We will so govern the country under our King
-Cetywayo, and we look to England to support him as the king of the Zulu
-nation." Shepstone replied that he hoped the Zulus would live peaceably
-under the new king, whom England would expect to adhere to the terms to
-which he had just assented.
-
-But these promises were broken on more than one occasion. Cetywayo
-having called up his army, and finding them tardy in response, and many
-absentees on the plea of illness, forthwith sent a regiment to slay all
-those thus absent, saying, "Sick men are no good; I will save the
-doctors the trouble of attending them." Again, one of the divisions of
-females being ordered to marry a certain regiment, objected that they
-were too few. Another regiment was named, and further objections raised.
-Then an impi was sent to punish these women, and a great number were
-killed. Great abuses in the practice of "smelling out" by witch-doctors
-also prevailed, though in this respect Cetywayo appears slightly better
-than his predecessors.
-
-It is now time to turn attention to what is called the Boundary
-Question.
-
-It has been previously stated that in Panda's time the Boers had settled
-in the Utrecht district. From time to time cattle undoubtedly was passed
-between the Boers and the Zulu king. The former assert that it was the
-price for the absolute ownership of the land they occupied, whilst on
-behalf of Cetywayo it is urged that it was merely a tribute from the
-Boers, whose outside limit had been fixed at Utrecht. Be this as it may,
-there kept occurring at frequent intervals outrages, robberies, and
-reprisals on either side, Sirayo, whose kraal was nearest the border,
-being the most prominent actor in these scenes.
-
-Umbelini also now appeared, to further complicate matters. Originally a
-Swazi, he had fled from his native land, and settled in Zululand,
-together with his uncle Umbeliani and his people. This uncle joined the
-Boers, taking his cattle with him. Land was assigned to Umbeliani by the
-Boers close to where Umbelini was dwelling. No sooner, therefore, had
-the former built himself a kraal than the latter attacked and destroyed
-it. Thus ensued a contest between the Boers and Umbelini. The Boers
-drove Umbelini from his stronghold, but failed to capture him. He,
-retreating, erected a new kraal on the Dumbe range, north of the
-Zlobani, whence he continued to make raids into Swaziland and the
-Transvaal, which had now become British soil.
-
-At Cetywayo's coronation this vexed question of the boundary had been
-referred to Mr. Shepstone, and he, in accordance with a promise then
-given, subsequently met the Zulu envoys at Conference Hill to hear their
-claims in this matter. They then claimed the Buffalo river as their
-original and proper boundary. In reply, Mr. Shepstone said that he
-considered this was asking too much; but that a fair line would be the
-Blood river and the old hunting road running close by the Kambula Kop to
-the Pongola or Zulu side of Luneberg. He would, however, examine the
-question more closely before coming to a final decision, which, when
-arrived at, would be communicated to them.
-
-During all this time the Zulu army had been growing more and more
-restless, and the younger men especially were clamorous for an
-opportunity of "washing" their spears. For this sole purpose they
-contemplated a raid on the Swazis, then in alliance with England. But on
-Cetywayo's applying to the British Government for its sanction to this
-project, it naturally declined to allow its allies to be thus wantonly
-attacked.
-
-There also existed amongst the Zulu an intense antipathy to the Boers;
-and Cetywayo, after his capture, himself admitted that had the Transvaal
-not been annexed, it was a mere question of time how soon a war broke
-out between his people and the Dutch settlers; nor can this afford much
-ground for wonder, when the characteristics of a Boer are had well in
-mind. The typical Boer is doubtless a pattern of hospitality, simplicity
-of heart, fondness for his home and family, and of those general
-domestic attributes which are so dear to an Englishman. But in his
-relations and contact with the native races and real owners of the soil,
-the Dutch Boer seems to lose all sense of reason and justice, and to
-remember only those early and blood-stained annals of pioneering, when
-the white man and the black neither gave nor asked for quarter in their
-struggle for supremacy in the land. Indeed his intolerance of a native
-is so intense that he cannot be induced to look upon him as a human
-being, but he regards the unfortunate aboriginal as a wild beast to be
-hunted and shot down. But the Boer has his fairer side, although his
-type has as yet been unchangeable. As he existed when he ruled in Cape
-Colony in 1808, so he now exists in the present day in his settlements
-in the interior. He is uneducated, uncultivated, unprogressive, and
-obstinate; but he developes qualities under adverse circumstances which
-must command English respect. He is certainly domestic as far as his own
-family circle is concerned, but, at the same time, the reverse of
-gregarious in regard to the world in general. When he first commences to
-farm and settle he likes to possess not less than 6000 and not more than
-20,000 acres of good undulating "veldt." When he has obtained this, he
-starts in his waggon with his wife, his children, his scanty supply of
-goods and chattels, his cattle and sheep, and his only literature, the
-family Bible. He selects a good spring of water, being careful that no
-neighbour is located within at least ten miles. He builds his house with
-one large central hall, with the kitchen in rear, and four or five
-bedrooms opening out of the hall, all on the ground floor, and sometimes
-with a wide verandah outside. Kraals for his cattle, fences to his
-garden, and enclosures of 50 or 100 acres, are quickly run up; and so
-fertile is the soil and so favourable the climate, that in four or five
-years his garden will be full of oranges, lemons, citrons, peaches,
-apricots, figs, apples, pears, and vines. His herds and flocks multiply,
-his wheat and Indian corn thrive, and thus he lives in a rude but
-grateful abundance. His sons arrive at manhood and marry; his daughters
-are sought as wives, and if the land is good and plenty they remain and
-farm near, and for each generation and new family a new house is built a
-few hundred yards from the original. More acres with each generation are
-brought under the plough, and the man who is a good farmer, good father,
-and good husband cannot be brought to see that he must not covet his
-neighbour's land when that neighbour happens to be a black man! Without
-sentiment, without tenderness, and without a particle of enthusiasm, and
-with the most circumscribed intellectual horizon, he has a stubborn
-practicability which is admirably suited for the work of a pioneer, but
-which never developes into a power of civilization amongst savage
-tribes.
-
-As has been shown in the preceding narrative the relations between the
-Zulu king and the English Government had been growing more and more
-tense. Two conspicuous outrages in the early part of 1878 at length
-brought matters to a climax. These two events were the Sirayo affair,
-and the Middle Drift difficulty. To understand the Sirayo business it is
-necessary to enter somewhat into detail. Sirayo and his tribe had a
-quarrel with one of the royal tribes--the Ischeni. This, like many
-another tribal dispute common enough in Zululand, never grew to an
-"assegai" matter, but encounters frequently occurred, in which sticks
-only were used, and the object of the rival factions was to drive off
-the opponent's cattle. The result of this, and a "law-suit" between the
-parties, settled by the king, was that Sirayo lost all his cattle.
-Shortly after this, one of Sirayo's wives, who had already been put
-aside on account of having a son whose legitimacy was suspected, being
-again in the family-way, fled with her paramour into Natal. Another
-wife, in a similar condition, also accompanied her. Nothing was done at
-the time, but Sirayo's sons subsequently learning that these women were
-in kraals close to the border, having collected an armed band, crossed
-the river Buffalo in broad daylight, seized one of the women, recrossed
-the stream, and then killed her. The Natal Kaffirs armed and threatened
-a rescue, but made no attack on Sirayo's party, who, on the same night,
-made another incursion, and the second woman suffered the same fate as
-the first.
-
-Thereupon the English demanded the surrender of Sirayo's sons. Cetywayo
-sent to Sirayo advising him to hand over cattle instead of his sons.
-Sirayo replied that in consequence of the Ischeni dispute he had no
-cattle; that he was aware that his sons had transgressed; and that he
-was sorry. Again the English insisted on the surrender of the two young
-men. To this Cetywayo replied that they were very young, and therefore
-their conduct should be excused, and mercy shown to them. He added, that
-beyond all doubt they had done wrong; that the English had good cause
-for anger, and that he himself was displeased with Sirayo for not
-sending either his sons or cattle.
-
-The Middle Drift affair occurred thus:--At the very beginning of 1878
-the English were constructing a road from Kranz Kop to the middle drift
-of the Tugela. The men at work on this were interrupted, and driven away
-from their task by the Zulus living in the district, and Smith, the road
-engineer, who had landed on the island at this drift, was seized,
-stripped of all his clothing, and much maltreated by the same people.
-Reparation was demanded by the Government for this outrage. Furthermore,
-from June, 1877, it was evident that Cetywayo was instigating Secocoeni
-to hostilities; and even allowing that part of this chief's claim for
-compensation was just, it was necessary that the former chief should be
-made to understand that while arbitration was going on the law could not
-be broken by either side. With great tact, Sir T. Shepstone kept the
-peace until the Galeka and Gaika war was over, when Lord Chelmsford and
-his forces were freed, and it became possible to support words by
-action. Such were the events which led to the sending of an ultimatum by
-Sir Bartle Frere.
-
-In the beginning of December, 1878, therefore, Messrs. John Shepstone,
-Brownlie, Walker, Fynn, and Fyney were selected to be the messengers to
-Cetywayo, to whom they were to communicate a message, of which the
-following was the purport:--The boundary-line was to be drawn from the
-junction of the Buffalo and Blood rivers to the Magedala Mountains, and
-thence on to the district of Roundhill and the source of the Pongolo.
-All the farmers on the frontier and disputed territory who could produce
-any tangible evidence of damage or loss due to Zulu menace or warlike
-demonstration were to receive a moderate but fixed compensation. A fine
-of 500 head of cattle and the surrender of the guilty members of the
-tribe was imposed upon Usirayo's (Sirayo) people, and twenty days only
-allowed for the payment of the penalty; 100 head of cattle to be paid
-for the outrage upon Lieut. Smith; Umbelini, who had given so much
-trouble, to be handed over to and dealt with by the Transvaal
-Government; the whole of King Cetywayo's large army at once to be
-disbanded; freedom of marriage to be allowed when the parties thereto
-were of age; justice to be impartially administered; missionaries to be
-allowed to return to the Zulu country; British Residents to be
-appointed; all disputes between Europeans to be referred to the king and
-the resident; and, finally, no expulsion from Zulu territory to be
-carried into effect without the distinct approval of the resident.
-
-It was further intimated to the king that unless he showed his
-compliance with these terms, on or before December 31st, then on January
-1st, 1879, the British army would commence the invasion of his land, and
-would enforce them at the point of the bayonet. The advance, it has been
-said, originally was to have been made on the 1st; but his Excellency
-the High Commissioner, allowing for the possibility of letters being
-delayed by the swollen state of the river, the Tugela being then in
-flood, extended his term of grace to the 11th. A _Gazette_ extraordinary
-was published on January 6th, containing a declaration from Sir Bartle
-Frere, demanding from Cetywayo unqualified submission, stating that the
-general would after the 11th instant demand redress, and that the Zulu
-people were to be protected. The following was its form:--
-
-
- "NOTIFICATION BY HIS EXCELLENCY THE HIGH COMMISSIONER
-
- "In July last two armed bodies of Zulus, retainers of the Chief
- Usirago, led by his sons and brothers, entered Natal and took away
- by force refugee women, who were claiming protection from the
- resident magistrate of Umsinga. These women were dragged across the
- border, and, it is believed, murdered. These acts of outrage were
- promptly brought to Cetywayo's notice by his Excellency the
- Lieutenant-Governor of Natal, but no explanation or redress could be
- obtained from Cetywayo. Twenty-one days were allowed to the Zulu
- king to surrender the three sons and brother of the Chief Usirago
- for trial, and as this term expired on 31st December, 1878, the High
- Commissioner entertains no hope that it is the intention of the Zulu
- king to afford the redress which her Majesty's Government has a
- right to demand.
-
- "Therefore I hereby make known, for the information of Cetywayo and
- all the Zulu people, that I have placed the further prosecution of
- this and all other demands for redress and reparation in the hands
- of his Excellency the Lieutenant-General Lord Chelmsford, commanding
- her Majesty's Forces in South Africa, with the request that he will
- take such steps as he may find necessary to protect the British
- territory from further aggression, and to compel the Zulu king to
- comply with all the demands made on him for satisfaction due to the
- British Government, or for the greater security of the British
- territory, or for the better and more peaceable government of the
- Zulu people. Lieutenant-General Lord Chelmsford will carefully
- notify to all Zulu chiefs and people who may come within his reach
- that the commands of the British Government are made on Cetywayo, as
- much in the interests of the Zulu people as of the English nation,
- and that till the 11th January the Lieut.-General will be willing to
- receive and to transmit to me any intimation of the unqualified
- acceptance by Cetywayo of all the terms offered to him. If such
- intimation of unqualified and complete acceptance be received by the
- Lieut.-General before the 11th January no further hostile movement
- will be made, unless rendered necessary by the action of the Zulu
- forces, and up to the above date Lord Chelmsford will be ready to
- consider any steps which the Zulu king may propose for the purpose
- of giving real and permanent effect to the demands of the British
- Government. But unless all these terms be fully complied with by the
- above date, the Lieut.-General will no longer be bound by the terms
- of the 11th December, but will take such measures as the forces
- under his command will permit for compelling the submission of the
- Zulu king; always bearing in mind that the British Government has no
- quarrel with the Zulu nation, and that the future good government
- and well-being of the Zulus is as much an object of the steps now
- taken as the safety and protection of the British territories of
- Natal and the Transvaal. And I do hereby warn all residents and
- inhabitants of her Majesty's possessions and colonies in South
- Africa, of whatever race, to be guided by this, my notification,
- and I do strongly charge and command all her Majesty's officers,
- ministers, and subjects, and all others whom it may concern, to
- govern themselves and to act accordingly, and to take due notice of
- and to pay due regard to the tenor thereof.
-
- "H. B. E. FRERE,
- High Commissioner.
-
- "Pietermaritzburg, Natal, Jan. 4, 1879."
-
-During the whole of December Lord Chelmsford had been indefatigable in
-collecting and organizing the military forces at his command. The result
-was that at this date (Jan. 11th) the return in the order-book was as
-follows:--
-
-
- GENERAL STATE OF THE FIELD FORCES.
-
-
- NO. 1 COLUMN (Headquarters, Thring's Post, Lower Tugela).
-
- Commandant--Colonel C. K. Pearson, the Buffs.
-
- Naval Brigade--170 bluejackets and marines of H.M.S. "Active" (with
- one Gatling and two 7-pounder guns), under Captain Campbell, R.N.
-
- Royal Artillery--Two 7-pounder guns and rocket battery, under Lieut.
- W. N. Lloyd, R.A.
-
- Infantry--2nd battalion 3rd Buffs, under Lieut.-Col. H. Parnell.
-
- Mounted Infantry--100 men under Captain Barrow, 19th Hussars.
-
- Volunteers--Durban Rifles, Natal Hussars, Stanger Rifles, Victoria
- Rifles, Alexandra Rifles. Average, forty men per corps, all
- mounted.
-
- Native Contingent--1000 men, under Major Graves, the Buffs.
-
-
- NO. 2 COLUMN (Headquarters, Helpmakaar, near Rorke's Drift).
-
- Commandant--Colonel Glyn, 1st battalion 24th Regiment.
-
- Royal Artillery--N battery 5th brigade Royal Artillery (with
- 7-pounder guns), under Major A. Harness, R.A.
-
- Infantry--Seven companies 1st battalion 24th Regiment and 2nd
- battalion 24th Regiment, under Lieut.-Col. Degacher.
-
- Natal Mounted Police--Commanded by Major Dartnell.
-
- Volunteers--Natal Carabineers, Buffalo Border Guard, Newcastle
- Mounted Rifles. All mounted; average forty men.
-
- Native Contingent--1000 men, under Commandant Lonsdale, late 74th
- Highlanders.
-
-
- NO. 3 COLUMN (Headquarters, Utrecht).
-
- Commandant--Colonel Evelyn Wood, V.C., C.B., 90th Regiment.
-
- Royal Artillery--11th battery 7th brigade R.A. (with four 7-pounder
- guns) under Major E. Tremlett, R.A.
-
- Infantry--1st battalion 13th Regiment and 90th Regiment.
-
- Mounted Infantry--100 men, under Major J. C. Russell, 12th Lancers.
-
- Frontier Light Horse--200 strong, under Major Redvers Buller, C.B.,
- 60th Rifles.
-
- Volunteers--The Kaffrarian Vanguard, Commandant Schermbrucker, 100
- strong.
-
- Native Contingent--The Swazis, our native allies, some 5000 strong.
-
-An idea of the numbers and nature of Cetywayo's force may be gathered
-from the report of the Government Intelligence Department made at this
-time.
-
-"The Zulu army, as at present constituted, is drawn from the entire male
-population, as every male between the ages of fifteen and sixty-five is
-called upon to serve, without any exemption. The military force consists
-of fourteen corps or regiments, divided into wings right and left, and
-the latter into companies. The companies, however, are not of equal
-strength, but vary immensely, even from ten to 200, according to the
-numerical strength of the corps to which they belong. In fact, the
-companies and regiments would more correctly be termed families or
-clans, and each corps possesses its own military headquarters, or
-kraal, with the following hierarchy, namely, one commanding officer,
-chief, or Iduna-Yesibaya; one second in command, major, or
-Iduna-Yohlangoti, who has charge of the left wing; two wing officers,
-and company officers according to the need of the battalion. As a rule,
-all these officers are in command of men of the same ages as themselves,
-and the method of recruiting is as follows:--At stated and periodical
-intervals, generally from two to five years, a general levy takes place,
-when all the youths who happen at that time to have attained the age of
-fifteen are formed into a regiment and undergo a year's probation,
-during which time they are supposed to pass from boyhood to manhood. As
-the regiment becomes disciplined and seasoned it receives large drafts
-from other corps, so that as the elders die out young men come in to
-fill up the ranks. The entire Zulu army consists of thirty-three
-regiments, married and unmarried. No one in Zululand, male or female, is
-allowed to marry without the king's permission, and this permission is
-never granted until the men are about forty years of age. They then have
-to shave the crown of the head, and to put a ring round it, and carry a
-white shield, in contradistinction to the unmarried regiments, who do
-not shave their heads and carry coloured shields. Many of these
-regiments are too young for active service, others are too old,
-consequently it is estimated that only about twenty-five regiments would
-be able to take the field, and these would muster perhaps 40,000. Of
-these 4500 are between fifty and sixty years of age; 3400 are between
-forty and fifty; 10,000 between thirty and forty; and 22,000 between
-twenty and thirty. We have heard a great deal about the drill of these,
-but their movements, as far as we can learn, are few and very simple,
-but very quickly performed in their own way. They form circles of
-regiments in order to outflank the enemy. From this formation they break
-into columns of regiments or companies, and from these into skirmishing
-order, with supports and reserves. The sole commissariat of the Zulu
-army consists of three or four days' grain, carried by the lads who
-follow each corps, and, if necessary, a herd of cattle driven with each
-column."
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER II.
-
- Plan of campaign--Native levies--Special service officers--The
- advance--Pearson's column--Glyn's column--Wood's
- column--Utrecht--First brush with the enemy--Difficulties of
- transport--Action on Inyezani--Pearson at Ekowe--Glyn's
- advance--Durnford's failure--Isandhlwana--Description of camp--The
- battle--Details--Reconnaissance and return of Lord
- Chelmsford--Rorke's Drift--Causes of Isandhlwana--Remarks.
-
-
-The plan of the campaign now commenced was to advance into Zululand in
-four columns, each column complete in itself, having its own artillery,
-cavalry, and independent leader. Each column was also to keep up
-communications with the columns on flank, thus creating, as it were, the
-effect of an advance in one extended line.
-
-By this means it was intended to thoroughly sweep the entire Zulu
-territory, and at the same time to prevent any large body of the enemy
-from slipping between the columns, and so getting to the rear and
-delivering a counter-attack on the colonies.
-
-In addition to the regular European forces, large native levies had been
-raised, amounting in all to 7400. It is a great error to suppose that
-these were without arms, dress, or discipline. On the contrary, a great
-many of them came to us well armed with serviceable-looking rifles,
-evidently of Birmingham or Sheffield make, while some of the
-older-fashioned fire-arms had the Tower mark.
-
-Nor were they clothed only with the conventional blanket. On the
-contrary, their uniform was neat, and, at the same time, workmanlike,
-and consisted of a corduroy tunic, or rather patrol jacket, and
-breeches, with long boots of untanned leather, and a broad-leafed
-_sombrero_ as a head-dress.
-
-Several native corps were rapidly formed, in the following manner:--The
-commandant and his staff officers were British officers, the captains
-mostly retired British officers, colonists, or settlers; the
-non-commissioned officers, white settlers of different nationalities,
-and the privates usually Kaffirs.
-
-Among the English officers who received commands in this native
-contingent were Captain Nolan (Pioneers), Major Bengough, Captain
-Russell (Rocket Battery), Captain Ulich de Burgh (5th West York
-Militia), Captain Cherry (32nd Foot), and Lieutenant Hon. H. Gough.
-Colonel Durnford had command of the whole column, which was to be
-entirely native so far as the rank and file were concerned, and to be
-composed of all the three arms--artillery, cavalry, and infantry.
-
-There was also a considerable contingent of European Volunteers--more
-especially of mounted men, whose total reached close on 1000.
-Conspicuous amongst these were the Volunteer Hussars and Alexandra
-Mounted Rifles, the Durban Mounted Rifles, Captain Raaf's Diamond Field
-and Free State Horse, and a contingent of mounted Boers under Piet Uys,
-who gallantly responded to Colonel Wood's spirited and soldierlike
-appeal. These Boers were a splendid body of men, most of them crack
-shots with the rifle, and although somewhat fierce and uncompromising
-towards their ancient enemies, the Zulus, proved of invaluable service
-through their knowledge of localities.
-
-The following "special service" officers, sent out from England, had
-also arrived and entered on their respective duties:--Captain Cherry
-(32nd Light Infantry), was placed in command of the 3rd battalion Natal
-Contingent; Captain Gardner (14th Hussars), was sub-director of
-transports at headquarters, as well as Captain Huntley (10th Regiment),
-who was posted to the River Mooi; Captains Essex (76th), and Hon. H.
-Campbell (Coldstream Guards), were also directors of transports. Major
-Hopton had this duty at Pietermaritzburg. Captain Brunker, of the
-Cameronians (26th), had the command of a squadron of Light Horse.
-Captain Barton (7th Regiment), was staff officer to Colonel Durnford;
-Captains Pelly Clark (103rd Regiment), Spratt (29th), and Lieutenant
-Lawrence (18th), were all employed on transport duty at Durban, where,
-as most of the ammunition and stores were landed, their office was no
-sinecure. Captain Macgregor (29th Regiment), was staff officer to
-Colonel Pearson, and Captain Hart (31st Regiment) was on the staff of
-Lord Chelmsford.
-
-Meanwhile Cetywayo's term of grace had expired; the 11th of January had
-come and gone without any sign from the Zulu monarch. On the following
-day the war had begun, and the Tugela was successfully crossed. By four
-o'clock on the 12th the Buffs, four companies of the 99th, the Victoria
-Mounted Rifles, the native Sappers, the 1st Natal Native Contingent, and
-the Naval Brigade were well over the Lower Tugela, near Fort
-Buckingham. The pontoon worked remarkably well, making three trips an
-hour. Four small boats were also employed. A herd of cattle was brought
-into the camp by the vedettes, who also reported that a large Zulu force
-was in position about twenty miles off, and also at Ondini. It has been
-mentioned that four columns would be formed from out of the three (whose
-details have been given above), and these four were now advancing into
-Zululand in a line which partly described a crescent, of which the left
-extremity rested on Luneberg and the Pongolo, the right upon the Lower
-Drift of the Tugela, close to the sea, while the inner half of the
-circle was represented by the boundaries of Natal and the Transvaal.
-
-The centre may be considered as being at Fort Pearson, where there was a
-strongly entrenched camp on the summit of a rising or bluff overlooking
-the river Tugela. The column moving from Fort Pearson consisted of 1500
-regular infantry, that is to say, eight companies of the Buffs, under
-Colonel Parnell; six companies of the 99th, under Colonel Welman; one
-company Royal Artillery and two 7-pounder guns, drawn by mules under
-Lieutenant Lloyd; one Naval Brigade of 276 bluejackets and Marines,
-under Captain Campbell, from her Majesty's ships "Active" and "Tenedos,"
-with three Gatlings; 200 Mounted Infantry, under Captain Barrow, and 200
-Mounted Volunteers (Durban Mounted Rifles), under Captain W. Shepstone;
-the Alexandra Mounted Rifles, Captain Arbuthnot; Victoria Mounted
-Rifles, Captain Saner; Stanger Mounted Rifles, Captain Addison; the
-Natal Hussars, Captain Norton. Colonel Pearson, of the Buffs, was in
-command of the column, and had to co-operate with him a native
-contingent of 2000 men, under Major Graves, as well as two companies of
-the 99th posted at Stanger and Durban. The total strength of Colonel
-Pearson's column may, therefore, be set down at 2200 Europeans and 2000
-natives.
-
-The second or right centre column moved from Kranz Kop, a most
-formidable position, supported by Fort Buckingham. This was the scene of
-operations in 1861. The heights are commanding and look over a wide
-field of country. The position is unassailable except from the Natal
-side, and this was strongly fortified. Colonel Durnford, R.E., commanded
-this district and attack, and had with him now the 1st Regiment Native
-Contingent, which then consisted of three fine battalions, with three
-rocket tubes, under Lieutenant Russell, and 250 mounted natives, making
-altogether 3300 natives, officered by 200 European officers.
-
-Following the line of advance to the left, and occupying about fifty or
-sixty miles of frontier, we come to column three, the left centre
-attack, commanded by Colonel Glyn. Take any good map and you will remark
-how the boundary winds serpentine fashion in its length from Fort
-Buckingham to Rorke's Drift and Helpmakaar. Helpmakaar made an excellent
-base to Rorke's Drift. Being situated on a lofty plateau, it formed an
-admirable place for a permanent encampment. It also had depôts at
-Greytown on the one side and Ladismith on the other. Colonel Glyn had
-with him seven companies of the 1st battalion 24th and eight companies
-of the 2nd battalion 24th, six 7-pounder guns with Kaffrarian carriages
-under Colonel Harness, a squadron of mounted infantry under Captain
-Browne, the Natal Mounted Police (150 men), the Natal Carabineers under
-Captain Shepstone, the Buffalo Border Guard (Captain Robson), the
-Newcastle Mounted Rifles (Captain Bradstreet), also the native
-contingent (2nd Regiment), 2000 strong, under Commandant Lonsdale,
-officered by 200 whites. From Rorke's Drift, about five miles over the
-river is Ungusdana, and thence on the traveller comes to the Intalalala
-river, which is about fifteen miles inland. The country all about the
-district is rugged and broken, and calculated to afford positions of
-great defensive strength. Colonel Glyn was, if possible, to bear a
-little to his left flank after crossing the boundary with a view to
-communication being opened with Wood's right flank. To effect this
-connexion, however, there was a sad need of cavalry.
-
-We now come to the extreme left of the advance, whose headquarters were
-Utrecht, and which was thus composed:--Colonel Evelyn Wood, V.C., C.B.,
-90th Light Infantry, commanding No. 4 Column; Staff Orderly Officer,
-Lieutenant Lysons, 90th Infantry; Principal Staff Officer, Captain Hon.
-R. G. E. Campbell, Coldstream Guards; general Staff duties, Captain
-Woodgate, 4th Regiment; transport duties, Captain Vaughan, R.A.; senior
-commissary officer, Commissary Hughes; commissary of ordnance, Assistant
-Commissary Philimore; subdistrict paymaster, Paymaster M'Donald; senior
-medical officer, Surgeon-Major Cuffe. Corps--Royal Artillery, six
-7-pounders, Major Tremlett, R.A.; 1st-13th Light Infantry,
-Lieutenant-Colonel Gilbert, 13th; 90th Light Infantry, Brevet
-Lieutenant-Colonel Cherry, 90th; Frontier Light Horse, Brevet
-Lieut.-Colonel Buller, C.B., 60th; Wood's Irregulars, 700 men,
-Commandant Henderson. In addition, a few Boers were coming in, and more
-were expected.
-
-Utrecht is the most southerly part of the Transvaal, and lies upon the
-border of both Natal and Zululand. It is separated from the former by
-the Buffalo river, and, after crossing the Blood river, a few marches
-bring one to the territories of King Cetywayo. From the lowest, or most
-southerly portions of Utrecht, just where the Buffalo and Blood rivers
-form a junction, to the port of Durban, on the coast of Natal, is but
-100 miles, and the capital city is about thirty miles from Newcastle,
-the most northern of Natal towns. The two districts are connected by a
-tolerably fair road and a drift over the Buffalo river. Utrecht, in a
-strategical point of view, wedged in as it were between Natal and
-Zululand, cannot be equalled by any position of a similar nature. The
-interior of this district extends away to the summit of the Drakenberg
-range, one of which reaches an altitude of 4000 feet. Most of the
-Utrecht land lies in what is called the "terrace country," and has the
-advantage of the most splendid bracing air, added to which are mountain
-ridge and peak, precipice, wooded gorge, and grass-land, and scenery
-whose characteristics are of a grander and nobler nature than that of
-the Cape Colony. The portion of the Drakenberg which runs through
-Utrecht has its eastern front and glacis looking towards the sea, which
-is about eighty miles distant, and as each terrace or range slopes down
-the character of the country changes, presenting many of the features
-of the upper portions of the Cape Colony, that is to say, broad
-undulating downs in one part and immense flats covered with bush on the
-other. All the principal rivers and streams of Utrecht and their
-tributaries flow eastward to the Indian Ocean. On one boundary there is
-the Pongola, and on the other the Buffalo, while the Blood river passes
-through it with a south-eastern flow, and the Pifan does the same, but
-with an inclination to the north-east. From the wild highlands between
-these two streams issue the head waters of the Umoolosi, which traverses
-Zululand and empties itself into St. Lucia Bay.
-
-Wood's column marched from Utrecht on the 7th, so as to be on the
-borderland in order to operate with the right-hand column on the
-appointed day. General Lord Chelmsford had given orders that Colonel
-Wood was to be at a certain point on the 10th, and consequently
-arrangements were made to carry out these instructions. It was known
-that Sirayo would probably oppose the crossing of Colonel Glyn at
-Rorke's Drift, and Colonel Wood had been told, if possible, to get
-sufficiently near to operate on the enemy's right and rear should such
-an attempt be made. Leaving a small guard at his camps at Sandspruit,
-the rest of Wood's force paraded in the lightest possible order at 1.30
-p.m. on the 10th, and marched from two that afternoon until six p.m. A
-halt was then made until 1.30 a.m., when by the light of a glorious moon
-the advance was pursued. A mounted advanced guard was thrown out,
-flanking patrols were organized and told off, and the troops moved in
-the greatest silence, not a word in the ranks being allowed to be
-spoken. At 3 a.m., a short halt took place, and the chief ordered
-forward a reconnaissance, consisting of Buller's Light Horse, two
-7-pounder guns under Major Tremlett, and twenty-four picked shots from
-the 13th and 90th Regiments respectively. These men were to be carried
-in some of the mule waggons, and were accompanied by the 700 irregulars,
-horse and foot. Colonel Wood accompanied this advanced force, leaving
-the remaining (main) body in charge of Colonel Gilbert, who was ordered
-to follow at a fixed time. The advanced body arrived within ten miles of
-Rorke's Drift at 7.30 a.m., and by eight the camp fires were lit and the
-men comfortably having their breakfasts on the banks of a small stream;
-the mounted men having at once off-saddled, the infantry piled arms, and
-the horses and mules turned out to graze under a strong guard.
-
-About nine o'clock the general, Lord Chelmsford, cantered up to the
-camp, accompanied by his staff and an escort of 100 mounted infantry and
-some Natal mounted police. The general seemed delighted at the celerity
-with which his orders had been carried out, as in eighteen hours Wood's
-party had covered twenty-seven miles, and the men and horses were as
-fresh as paint. A long consultation took place with the general, and
-then the order was issued for the return to the main body; but this was
-not found necessary, as Colonel Gilbert met them after about ten miles.
-
-In this day, or rather twenty-four hours, the men had marched thirty-one
-miles, and were not fated, on camp being pitched, to enjoy the fruits of
-their labour and toil, for soon after they were settled for the evening
-a heavy thunderstorm came suddenly over the tents, and in a quarter of
-an hour they were up to their ankles in a perfect river of water. The
-tents went down in all directions, and in many cases poles were snapped.
-The next day, however, a patrol of Buller's horse was paraded soon after
-daybreak, as scouts had brought in information that a large number of
-cattle were to be seen in the neighbouring kloof. Soon after leaving
-camp Buller's men were fired upon, but the Zulus did not stand their
-ground, and by the afternoon they had brought in nearly 1000 cattle.
-Captain Barton, who had gone out later in the day with another party,
-marched twenty miles in the direction of Umkanga's kraal, where in the
-skirmish which resulted 550 cattle were taken, and seven of the Zulus
-were killed and wounded. On the following morning a strong
-reconnaissance was made in the direction of the Bushee Valley. The Zulus
-were in considerable force, and their general tried to induce the
-English skirmishers to follow him to ground of his own choosing. Colonel
-Wood, however, kept his men well in hand, and contented himself by
-sending forward two companies of the 13th Light Infantry, Colonel
-Gilbert's fine corps, and menacing the Zulu flank with some score or
-more horsemen, who, galloping to a favouring eminence, made capital
-practice at the Zulu main body with their rifles at 700 and 800 yards.
-The Zulus still continued to creep up in rear, getting what cover they
-could from the bushes, and a sharp fire was kept up on both sides. As
-the men in skirmishing order pushed the enemy gradually before them, the
-mounted force harassed them on either flank, sometimes galloping round
-to the right and left to obtain vantage-ground and cover, and then
-dismounting in sections, and acting as infantry, while the main body was
-kept carefully out of sight in the dense mimosa which was found in the
-rear. The bush, as they advanced, gradually became more dense, and the
-path scarcely allowed them to move in fours by a steep descent into a
-wooded valley. Instinctively it was guessed that here would be the main
-body of the foe, and this turned out to be the case, for away to the
-left front, on a tall "copjie" or circular hill, about twenty mounted
-Zulus were to be seen, evidently the commander and his staff giving
-orders and directing the operations of the columns in the plain. The
-firing had now become general, but the soldiers were not allowed to
-waste their ammunition, and nearly every shot told with fatal effect.
-Colonel Wood had taken the precaution to strengthen his flanks as he
-advanced, and as the enemy could not tell how strong he was, the main
-body being still invisible, they were completely puzzled by the daring
-of the mounted men, who seemed ubiquitous. The guns were found rather a
-nuisance; one of the carriages broke down, and the limber had to be left
-behind, while the gun itself was secured. The head of the first line of
-skirmishers had now made good their way through the kloof with slight
-loss, and the Zulus attempted in vain to get round to its rear, but
-found all hopes of such a man[oe]uvre utterly futile--as the flanking
-parties were on the _qui-vive_. It was now Wood's turn to push them, and
-he used the opportunity. Two more companies were advanced at the double
-to force the centre of the Zulu line, and in a few moments we had cut
-it in two. In the meanwhile one of the light field-pieces had obtained a
-favourable position, and had got the enemy's range exactly, but the
-execution done was not what could have been obtained with a good honest
-nine or twelve-pounder. The pursuit was carried on for about a mile, and
-the Zulus were scattered in all directions, but the commander was too
-wary to allow his men to go too far, and the recall was sounded, and in
-a short time brought back the excited fellows, puffing and blowing, to
-rejoin the main body.
-
-For some days this column continued to advance steadily without meeting
-any serious opposition. Having moved on from the Blood River, Wood's
-force encamped at Bemba's Kop till the 20th January. The country over
-which they had passed since they left Utrecht may be described as a
-succession of large rolling plains, interspersed in all directions by
-watercourses (_dongas_), which radiate from the bases of the
-table-topped mountains rising at intervals throughout this part of the
-country. These watercourses are as a rule about twelve to fourteen feet
-deep, and serve to irrigate the country, which seems prosperous and
-well-populated. What would be called a road in England does not exist in
-Zululand. The tracks made by the traders with their waggons answer the
-purpose. These tracks are, however, tolerably good, and experience
-proved that artillery could be moved almost anywhere, except in wet
-weather. Waggons could pass each other at almost any part of the main
-road from Utrecht to Ulundi, except at that portion leading across the
-Inhlazatye Mountain, which runs along a narrow ledge, and where it
-ascends the Intendeka table-land. Wherever the troops moved they came
-across numerous kraals, each kraal containing from eight to fifteen
-huts, and each hut ten to fifteen men. From Bemba's Kop they moved on
-the 20th to Wolpoint, as nearly as possible seven miles west of the
-White Umbolosi, and thence went on to Tunguin's Neck, where a laager was
-planned and completed. After a reconnaissance made by Colonel Wood on
-the 22nd, in which his troops had a slight skirmish with a small body of
-Zulus, suffering no casualties, and inflicting a slight loss upon them,
-he halted on the 23rd, and sent out strong patrols in the direction of
-the Ingwazini River. These men rode over an open plain admirably suited
-for cavalry operations, but found nothing but some deserted kraals and
-the dead bodies of some Zulus, who, it was subsequently discovered, were
-wounded at Isandula the previous day. On their return the party were
-fortunate enough to discover the whereabouts of a strong body, some 4000
-to 5000 Zulu warriors, who, it was imagined, were merely the nucleus of
-a force intended to surprise Wood's column. They were posted in a
-well-chosen position at a place called Tintas Hill, and when they moved
-down in his direction the following day, Wood had concealed a portion of
-his force so well, that he got them between two fires, and in about half
-an hour had killed about sixty or seventy of them, his own casualties
-being only two men wounded. It was during this action that information
-was brought by Captain Alan Gardner, who gallantly rode without any
-escort from Helpmakaar to Utrecht, notifying the terrible disaster of
-the 22nd, and the destruction of No. 3 Column. This news caused Colonel
-Wood to change his plans, and after a halt of a couple of hours, he
-turned back towards the Umbolosi, where his little force arrived at
-seven a.m. on the 25th. On Sunday (26th) he moved on to Ugaba Ka Hawana,
-where good camping-ground and a defensive position were chosen, and
-where the minor essentials of wood and water were in plenty.
-
-Colonel Pearson, who commanded No. 1 Column on the extreme right, had
-also been prosecuting his advance with the greatest vigour, and the
-results were in every way satisfactory, though already the tremendous
-difficulties of commissariat and transport had made themselves
-unpleasantly evident. This force assembled near Fort Stanger, and
-crossed the Lower Tugela on the 12th, having as nearly as possible 1500
-regular troops, consisting of eight companies of the old Buffs, under
-Colonel Parnell; six companies of the 99th, under Colonel Welman; one
-company Royal Engineers, and two 7-pounder guns. A naval brigade,
-however, which might be considered as a little army in itself, went with
-them, and were under Colonel Pearson's command. This force consisted of
-270 bluejackets and marines, under Captain Campbell, of her Majesty's
-ships "Active" and "Tenedos," with three of the new-pattern Gatling. Two
-hundred mounted infantry and 200 colonial mounted riflemen also formed
-part of the column, while the whole force was supplemented by Major
-Griffiths and about 2000 men of the Native Contingent. The crossing of
-the river was at first impeded by the rains, and another delay occurred
-at the lower drift, where the river was at least 400 yards wide, but all
-these difficulties were overcome, and after a week's delay a flying
-column was sent forward on the 18th in the direction of Ekowe, which is
-a mission-station not quite forty miles inland, and distant nearly
-seventy from the king's kraal at Ulundi. It was the intention of Colonel
-Pearson to establish here an entrenched post as a _point d'appui_ to the
-invading army. On the following day the colonel was followed by the rear
-division, escorting the heavy baggage, necessary though inconvenient
-_impedimenta_, as it contained stores and ammunition. The column of
-waggons extended for five miles, and it took the officers in charge all
-their time and the services of three horses each during the day to
-supervise its progress from inspan till outspan. Again, two days later,
-came the commissariat, and here imagination fails to describe the
-difficulties encountered. The subject of transport is one that must be
-considered in any future operations in Africa. The waggons must be
-stronger than those employed; the animals should be proof against
-sickness caused by climate, the tulip plant, and the tsetse fly, and
-this can be avoided by choosing one's own season for marching. The
-employment of mules would be much preferable to that of oxen, although
-in many books the converse is stated, the Dutch being infatuated in
-regard to the superior qualities of the latter. Mules, for instance,
-have this advantage over oxen. They can travel twenty-five miles a day
-with ease, while twelve or fifteen a day with oxen is considered good
-work; but, on the other hand, it must be remembered that a mule costs
-twice as much as an ox, apart from the cost of feeding. The mule must,
-of course, be fed on forage carried for him or bought on the road,
-while the ox will feed on the veldt, except during the three winter
-months, when his services are not often required. Two kinds of mules can
-be procured about Pretoria--the Montevidean and the home-bred animal.
-The latter is generally preferred, although no doubt the former is most
-tractable. There is an immense trouble in selecting oxen for
-campaigning, as none but those bred in the sour veldt of Natal or
-Zululand are of any use for such rough food and hard work; and, as a
-rule, these will live where others would die. The usual load is 7000
-lbs., placed on a waggon weighing 3000 lbs., and drawn by sixteen or
-eighteen oxen. The cost for oxen averages about 9_l._ each, but during
-this war they went up to 18_l._, and even 25_l._ Each waggon, with
-dissel-boom and yokes complete, costs at least 180_l._ The cost of mules
-will average 20_l._ each, and mule waggons 100_l._, with harness at
-5_l._ for each animal.
-
-The road, after crossing the river Tugela, crosses no less than four
-streams, and before reaching Ekowe passes through a broken bushy
-country. On the 22nd, the day on which Isandula was attacked, Colonel
-Pearson had a sharp engagement with the enemy at a place called by the
-natives Inyezane, about four or five miles beyond his camping-ground of
-the 21st. Major Barrow had been sent forward along a fertile valley
-which led to the Inyezane, when Colonel Pearson received a despatch from
-him, saying that he had selected a tolerably good place for camping,
-which he had carefully guarded by vedettes. On receiving this
-information the colonel at once rode on to the spot, and although he did
-not quite approve of the ground, as being too full of bush for an
-outspan, he decided to allow the waggons to be outspanned for two hours
-on account of there being no water near at hand. This was done to rest
-and feed the oxen, and to allow the men to have their morning meal.
-About eight o'clock, just as the waggons had begun to park, and while
-the officers were busy in directing the posting of pickets, scouts, and
-sentries, the advanced company of the Native Contingent, which had been
-scouting in front under Captain Hart, discovered the Zulus in force
-rapidly advancing over the slopes and attempting to gain the bushes on
-both flanks. They came on in skirmishing and extended order in the
-finest style, rushing from bush to bush in a steady but stealthy manner
-until within 100 or 150 yards of the outposts. Captain Hart's men, being
-in the open, had to bear the brunt of a heavy fire, and not without
-casualties, as they lost one officer, four non-commissioned officers,
-and four privates almost at once. These poor fellows, it is feared, were
-sacrificed, inasmuch as they did not understand the order to retire and
-seek cover, and concluded that it was their duty to remain in the open.
-The Naval Brigade was now ordered into action, and most ably they
-acquitted themselves. Two 7-pounders and two 24-pounder Naval Brigade
-rockets were smartly brought into action on a knoll at the base of the
-pass, but commanding the valley from which the flank attack was made.
-Meanwhile two companies of the Buffs and A and B companies of the Naval
-Brigade opened a heavy and well-directed fire upon the enemy, and
-effectually held him in check. This coign of vantage was occupied by
-Colonel Pearson, whence he directed the movements of his troops during
-the fight. All this time the waggons continued to park, and while the
-fire was kept up by Commander Campbell, Lieutenant Lloyd, with his guns,
-and Lieutenant Martin with the Buffs, two other companies of the same
-regiment which had been employed in guarding waggons were moved down,
-ready to clear the bush as soon as it was well shelled and swept with
-rockets and musketry. Colonel Pearson selected Captain Macgregor to
-undertake this duty, with the assistance of Captains Harrison and Wyld,
-who, getting their men into skirmishing order, and bringing their
-shoulders gradually forward as steadily as if man[oe]uvring at a
-field-day, sent the Zulu braves flying discomfited before them, and
-exposed them once more in the open to the hail of shot and shell which
-swept the plain. Colonel Welman, 99th Regiment, now took advantage of
-this favourable moment, when the enemy was demoralized, to send forward
-Captain Wynne and Major Barrow with the infantry. These, with
-skirmishers and flankers on the left, and supported by two
-half-companies of the Buffs and 99th, now moved forward at a steady
-pace.
-
-The Zulus, however, were not beaten, though evidently puzzled, and
-Campbell, who was in charge of the Naval Brigade, saw that they were
-making a flank movement on the left. This officer at once obtained
-permission from Colonel Pearson to take a portion of his men and drive
-out a body of Zulus who had obtained possession of a kraal about 400
-yards from the knoll. Captain Hart, with part of his Native Contingent,
-gallantly supported this movement. They managed to obtain possession of
-the high ground to the left of the Ekowe road, and effectually checked
-the enemy in their movement on the British left.
-
-But the gallant sailor Campbell was not satisfied with this partial
-success, and sent for further permission to follow up his _coup_ by
-driving on the foe to a more respectable distance. Colonel Parnell, of
-the Buffs, who up to this time had been acting as a sort of reserve with
-Captain Foster's company at the foot knoll, where Colonel Pearson
-remained throughout the action, had now an opportunity of mingling in
-the fray. Smartly deploying his men, he advanced at the double, and
-forming up on the right of the bluejackets, swept the heights beyond the
-kraal which a few moments before were crowned with savage warriors. This
-decided the action, as the Zulus, thoroughly distracted, fled in all
-directions, the guns making capital practice wherever a group collected.
-The last round from the rocket-tubes seemed to carry destruction and
-confusion amongst them, and was fired a little before ten a.m.
-
-Colonel Pearson and Colonel Parnell both had their horses shot under
-them, and several officers remarked that the fire of the Zulus was
-principally directed at the English leaders. The regiments opposed to
-Pearson were composed of the Umxapu, Umdhlanefu, and Ingulubi, and as
-near as could be judged, and from the information subsequently received,
-numbered about 5000 men. Of these at the very least 300 were slain,
-while the number of wounded, as a rule carried away into the bush, could
-not have been less than double that. Pearson's loss was eight killed and
-sixteen wounded, and of these were six officers and non-commissioned
-officers of the Native Contingent. The following day two companies of
-the Buffs, two companies Native Contingent, and a few mounted men were
-sent off to the help of Colonel Ely, 99th Regiment, who with three
-companies of his regiment was bringing up a convoy, much wanted, of
-seventy waggons of stores and ammunition, while on Saturday, the 18th,
-Major Coates started with fifty extra waggons to bring up more supplies.
-On the day after the Inyezane engagement Pearson arrived at Ekowe. The
-position was a strong one, and he immediately set to work to make it
-still more formidable. Water was close to the fort, and well under its
-fire.
-
-At this juncture news of the Isandhlwana disaster reached Colonel
-Pearson. After consultation with his officers, he decided to remain
-where he was, feeling confident that even without further supplies or
-reinforcements he could hold his position for at least a couple of
-months. All his waggons came in safety to the fort except five, which
-broke down and had to be abandoned. The mounted men and Native
-Contingent were sent back to save food, and there thus remained 1200
-British troops, having 320 rounds per man.
-
-The first failure in the carrying out of Lord Chelmsford's plans
-occurred to No. 4 Column, and proved the initial step to the crowning
-disaster of Isandhlwana. The right centre column, which should have
-operated simultaneously with Colonel Wood's force, was unfortunately
-composed almost entirely of natives, and these fellows did not succeed
-in getting over at the point directed in orders. As this column could
-not be brought over the river, a portion of it was left behind to keep
-open communications and guard the frontier, while the remainder, under
-Colonel Durnford, was moved up to Rorke's Drift to reinforce Colonel
-Glyn's command. The following day (12th) Colonel Glyn had his first
-brush with the enemy. Lord Chelmsford had joined this column, and after
-crossing the Tugela ordered out a reconnaissance by the Bashee Valley
-and along the road leading to Izpizi. Glyn took with him three companies
-of the 1st battalion 24th and one battalion 3rd Regiment Natal Native
-Contingent, while the mounted men, crossing the valley, went rapidly
-along the road leading over the Ngudu mountains, where high cliffs close
-in the gorge for more than three miles. Cattle and armed Zulus were seen
-on the heights, and some of the 24th and the natives were ordered to
-bear round to the right flank and cut them off. The skirmish which
-followed lasted about twenty minutes, and was a very smart affair. It
-resulted in the taking of the fastnesses and the precipitate flight of
-the Zulus, who suffered a loss of ten killed, three wounded, and nine
-prisoners taken, together with a quantity of cattle, horses, and sheep.
-Colonel Glyn's loss was two privates Natal Contingent killed, one
-officer of the same, Lieutenant Purvis, severely wounded; Corporal
-Mayer, Natal Native Contingent, severe wound in thigh. Four companies of
-the 2nd battalion 24th, and four companies of the 2nd battalion 3rd
-Regiment Natal Native Contingent, under Colonel Degacher, were now
-ordered by the General to advance up the Bashee and attack Usirayo's
-kraal, a place called Loxie, about two or three miles farther on. This
-place, situated in a wild and mountainous gorge or krantz, interspersed
-with caves, guarded by huge boulders, was completely explored by these
-men. In the meantime Russell and his mounted men had ascended to the
-summit of the Ngudu mountain, where they were fired upon at a distance
-of 90 or 100 yards. Sixteen of the Zulus were killed, and a very heavy
-thunderstorm came on during the fight. No signs could be observed of any
-Zulu force in reserve, and this was explained by the subsequent news
-that Usirayo had made a precipitate flight in the direction of the
-king's kraal. On the following day communications were opened between
-Wood's column and that of Colonel Glyn. The General's movements from the
-first appear to have been hampered by baggage and transport
-arrangements, and a similar reason delayed Colonel Pearson. Lord
-Chelmsford was present with this column when it moved from Rorke's
-Drift, and saw the site which was chosen by Colonel Glyn at Insalwana,
-ten miles on the road to the Indeni forest. He then left Colonel Glyn in
-charge of the camp, and on the same day moved, with a portion of the
-force, ten miles further on, to reconnoitre the country in front.
-Returning to camp that evening, without having had time to fully
-explore, the General, the following morning, sent out two separate
-reconnoitring columns, under the command respectively of Major Dartnell,
-who took with him the Mounted Police and Natal Volunteers, of which he
-is commandant, and Commandant Lonsdale with two battalions of his Native
-Contingent. Dartnell went along the same road as that explored by the
-General the previous day, while Lonsdale moved along the southern slope
-of the Inhlazatye range, towards a hill called Malaka's Kop. If
-possible a junction between these two bodies was to be effected; and, as
-soon as information could be obtained as to the situation of the enemy
-and the strategical features of the locality, both were to return to the
-headquarter camp. By some extraordinary oversight, neither of these
-reconnoitring columns seems to have been supplied with rations, while it
-was usual on such expeditions for the men to take preserved meat and
-three days' biscuit in their haversacks, supposing that mule transport
-cannot be had. On the afternoon of the Tuesday Major Dartnell sent an
-officer to the headquarter camp, to inform the General that he could not
-advance beyond the Insangu river, a small stream near Inkankla Mountain,
-as the Zulus were posted there in force. Dartnell, therefore, sent an
-orderly to call up Lonsdale with his Native Contingent, and sent to Lord
-Chelmsford to request a reinforcement of regulars to enable him to
-attack the enemy. His lordship did not consider it advisable to comply
-with this demand, as the daylight was almost gone, and the distance was
-long. A supply of biscuit was, however, sent out to the exploring party,
-who bivouacked at the foot of the Inhlazatye. During the night, however,
-Major Dartnell appears to have become aware of his critical position,
-and at half-past two on the morning of the 22nd (Wednesday), Colonel
-Glyn received a letter from him, saying that the Zulus had been strongly
-reinforced, and were now in his front in great strength. Instead of
-recalling the column, or at once pushing forward troops to its
-assistance, a delay took place, and a staff officer was despatched to
-ask Dartnell what he wished done. After some further lapse of time the
-General ordered Colonel Glyn to march to Major Dartnell's assistance
-with the 2nd battalion 24th Regiment, consisting of six companies, the
-mounted infantry, and four of Harness's guns. As this detachment would
-considerably weaken the camp, the General at the same time sent off two
-expresses to Colonel Durnford, who had been left at Rorke's Drift,
-telling him to move up at once to Isandula with his 500 native troops,
-250 of whom were mounted. The General then decided to accompany Colonel
-Glyn's force, and Lieutenant-Colonel Pulleine, 1-24th, was left in
-charge of the camp, with orders to defend it, pending the arrival of
-Durnford's natives. The actual fighting strength of Pulleine's force
-consisted of 2 officers, 78 men, and 2 guns R.A.; 1-24th Regiment, 15
-officers, 334 men; 2-24th Regiment, 5 officers, 90 men; mounted
-Europeans, 5 officers, 204 men; Native Contingent, 19 officers, 391 men;
-Natal Pioneers, 1 officer, 10 men; while Durnford, when he arrived very
-soon after, brought with him 18 officers and 450 men, thus making an
-aggregate of 772 Europeans and 850 natives, or in all 1622 combatants.
-On his arrival at the camp, Colonel Durnford, being the senior officer,
-of course immediately assumed the command.
-
-To the right understanding of what follows it is necessary to give a
-somewhat detailed account of the situation. The leading feature of the
-plain on the southern slopes of which the English camp was placed is the
-Isandhlwana, or Lion Hill. To the west it rises abruptly, forming the
-head of the crouching animal it resembles in shape; after forming the
-back it descends sharply to the east. At both ends are necks or ridges
-connecting the hill with the smaller undulations of which the more level
-part of the country consists. The road from Rorke's Drift passes over
-the western ridge, while on the north facing the camp was a deep ravine
-and watercourse. To the immediate right was a small copse; beyond this
-the ground was much broken, irregular krantzes and hills all covered
-with huge boulders continuing as far as the Buffalo river. To the left
-of the camp, at the distance of rather more than a mile, ran a long
-ridge towards the south, connecting it with the great Isandhlwana hill,
-having on its summit a plateau which, towards the east, opened on to an
-open and extensive valley. On the extreme left of the camp, looking
-towards the ridge, were pitched the tents of the Natal Native
-Contingent; between these and the next two battalions intervened a space
-of rather less than 300 yards; occupying the centre were the British
-regular Infantry, just above whom came the headquarters camp of Lord
-Chelmsford, and in close proximity the headquarters of the column. On
-the right were the guns and mounted corps lining the edge of the road.
-Soon after it came over the neck at the back of the camp the ground rose
-considerably, until the bottom of the precipitous Isandhlwana was
-reached: the camp therefore literally had its back to a wall.
-
-At six a.m. on the 22nd, a company of the Natal Natives was ordered to
-scout towards the left, the enemy having appeared in that direction.
-Whilst these were away Durnford arrived, about nine o'clock, with a
-rocket battery under Colonel Russell, R.A., 250 mounted natives, and 250
-native foot. News was now brought in that the Zulus in very large
-numbers were driving the pickets before them. A later messenger--a
-native without uniform, supposed by some to be a Zulu purposely sent
-with false intelligence--brought the news that the Zulus had divided
-into three columns, one of which it was supposed was about to attack
-Colonel Durnford's baggage, still on the road from Rorke's Drift, the
-other to harass Lord Chelmsford and Colonel Glyn's party in their rear,
-whilst the third was to hover round and watch the camp. Finally came the
-news "Zulus retiring in all directions." Colonel Durnford thereupon
-asked Colonel Pulleine to lend him a couple of the 24th companies, but
-he declined, saying his orders were to guard the camp, and he could not,
-under the circumstances, let them go without a positive command.
-Durnford then determined to go on with his own force, which he divided
-into three, one part being sent up the hill to the left (east), one to
-the left front, and the third to the rear, in the direction of Rorke's
-Drift, to act as an escort for the baggage not yet arrived. The rocket
-battery was of the party that proceeded to the front under Colonel
-Durnford in person, to a distance of four or five miles from the camp,
-but being unable to keep pace with the mounted force was soon left
-behind.
-
-The body of troops despatched to the left became engaged with the enemy
-almost immediately, and firing was soon heard all along the crest of the
-hill. In about an hour Durnford's mounted men re-appeared over the
-hills, hotly pursued by swarms of Zulus; at the same time the horsemen
-to the front were also driven back. These, after retiring steadily in
-skirmishing order for about two miles, came upon the remains of the
-rocket battery, which had been cut off and broken up, whilst a hand to
-hand engagement was going on with those who remained. It appears that
-Russell, whilst advancing with his battery, perceived a body of the
-enemy on his left, he fired three rockets with some effect; then the
-Zulus fired a volley, upon which the Native Contingent of infantry
-retreated, the mules were frightened, and disorder ensued. Taking
-advantage of this, the enemy charged down the hill, a _mêlée_ ensued,
-and Russell was killed. As the mounted men retired towards them, the
-Zulus retreated to their cover, and they, after making a final stand in
-a spruit about a mile and a half in front of the camp, were eventually
-driven in.
-
-As the cavalry on the left was being pushed rapidly back, Captain Mostyn
-was ordered to advance with two companies of 1-24th on the eastern neck
-of the Isandhlwana, where at a distance of about a mile and a half the
-Zulus were advancing in large numbers along the north of the
-Isandhlwana, to outflank the camp on the right, and with this wing of
-the foe they at once became engaged.
-
-Meanwhile the Zulu left rapidly, and the centre steadily, though more
-slowly, pushed forward, despite the artillery fire poured into them.
-Orders were now given for three companies of the 1-24th to occupy ground
-near the Native Contingent camp, facing the hill over which the Zulu
-force was streaming. These three companies were supported to their right
-front by the Natal Native Contingent.
-
-Immediately to the right of the Native Contingent tents came the guns,
-at a distance of about four hundred yards from the left, and rather more
-from the right, which was composed of two companies, 24th Regiment and
-the Mounted Corps, and which occupied the extreme right of the camp and
-rested on the road. The infantry, in extended order, were by this time
-engaged along the whole line, and were firing rapidly and steadily.
-Though the enemy fell in hundreds they kept advancing in apparently
-undiminished numbers. As rank after rank of the foremost were swept down
-others pressed on, till at length the companies of the 1-24th above
-mentioned had been driven back to within 300 yards of that portion of
-the camp occupied by the Native Contingent. A number of the native
-infantry now began a hasty retreat to the camp; their officers
-endeavoured to restrain them, but without effect. Captain Essex pointed
-this out to Colonel Durnford, who ordered him to take men to that
-portion of the field, and endeavour to hold the enemy in check. But
-before this could be executed the natives rushed back in the utmost
-disorder, thus laying open the right and rear of the companies of the
-first battalion of the 24th on the left and rear, and the enemy dashing
-forward at once poured in through this part of the line. In a moment all
-was disorder, and but few had time to fix bayonets before the Zulus were
-amongst them, using their assegais with terrible effect. Then followed a
-scene of utter confusion; horse and foot, black and white, English and
-Zulu, friend and foe, in a struggling, fighting crowd, pushed gradually
-through the camp towards the road, where the Zulu right already barred
-the way. Every man endeavoured to escape towards the Buffalo river, but
-this was almost an impossibility even for mounted men. The ground was
-rugged, broken with water-washes, boulder-strewn: ground over which an
-active native Zulu could progress even faster than a horse. In front ran
-the river, swift, deep, and fordless, sharp rocks, and deep water
-alternating. Not half of those who escaped from the camp succeeded in
-crossing this obstacle: many were drowned, many assegaied, some few
-shot, and so the pursuit continued right into Natal. The guns moved from
-right to left across the camp, and endeavoured to get on the Rorke's
-Drift road. This being occupied by the enemy, they turned off to the
-left, and coming to grief in a donga had to be abandoned. Major Smith,
-though wounded, managed to reach the Buffalo, but was there shot.
-
-Lieuts. Melvill and Coghill, seeing all was lost, made an attempt to
-escape on horseback with the colours of the 24th. Coghill succeeded in
-getting safely across the Buffalo, but Melvill was struck by a shot just
-as he was reaching the far bank of the river. Coghill, with heroic
-devotion, turned back to assist his less fortunate comrade--alas! only
-to share his fate. Their bodies were subsequently discovered in close
-proximity, and around them a group of dead Zulus. The colours which they
-had so desperately defended were also found in the bed of the river,
-saved from the degradation of capture and contamination by the hands of
-savages.
-
-In this sad affair there perished twenty-six Imperial officers and 600
-non-commissioned officers and men. The loss of the Colonial forces was
-not less terrible, twenty-four officers being included in the list.
-
-The following is a detailed list of the victims of that sad
-day:--1-24th, Col. Pulleine, Major White; Captains Degacher, Wardell,
-Mostyn, Younghusband; Lieuts. Hodson, Cavaye, Atkinson, Daly, Anstey,
-Porteous, Melvill, Quarter-Master Pullen, and five entire companies:
-2-24th, Lieuts. Pope, Austin, Dyer, Griffiths, Quarter-Master
-Bloomfield, and ninety men. Royal Engineers, Colonel Durnford, Lieut.
-McDowell, Captain G. Shepstone (political assistant to Col. Durnford),
-Lieut. Coghill, A.D.C. (to Sir Bartle Frere), Surgeon-Major Shepherd.
-The Mounted Police Carabineers and Volunteers lost forty-three out of
-seventy-one, including Captain Bradstreet, Lieut. F. J. D. Scott, and
-Quarter-Master Hitchcock. The Mounted Infantry lost thirty out of
-thirty-four. The N Battery 5th Brigade, Royal Artillery, under Major
-Stuart Smith, was destroyed (Lieut. Curling escaped), as also the Rocket
-Battery under Major Russell, R.A. 1st Battalion 3rd Regiment, N.N.C.,
-lost in officers, Captains Robert Krohn and James Lonsdale, Lieuts.
-Avery, Holcraft, and Jameson; Surgeon F. Bull, Quarter-Master John
-McCormick. 2nd Battalion 3rd Regiment, N.N.C., lost Captains Erskine,
-Barry, and Murray; Lieuts. Pritchard, Young, Gibson, Standish Vereker,
-and Rivers, Quarter-Master A. Chambers. The loss of material is put down
-at 102 waggons, 1400 oxen, 2 guns, 400 shot and shell, 1200 rifles,
-250,000 rounds of rifle ammunition, 60,000_l._ worth of commissariat
-supplies, a rocket trough, and a number of tents.
-
-Four special-service officers, viz. Captain Alan Gardner, 14th Hussars
-and Essex 75th Regiment, and Lieuts. Smith, Dorien, 95th, and Cochrane,
-32nd, together with Lieut. Curling, R.A., succeeded in escaping, and
-rode away to Helpmakaar, where a laager was immediately formed. The same
-night, as no other messenger could be found, and it was feared Wood's
-column might be cut off in rear, Captain Gardner started to give him
-timely warning. Riding all night, he reached Utrecht about four o'clock
-next day, thence despatching a messenger to Colonel Wood, he himself
-returned to Helpmakaar.
-
-The following account is of great interest as having been given by a
-Zulu deserter:--
-
-"The Zulu army, consisting of the Ulundi corps about 3000 strong, the
-Nokenke 2000, the Nkobamakosi, including the Uve, 5000 strong, the
-Umcityu 4000 strong, the Nodwengu 2000 strong, the Umbonambi 3000, and
-the Udkloko 1000--a total of 20,000 men in all--after an address from
-the king left the Nodwengu military kraal on January 17th, and proceeded
-on their march towards Rorke's Drift. On the 20th they halted for the
-night close by the Isipezi hill, and on the 21st, keeping to the
-eastward, they occupied a valley running north and south under the spurs
-of the Ngutu hill, which concealed that of Isandhlwana, distant about
-four miles nearly due west. The order of encampment was--on the right,
-the Nodwengu, Nokenke and Umcityu; in the centre, the Nkobamakosi and
-Umbonambi; on the left, the Ulundi and Udkloko corps. On the morning of
-the 22nd there was no intention of making an attack on account of some
-superstition as to the state of the moon, and they were sitting down
-resting when firing was heard by the Zulus on the right. This was at
-first supposed by them to be an attack on the centre, but a move being
-made in that direction this proved not to be the case; and it was soon
-found out that this was the whites engaged with Matyana's people some
-ten miles off to the left front. Just after the Zulus had resumed their
-position, and again sat down, a herd of cattle came past their line
-driven down by some of their scouts from the right. Just when these were
-opposite the Umcityu regiment a body of mounted men on the hill to the
-west were seen galloping and evidently trying to cut them off. When
-several hundred yards off, seeing the Umcityu, they dismounted, fired a
-volley, and retired. The Umcityu at once jumped up and charged. This
-example was followed by the Nokenke and Nodwengu on the right, as well
-as by the Nkobamakosi and Umbonambi in the centre, whilst the Undi and
-Udkloko formed a circle--as is customary with the Zulus when a force is
-about to engage--and remained in their position. With these were the two
-chief officers Mavamingwana and Tyugwayo, who after a short pause led
-away these centre troops in a north-westerly direction, and keeping to
-the north of the Isandhlwana performed a turning movement, unseen by the
-English through the nature of the ground. Thus the original Zulu left
-became the extreme right, the right the centre, and the centre the left.
-The two regiments forming the latter--the Nkobamakosi and
-Umbonambi--made a turning movement along the front of the camp to the
-English right, but became engaged before they could complete it. The Uve
-battalion of the Nkobamakosi had to retire till reinforced; and the
-Umbonambi suffered heavily from the artillery fire. Meanwhile the Zulu
-centre, consisting of the Umcityu (left centre) and Nokenke and
-Nodwengu (higher up on the right) under the hill, were making a direct
-attack on the left of the camp. The Umcityu suffered very severely from
-both artillery and musketry fire; the Nokenke from musketry fire alone;
-while the Nodwengu suffered least. When the camp was carried the
-regiments became all mixed up together; some pursued the fugitives to
-the Buffalo; the remainder plundered the camp: but the Undi and Udkloko
-made the best of their way to Rorke's Drift, in order to plunder the
-post there."
-
-It is now time to turn attention to the remainder of the troops that had
-left the camp before this sad event occurred.
-
-The force under Colonel Glyn, accompanied by Lord Chelmsford, moved off
-at early dawn, and had reached Major Dartnell by 6.15 a.m. The General
-at once took command, and ordered out scouting parties of mounted men to
-gain intelligence of the positions and strength of the enemy, who soon
-after showed in some force on the opposing heights parallel to the
-Inhlazatye Mountains. A general advance of the troops was made, and the
-enemy retired slowly, but without firing. The guns and 24th Regiment
-meanwhile moved up the valley, their left being protected by the Mounted
-Infantry, while the Mounted Police and Volunteers guarded the right
-flank. The main body of the enemy drew back in regular order and took up
-a position with great skill on the spurs of the Isipisi Mountain,
-distant about six miles, but Captain Shepstone, with his Natal
-Carabineers, managed to cut off about 300 of the stragglers and
-destroyed fifty of them. At nine a.m. a messenger, whose horse was
-panting and covered with foam, arrived before Colonel Glyn with a brief
-despatch from Colonel Pulleine, notifying that musketry firing was heard
-on the left front of the camp. Lord Chelmsford at once sent a staff
-officer, Lieutenant Milne, to an eminence from whence the camp and
-valley of Insalwana could be seen, and it seems that a delay of an hour
-took place while this officer was vainly scanning the horizon. The
-actual scene of conflict where Colonel Durnford was engaged with the
-Zulu army was five miles away, and hidden by some hills intervening
-between Lord Chelmsford's position and the British camp. The General,
-therefore, seems to have felt no apprehensions in regard to the safety
-of the camp, and continued his operations against the supposed main body
-of the Zulus.
-
-About two o'clock Lord Chelmsford was on the banks of the Amange stream,
-selecting a fit spot for a camp, he having already in the morning sent
-Captain Gardner back to Colonel Pulleine with an order to that officer
-to forward the camping materials of the party out on reconnaissance.
-While thus engaged a native on horseback galloped down from the opposite
-ridge saying that an attack was being made on the camp, and that he had
-seen heavy firing and heard the big guns. Lord Chelmsford immediately
-hastened to the crest of the hill, whence through a glass the camp could
-be plainly seen. All, however, seemed quiet: the sun was shining on the
-white tents; no signs of firing were seen, and the bodies of men moving
-about in the camp were put down to be English soldiers and friendly
-natives. Knowing how careful were his dispositions and how positive his
-orders for the defence of the camp, one and all of Lord Chelmsford's
-escort came to the conclusion that an attack had been made and repulsed.
-It was then decided that the headquarters camp should move to the spot
-selected on the Amange stream, whilst the General himself, who was
-anxious to know the details of the attack, should proceed back to camp.
-The Carabineers and the Mounted Infantry accompanied him: the 1st
-battalion 24th Regiment, the four guns, the Mounted Police and 2nd
-battalion of 3rd Regiment Native Contingent were left to form the new
-camp. During the first seven miles of the journey nothing occurred to
-excite the General's suspicion. Certainly some of the tents had
-disappeared, but then this was in accordance with the orders given in
-the morning. When about four miles from the camp he fell in with the
-Natal Native Contingent, which had been ordered to return many hours
-previously, but which seeing the camp attacked by forces superior to its
-own had wisely halted. In about half-an-hour they were met by a solitary
-horseman coming at a foot pace from the direction of the camp.
-Commandant Lonsdale, for it was he, rode up to the General and uttered
-the astounding words "The camp is in possession of the enemy." It
-appears that Lonsdale, who had been ill, being very tired was quietly
-returning from Glyn's column to the camp. He had crossed the small
-water-wash to the south of the camp and was jogging slowly along in a
-sort of lethargy, from which he was roused by the discharge of a rifle
-close to him. Looking up, he saw a native, who had evidently just fired,
-and him he imagined to be one of his own contingent indulging in
-reckless firing; so he pursued his way. Sitting in and around the tents
-were groups of red-coats, so he still kept on till within a bare ten
-yards of the tents. He then saw a great black Zulu come out of one with
-a blood-besmeared assegai in his hand. Gazing more carefully, he saw
-that black men, and black men only, were the wearers of the red-coats.
-The truth flashed on him: turning his pony sharp round he galloped off
-before the enemy knew what he was about. Not less than 150 shots were
-fired at him as he did so, but, providentially, he escaped to warn the
-General, who, without such warning, his staff and troops with him, would
-have walked unsuspiciously into the trap, and the whole force would
-probably have perished to a man.
-
-The General at once sent back to hurry up Colonel Glyn and his force,
-while Colonel Russell was sent on to reconnoitre the camp, which was
-found to be as Commandant Lonsdale had reported. On Colonel Glyn's
-arrival the whole force was disposed in fighting order, and moved
-rapidly across the plain, but could not arrive in the vicinity of the
-camp until after dark. All was found a wreck--corpses, broken tents,
-dead horses, oxen, and other _débris_ were strewed around; and the men,
-most of whom were without ammunition, and had not tasted food for
-forty-eight hours, were ordered to bivouac amidst the crowd of
-blood-stained relics which marked the day's slaughter. Our soldiers had
-covered more than thirty miles on the previous day without food or
-ammunition, and if resolutely attacked by the entire force of Zulus
-might have shared the fate of their comrades. The next morning,
-therefore, before daylight a sad retreat was effected to Rorke's Drift,
-where the first glad tidings were heard of the glorious defence which
-had been made by Chard and Bromhead, with their handful of men.
-
-It came about thus. Lieutenant Chard, with one sergeant and six men, had
-been left in charge of the ponts over the Tugela at this point. Close by
-was a commissariat depôt in charge of Lieutenant Bromhead and a company
-of the 24th Regiment. About three o'clock on January 22nd news of the
-disaster at Isandhlwana reached this officer, together with a note,
-saying that the enemy were advancing in force against his post, which
-was to be held at all costs. Chard immediately withdrew his small party,
-and in concert with Bromhead arranged for the loopholing and barricading
-the store-building and hospital, and for connecting the defences of the
-two by building walls of mealie-bags. At 3.30 an officer of Durnford's
-Horse with about 100 men came in, and was asked to send them out as
-vedettes; these, when pressed, to fall back and assist in the defence of
-the buildings. At 4.30 this officer returned with the news that the
-enemy was close at hand, that his men would not obey orders, but had
-galloped off to Helpmakaar. About the same time Captain Stephenson and
-his detachment of natives also withdrew. It was at once perceived that
-the line of defence was now too extended for the small force left, and
-an inner entrenchment of biscuit-boxes was made, and this had been
-completed to a wall two boxes high, when suddenly 600 of the enemy
-turned the hill to the south. They advanced at a run against the
-southern wall, and notwithstanding a tremendous fire reached to within
-fifty yards of it. Being here encountered by a cross-fire from the store
-they were stopped. Taking advantage, however, of some shelter afforded
-by the cookhouse and ovens, they kept up heavy musketry volleys thence,
-whilst the main body moved on to the left round the hospital, whence
-they made a rush upon the north-west wall and breastwork of mealie-bags.
-Meanwhile the mass of the advancing foe lined a ledge of rocks and
-filled the caves overlooking the English position at a distance of 100
-yards to the south, whence they too kept up a constant fire. Another
-party to the left occupied a garden in a hollow in the road, and also
-the bush beyond, which time had not permitted to be cut down. The enemy
-could thus advance close to the English works, and were soon in
-possession of one whole side of the wall, whilst on the other in a line
-extending from the hospital all along the wall to the bush they made a
-series of determined onsets. But each attack was met and splendidly
-repulsed with the bayonet, Corporal Schiess (N.N.C.) especially
-distinguishing himself. The fire from the ledge of rock and caves at
-length became so galling, that it was necessary to retire behind the
-inner line of biscuit-boxes.
-
-All this time the enemy had been trying to force the hospital, and at
-length they did set fire to the roof. The garrison defended the place
-room by room, bringing out all the sick who could be moved before they
-retired. Privates Williams, Hook, R. Jones, and W. Jones, 24th Regiment,
-were the last to leave, holding the doorway against the Zulus with their
-bayonets, their ammunition being quite expended. Five sick men, owing to
-the smoke and want of interior communication, had unfortunately to be
-left to their fates. Two heaps of mealie-bags were now converted into a
-sort of redoubt, and a second line of fire was thus obtained all round.
-Darkness now came on, and after several more furious attacks had been
-repulsed the defenders had ultimately to retire to the middle, and then
-to the inner wall of the kraal, east of the position they had at first
-held. The attacks continued all night, the soldiers firing with the
-utmost coolness, and never wasting a shot. At four a.m., January 23rd,
-firing ceased, and by daybreak the enemy were disappearing over the hill
-to the south-west. The ground was then patrolled, the arms of the dead
-Zulus collected, and the position strengthened as far as possible. About
-seven a.m. a large body of the enemy was again seen on the hill to the
-south-west, and a friendly Kaffir, who had come in shortly before, was
-sent to Helpmakaar to ask for assistance. However, about eight a.m. the
-British 3rd column began to appear, whereupon the enemy, who had been
-again advancing, fell back as the troops advanced, and Rorke's Drift
-Post had been saved.
-
-The number of English engaged in this action was eight officers and 131
-non-commissioned officers and men; of these fifteen were killed and
-twelve wounded, two subsequently dying of their hurts. The attacking
-Zulu force consisted of two regiments--the Undi and Udkloko--in all a
-total of something less than 4000. Of these 370 lay dead around the post
-on the morning that Lord Chelmsford so opportunely arrived.
-
-Surgeon Reynolds, Acting Commissary Officer Dalton, and Assistant
-Commissary Dunne were throughout conspicuous for their gallantry and
-coolness. Lieutenants Chard, R.E., and Bromhead, 24th Regiment,
-subsequently received the thanks of both Houses of Parliament for their
-heroic conduct, and were advanced to the rank of majors.
-
-So much has been said and written as to the cause of, and so many people
-have been held responsible for the Isandhlwana disaster that the subject
-cannot here be passed over in silence.
-
-The living no less than the dead have a claim to a full share of justice
-and truth; but remembering that the mouths of one party--"les morts qui
-ne reviennent pas"--are closed, we should be extremely careful in
-drawing any conclusion from acts which, could the testimony of the
-fallen be obtained, it would not only explain and excuse, but amply
-justify.
-
-The court of inquiry held at Helpmakaar found itself unable to form from
-the available evidence any positive judgment; but the facts disclosed
-point irresistibly to a negative conclusion. Had the troops acted on the
-defensive, the camp would not have been lost.
-
-Still there may have been cogent--nay irresistible reasons which caused
-Colonel Durnford to push forward his forces. Were Colonel Pulleine
-alive, he might give equally good reasons for acceding to Durnford's
-urgent request and sending out the reinforcements.
-
-The British regular infantry advanced successfully, retired slowly and
-in unbroken order; they were still firing rapidly, coolly, and with
-great effect. Things though desperate were by no means hopeless.
-Suddenly the native levies, "though their officers tried to restrain
-them, rushed back in the utmost disorder," thus exposing the flank and
-rear of the regulars. "Few of the men had time to fix bayonets before
-the enemy were amongst them, using their assegais with terrible effect."
-Here is the answer to "How did it happen?" The natives on one side--the
-Zulu--were regarded too lightly; on the other, fighting for the English
-with too great confidence. "Why," it will be asked, "were not the
-waggons laagered? Whose duty was it to see this done?" Lord Chelmsford
-had issued a standing order at the very commencement of the campaign,
-that this was to be the first consideration in all camps. Lord
-Chelmsford, accompanied Colonel Glyn from Rorke's Drift, saw the site
-chosen at Isandhlwana, and then immediately started on a reconnaissance
-which lasted till after nightfall. Doubtless Lord Chelmsford supposed
-Colonel Glyn had done what was necessary. On the following morning with
-the first streak of dawn Colonel Glyn was ordered to proceed to Major
-Dartnell's assistance, and Lord Chelmsford determined to accompany him,
-after despatching an express to Colonel Durnford ordering him up "to
-strengthen the camp." Doubtless Colonel Glyn supposed that Colonel
-Pulleine would see to laagering the waggons. Colonel Pulleine was in
-command of the camp a bare three hours, and doubtless, knowing how brief
-his tenure of office was to be, preferred to let things remain as they
-were till his successor's arrival. Colonel Durnford had not been a
-single half-hour in camp before the action was commenced.
-
-It is asked why did not the troops form squares? Hastings, we are told,
-had Harold's men only remained in their position, would have been a
-Saxon victory--Torres Vedras a disgrace instead of a glory had the
-British troops been rashly taunted into leaving their trenches: and
-Waterloo a more glowing theme for Beranger's lyre had Napoleon been able
-to entice the patient English squares to forsake their adamantine
-formation. But why was Colonel Durnford to form squares? How was he to
-imagine that such an immense force was arrayed against him when the
-Commander-in-chief had with him a superior force to that left in the
-camp avowedly to operate against the enemy's main body? For such his
-information and personal observation led him to believe was the force
-against whom he and Major Dartnell were acting.
-
-Colonel Durnford was no novice in South African war; like Cæsar, he had
-the gift of the pen no less than the sword; he had both written and
-fought well. Colonel Pulleine was an experienced officer of no mean
-reputation, and by whatever device they were deceived, we may be sure
-that it was no ordinary one, and that few would have stood where they
-fell.
-
-Again, who could have anticipated the attack? We have it from the lips
-of a Zulu that the onset was unpremeditated, and the result of accident.
-With all humbleness, let it be confessed that--
-
- "Our indiscretion sometimes serves us well
- When our deep plots do fail; and that should teach us
- There's a divinity that shapes our ends
- Rough hew them as we will."
-
-Another question, often asked, is, "Why did not Lord Chelmsford,
-immediately on his return, make a counter-attack on the enemy." First of
-all he had to wait for Colonel Glyn and the main body to come up to
-him. Meanwhile darkness had come on. When Glyn arrived he did advance
-with his troops formed up for action, and with the intention of
-re-taking the camp, which he had every reason to suppose was occupied by
-the enemy. The event proved they had abandoned it. Was not this a good
-reason for striking a blow? Let the facts of the case be well borne in
-mind. Lord Chelmsford knew that there was a large force in his rear; the
-force that had sacked the camp was supposed, and reasonably enough, to
-be on the right flank. In front were the bright watchfires of another
-force, and the blazing hospital at Rorke's Drift, which, together with
-Helpmakaar, there was every ground to believe had been captured and
-looted by the foe; in a word, his force was surrounded. The men had only
-fifty rounds of ammunition apiece; they had been twenty-four hours
-without food; they were physically exhausted by eighteen hours'
-continuous marching, and no less morally by the loss of their camp;
-their probabilities of escape were distant. How could a general lead
-troops in such a condition against a foe flushed and elated with spoil
-and recent victory?
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER III.
-
- Ekowe described--The fort--Guard for the frontier--Raid on
- Dabulamanzi's Kraal--Another raid--Life in Ekowe--Wood at Potter's
- Kraal--Capture of Baglusini--Skirmish and capture of
- cattle--Destruction of Manyanyoba Kraal--Colonel Rowlands--Capture
- of Makatees Kop--Junction with Wood--Camp at Kambula--Coming in of
- Oham--Disaster at Intombi Drift--Death of Moriarty--Rescue of Oham's
- wives and people--Events that led to the attack on Umbelini--The
- Zlobani--The attack--Details--Death of Campbell--Narrow escape of
- Wood--Death of Weatherly--St. Helena and H.M.S. "Shah."
-
-
-We must now return to Pearson, whom we left entrenching himself at
-Ekowe.
-
-The position is a most commanding one, being almost on the summit of the
-Tyoe range, and more than 2000 feet above the sea level; and for beauty
-of site could scarcely be surpassed. To the north, about a mile and a
-half, is the Umlalazi river, at that time rather full from the late
-rains, and beyond this stream are long undulating grassy plains, almost
-devoid of bush, with the exception here and there of a few wild and
-dwarf date-palms, and lichens in the hollows. Behind, to the south, is
-the Umkukusi range, and a hilly but open country, while on the west is a
-very broken and difficult country, bounded by the Hintza forest. Away to
-the east, right to the coast at Port Durnford, is about forty miles of
-undulating and here and there hilly country. About 1200 yards to the
-south-east there is a rocky eminence at least 600 feet higher than the
-fort, and from this place a magnificent view of Port Durnford and the
-mouth of the Umlalazi can be seen. The sea is not more than twenty-two
-miles off, in a line as the crow flies. The original building was
-formerly a Norwegian mission station, and when the present war began it
-was abandoned by the missionaries and plundered by the Zulus. The
-buildings, when Pearson arrived, consisted of three moderately-sized
-brick erections, thatched originally with straw, but subsequently
-covered with a less inflammable material. In addition to these
-buildings, which were utilized as stores, there was a small church,
-built of the native-made sun-dried bricks, and covered, as most of these
-edifices are in that country, with corrugated galvanized iron. The
-church was turned into an hospital, while the tower made a capital
-look-out, from whence could be seen the next post, and which afterwards
-proved of such service in the way of signalling. Pearson now began to
-suffer the inconveniences of a regular siege; his communications were
-cut, and it was found that of the twelve messengers belonging to the
-Natal Native Contingent sent from Ekowe with letters during the first
-week in February, only one arrived, the others having been intercepted
-and killed on their way. The fort soon completely changed its character
-under the incessant labour bestowed upon it by Pearson's men, under the
-vigilant supervision of their chief. It now became a six-angled
-enclosure, about sixty yards wide, having a ditch eighteen feet in
-depth, while its breadth was twelve feet. At the bottom it was studded
-profusely with assegai heads securely planted, and the parapets,
-carefully rivetted, were proof not only against any musketry fire, but
-field artillery. From its southern angles ran out two well-built curtain
-walls, enclosing a fine kraal for cattle and horses. These curtains were
-well protected by the fire of the angles from which they sprung, while
-the kraal itself had its own massive gateway and drawbridge. At the end
-of the kraal, or cattle enclosure, furthest from the angular fort, was
-constructed from the remains of a dilapidated magazine, a kind of
-irregular redoubt, which also had a deep ditch and thick mud walls,
-defended by a quantity of powerful thorns laid along the parapet. It was
-most fortunate that this force brought with them a large supply of
-well-selected entrenching tools, consisting of shovels, picks, spades,
-billhooks, axes, and crowbars. Day by day, whenever their time could be
-spared from patrol and outpost duty, the men were employed in making
-entanglements of rows of felled trees, as well as constructing fascines,
-filling sandbags, turning out gabions, loopholes, and _abattis_. All
-these obstacles possessed the usual requisites. They were under the
-close fire of the fort, were covered from the enemy's fire, and gave him
-no cover; while they were all made so substantially that they could not
-be cut down or removed without immense difficulty. The piquet duties
-were rather severe, and each piquet had to furnish two or three double
-sentries in reliefs, patrols, and links. They were posted under the best
-circumstances obtainable, being sheltered from the enemy, having a good
-range in front, with every advantage in retreating if attacked in force.
-Each face or front of the fort was cleared up to 800 yards; shelter
-trenches were made for the first line of defence; cover was left for the
-supports and reserves; ranges were marked and measures taken for the
-artillery and rifle fire, and all precautionary arrangements made in
-regard to the supply and storage of provisions, forage, water, and
-ammunition.
-
-The water was good, and not brackish at that time of the year. It was
-taken from a bright stream well under the fire of the fort, and fed by a
-capital spring, also under fire of one of the seven-pounders. The church
-and the storehouses were also carefully loopholed, and sandbags
-furnished to make the defences more secure. These three strong loopholed
-buildings, forming part of the _enceinte_, were rendered more formidable
-by double planking, backed crossways by iron barrel hoops, while fine,
-damp, heavy sand from the neighbouring hill was employed in filling
-bags, made from old provision sacks.
-
-Every man in the fort had his proper place assigned to him, and at
-exercise it was found that with three minutes' notice each detachment
-was in its place. The Buffs were told off to the two northern faces, on
-which side there was a well-made _caponnière_ thrown up in the
-re-entering angle. At the west angle of this fort one gun and a
-detachment of the Royal Artillery were posted, while on the east salient
-were two guns and a somewhat stronger number of men. Here there was a
-small outlet for water-parties, guarded on the flank by a little
-loopholed building, and commanded in the rear by a strong building with
-a thatched roof. The rocket tubes were placed under charge of the Royal
-Marines, on the south-west front, and could, if necessary, sweep the
-trek oxen laager, and slaughter oxen laager outside the fort on that
-side. The principal gateway was on the west face, and was guarded by a
-company of the Buffs, who loopholed the church tower in their rear to
-fall back upon, and to act as a commanding flanking fire. The front,
-facing due south, was served by the 99th, with one gun at the salient
-angle, a _caponnière_ in the centre, guarded by a Gatling, and with a
-thirteen feet stockade at the opposing angle. Another strong building,
-also thatch roof, commanded this front. Not a day passed but some
-improvement was made in strengthening these works, and this as much for
-prudence against possible attack, as to keep the men occupied and free
-from the lassitude attendant upon long confinement. It should also be
-mentioned that torpedoes had been laid down by the bluejackets for three
-miles along the bed of the Tugela, so that if the Zulus attempted to
-cross near any of the posts of observation they might be somewhat
-astonished.
-
-The ration daily used to be two pounds of beef--fresh killed and tough
-as leather--a couple of commissariat biscuits--hard as flint--a very
-small complement of coffee or tea, sugar, and one spoonful of lime
-juice, which every man had to take whether he liked it or not; preserved
-potatoes, compressed vegetables, and an occasional ration of beans, made
-a little variety now and then. During the last days of the siege the
-meat and biscuit ration was reduced. A day's routine was as
-follows:--The men rose with the _réveille_ at four a.m. for a parade of
-all hands and fatigue duties for a couple of hours, weather permitting:
-the breakfast bugle sounded at eight, and fatigues were again performed
-from 9.30 till noon; dinner bugle at 1.30, and rest and recreation till
-4.30, and finally "retreat" at 6.30, when no one was to be outside the
-walls. The men amused themselves with quoits, cricket, and athletics,
-some of the Buffs being good "all round;" while all the officers,
-especially the colonel, encouraged these pastimes by example as well as
-precept. After all, the life was not more monotonous than that on board
-ship. There was no lack of ammunition, as Colonel Ely on march to Ekowe
-had to abandon only ten waggons, and these were looted. The rest,
-however, arrived safely. The garrison also from time to time received
-valuable and most reassuring information regarding the disposition and
-whereabouts of their friends along the line of the Tugela, and in their
-rear. At Fort Pearson, which might be said to be the principal base of
-operations, and which commanded the river and lower drift from the Natal
-side, there were sufficient men of the Naval Brigade to work the two
-guns there. They had also the European officers and the non-commissioned
-officers of the disbanded native corps. Then, to keep up communications,
-the Mounted Volunteers of Coast District were posted at intervals along
-the river, between Fort Pearson and Kranz Kop. Another fort on the Zulu
-bank of the Tugela was called "Fort Tenedos," in compliment to the
-detachment which formed its garrison. Major Barrow, with a squadron of
-mounted infantry, and Lieutenant Kingscote, with a smart body of
-marines and bluejackets, formed the defensive force. At Rorke's Drift
-there were now five companies of the 2nd battalion of the 24th Regiment.
-A strongly entrenched position had also been formed on a commanding site
-called Macdonald's Farm, on a rocky eminence overlooking the Tugela.
-Ditches ten feet deep were cut, parapets seven feet high thrown up, the
-farmhouse itself strengthened, and all the garden walls loopholed. The
-garrison consisted of the Stanger Mounted Rifles, and some native
-auxiliaries, who proved most trustworthy as scouts and messengers.
-Captain Lucas, whose admirable powers of organization were quite
-proverbial amongst the colonists, and whose frontier experiences were of
-long standing, was strongly posted at a bend of the river between the
-farm and Thring's Post, and had with him a useful body of natives.
-Thring's Post came next on the list, and here there were a couple of
-hundred of well-mounted and well-armed volunteers divided into
-squadrons, or corps of fifty men. Thring's Post is on the Imyamazana
-Mountain, and is about twenty-seven miles from Fort Pearson. The
-volunteers, knowing the country well, were employed in keeping up by
-constant patrols communications with Fort Pearson and Fort Cherry.
-
-News also reached them that Wood had been reinforced, and was more than
-holding his own. There was, therefore, little anxiety felt for the
-security of the frontier, and everything strengthened Colonel Pearson in
-his determination to remain in his position instead of attempting to cut
-his way out.
-
-The health of the Ekowe garrison continued very good. The hospital, it
-has been said, was the old church of the mission-station. At the end of
-the second week in March there were only twenty-five men on the
-sick-list, and many of these almost convalescent. They had, however,
-lost two of their number lately, namely, poor Williams of the Buffs, and
-another great favourite, young Coker, the mid-shipman, who fought his
-Gatling so well at Inyanezi. Both these fine fellows were ill but a
-short time, and succumbed to fever. They were buried with the usual
-honours just outside the fort.
-
-Lieutenant Rowden, 98th Regiment, who was nominated by Colonel Pearson
-commander of the mounted scouts, performed his difficult and dangerous
-task to perfection. He had by the end of February successfully explored
-the country in the direction of the Isangweni military kraal, which was
-not far from Ondini, and about three miles from Ekowe. He reported that
-there were 1500 men there, and more collecting. The 1500 were composed
-of the married regiment Isangu, whose average age is fifty-four, and
-whose services in former wars had been most distinguished. The country
-between the fort and Isangweni was an undulating table-land, running
-parallel to the forests on either side, and admirably suited for
-cavalry. Another brother of Cetywayo, named Dabulamanzi, had a fortified
-kraal not far from that of Isangweni, and Pearson determined to attack
-both those places as soon as he was in a position to move upon them.
-
-The second week of March had now come to an end, and it was deemed
-advisable to vary the monotony of life in the fort by one or two
-offensive expeditions. The most important of these, both as to the
-numbers engaged and its effects, was the foray on Dabulamanzi's kraal.
-The forces detailed for this expedition consisted of fifty men of the
-Buffs, the same number of the 99th, and twenty-five of the Naval
-Brigade, with their Gatling, and a small body of mounted scouts, under
-the active Lieutenant Rowden (98th). Starting about five a.m., the party
-descended the slopes that led to the river, and continued its march
-along a valley running north-east, and gradually narrowing. The track in
-some places was crossed by difficult spruits, and was scarcely defined;
-but their guides were well acquainted with the landmarks, although the
-pathways were often obliterated by thorns and bush. The track was also
-frequently commanded by spurs and bluffs projecting overhead, but these
-were carefully explored by the mounted men, and no enemy could be seen.
-A considerable watershed was reached about eight miles from Ekowe, and
-here, in a favourable and secluded position, was made the first
-off-saddle for half an hour. The country about here was entirely denuded
-of fodder, but the horsemen had been fortunately directed to bring a few
-mealies for their mounts. On resuming the march they crossed the bottom
-of a deep sandy nullah with very precipitous sides, which they were
-forced to follow, as it was the only practicable track. About a mile and
-a half further on the advanced patrols sent back to inform the officer
-of the main body that there was a camping-ground or temporary kraal
-about three miles and a half north, where there was sufficient water and
-grass. The orders were therefore given to push on for this point, and in
-about forty-five minutes it was reached. It was now sundown, and their
-chief, having decided that it was inexpedient to march during the
-night, orders were issued for the usual precautions to be taken, and to
-bivouac till daybreak.
-
-During the night, however, no one slept, as they had several alarms, and
-it became evident from certain indications known to the experienced in
-Zulu camping-out, that they were being reconnoitred by the enemy, though
-in all probability not in sufficient force to deliver an attack. As,
-however, it was quite possible that messengers would be despatched to
-the neighbouring kraals, it was deemed advisable to strengthen the
-position, in case of their being surrounded before the morning. Taking
-one of the guides, who said he knew the neighbourhood, from having
-frequently hunted here, one of the officers and a couple of men were
-sent to make a reconnaissance round the bivouac. This party at once
-started without making any noise, and entering on the old watercourse
-worked their way up towards the summit of the kloof. Large, indeed
-enormous, blocks of stone were lying about in various directions, and
-the water during the heavy rains had so far worked its way among these
-rocks that several hollows were scooped out so as to form caves large
-enough to hold one or two human beings. These places had evidently been
-recently occupied, remains of mealies and the charred wood of a recent
-fire indicating the use to which the shelter had been applied. Ascending
-the kloof still farther, and keeping well under cover of the bush, these
-scouts walked along what at first seemed an old war-path, and this being
-examined it was evident that it had been worn by human beings, and not
-long since. On following this path, it led to a small piece of
-table-land not much larger than an ordinary mess-tent or marquee, and
-this platform was formed by a solid piece of rock rising, not unlike the
-Pieter Bot at Mauritius, to a couple of hundred feet above where the
-explorers were standing. To the eye of a soldier the place was
-impregnable, and as the scouts scanned the country round by the fitful
-gleams of occasional moonlight they saw that twenty well-armed and
-steady men could hold the rock against an army. The face of the rock had
-been scooped out, and, either by time or human labour, a sort of cave or
-shelter afforded additional protection. Upon leaving the rock and
-descending the ravine to carry the intelligence to the column in
-bivouac, these patrols were startled to see the outlines of several dark
-figures moving in the neighbouring bush. Making all possible speed,
-therefore, the messengers hurried back, and at the news received every
-man stood to his arms. They had not long to wait, for the enemy soon
-appeared, drawn out in clear relief against the grey of the early dawn,
-which was now coming on. Bodies of Zulus on the opposite ridges, which
-could not have been seen lower down, were now observed, while a few
-cattle were being rapidly hurried away in the distance. The Zulu scouts
-were evidently puzzled at the white men's proceedings, the more so as
-before leaving the kop one of the guides had tied his handkerchief to an
-overhanging branch, thus giving the enemy the idea that a detachment had
-been left to occupy the post. This error on the part of their
-antagonists served the troops materially, as, by hurrying forward at a
-quick pace, they were enabled to gain the kop, and with some
-considerable difficulty get their Gatling to the summit. Their horses,
-of course, could not ascend, but halfway up there was an excellent
-position, where grass and water were found, and here the animals were
-tethered in the usual manner--by the head and knee. When daylight
-enabled them to examine the surrounding country with field-glasses, they
-could see the neighbouring kraals of the chief Dabulamanzi and his
-neighbour, Ungakamatue, and it was evident that the alarm had been
-given. Several extraordinary movements attracted their attention. Armed
-bodies of natives were seen to be leaving the villages in various
-directions, as if going upon messages of importance. Aware of the
-celerity of movement of the Zulus, and the enormous distances their
-soldiers can cover in a few hours, this activity was not reassuring, as
-it was concluded that reinforcements were being sent for, for the
-purpose of intercepting the retreat to the fort of Ekowe. The English
-commander, however, was not long in choosing his plan of operations. It
-would never do to sustain a siege on the rock or kop, which, however
-defensible if provisioned, was sure to be taken by starvation in the
-long-run. The Dabulamanzi kraal had evidently been weakened by the
-absence of men harvesting, and it did not seem more than a mile from
-where the troops were. One of the guides remembered a cattle-track
-which, by a circuitous route, led back on the eastern side to Ekowe, and
-as the road they had arrived by was certain to be now ambushed, it was
-deemed advisable to make a dash at the kraal, and return with what spoil
-they could obtain in the new direction. Having cut some long canes, some
-of the soldiers fixed them securely between the ledges of the rocks,
-and attached to them some coloured clothes, which they hoped would lead
-to the belief that they still occupied the kop. These precautions having
-been taken, the troops moved silently down through the dense bushes on
-the reverse side of the cliff, and succeeded in getting away without
-being observed by the Zulus, who evidently seemed principally anxious
-about their cattle. Part of the mounted force went in front to explore
-the bush, while the rest remained in rear to follow and reconnoitre. On
-coming again to the valley, they moved still more rapidly until they
-came to a little rise, which, on surmounting, they found led to a deep
-kloof, the mouth of which was almost closed by the proximity of the
-hills, on either side rising to about 600 feet in height. These
-curious-looking hills appeared to be a series of ledges of rocks, with
-lines of dykes--probably of volcanic origin--cropping up, and forming
-the most natural-looking breastworks, behind which a determined party of
-men might destroy any attacking party. Having waited to collect the tail
-of the column, they descended the rise, and sending out a few men to
-scout on the ridge skirting the hill on their right, the commander led
-the main body under cover of this range towards the mouth of the kloof,
-which the guides said was the main entrance to the kraal. When about 200
-yards from the mouth of the gorge, the enemy commenced firing upon the
-advanced files from behind a formidable-looking dyke, and seeing that
-one of the horses had been badly wounded in the quarter, an officer sent
-up a dozen men to the top of the range to extend as a covering party.
-These had barely been posted in a good position, when a perfect shower
-of bullets fell amongst the main body, the only casualty being, however,
-one man struck by an almost spent bullet. It being thus seen that they
-were out of range as far as any material injury could be effected, the
-men were directed to keep moving along the flank, while the Buffs
-advanced along the valley in a parallel line, closing to their centres
-as they neared the mouth of the kloof. At the same time, the men of the
-Naval Brigade (twenty-five) were detached with their Gatling towards the
-foot of the left-hand hill, to see if there was a path by which the
-kraal could be taken in reverse. This left-hand hill seemed to be the
-key of the position, as it looked down upon the kraal itself. The 99th
-were all this time held in reserve to prevent the troops being taken in
-reverse should the enemy's reinforcements come up. While the English
-were effecting these movements the Zulus, whose forces did not seem to
-be augmenting, kept up what would have been a hot cross-fire had they
-been armed with Martinis, but which was perfectly innocuous at 700
-yards.
-
-A bugle-call now gave notice to the skirmishers to close in, and when
-this was effected the mounted men dashed through the kloof, followed by
-the Buffs and the 99th at the double. The Naval Brigade meanwhile was
-seen working its way in the most energetic manner round the left flank
-and ready to effect a junction with the others at the foot of the mound
-on which stood the outer defences of the kraal. A general stampede of
-men, women, and cattle now took place, the soldiers being specially
-warned not to fire at the two latter, and only at the former in return.
-In ten minutes the outer and inner circles of the kraal were fired,
-care having been taken to see that no living creature was hidden within.
-As the Zulus generally store their mealies (Indian corn) underground in
-the cattle enclosures, there was not time to look for any supplies, but
-they managed to carry off a few large packages which were found in two
-huts, as well as some millet (Kaffir corn). They also collected all the
-cattle they could find, not many having been left, and getting them
-together in the centre of the column, moved away by the path mentioned
-by their guides. These movements were conducted so quickly, that they
-were on the homeward march within half an hour of the time they had
-entered the kraal. About half a mile from the kraal the kloof separated
-into two narrow gullies, the ledges of rock between them being
-inaccessible, and as it was known that these paths made a junction some
-two miles on, it was decided to use them both, to enable the troops to
-march more quickly. The Buffs accordingly took one trek, and the 99th
-detachment the other, both uniting again without any casualty later on.
-The English attack was undoubtedly a complete surprise, inasmuch as the
-bulk of the people belonging to the kraal were away, and could not be
-recalled in time to defend their village. Had the British column
-possessed a larger force of mounted men, they could have intercepted and
-carried back the cattle which they saw the attendants driving off. As it
-was, however, it was not safe or prudent to risk the chances of
-communications with the fort being cut off by delaying to pursue these
-animals.
-
-The column had made good about ten miles of the return march when they
-discovered that their retreat had been found out; straight in front of
-them also were wooded krantzes and dark ravines, where an army of Zulus
-might have been concealed, but pioneers having been sent out reported
-that all was safe in that direction. Upon this they used the utmost
-speed to gain the friendly covert, as they saw that if pursued there was
-the best chance of eluding the vigilance of their enemies; or if unable
-to do this, they would have the opportunity of fighting them to the best
-advantage. As the troops moved quickly on, they entered the forest and
-lost sight of the Zulus, who seemed in force, and were apparently
-retracing their steps for some mysterious object. They were not,
-however, kept long in doubt as to their proceedings, for upon sending on
-scouts to an eminence where they could see without being seen, it was
-found that the whole Zulu force, apparently some 2000 strong, was upon
-the crest of the hill over which they had passed. An advanced party of
-skirmishers were running very rapidly, their shields held aloft, and
-their assegais waving over their heads. They had discovered the trick
-played upon them, and the ruse of the coloured cloths planted upon the
-kop. When, however, they could not discover the spoor upon the direct
-trek by which the English party had come, they lost a considerable
-amount of time in casting about to make out their real direction. At
-last, however, when crossing a bit of open veldt, the keen-sighted Zulus
-observed their cattle being carried away, at least five miles from them.
-The rage of the pursuers, and their contempt for the marching qualities
-of British soldiers--compared to their own speed and powers of
-endurance--no doubt made them confident of overtaking them; but the
-latter had little apprehension of the result, even if this were
-effected. They knew that as soon as their foes came within range, they
-could pick them off at 1000 or 1200 yards, and the little column had
-been specially furnished with several crack marksmen to whom this
-distance was no difficulty. They continued their march therefore
-steadily, and did not abandon the cattle, which, strange to say, gave
-little trouble, and were kept at a good pace by some of the mounted men,
-whose anticipation of a full beef ration on their return, from the
-spoil, made them doubly zealous in their duties. In about an hour the
-Zulus had gained considerably upon them; they were imprudent enough to
-move in close order. The evening was, however, now drawing on, and in
-another hour the troops should be under the guns of the fort. A mist,
-which had been for some time hanging about the streams and the kloof,
-prevented the exact progress of the pursuers being seen, but the pursued
-were not long without intimation of their whereabouts. The rear-guard
-were attracted, when about three miles from the fort, by what seemed to
-be dark objects moving between some rocks about half a mile on their
-left rear. So fitful was the view obtained, however, that the men were
-uncertain whether they were Zulus or some of the larger species of
-baboon, which often come out of their holes and caves to look at any
-human creature passing by. A steady watch was, however, maintained, and
-before many minutes they could plainly see that a large body of the
-enemy had, by the most tremendous pedestrian feat, succeeded in getting
-almost on a level with them, in a position to assail them in flank. The
-column had not long to wait, for as they came to a portion of the trek
-they could not avoid, on account of the proximity of a deep morass on
-the right, the pursuers, deeming them within range, treated them to a
-volley which rattled up to about fifty paces short of their flank. Ten
-of the mounted men, all excellent shots, were now sent out to cover the
-attacked flank, and, as far as they could, to harass the enemy. The
-ground was difficult and broken, but this was no impediment to these
-gallant fellows, who, gaining a commanding position 500 yards from the
-Zulus, and where there was admirable cover, dismounted, and kept up such
-a galling fire that the Zulus retreated, as if waiting for their main
-body to come up. As the mist rolled away, they could distinctly be seen
-carrying off their dead and wounded with improvised stretchers of
-branches of mimosa. A running fire was now kept up, the English shot
-taking deadly effect, while no casualty occurred to their men. For more
-than half an hour this went on, until the fort was sighted, and as the
-Zulu main body had not come up, the flanking party drew quietly off.
-
-The sun was sinking in the horizon as the returning soldiers received
-their well-earned welcome from their beleaguered comrades, who were
-beginning to be somewhat anxious as to their safe return.
-
-Pearson's next raid was a most brilliant affair. It was found out from
-reliable sources that a body of Zulus had charge of a convoy of cattle,
-intended for the king's kraal at Ulundi. Deeming the Ekowe garrison as
-of no account for more than defensive purposes, the Zulu general had
-merely detailed 400 or 450 men to form the escort, which was known to
-be on its march not more than seven miles to the north-west of Ekowe,
-not far from the Inyezani river. Now here Pearson had an opportunity of
-achieving two objects at one stroke. He wished to explore the land and
-salient features of the country towards Inyezani, in order to see
-whether a road could be made by which the dense bush of Hintza could be
-avoided, while, at the same time, he could inflict a lesson upon the
-Zulus, and possibly obtain some cattle. The foray was not to be on such
-a grand scale as that made on Dabulamanzi's kraal, but it was intended
-to be equally important for military purposes. Twenty men of the Naval
-Brigade, all the small force of acting engineers, forty of the Buffs,
-twenty of the 99th, and the mounted scouts were placed under orders to
-parade before daylight on Friday, 21st March. No Gatling was to
-accompany, as the utmost celerity of movement was required, and if the
-expedition did not succeed in its first dash an immediate retreat upon
-the guns was to be made. On leaving the fort at 3.30 a.m., the road by
-which the band advanced was found to be good, although here and there
-commanded from the neighbouring mountains. About two miles from Ekowe a
-bluff runs out from the spur of the range of hills which had often
-served as a reconnoitring point, and this was immediately occupied by
-the mounted men, who had orders to keep up signalling both with the fort
-and the rest of the expedition. Continuing on its march, the column came
-to the Inyezani river, which for several miles runs between two
-remarkable mountains, the bases of which are clothed with luxuriant
-forest growths, while above spring sheer precipices 1000 and 1100 feet
-high. The formation seemed to be sandstone and limestone, affording
-excellent material for building purposes. Before reaching these dark
-solitudes the river passes through a country undulating and fertile, and
-the horizon is closed by higher hills, covered in the most part by
-forest. These forest-trees are of fine growth and of the most valuable
-description. The banks of the river are fringed by a quantity of
-bamboo-looking reeds, which serve as wattles in the district, and which
-are about the thickness of a finger, and some ten or twelve feet high.
-Tracks of hippopotami are occasionally seen, and it is known that such
-are in the neighbourhood. The river here is about 200 yards broad, while
-the depth averages twenty-five feet. The expedition now noticed a few
-deserted kraals on the right bank, while those on the left were found to
-be in ruins, as if lately destroyed. At eight a.m. a herd of cattle was
-seen some two miles off, and rapidly skirting the base of a friendly
-hill the troops managed to cut in between these animals and a body of
-Zulus, who appeared to be bivouacking in front of some neighbouring
-caves, where fires were lit and cooking was going on. The mounted men,
-who were observing these movements, now descended from the bluff where
-they had been watching, and coming up rapidly at a canter, made a dash
-at the Zulus, to cover the infantry retreat, which they effected with
-the capture of some thirty-five fine cattle. A desultory fire was kept
-up upon them from the hills during their return, and the enemy, who
-seemed to be gradually augmented, at one narrow gorge managed to get
-within range, slightly wounding two or three of the rear-guard. By noon
-on the same day the men with the captured cattle were safely discussing
-their frugal dinner, consisting of an extra half-ration in honour of the
-event, within the old fort, which they were already beginning to look
-upon as a friend from whom they were soon to part.
-
-In spite of the rapidity of the raid, the necessary observations were
-made by the officers deputed for this duty, and a rough sketch of the
-ground passed over gave all the information requisite for the
-construction of the projected road. This work, which was forthwith taken
-in hand, had a most satisfactory effect upon the spirits of the garrison
-generally. The working parties were occasionally driven in, but not
-without inflicting loss upon the enemy, whose attention was much taken
-up in guarding and patrolling the main road by which Pearson came.
-
-Wood, it has been mentioned, fell back upon receiving the news of
-Isandhlwana; but this retrograde movement was of short duration, and
-from that time till all was ready for the relief of Ekowe, his was the
-only column acting on the offensive.
-
-From the 25th January to the 1st February his marches and countermarches
-afford little matter of interest. On the 28th he moved on to a new
-camping-ground, called Potter's Store, and there obtained full
-particulars of the Maglisini or Baglusini Kraal. This place Colonel Wood
-had for some time known as one of the principal rallying-points and
-depôts of supplies for the Zulu armies. Large quantities of "mealies"
-(Indian corn) and grain of other sorts were known to have been
-accumulated at this magazine, while cattle in large droves had been
-seen on their way to the depôt. Under these circumstances it was
-necessary to proceed with caution, as, had any ostentatious preparations
-been made for an advance in the direction of the magazine, it is more
-than probable Wood's object would only have been gained at a severe
-cost. In this view it was determined that a cavalry raid should be made
-by the mounted troops under Piet Uys, with his Burghers, and Colonel
-Buller, with his dashing corps of Frontier Light Horse. From the camp
-near Potter's Store to the Baglusini stronghold was at least thirty
-miles. A plain suitable to the passage of cavalry intervened before the
-Manzana river was reached, and Colonel Buller saw no reason why the
-distance should not be covered in one day. The kraals of Umbelini and of
-Inyatini were also in the same neighbourhood, therefore the utmost
-caution and secrecy were necessary in making preparations for the
-attack. The weather had been most unfavourable for some days, but
-fortunately cleared up, and became settled on the 1st of February. On
-that morning Colonel Buller, having selected on the previous day 106 of
-his best mounted men and thirty-three of the Dutch Contingent under Piet
-Uys, their commandant, paraded his men under the supervision of Colonel
-Wood, and explained to them clearly the feat they were about to attempt,
-not concealing the danger which they would have to incur in the
-performance of a most difficult and dangerous duty. The scene was a most
-dramatic one, as the camp lanterns lit up the faces of the bronzed and
-stalwart volunteers who formed the devoted band. Each man was
-exceedingly well horsed, and no precaution had been neglected in the
-careful overhauling of arms, accoutrements, and saddlery. Biscuit and,
-for those who cared, a little ration of rum were served out, and with a
-hearty "God-speed" from their comrades, who half envied their chances of
-adventure, the little troop of 141 gallant fellows started long before
-the earliest streak of dawn. The utmost silence was ordered and
-maintained, while the ground for some miles was so favourable that the
-horses' hoofs were scarcely heard as they cantered over the light and
-springy veldt. Distances on horseback are so differently estimated out
-in South Africa and at home in England, that when the ground is
-favourable, very long, and to European experience almost impossible,
-marches are constantly made without distress to horse or rider. In the
-present instance two short off-saddles only were indulged in; the first
-not far from the centre of the flat, and the next after the Manzana
-river had been safely crossed. The country now became more broken and
-the pace was reduced to a walk, but before the sun was well up the goal
-was in sight, and the herds of cattle were seen calmly feeding on the
-slopes. No suspicion would seem to have been excited, and it is more
-than probable that the very smallness of the attacking force, and its
-being all composed of the mounted branch, contributed to the success of
-the affair. The kraal was exceedingly well built, and seen from a
-distance of 1200 or 1000 yards it was doubtful whether it held a large
-guard or not. Cautiously yet swiftly advancing, Colonel Buller felt his
-way, with a few of his best shots thrown out as vedettes. These men soon
-encountered some scattered Zulus, who did not seem at all prepared for
-any hostile demonstration, but on retiring towards the hills they were
-reinforced by several other larger bodies, who had evidently been sent
-out to reconnoitre. After a few shots had been fired, a sudden and
-simultaneous advance was made on two sides of the kraal, and almost
-without resistance on the part of its defenders the kraal was captured.
-Two hundred and fifty well-built huts were counted by Buller's men, who,
-losing not a moment, collected no less than four hundred head of cattle,
-and a large quantity of grain, and then set fire to the magazine. Six
-Zulus were killed in the capture of the place, and although more than
-one body of them were seen hovering about in the vicinity, numbering
-severally 100 to 200 and 300 men, no opposition was offered to the
-rear-guard or patrols.
-
-Wood then again moved his camp to the White Umvolosi. His position here
-was a remarkably strong one, and from it he commanded the passage of the
-White Umvolosi, the Pewana, while his day and night patrols held the
-disputed territory south of the Pongolo. A raid was next made in the
-direction of the Insulwa Kraal. The men got upon the road about seven
-a.m., and steady marching for about three miles brought them opposite
-the spot where, a few days before, a large force of Zulus had been seen
-engaged at drill. A scout who had been sent out on the right front came
-galloping back with the news that the Zulu cattle were in considerable
-numbers at the lower end of the valley, while he also added that the
-guard over these animals was not much larger than the English party.
-Piet Uys at once concerted with a couple of his smart non-commissioned
-officers, and decided, as they were exceedingly well mounted, to ride
-for the kloof which formed the exit to the valley. To execute this
-man[oe]uvre was the work of ten minutes, during which they were hidden
-from sight of the Zulus by a tall ledge of scarped rocks which almost
-divided the valley. In the meanwhile the remainder moved steadily on at
-a walk, so as not to alarm their prey. In rather more than half an hour
-they had so far gained upon the cattle that they could make a tolerable
-guess as to their probable number, which was estimated at a couple of
-hundreds. The main body had now arrived at a place which Piet Uys and
-his Dutchmen seemed intimately acquainted with, and the Zulu cattle and
-guard could be seen on a ridge running parallel to the one they
-themselves were upon. Below was a deep kloof leading to the river. Some
-of Buller's Horse were now sent round to the opposite side, to drive the
-enemy down the kloof to the main party, while they continued to march
-down the ridge to meet these men as they came on. But they had not
-advanced very far when, as was expected, a much larger force appeared on
-the neighbouring heights, but the cliff was so precipitous they could
-not join their comrades. The seven-pounder was now brought into action,
-and sent a couple of shells right in amongst them, one of the rounds
-being a capital shot. Advancing still, the English leader saw that the
-enemy lately on the heights had managed, by making a détour, to get to
-the cover of a dense mimosa bush on his left. This move was answered by
-several rounds of canister, which it was afterwards found were not
-without effect. The foes were thus driven out into the open, and at one
-moment it seemed as though they were going to fight; the Boers, however,
-who had been detached to the neck of the valley now served their
-comrades by an excellent ruse. They had taken with them one of the bugle
-boys of the 13th, mounted on a wiry Kaffir pony, and the main party now
-heard coming across the valley the echoes of his bugle sounding the
-advance. The Zulus could not make out the meaning of this sound, and
-evidently imagined that the English commander had posted at least the
-wing of a regiment to intercept them. The consequence was, that the
-moment the main body cantered forward with a bold front, the cattle were
-abandoned; and they were left masters of the field, taking 170 head and
-some few wounded prisoners. Two villages were left in flames behind the
-retiring troops, who, as the crackling and flashing approached the bush
-where the hills met the plain, could see individual forms of black
-warriors shouting and gesticulating from out of the dust and smoke, wild
-with impotent rage at the loss of their kraal and cattle. The ridges
-beyond the gullies still afforded considerable shelter, and the English
-party were continually fired upon as they returned with their spoil; but
-it was evident that the Zulus had not any long-range weapons, as it
-could be seen from the splashes of dust how far short their bullets were
-falling. Ten of Buller's men were now sent on to cover the passage of
-the guns through the drift, and in about twenty minutes, and under the
-protection of the rear-guard, it was passed over in safety.
-
-On the 15th, Wood was fortunate enough to destroy the great military
-kraal of Manyanyoba. Several reconnaissances had been made by Colonel
-Wood's directions, and from the local knowledge of one of Piet Uys's
-men, Colonel Buller was enabled to carry out the instructions of his
-chief with a success fully equal to the most sanguine expectations. The
-stronghold in question was situated on the Intomba river, and had always
-been considered by Cetywayo and his Indunas as a place of more than
-ordinary strength. At ten p.m. on the 14th the men were got under arms,
-and the column was composed of a strong detachment of Buller's Horse and
-fifty of the Burgher Volunteers under Piet Uys, whose services had on
-more than one occasion been most handsomely mentioned by Colonel Wood.
-The men paraded without lights, bugles, or the slightest sound, and
-moved off silently into the bush, without even the jingle of a sabre or
-the clank of a chain. Their march was accompanied by one gun, the wheels
-of which were, however, carefully wrapped with cloth and bound with raw
-hide. This was not only a protection against sound, but a preventive to
-injury to spokes and axles from the sharp boulders and rocks in the bed
-of the drift. The column left the camp by moonlight, crossing the usual
-ford, and were fortunate enough to gain the shelter of the bush without
-being seen or heard in the neighbouring villages. After a couple of
-hours' marching they reached a wide plain, where there was a broad
-watercourse, but sufficiently shallow to be easily forded. Here the gun,
-as the early grey of the morning came on in the sky, was brought into
-position, and here the final instructions were given to the men. As the
-daylight grew more marked there could be seen in front a long unbroken
-range of mountains, varying in height from 900 to 1000 feet. This range
-ran along the valley leading to the smaller kraals in the distance. Half
-the cavalry were now sent away by Colonel Buller to the left, with
-instructions to gain the bush, and wait dismounted until the shells were
-heard. They were then to dash forward at a swinging canter and cut off
-the cattle to be seen feeding on the slopes, which man[oe]uvre would, if
-carried out, drive them into the hands of Piet Uys and his men posted on
-the right. Just as the sun began to appear above the horizon the gunners
-managed to hit off the range to a nicety, and the second shell crashed
-and burst right into the centre of the interior circle where the cattle
-were placed at night, and which is usually surrounded by the
-beehive-shaped huts where the Zulus live. It was at once perceived that
-this shot had caused the wildest commotion, as it was immediately
-followed by smoke and flame, figures rushing about through the village,
-the bellowing of oxen, and the shouts of men. As the horsemen advanced
-at a gallop towards the kraal, the enemy, firing a random and hasty
-volley, fled up the sides of the mountain, where cavalry could not
-follow. All the huts and stores along the base of the mountain were now
-destroyed without much resistance, although as soon as the Zulus got a
-little vantage-ground on the cliffs, they turned, and replied to the
-English fire. Four hundred head of cattle and a quantity of sheep and
-goats were brought off by Buller's men, who behaved with the most
-admirable coolness and steadiness. The fight had lasted about half an
-hour, when indications of reinforcements to the Zulus were observed.
-Seeing that nothing more was to be gained, and that he might lose the
-cattle, Colonel Buller gave the order to make good the retreat, covered
-by skirmishers and a rear-guard. This movement was skilfully effected
-without loss, and the column reached the camp early in the afternoon,
-having been about eight or nine hours in the saddle.
-
-Meanwhile, to strengthen Wood's hands, the Commander-in-chief had
-ordered Colonel Rowlands to join that general. Rowlands at this time had
-with him, at his entrenched camp at New Derby, only a wing of the 80th,
-a couple of guns, and 200 Swazis. Raaf's Horse and Weatherly's Borderers
-were, however, expected daily to reinforce him. In the meantime,
-Rowlands was not allowing the grass to grow under the feet of his men,
-for, on the same day that Wood destroyed the Manyanyoba Kraal he left
-his camp at Derby and marched on to the Talako range, where he knew the
-enemy were in the numerous caves hidden by dense bush. The operations
-were entirely successful. Five large kraals, some of them of great
-natural strength, were burnt to the ground, 197 cattle, seventy goats,
-and forty-five sheep were captured. Magalini, the chief, was killed,
-with ten of his men, while defending one of the caves. One Zulu prisoner
-was taken, and forty women and a number of children came in and claimed
-protection. Six of the Swazi allies, under Fairlie, were wounded, and
-one horse killed.
-
-On a still more recent occasion Colonel Rowlands had shown even greater
-activity. On the 20th February intelligence was brought to his camp that
-a small force of Zulus had been left in charge of supplies at Makatees
-Kop, a natural fortress close to Elozo, and intended as a depôt for
-future operations. The place was by no means easy of access, and
-apparently innumerable difficulties were mentioned to dissuade the
-colonel from any hostile attempt. On the date just named (20th) the
-detachment sent forward as a sort of advanced guard by Colonel Rowlands
-reached one of the mission-stations still left on the border. There was
-a laager consisting of a simple stone enclosure, bastioned, however, and
-loopholed, and situated on the bank of a running stream of bright and
-clearly sparkling water. In the dead of night the sentries were heard to
-challenge, and the sergeant on guard at once called his men to arms.
-This alarm, however, proved to be merely the return of some mounted
-Boers who had been sent on to reconnoitre on the previous day, and the
-information they brought in was important. The kraal which they had been
-seeking was about twenty miles off and supposed to be only held by about
-fifty Zulus, belonging to the regiment of Nkobamakosi, and part of the
-Undi or Royal corps. A large number of cattle were not supposed to be
-yet there, but some were coming in daily, and it was considered
-advisable to break this link in the enemy's communications. In the early
-morning, preceded by a few horsemen (many were coming in as volunteers
-to both Rowlands' and Wood's column), and marching with only their
-haversacks full of rations for two days, the little expedition started
-for a duty uncertain and believed to be full of risk. Eight European
-officers, 275 natives, partly Swazi allies, and some volunteer horse,
-the whole under command of Captain Harvey, staff officer, formed the
-reconnaissance; but, as it turns out, a smaller force would have
-sufficed. From the post or laager at the mission-station the road lay up
-a narrow valley, from which, after an ascent of about 200 feet, it
-stretched out on to a wide grassy plain ten miles in length. On the left
-of this could be plainly seen a number of Zulus tending sheep and cattle
-on the hills. Crossing part of the Iwangovini district, and fording a
-drift on the Inpongo river, the Iembe mountain could be seen always to
-the right; while the Eloso, a rocky height, loomed in front. At the
-bottom of a steep, rocky, and heavily bush-grown gorge, fourteen miles
-from the laager, a halt and short off-saddle were made, and every
-precaution taken against surprise. From this point to the stronghold the
-pathway was most difficult, and the men had to proceed with the greatest
-caution, in case of an ambush, which was half suspected. Two columns of
-smoke, one from a steep krantz on the left and another lower down on the
-right, were noticed, but these were afterwards found to be abandoned
-camping-grounds of the enemy, who fancied the British force was much
-stronger than it really was. On nearing the kraal, and on turning an
-angle of the gully, the column came in sight of the first village, which
-was as usual fortified in the Zulu fashion. As the foremost files dashed
-on, a couple of shots rang out and some assegais were thrown, causing a
-couple of casualties amongst the Swazis, who, however, showed a bold
-front, and, gallantly led by the European officers, carried the kraal by
-a rush. The results of this skirmish may not appear of great importance,
-but, taken in conjunction with Wood's recent successes, they had a most
-useful effect upon both the minds of the regular soldiers and those of
-the colonial volunteers.
-
-The junction of Rowlands' column with Wood's was the next eventful
-incident in the history of the latter force. It was found, of course,
-impossible for Wood with so small a column and with so few cavalry to
-keep an efficient and reliable watch over the lengthy border he had to
-defend, and the result was that a Zulu force managed to effect a raid in
-the German settlements over the Pongolo. Commandant Schermbrucker had
-hitherto done remarkably well in keeping his line of defence intact, but
-his want of mounted men seriously hampered him, and enabled the Zulus to
-elude his vigilance. A serious raid happened on the 11th February; but
-Schermbrucker came up with the marauders as they were retiring with
-their booty, recaptured some of the cattle taken, and killed about a
-dozen of the enemy. On the 13th a large Zulu force managed to cross the
-Pongolo, and steal past the fort and laager of Luneberg. This was in the
-dead of night, and by daybreak they had burnt a number of huts belonging
-to natives friendly to or in the employment of the Dutch. The savages
-rushed in thousands upon the kraals and single huts, setting the roofs
-on fire and massacring old people, women, and children who could not
-escape. They deliberately tortured to death about a score of old men,
-killed in the most brutal manner at least fifty women and an equal
-number of children, while they left several young women fearfully
-stabbed with assegais. All this took place within five miles of the
-fort; and as fire-arms were not employed, the attention of the sentries
-was not aroused. Early in the morning one of the wounded managed to
-effect his escape, and brought this terrible news to the laager, and
-measures were immediately taken to follow and punish the band. Patrols
-were ordered out, and the utmost diligence exerted to overtake the
-enemy, who, it was known, was overladen with spoil. Before the Tombe
-river was reached, the leading patrol came up with a portion of the
-enemy's rear-guard, and a very pretty fight took place. The Zulus
-numbered about 450, but they were embarrassed by the cattle they had
-charge of, and this did not allow them to make a good stand. The
-consequence was that the Boer patrol killed twenty of their foes, put
-the remainder to flight, and won back a number of the stolen cattle. The
-rest, however, managed to escape over the Tombe, and the patrol were
-wisely ordered not to pursue. These raids were principally due to the
-activity of both Umbelini and Manyanyoba, and were the immediate cause
-of the expedition to attack and burn the kraals of the chiefs on the
-Intombe river. It should be mentioned that Umbelini was a Swazi refugee,
-and not even a legitimate chieftain of that tribe, but was regarded by
-the real headmen as a mere adventurer and pretender. Manyanyoba's
-people, again, were not Zulus, but the _débris_ or remnants of various
-tribes conquered by Chaka and Dingaan. They wandered about in a starving
-condition, landless, and without flocks or wealth of any kind, until
-Cetywayo, from compassion, allowed them to settle north of the Pongolo,
-and on the banks of the Tombe river. This very land was mentioned in the
-ultimatum sent by Sir Bartle Frere to the king, who had no right
-whatever to cede any portion of it.
-
-Wood next moved his camp to the Kambula Kop, and there entrenched
-himself in a position of great natural strength. There now occurred an
-event of considerable importance. Oham, brother of Cetywayo, had always
-declared himself opposed to war, had openly stated his opinion in Zulu's
-councils, and had ever since the outbreak of hostilities been making
-overtures of friendship to the British. These, however, had been but
-lightly treated, as suspicions of their honesty were entertained by the
-powers that were. How groundless were these suspicions the event proved.
-On the 2nd inst. Oham came into the camp of Captain M'Leod, the
-political agent on the border of Swaziland, arrived at Derby on the 4th,
-and came on thence to Wood at Kambula a couple of days back, and
-declared his complete submission to her Majesty's Government.
-Immediately before leaving his kraal in Zululand the chief took the
-precaution to try and save some of his best cattle, and he subsequently
-sent a thousand head of his finest herds into the Swazi county; but they
-fell into Dutch hands, and some of the Boers, obtaining possession of
-them, had the audacity to brand them as their property before M'Leod
-could arrive to claim them. Oham had with him between 300 and 400 of his
-people, and was accompanied by his eldest son, an intelligent lad of
-fifteen, who soon made himself an object of great interest in Wood's
-camp, and a favourite with the soldiers. Immediately on his arrival he
-had an interview with, and was received with great respect by Colonel
-Wood, who was informed by him that he would have surrendered some time
-back but for two reasons. In the first place, he was under a system of
-espionage by the orders of the king, with whom he had never been on good
-terms since he openly, before the Indunas, spoke against the warlike
-attitude and aggressive tone of his brother; and, secondly, when he did
-make his first overtures for submission, he was told that he was not
-believed by the English, and would be cast into prison, and sent to
-Robbin Island as a convict.
-
-Oham was a black ikehla (head-ringed man), resembling both his father,
-the late Mpanda, or Panda, and his brother Cetywayo, and although a
-large man, his body and muscles were firm, not flabby like those of so
-many other big Zulus. After the usual salutations he thus opened his
-interview with Wood:--
-
-"Sir, chief, and great warrior, whom I respect, because you fight
-against men, and do not kill women or children, I came here to your camp
-from a desire to see you, and to ask you to intercede for me and my
-people, who have never wished to make war upon you, but to live in peace
-and goodwill, and hunt the wild deer together. I have left more than two
-thousand of my people ready and most anxious to come in and submit to
-you, surrendering their arms and cattle, and giving their sons as
-hostages, if you will guarantee their safety."
-
-The chief, who had a dignified manner and an honest expression of
-countenance, was then informed that he and his people should receive
-every consideration, and as much protection as was consistent with the
-safe advance of the English troops into Zululand. He then assured Wood
-that the Zulu army was considerably demoralized, and that, the people
-having gone back to their kraals, Cetywayo found it no easy task to
-collect a really effective fighting force. With some difficulty,
-indeed, the king had managed to get together a strong impi, composed of
-the Udhlambedhlu, or "Ill-tempered" Regiment, whose kraal was at
-Udhlambedhlweni, about six miles east of the Usixepe, to exercise a
-surveillance over Oham and his people. This corps, however, was formed
-originally from a clan, or tribe, which were Dingaan's chief and
-favourite regiment, and although in a measure loyal to their then ruler,
-they were somewhat indignant at the duty imposed upon them, when they
-would infinitely prefer the chances of raiding and plunder, which the
-present unsettled state of the border presented. Now, when Wood was at
-Utrecht the previous autumn, a letter was sent by the Landdrost Rudolph
-to the Secretary for Native Affairs, in which he mentioned the arrival
-of Gwegwana, the favourite messenger of Uhamo or Oham, with letters from
-that chief to the following effect, which Oham now repeated to Colonel
-Wood:--"I am sent back by Uhamo to hear what answer his father, Somtseu
-(Sir Theophilus Shepstone), has sent to his message brought by me on the
-10th October last. Uhamo is very anxious to know what is going to take
-place in the land now that Cetywayo has called the whole of Zululand
-together, and Uhamo has refused liberty to his people to assemble at
-'Ondi,' and will openly tell Cetywayo that if he (Cetywayo) makes war
-upon the English, he (Uhamo) will not join him, because Cetywayo's
-people, Sirayo and Umbelini, have, by their overt acts, brought the
-country into its present state of trouble and disgrace. Moreover, the
-building by Cetywayo's orders of a military kraal on the Pongolo, and
-the claims made by him of a portion of the Transvaal beyond the Blood
-River, which had been, as Uhamo repeatedly told Cetywayo, ceded many
-years ago to the Transvaal people, and other acts, had never received
-any countenance from Uhamo, who now asks, Why does Cetywayo want to
-quarrel with the English, who have ever been his friends, and who,
-indeed, placed him on his present throne?"
-
-In his second interview with Colonel Wood, Oham was still more explicit
-and demonstrative. He expressed himself with much indignation at his
-brother's countenancing such a despicable character as Umbelini, who,
-neither a pure Zulu nor a Swazi, had all the vices and none of the good
-qualities of either; and he added that the degradation which his brother
-had brought upon the race of Chaka by such an unworthy alliance has
-caused him to lose much of his former popularity. Oham also added that,
-in case of the continuance of the war, rather than be compelled to fight
-against his old friends the English he would at all hazards bring his
-people bodily over to that Government, and under these circumstances
-claim their protection. "Uhamo loves peace as his father Panda did,"
-said the chief in conclusion, and his open and honest-looking eyes
-seemed to corroborate this expression.
-
-We now come to another sad event, which though less in magnitude, is in
-many points similar to the Isandhlwana disaster. Major Tucker, the chief
-officer at Luneberg, gives this account of the affair:--Captain
-Moriarty, with a company of the 80th, was ordered to march from Luneberg
-on the 7th March, for the purpose of bringing in twenty waggons from
-Derby, variously loaded, which had arrived at the Intombi Drift.
-Earlier in the month Major Tucker sent down to the Drift, which was not
-more than four miles off, a small escort to await the arrival of these
-waggons. Believing, however, the position a perilous one, owing to the
-proximity to Umbelini's kraal, on the 5th he ordered it to return. On
-the 7th, however, the waggons, which had all but been captured on the
-way down, did arrive at the Drift, and Moriarty was again sent with
-seventy men of his company to act as escort and assist in getting the
-convoy across the stream, which was considerably swollen by the
-continued rains. The Drift was only four miles from the stronghold of
-the renegade Swazi freebooter, Umbelini, who had of late given so much
-trouble, and Moriarty had orders to neglect no precaution, and above all
-to laager his waggons and keep an incessant and vigilant look-out. It
-was ascertained from survivors that the waggons were actually parked,
-but in a somewhat loose and careless fashion, and that no earthworks
-were thrown up around the camp. For several days the river continued in
-strong flood, and consequently no crossing could be effected. On the
-11th it was reported by the native waggon-drivers that Umbelini's people
-were gathering in the neighbourhood. The camp was pitched in a most
-dangerous position, with its face towards some high ground, covered here
-and there with dense bush, while its rear was resting upon the swollen
-river, across which Lieutenant Harward and thirty-four men were posted.
-No particular precautions appear to have been taken, with the exception
-of a sentry being posted about fifteen paces from the front of the camp,
-on the Derby side. When first warned by the drivers, Moriarty ordered
-the men to stand to their arms, but only for a short time. On the
-morning of the 12th, at four o'clock, a shot was heard from the
-unfortunate sentry, who had barely time to call "Guard, turn out!" when
-dense masses of the savages were seen not more than two hundred yards
-from the camp. Their front extended for several miles, and they could
-not, by the lowest estimate, have been less than 4000 or 5000 strong.
-Lieutenant Harward, who had been on the _qui-vive_, and who had
-carefully placed his thirty-five men under cover of his solitary waggon,
-at once called his detachment to arms, and made what dispositions he
-could to open fire upon the enemy's flank. In less than ten minutes,
-however, the whole valley was swarming with the savages, who at once
-proceeded in their usual manner to surround and overlap the camp and
-waggons. In less time than it takes to tell, the camp was in their
-hands, and the majority of the soldiers were assegaied, many of them
-before they could leave their tents. The fight, or rather butchery,
-which ensued was soon over, and, in spite of a well-directed and
-well-sustained fire from the Luneberg bank of the river, the enemy
-followed up the men, and assegaied them as they endeavoured to swim the
-river. Harward, seeing the enemy crossing the river in large numbers,
-gave the order to his men to retire slowly. Then, jumping on the back of
-his horse, he galloped away at full speed to Luneberg, where he reported
-what had happened. The savages continued to cross the stream, and coming
-on in dense masses, for a short time a hand-to-hand fight took place,
-ending however in the little band being broken up.
-
-Eight men, and the sergeant of Harward's detachment, by taking advantage
-of shelter afforded by an old and dismantled kraal wall at some little
-distance from the stream, and by their cool and determined shooting,
-succeeded in saving their lives and getting to Luneberg. Ten men only
-were saved from Moriarty's party, while he, with a civilian, Surgeon
-Cobbin, was slain.
-
-The camp was evidently wrongly placed, and was clearly taken by
-surprise. Major Tucker went out from Luneberg in person, with a small
-party of horsemen, followed by 150 of the 80th, to see what could be
-recovered, and the bodies of the dead were brought over the river and
-buried, while twenty-five of the enemy's dead were discovered, and a
-couple of wounded taken prisoners. From these men it was ascertained
-that Umbelini himself was in command, having with him some men belonging
-to our old antagonist Manyanyoba. Mcame, a powerful induna, had been
-asked to join in the foray, but refused. When Tucker and his handful of
-horsemen arrived on the banks of the river, the enemy were seen to be
-retreating, but they could not be followed until the infantry came up.
-Curious to remark, the waggons were not taken, and many of them were
-only half plundered by the savages, who seemed most anxious to decamp
-with what spoil they had secured.
-
-For his conduct in this affair Lieutenant Harward was subsequently tried
-by court-martial. The ground of complaint was his having galloped off on
-his horse--the only one present on the scene--leaving his men engaged in
-a desperate engagement. The loss of the camp, or anything of a similar
-nature, was in no way charged against him. His defence was that he had
-ridden off to obtain assistance from the nearest point--that this was
-his duty--and that he could not send a soldier in his place, as none of
-them could ride. In the event the Court acquitted him. But in May of the
-ensuing year (1880), the Field-Marshal Commanding-in-Chief issued the
-following special general order relative to a court-martial recently
-held on an officer in South Africa:--
-
-"At a general court-martial recently held, an officer was arraigned upon
-the following charges,--First. Having misbehaved before the enemy, in
-shamefully abandoning a party of the regiment under his command when
-attacked by the enemy, and in riding off at speed from his men. Second.
-Conduct to the prejudice of good order and military discipline in having
-at the time and place mentioned in the first charge, neglected to take
-proper precautions for the safety of a party of the regiment under his
-command when attacked. The Court recorded a verdict of 'Not Guilty' on
-both charges. The main facts of the case were not in dispute. The
-officer rode away from his men to a station distant four and a half
-miles, at a moment of extreme danger, when to all appearance the small
-party under his command were being surrounded and overwhelmed by the
-enemy. The charge alleged misbehaviour--that is, cowardice in so doing;
-the defence averred that it was to procure reinforcements, and either by
-their actual arrival, or by the imminence of their arrival, to ward off
-destruction. In acquitting the prisoner, they have found that he was not
-guilty of cowardice. The proceedings of the Court were submitted to the
-General commanding, who recorded the following minute:--'Disapproved and
-not confirmed. Lieutenant ... to be released from arrest, and to return
-to his duty.' The confirming officer has further recorded his reasons
-for withholding his approval and confirmation in the following
-terms:--'Had I released this officer without making any remarks upon the
-verdict in question, it would have been a tacit acknowledgment that I
-concurred in what appears to me a monstrous theory, viz., that a
-regimental officer who is the only officer present with a party of
-soldiers actually and seriously engaged with the enemy can, under any
-pretext whatever, be justified in deserting them, and by so doing
-abandoning them to their fate. The more helpless the position in which
-an officer finds his men, the more it is his bounden duty to stay and
-share their fortune, whether for good or ill. It is because the British
-officer has always done so that he occupies the position in which he is
-held in the estimation of the world, that he possesses the influence he
-does in the ranks of our army. The soldier has learnt to feel that, come
-what may, he can, in the direst moment of danger, look with implicit
-faith to his officer, knowing that he will never desert him under any
-possible circumstances. It is to this faith of the British soldier in
-his officers that we owe most of the gallant deeds recorded in our
-military annals; and it is because the verdict of this court-martial
-strikes at the root of this faith that I feel it necessary to mark
-officially my emphatic dissent from the theory upon which the verdict
-has been founded.' In communicating to the army the result of this
-court-martial, the Field-Marshal Commanding-in-Chief desires to signify
-his entire approval of the views expressed by the confirming officer in
-respect of the principles of duty which have always actuated British
-officers in the field, and by which his Royal Highness feels assured
-they will continue to be guided. This general order will, by his
-Highness's command, be read at the head of every regiment in her
-Majesty's service.--By Command, H. ELLICE, A.-G."
-
-It was about this time that Oham, whose actions had now clearly proved
-his sincerity, and the value of his friendship to the British, having
-made an earnest request to Colonel Wood that his wives and family might
-be rescued from the power of Cetywayo, the colonel sent off about twenty
-of the chief's men to collect them. To carry out the remainder of the
-project, some days after, (on the 14th), a strong detachment of Buller's
-men and the Burghers under Piet Uys, with 200 of Oham's people, left the
-camp at daybreak, and guided by James Rorke and Calverly, marched to the
-caves of Nhlangwine, which were situated rather more than twelve miles
-east of the source of the Unkassi, and not less than forty-five miles
-from Kambula. The caves were reached at 9.30 p.m., the last of the march
-of seven miles being very difficult travelling, and taking three hours
-to surmount. A few Zulus in charge of cattle were shot, and the animals
-which had belonged to Oham were taken possession of. As has been said,
-it was scarcely daybreak when the little column started. They rode along
-for a considerable time in complete silence, the men being allowed to
-smoke their pipes, but not to speak above a whisper. At first they
-followed the spoor of some cattle, which indicated the road by which
-Oham and his people had come to the camp, and then turning more in a
-northerly direction, followed the course of some small streams which
-flowed from the hills upon the left. The moon shone brightly, and
-enabled them to see clearly for some distance before them. Many strange
-sounds were heard, the growl of some beast of prey or the scream of the
-night-birds disturbed by the clank of the horses' hoofs, or the
-occasional rattle of a chain. The rapidity with which the column
-cantered over the soft and springy veldt, the dead and ominous silence
-maintained by all hands, and the steady and business-like mode in which
-they pursued their course, neither turning to the right nor the left,
-gave the journey a singularly weird character. As soon as the first
-morning's light began to appear the guides, who rode in front, turned
-into a ravine covered with dense brushwood and trees, and, having
-ascended this for about three miles, they found it was possible to ride
-out of it in three different directions, besides the one by which they
-had entered, and thus a retreat could be effected if any attack were
-made. Here it was decided to make the first off-saddle and partake of
-breakfast. At a signal from their leader, and without any word of
-command, the horsemen dismounted, slackened girths, and took off
-saddles, while the bits were removed from the horses' mouths and the
-animals allowed, Cape fashion, to take the customary roll in the grass.
-This luxury to a Cape horse seems indispensable, and without it he will
-rarely enjoy his grass or corn. No sooner, however, had the steeds
-rolled than each was again saddled, and, with the exception of the still
-slackened girths, was ready to be mounted in half a moment. Rifles and
-revolvers were carefully examined, to see whether the night dew had done
-any mischief, and then, having made a careful sweep round the horizon
-with his field-glasses, the commander gave the order for the morning
-meal, which consisted of a little cold tea, some bread, and "beltong"
-(sun-dried game).
-
-After half an hour's rest they again started as silently as before. The
-day had broken with all the splendour of an African morning. The day
-before had been rainy, and the showers had refreshed the ground and
-filled the various pools with water, and all kinds of wild animals were
-busy and cheerful in the plains. A number of parrots and monkeys were
-screaming and chattering with content, and the sportsmen of the party
-were much exercised at hearing the pleasant double whistle of the quail
-sounding from various patches of long grass. Figures which it was first
-thought were Zulus were seen on the summits of the rocks, but Piet Uys
-declared that they were merely baboons, whose early morning custom was
-to come from the heights to search for and dig up roots, which seemed to
-grow here in abundance. Vultures, sweeping aloft, were circling in the
-air above where there had evidently been a skirmish, for the carcasses
-of some horses still remained uneaten and poisoning the pure air. Here
-and there a black-breasted and magnificent eagle sat on some withered
-branch, and, seeming quite indifferent to the soldier's presence,
-scanned the ground below him as if to select the daintiest morsel for
-his morning meal. Mounting to the head of the kloof the party came to a
-splendid prospect and panorama stretching out below. The plains seemed
-to roll away to the north-east as far as the eye could see, while the
-bright, glowing tints of the rugged foreground were mellowed away into
-the middle distance, until, quite far away, the bold outlines of the
-mountains assumed, not a purple, as in Europe they would have done, but
-a rich blue tint, yet standing out in fine clear relief against the
-distant sky, the dry atmosphere failing to give the subdued effect of
-distance usually observed in other climates. These mountains were the
-Tobomba range, which run northward, and almost parallel to the
-coast-line. Amidst small groves of what seemed in the distance to be
-acacia, and near the banks of many tiny streams that wound along the
-plain, were groups of game. Herds of various kinds of bok were there,
-and here and there some solitary and not gregarious animal was to be
-seen, now bounding away from some imaginary danger, and now calmly
-browsing on the sweet veldt. What a place for an encampment!--wood,
-water, cover, commanding heights, which, properly occupied and
-entrenched, could be held against an army; and a climate where fever
-could scarcely penetrate, so pure and bracing was the air. Away up a
-smaller valley on the right lay the path that had to be followed, and,
-leaving the bright and smiling landscape in front, the column once more
-plunged into the gloom of the bush. Two more outspans brought them to
-sunset, and now precautions had to be redoubled, as they were nearing
-most dangerous ground. The chances were more than probable that
-Cetywayo, on hearing of his brother's defection and flight, had sent a
-party of his warriors to take possession of his wives and cattle, both
-vendible commodities in the land. If this were the case, it would
-inevitably result that a vigilant watch would be kept to prevent their
-escape to Oham. Strange to say, these anticipations were only partly
-verified, for as the troops neared the caves they could see that they
-were watched, but only by scattered and weak bodies of Zulus. These
-fellows had evidently discovered that the white man's intention was
-hostile, and they probably thought his object was cattle, and not to
-recover or rescue Oham's wives and children, for they ran rapidly along
-the heights above, taking no precaution for concealment, and seeming
-only anxious to drive away their herds. As the horsemen approached the
-caves at a canter, flankers were extended on either side to prevent
-surprise. The excitement of Buller's men could hardly be restrained,
-while the calm and stolid Dutchmen, who glided silently and grimly on,
-offered a wide contrast to their more hot-blooded comrades. As they came
-nearer and nearer the place seemed inhabited, and it was evident that
-the natives sent on a few days previously had apprised the people of
-Buller's advent and friendly intentions. Then Oham's people came
-crowding out of their caves, jostling each other in their anxiety to
-greet the English soldiers, grasping their assegais, and giving vent to
-a succession of guttural clicks, which it would baffle any known
-combination of vowels to reproduce. They did not cheer; such was not
-their custom, but they waved their spears aloft, as if they felt them
-entering the enemy's body.
-
-Rorke, having now been sent on with a small escort to explore the
-caves, was not long in reporting that all the women and children had
-been collected, and a bivouac having been formed, with outlying pickets
-in every direction, and sentries posted, that night was passed without
-molestation. At nine a.m. the following morning a compact column was
-formed, consisting of the rescued allies or prisoners, the few cattle
-collected in the centre, and the whole party started for the homeward
-march. It could scarcely have been hoped that the retreat would have
-been unmolested, yet only at the Inklepgwene, a difficult defile, were
-they fired upon by a body of Zulus, evidently hastily collected, and
-numbering some thousand men. The detachment reached the camp, with the
-rescued families, at one p.m. on the 16th.
-
-Wood had for some time purposed taking the initiative against Umbelini,
-and from information obtained from Oham's people came to the conclusion
-that Umbelini's place on the Mhlobana Mountain, which was not more than
-five and twenty miles from Kambula, was capable of being successfully
-surprised. He had heard from headquarters that Lord Chelmsford would
-probably start for Pearson's relief on the 28th, so he determined to
-take that opportunity of making a diversion towards Mhlobana.
-
-On Wednesday, 26th March, Colonel Buller and Piet Uys were summoned to
-Colonel Wood's tent, and told that information had come in to the effect
-that a large quantity of fine cattle had been seen on the Zlobani range
-of mountains, some ten or twelve miles from Kambula. This Zlobani range
-could be seen from the camp, and in most places was steep and
-precipitous, well wooded, and full of large caves, places of
-concealment, and natural fastnesses.
-
-Several reconnaissances had been previously made by Colonels Wood and
-Buller, who had both made themselves well acquainted with its natural
-features and its various difficulties of attack. It was well known that
-scattered bands of predatory Zulus, guarding large quantities of cattle,
-had been for some time concealed in these rocky recesses, and that, in
-compliance with the king's orders, these bands had been consolidated and
-reinforced by regiments sent by Cetywayo from Ulundi. Colonel Wood had,
-however, other information, from some of Oham's people, that all the
-regiments indicated had not yet come in, and that want of ammunition was
-detaining them in their own kraals. This, as it turned out, could not
-have been quite correct. After some conversation, Colonel Weatherly and
-Commandants Raaf and Schermbrucker were also summoned to the colonel's
-tent, and it was unanimously decided that it would be advisable to take
-the initiative and strike a blow before the Zulus concentrated to attack
-the camp, as Wood was on all hands assured they would do. Before any
-operations on the Zlobani are described, it should be mentioned that
-Wood had been enabled from the additions to his column to establish a
-chain of communications between Kambula, Utrecht, and Dundee. He had
-also organized a strong outpost between his camp and the Transvaal
-border, and another at Doornkop, or Thorn-hill. To this place Captain
-Schermbrucker and a party of his men were sent, but had been temporarily
-recalled to assist us at Kambula.
-
-After the council of war held by the colonel on the 26th, arrangements
-were at once made for the reconnaissance to the Zlobani. The force
-selected for this expedition consisted of the Imperial Mounted
-Infantry, 150; the Frontier Light Horse, 125; Raaf's Contingent, 50;
-Piet Uys's Boer Contingent, 50; Weatherly's Horse, 80; and
-Schermbrucker's Horse, 40, making a total of 495; and each man was
-supplied with three days' rations and 100 rounds of ammunition.
-
-All the horses intended for the expedition were carefully inspected on
-the 26th, and the colonel rejected several that did not seem in good
-form. They did not, as a rule, average more than fourteen hands two
-inches in height, but all were stout, short-backed, well ribbed up
-animals, and up to far more weight than their appearance would lead a
-novice to suppose. All these animals were trained to remain perfectly
-quiet when the men dismounted to fire, and many of them would actually
-come to their rider at a whistle. Piet Uys's men were especially well
-mounted, and it was necessary that they should be, as your Dutch Boer
-is, as a rule, by no means a feather-weight, being usually over thirteen
-stone. They are also very powerful men, and until forty or forty-five
-not unwieldy. After that age, they generally get heavier. Most of the
-old-fashioned Boers still retained the long "roer" or smoothbore, but
-all the younger generation had taken to the latest pattern rifles. A
-revolver and stout cutlass also formed part of their equipment, and a
-single blanket strapped in front of the saddle carried all their kit.
-
-At three a.m. on the 27th, the first little band of gallant horsemen
-under Colonel Russell were quietly paraded in the moonlight, and after
-being carefully inspected were addressed in a few well-chosen words by
-Colonel Wood, who had finally decided to accompany the party. The whole
-party made up altogether 495 sabres, every one of whom was a good
-swordsman and a picked marksman. The horses, although somewhat rough in
-the coat, were in good wind and excellent condition, and every one of
-these animals was well trained to stand fire. They moved off quietly
-from the camp, and passing along the track, which descended towards a
-sandy and deep nullah with most precipitous sides, debouched into an
-open space, from which the Zlobani range could be seen in the intervals
-of moonlight, now and then obscured by the passing clouds, which seemed
-to foretell a stormy day. The track in many places crossed difficult
-spruits, and in parts was obliterated by thorn-trees and bush. It was
-frequently commanded by projecting spurs and bluffs, from which an enemy
-could have seriously annoyed the advance. At five o'clock the column
-halted, and after a careful reconnaissance, off-saddled for half an
-hour, while the men partook of a ration of cold tea and beltong. This
-halt was made near a large dried-up, sandy watercourse, in parts of
-which the sand was moist, and by digging holes water was found in
-sufficient quantities for the horses to wash their mouths. The
-surrounding country was totally denuded of fodder, and as far as the eye
-could reach the most wild and barren prospect was to be seen. Another
-advance of about five miles changed the aspect of the scene, and brought
-them to a slightly wooded ravine, amidst the rocks of which ran a clear
-stream, over a grassy or pebbly bed, behind which loomed a range of
-rocky hills, the summit of which seemed crowned by immense boulders,
-looking in the distance like huge slabs placed by giant hands in their
-present position. Away to the left was an undulating plain, upon which
-were detached clumps of bushes and trees. Over this plain small mountain
-streams flowed in various directions, winding amongst trees, shrubs, and
-ferns of different variety. Here and there antelopes were grazing,
-ostriches were stalking, and now and then vultures were seen grimly
-circling round in seeming anticipation of a morning feast. A couple of
-miles further on they came to a large cultivated flat terminating to the
-right in a long, dark, and winding gorge, black with bush and skirted by
-huge precipices of sandstone and granite. They turned into this, and
-proceeded silently but quickly along the banks of a small rivulet, until
-they came to the foot of the mountain, and, after some little time,
-discovered a steep path, which seemed cut out of the solid cliff, and
-wide enough only for one horseman to pass. They were more than
-three-quarters of an hour scaling this path, which was most dangerous to
-horsemen unaccustomed to such tracks, and suited more to the bush bok
-seen here and there as the horsemen ascended higher and higher.
-
-On nearing the top of the krantz the view was magnificent. Away to the
-extreme right was the purple range of the Ingive Mountains, behind which
-the sun was fast rising. The Ingonyama came next, and joined the
-Ntabatulu and Ingoma ranges, the latter of which overhangs the left bank
-of the Black Umfolosi, all along which are the most extensive forests
-and inaccessible kloofs and krantzes. The head of the column had no
-sooner gained the summit of the last ledge than the leading files
-noticed a large number of cattle grazing on the plateau. These were
-guarded by about 150 or 200 armed Zulus, who, however, did not see the
-advancing troops. The range upon which the English party now found
-themselves extended about seven or eight miles, and was accessible only
-by a few most difficult footpaths leading from the plains below. Huge
-masses of scrub and boulders, krantzes, terraces, and ledges of rock,
-caves and immense fissures in the sides of the mountain, formed a
-retreat for the cattle, which, upon an alarm being sounded, were quickly
-driven from the grazing-ground above. The northern face of the mountain
-was a sheer precipice, perfectly bare of all bush or shrub. They were
-now halted, and ordered to bivouac. At about seven in the evening
-Colonel Wood rejoined them, having with him his usual small staff and
-personal escort, consisting of Captain the Hon. Ronald Campbell, his
-staff officer; Lieut. Lysons, 90th Light Infantry, his orderly officer;
-Mr. Lloyd, political agent (son of General Lloyd, of the Natal
-Legislative Assembly); eight mounted men of the 90th Light Infantry, and
-six stalwart natives under Umtongo, one of Pondo's sons. Umtongo had by
-some means or other obtained information that the regiments named
-Naxeane, Umdomandi, Ucaridanburg, Macalsiene, Udmine, Ekotsamaclooser,
-and Macalvoore, under the Indunas Umgongo, Umsimoyao, and other noted
-chiefs, had left Ulundi three days before, on the 24th, and Umtongo was
-consequently most anxious that the column should at once return to the
-Kambula. This advice, however, could not have been followed without
-exposing Colonels Buller and Weatherly and Piet Uys, who were in front,
-to be cut off and surrounded, so that it was decided that a junction
-must be made with them at whatever risks.
-
-At half-past three a.m. the commanding officer ordered the word to be
-quietly passed round for the men to stand to their horses and prepare to
-march. An occasional and straggling ray of moonlight helped them to
-follow the faint tracks of those who had gone before them, and before
-going very far they came upon unmistakable evidences of the advance
-having been opposed. A distant shot was now and then heard, away towards
-the bluff of the mountain on the north-east side; and soon after these
-indications of fighting was heard the sound of horses, and Colonel
-Weatherly, with his son, and about eighty of his troopers, met Colonel
-Wood, bringing him the news that on the previous night he had been
-unfortunate enough to miss his road. As the morning was now breaking,
-and the warm sun commenced to light up the scene, Colonel Wood noticed,
-here and there on the path, a broken assegai, a damaged shield, rent
-with a Martini-Henry rifle-bullet, and further on the bodies of some
-Zulus and the carcass of a dead horse. These signs marked where Buller
-had passed and had been attacked. Campbell and Lysons therefore ascended
-the rocks above a huge cave, and, taking every precaution to screen
-themselves from observation, scanned the surrounding horizon with the
-field-glasses. Far away, almost upon the summit of an apparently
-inaccessible and gigantic cliff, the van of Buller's column could be
-seen slowly advancing, and driving some dark masses of cattle and Zulus
-before them. These officers came down at once to report, and Colonel
-Weatherly requested permission to lead his men on to Buller's
-assistance, while Colonel Wood followed with the remainder of his
-horsemen. This permission being granted, Weatherly moved on by a
-terribly difficult path to the right, while the remainder kept to what
-seemed to be the main track. About half a mile farther on this party
-saw, a few hundred yards to the left, about 200 Zulus, who appeared to
-be armed with rifles. They were moving rapidly across the English front,
-stopping occasionally to take a shot at the leading files, who had, on
-account of the difficulties of the road, been compelled to dismount and
-lead their horses. The object of this detachment was now evident, it
-being their intention to get between the main column and Weatherly's
-little band. It was noticed that half a dozen gigantic warriors, each
-armed with rifle, shield, and bundle of assegais, led the main body of
-these Zulus. These men took it in turns to run in front, and were
-evidently acting as guides, often enabling the rest to make short cuts,
-and thus to get over the ground more quickly. They paused, however, now
-and then, as if to examine the spoor of the horses, on which the
-previous night's rain had fallen, and from this Colonel Wood concluded
-that some of his people were in the same direction. By means of some
-wild vine and creepers Lysons and one of the escort now descended from
-the opposite side of the plateau on which was the cave, and running
-rapidly along the top of the next ridge, made their way unseen to the
-edge of the bush. They thus commanded the plain below, and the
-serpentine pathway by which Buller had found his way to the summit of
-the cliff. From this point Buller and his men could be seen scouring
-the mountains beyond the intervening kloof, and about halfway up the
-opposite ascent were observed a strong party of Zulus working forward as
-if to cut off the horsemen above. As Weatherly and Colonel Wood were now
-separated by a deep and impassable ravine, they could only hope that
-they should be able to effect a junction with Buller by different
-routes, and, if possible, in time to give effective help. Crouching down
-so as not to be seen by the main column were a few of the enemy on a
-narrow ledge of rock, about a hundred yards above their heads. Where
-these fellows had come from it was not easy to imagine, but they
-immediately opened a hot, but ill-directed fire, which the English
-troopers did not at first return, as they were too much occupied in
-guiding their horses over the dangerous places, where a single false
-step would have sent them to the valley below. Meanwhile Umtongo and two
-of his men had climbed round by a higher portion of the cliff, and,
-guiding some of the English marksmen, they opened a fire upon the Zulu
-scouts, which soon cleared them from the path. Another half-hour's
-toilsome march brought Wood upon Weatherly's track, and they then could
-see the rear of Buller's column high above them to the right.
-
-It would be difficult to describe the marvellously rugged and weird
-nature of the rocks around, and the ghastly features of the sheer
-precipices gaping on either side. Killed and wounded horses now were
-seen at every turn of the road, showing how stoutly the enemy must have
-held their ground, and how difficult an operation Buller had performed.
-Sending fifty men round to work on our right flank and to endeavour to
-take the Zulus in the rear, Colonel Wood kept his men for a few moments
-under cover of a friendly ledge of rocks to look to their rifles,
-girths, and ammunition, and then ascended rapidly to the front, passing
-the Border Horse, who had by this time got off the track. The scene was
-at this moment intensely exciting. The firing was almost continuous, and
-the yells of the savages were re-echoed back by the loud and
-heart-stirring cheers of their gallant comrades, who had seen Wood's
-column coming and gave them this encouragement. It was not long before
-they came under more direct fire, and at this juncture Colonel Wood, who
-had been keeping his men cool and steady by his own presence of mind and
-good-humoured encouragement, left Colonel Russell in charge, and jumping
-upon his horse, as the ground was now practicable for riding, trotted
-through the skirmishers, and, closely followed by his staff and escort,
-pushed rapidly to the front. This party, with a dozen of the Border
-Horse, galloped to within a hundred paces of the summit of the cliff,
-where they saw that they were in the thick of the fire, raining upon
-them both from front and flank, and proceeding from a mass of Zulus
-skirmishing in the most artistic and workmanlike manner from their
-caves, crevices, and enormous boulders which formed the natural
-fortifications of the mountain plateau. At this moment Weatherly, with
-his gallant and noble-hearted boy, aged only fifteen, and who insisted
-on fighting by his father's side, were cheering on their men, dashing
-boldly into the caves, and closing in mortal strife with the Zulus.
-"Take a dozen men over to the cave to the right front, and rattle out
-the fellows who are firing so well, Colonel Weatherly," said Colonel
-Wood, as his horse staggered under him from a deep assegai wound in the
-chest, and a savage from behind a boulder fired at that officer at ten
-paces' distance. The bullet missed him, and Llewellen Lloyd, seeing the
-man loading quickly again, at once rode to cut him down, and was shot
-through the head. Wood, seeing this officer fall, dashed spurs into his
-wounded horse and galloped up to catch him, closely followed by Ronald
-Campbell. Two other Zulus from the cave now fired simultaneously at the
-colonel, whose horse at this moment was again struck, and fell upon him.
-The colonel was upon his feet in a moment, and assisted Captain Campbell
-and his orderly to carry Lloyd's body to a ledge more out of the way.
-The shot which killed poor Llewellen Lloyd tore Colonel Wood's sleeve
-underneath his arm before reaching its mark. As Colonel Weatherly's men
-were engaged with several Zulus at close quarters, some little delay
-occurred in their advance upon the cave, whence the fire was most
-galling; and Ronald Campbell, calling on Lysons and some of the escort
-to follow him, dashed at the opening, having first cleared a sort of
-breastwork at the entrance. Poor Campbell fell, shot through the head;
-and Lysons and a brave fellow, Corporal Fowler, following closely upon
-the footsteps of the brave young guardsman, killed the two remaining
-Zulus within the cave, while another, severely wounded, managed to crawl
-away through a narrow crevice in the rock. Having ascertained that the
-enemy were retreating before Buller on the summit, Colonel Weatherly was
-sent to make a small circuit lower down the cliff, to endeavour to hit
-off the path by which the former had so successfully ascended, and
-which the others were unfortunate enough to miss. Buller, in the
-meanwhile, was not only driving the Zulus' cattle before him, but was
-able to assist his comrades by his fire from his vantage-ground above.
-The enemy in front and flank retired, disputing every available spot,
-while Weatherly was most skilfully working round to their left rear. His
-disposition of his men was most judicious, and he rendered very material
-help to Wood's portion of the force, intercepting and driving back a
-strong party which were coming up to assist the body they were engaging.
-These, however, eventually took up a formidable position in some caves
-in a deep kloof, from which they kept up a constant and dropping fire.
-Amongst Wood's party they had up to this time but few casualties, though
-the loss of such splendid and noble-hearted soldiers as Campbell and
-Lloyd was a terrible blow to their chief, whose right hand men they
-were. Colonel Wood, in spite of the galling fire still maintained by the
-entrenched Zulus, assisted the party told off to carry the bodies of the
-dead to a place about half way down the first hill, where, in disregard
-of the bullets which kept rattling round, these noble young heroes were
-buried in a soldier's glorious grave, the funeral honours being
-discharged over them by the rifles of friend and foe.
-
-Colonel Wood now made a flank movement with a portion of the column in a
-north-westerly direction, to see if a junction could be effected with
-that portion of the men which had been left in the charge of Colonel
-Russell. In effecting this change of position Wood had to pass under the
-steepest cliffs of the Zlobani Mountain. Umtongo, true to his Rob Roy
-and predatory instincts, had utilised his opportunity by a little
-cattle-lifting, and, in spite of the rather hot time he had been
-experiencing, was engaged in driving, with the aid of his people, a herd
-of sheep and goats abandoned by the foe. As Wood's party were carrying
-their wounded men, and now and then halted to give them stimulants,
-their progress was necessarily slow, and this delay led to serious
-consequences, for the large reinforcements they knew might arrive from
-Ulundi later in the day had, without their knowledge, actually arrived,
-and were marching parallel to their right front, and concealed from
-sight. Umtongo was the first to discover the proximity of this hostile
-array, and, although without an interpreter, Colonel Wood understood
-enough of his language, aided by signs, to comprehend the gravity of the
-situation. The colonel, having obtained a fresh horse, cantered across
-some very broken ground to a high bluff just under the Zunguin's Neck,
-and, guided by some of Oham's people, managed, not without considerable
-difficulty, to reach a point upon a ledge of rock whence he could,
-without a glass, see the movements and exact formation of the enemy's
-force. The column was evidently the reinforcements expected from Ulundi,
-and had a portion of the English column not missed its way on the night
-of the 27th, it is tolerably certain they would have effected the object
-of their raid and retreated to the shelter of the camp without much
-loss. Wood knew of the despatch of this army on the 24th, but did not
-calculate that it could have compassed the distance it marched in three
-days. As matters stood, however, the colonel and his staff could see
-from their coign of vantage that the Zulu army from Ulundi were
-marching in a line of five contiguous columns, with a line of
-skirmishers thrown out in front and on flank, forming the usual horns
-and chest. From subsequent description given by Buller, it appears that
-the first part of his task was successfully carried out; that the track
-up the Zlobani was correctly hit off, the Zulu entrenched caves
-triumphantly carried by storm, and a large quantity of cattle taken and
-driven off. Had Wood's portion of the attack and that commanded by
-Weatherly appeared on the scene of action in time to support Buller's
-splendid onslaught, all would have gone well, but the delay caused by
-their missing the track enabled the Zlobani followers of Umbelini and
-Manyanyoba to hold their own ground until the arrival of the Ulundi
-army. Buller did all that a skilled general could effect to bring off
-his men with small loss, but from the nature of the ground it was in
-this instance almost impossible for cavalry to work with any degree of
-celerity. The mountain having been carried soon after daybreak, a long
-off-saddle to feed the horses and an unavoidable delay of four hours
-were made, to enable the main division to come up. Suddenly the immense
-force of Zulus, seen by Wood from the Zunguin's Neck, was observed by
-Colonel Buller and Oham's scouts. An immediate but orderly retreat was
-commenced, but could not be effected without the most desperate fighting
-and severe loss. The enemy had massed themselves on three sides of the
-mountain, and only one terribly steep path was left to descend. This was
-thoroughly blocked by the Zulus, who, under cover, rained bullets and
-assegais upon these devoted men, and then, when the moment came for
-close fighting, dashed in dense masses upon their thinned and weakened
-files. Halfway down this fearful gorge the road was so narrow and so
-steep that it was nearly closed up by the proximity of the tall cliffs
-on either side. These hills seemed to be formed of smooth and slippery
-ledges, over which many wounded men and horses fell, coming down upon
-the points of the assegais waiting below to receive them! Caves, with
-natural breastworks, like casemated batteries, were on either side of
-the path, wet and slippery with blood. Colonel Wood was of opinion that
-the Ulundi army did not follow up Buller's retreat for two reasons:
-first, because its wonderful three days' march had in a great measure
-exhausted the men, who came in such haste as to dispense with provisions
-and spare ammunition; and secondly, on account of the powerful
-demonstration the main or second division made on their flank even at
-the eleventh hour. To the cool valour and devoted courage of Colonel
-Buller the safety of those who came back to camp was due. He fought at
-the rear of the retiring column, assisting the wounded, charged
-desperately at the dense masses of fiery Zulus who were pressing on with
-the thirst of blood, and not until he saw the last of his band through
-this terrible kloof did he turn his horse to follow his men, or to think
-of his own safety.
-
-Seeing that nothing more could be done to help Buller in his retreat,
-Colonel Wood despatched a messenger to Colonel Russell, who by this time
-had commenced the ascent of the extreme westerly point of the range, to
-retrace his steps eastward, and to cover the retreat of the native
-allies upon the camp. Russell lost no time in carrying out these
-instructions, but before he could arrive several natives had been
-overtaken and speared. The Kambula camp was reached by the column about
-7.30. Buller, on learning that our gallant young friend Barton had not
-returned, and was away on foot with the survivors of the Border Horse,
-some ten miles off, at once obtained permission from Colonel Wood to go
-in search of the party. The evening had set in stormy, and torrents of
-rain were now coming down. Buller had been in the saddle for forty-eight
-hours, was severely contused, and had escaped death by almost a miracle;
-but setting a noble example, he obtained a party of volunteers, and
-taking led horses, started on his expedition. Seven men, who would
-probably have never reached the camp, were brought in by this gallant
-act, and these were the sole survivors of Barton's Horse. It would seem
-that in attempting to follow Wood's track in retiring they were
-overtaken and cut off. They then attempted to retreat by the north and
-the Hyntecha Kloof, where the majority died fighting gallantly to the
-last. Splendid, manly, honest, simple, and taciturn Piet Uys, whose
-father, uncles, and cousins fought and fell in the old wars with
-Dingaan! On the evening of the 17th, after the conference in Wood's
-tent, he spoke in the most feeling terms of his children, of whom, like
-all Cape Dutchmen, he was passionately fond, and Colonel Wood, with that
-thoughtful kindness for which he is so well known, at once said that,
-should anything happen to the father, he would interest himself with the
-Government to provide for the orphans. Piet Uys could have easily
-escaped, but, like Buller, he would see the last of his men clear before
-turning rein. He was last seen with his back to the cliff, standing
-across the body of his favourite "mooi paard" (grey horse), with six
-large Zulus lying dead in a circle round him, his empty revolver in his
-left hand and his body pierced by two assegais! Colonel Weatherly's
-Horse went into action about eighty strong, and of these brave fellows
-forty-five were dead, including the gallant colonel and his brave,
-intelligent, and handsome son, a lad of fifteen, who, at an age when
-many an English youth is celebrated only in the cricket-field or on the
-river, had seen more of real fighting than many a veteran in the
-regulars. Nothing could be more sad than Weatherly's death. At the fatal
-hour when all save honour seemed lost, he placed his beloved boy upon
-his best horse, and kissing him on the forehead, commended him to
-another Father's care above, and implored him to overtake the nearest
-column of the English horse, which seemed at that time to be cutting its
-way out. The boy clung to his father, and begged to be allowed to stay
-by his side, and share his life or death. The contrast was
-characteristic. The man, a bearded, bronzed, and hardy _sabreur_, with a
-father's tears upon his cheek, while the blue-eyed and fair-haired lad,
-with much of the beauty of a girl in his appearance, was calmly and with
-a smile of fond delight loading his father's favourite carbine. When the
-two noble hearts were last seen, the father, wounded to death with cruel
-assegais, was clasping his boy's hand with his left, while the right cut
-down the brawny savages who came to despoil him of his charge.
-
- * * * * *
-
-Though in all these operations of which mention has been lately made
-Lord Chelmsford never once appears, it must not therefore be supposed
-that he had rested from his labours. On the contrary they were more
-incessant and arduous than ever. When the news of Isandhlwana first
-reached the colonies, it caused the utmost excitement and wildest
-apprehensions. Nothing less, it was averred, was about to happen than an
-immediate and overwhelming invasion of Natal by the Zulus. The black men
-were on the point of sweeping the whites into the sea. Lord Chelmsford's
-first duty, after an urgent application to the home authorities for
-reinforcements, was to render these alarms groundless. To organize of a
-sudden the defence of so extended a frontier was no easy task. How
-thoroughly and conscientiously it was performed the result testifies.
-
-Another duty scarcely less urgent was the rescue of Colonel Pearson. And
-in this project he received aid, as valuable as unexpected, from the
-Governor of St. Helena. No sooner did that official hear of Lord
-Chelmsford's urgent need, than he at once assumed the responsibility of
-sending on the garrison of his island--in all 160 soldiers--to the
-rescue. Captain Bradshaw, of H.M.S. "Shah," chanced to be lying in the
-harbour, homeward bound, after a period of foreign service, but he
-hesitated not one whit more than the Governor. He embarked the garrison,
-and on February 19th had anchored at Durban. There a naval brigade of
-400 men was furnished from his ship; and thus it came about that long
-before reinforcements from England could arrive, and on the day that
-Zlobani was fought, Lord Chelmsford was already well on the way to
-deliver Pearson from his captivity.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER IV.
-
- Effects of Zlobani--Description of Kambula Camp--Desperate Zulu attack
- thereon--Description of the battle--Deaths of Lieutenants Bright and
- Nicholson--Gallant rescue by Captain Woodgate--Force and commanders
- of the Zulu attack--Their losses--The English losses--Fortifications
- at Kambula Kop--Block House--Arrival of despatches--Exciting scene.
-
-
-Before Lord Chelmsford set out on his march, Colonel Pearson had sent
-messengers to warn him that not less than 35,000 Zulus were lying in
-ambush between the Tugela and Ekowe, in order to assail him as he
-advanced to the relief of that post. Orders were therefore sent to
-Colonel Wood to make an attack on the Zulu flank, and so to create a
-diversion in favour of the relieving column.
-
-Accordingly, Wood advanced from his entrenched position at Kambula Kop
-to the Zlobani mountain, where Umbelini's chief stronghold and kraal was
-situated. This Wood assailed, and though after a sharp engagement, which
-has been previously described, his forces received a decided check, yet
-he may be said to have achieved a success, inasmuch as he undoubtedly
-drew away a large part of the force that was intended to operate against
-Lord Chelmsford. Another result of this battle was that it gave the
-enemy sufficient encouragement to induce them to attack the English
-troops on the following day in their position at Kambula, thus enabling
-Wood to obtain a solid and decisive victory.
-
-From various incidents that came under his observation Colonel Wood
-formed an opinion, subsequently verified by the event, that an attack
-upon Kambula would not be long in following the check at Zlobani; a
-vigilant look-out was therefore maintained during the whole of the night
-of the 28th. The rain came down heavily during the early part of the
-night, and shortly before dawn Captain Raaf was sent out with
-twenty-five men to reconnoitre, and, if possible, pick up any wounded or
-straggling. Zulus, who would give any information as to the movements of
-the strong impi known to be in the immediate neighbourhood. About ten
-a.m. Raaf sent in one of Oham's people--a most intelligent and witty
-fellow--who gave a graphic account how he was captured when left behind
-with the recovered cattle taken from Umbelini. Having taken off his
-distinctive head-badge, although he was recognized by a friend, the
-Zulus were not aware that he was one of Oham's people, or that he had
-joined the English cause. On this account, therefore, he was allowed to
-accompany the Zulu impi as far as Umsedosi. While with the enemy he
-obtained a tolerably correct notion of their strength, and was
-intelligent enough to remember the names and titles of the various corps
-sent from Ulundi, and, indeed, of those which were retained by the king.
-Cetywayo, he said, had divided his entire military available force into
-three formidable columns of four regiments each. One of these,
-consisting of the Naxeane, the Umdomandi, the Ucaridanburg, and the
-Macalsiene, was sent without commissariat, and by forced marches from
-Ulundi on the 24th March, and part of this column, but not all, was
-engaged with Umbelini against Wood at Zlobani on the 28th. This column
-numbered at the least 20,000 men, and was well supplied with arms of
-precision. Four regiments were retained at Ulundi as a bodyguard and
-garrison to the king, and the remaining four were told off to attack
-Lord Chelmsford at or near Ekowe. Very early on the morning of the 29th,
-Oham's friendly Zulu, feeling anxious about his own safety, persuaded
-some of the Zulu braves to accompany him some distance from their camp,
-under the pretence of obtaining them some drink. Taking a favourable
-opportunity, however, he managed to elude their vigilance and give them
-the slip, when he made the best of his way to Raaf's party, who at once
-sent him on to the Kambula camp, with the information given above. This
-fellow gave an admirable account of the state of feeling in the Zulu
-armies, and his opinion was that great numbers of the men were now
-serving entirely against their will, as they found that, instead of
-getting plenty of booty in the shape of cattle, stores, arms, and
-ammunition, they were the losers, as during their absence with the army
-the English attacked their kraals, and carried off their oxen, sheep,
-and goats. This man, although quite a chief at Oham's kraal, would seem
-to be a sort of headman, and to be in the habit of conversing familiarly
-with those in authority; for, he added, that it was rumoured that
-Dabulamanzi would, if another reverse fell upon the Zulu arms, in all
-probability follow Oham's example, and proffer submission.
-
-On receiving the intelligence of the Zulu advance, Colonel Wood had few
-preparations to make, for in the camp at Kambula each corps, each
-company, each subdivision, each section, and each man had a place
-allotted, and had been taught to be in that place at one sound of the
-bugle. The little fort was in an exceptionally strong position, being
-laid out upon an elevated and narrow ridge of table-land. A complete
-precipice, perfectly inaccessible to a white man, even though a born
-cragsman, guarded the right flank. On the left a succession of steep
-terraces had been utilised, and carefully entrenched with lines _en
-crémaillère_, or outworks, each successive line defilading its
-neighbour. In front there was a narrow slip of land, hemmed in by ledges
-of rock, and swept by two 7-pounders, while immediately in rear, upon an
-eminence about 120 feet above the fort was a small _lunette_, with open
-gorge, and armed with two guns. The camp at first consisted of one
-laager, but an outer defence with a hundred waggons, and an inner one
-with fifty, had been subsequently added. Deep and wide ditches flanked
-by _caponnières_ protected the outer boundary, and were traced in the
-form of an irregular hexagon. As soon as Oham's Zulu had made his
-report, the garrison were called to arms without the slightest fuss,
-excitement, or confusion, and messengers were at once despatched to
-order the return of a fatigue party which had been sent out in the early
-morning wood-cutting. These men reported on their return that they had
-seen Zulus scouting about five miles to the west, and had they not been
-recalled they would have stayed to get further intelligence. As soon as
-the men of the various corps were at their posts, Colonel Wood rode
-round to give them a few final words of encouragement, saying in
-conclusion, that he knew they would hold the fort while a man was left
-to fire a shot. The tents were then struck, and the men lined the
-shelter-trenches. The horses stood to their bridles, and the ammunition
-was served out by fatigue parties told off for this duty. Most of the
-waggon-drivers had been taught to use the Martini, and a few were served
-out to each face of the laager.
-
-It was now nearly eleven a.m., and shortly after that time the Zulu
-battalions were seen on the base of the hill. Here they halted for a
-considerable time, and apparently a council of war was held. Their
-movements were evidently not so decided as on former occasions, and it
-was more than an hour before any forward measure was taken. The cattle
-had been brought into camp, with the exception of about 220 which had
-strayed away towards the enemy, and it could be seen that the Zulu chief
-had detached a portion of his men to secure these animals. On this
-movement being noticed, Colonel Buller was ordered out to reconnoitre,
-and to see if any opening offered for a charge upon the detached body of
-the enemy, but no chance presenting itself, the cavalry retired, and
-took up an excellent position on the north front of the camp. A flanking
-movement was now made by a body of Zulus, numbering about 7000 men.
-These regiments broke from line into column, and ran at a tremendous
-pace along a ledge situated at the commencement of the cultivated land.
-As the object of this man[oe]uvre was evidently to entice the cavalry to
-attack upon broken and difficult ground, Buller and Russell very wisely
-restrained their men from attempting any sortie. The Zulus were in range
-by this time, but it was thought desirable to reserve all fire until
-they were massed in closer order. It was nearly half-past one when the
-action actually commenced, and it was opened by a cloud of skirmishers,
-who, fed by supports and reserves, began to scale the north front of the
-English post. Here, behind the outermost line of entrenchments, Buller
-and Russell dismounted a portion of their men, and each trooper being
-cautioned to select his object and fire steadily, some excellent
-rifle-practice was made. No sooner did a head or a shield appear above a
-rock, a boulder, or a tuft of grass, than the "ping" of the deadly
-Martini-Henry rang out, and in nine cases out of ten there was an enemy
-the less to encounter. Some portion of the band of the gallant but lost
-Piet Uys, had been sent to reinforce Buller's attenuated squadron, and
-these men particularly distinguished themselves as highly-skilled
-marksmen. Many of these Boers still retained their old national weapon,
-the long single-barrelled _roer_, carrying an enormous bullet, suited
-for the destruction of big game. There is no doubt that, in the hands of
-a South African Dutchman, this is a terrible weapon. The conical bullet,
-perhaps, has a greater power of penetration, but the larger ball of the
-old-fashioned fire-arm, which in appearance is not unlike a huge
-duck-gun, inflicts a wound which rarely fails to kill. These splendid
-Dutchmen shot with all the skill that hatred of the savages and a desire
-for vengeance for their late leader could teach, and there could be
-noticed on the countenance of each a sterner expression and a more
-deadly resolve than usual. From the little fort a gun was now brought
-to bear upon the advancing line, but without much effect, as an
-intervening spur gave shelter to the foe. The attack was now renewed on
-the north side with redoubled vigour; the lines of skirmishers fell
-back, and were replaced by a more solid line, supported by the usual
-dense column in its rear. Buller saw that it became necessary to remount
-his men, and this movement of course weakened the effect of his fire. He
-retired, however, slowly, halting now and then, and sending a volley
-into the masses which kept pouring up the slopes. Major Russell, at this
-juncture, executed a brilliant dash at a body of Zulus who were running
-in an easterly direction to gain possession of a ledge of rock, and,
-catching them on a favourable piece of ground, with about a score of his
-men managed to sabre a great many without the loss of one trooper. This,
-however, did not suffice to check the steady advance, and orders were
-sent for Buller and Russell to retire slowly within the laager, their
-retreat being splendidly covered by Colonel Gilbert and four companies
-of his fine regiment, the 13th, who were posted on the right rear of the
-laager. One company of the 13th, under Captain Cox, an officer of former
-Cape experience, held the cattle laager, which gave a splendid flanking
-fire along the front, and these men waited until the Zulus were within
-300 yards, and then commenced an independent file firing at the same
-time that Gilbert's men delivered a withering volley. As Cox and his men
-could not see the right rear, to which point the principal Zulu attack
-had now changed, a skilful counter-attack was ordered by Colonel Wood,
-who directed Major Hackett to take a couple of companies of the 90th
-Light Infantry to advance over the slope, and open a cross-fire upon the
-enemy. This movement was magnificently carried out by Hackett, whose men
-moved out into the open as if on parade, and with a steady advance, such
-as British troops are proud of, marched on to the rear of the cattle
-laager, taking the Zulus completely by surprise. Nothing could be better
-than the calm and deliberate firing of these men. Every shot told with
-deadly effect, and dark bodies and shields soon began to dot the ground.
-Still, however, the living stream rolled on, and as one warrior went
-down in the death-struggle, another, with a shout of vengeance, sprang
-into his place.
-
-It was now a little after two o'clock, and while this attack upon the
-left rear had been progressing, another strong body of the enemy had
-succeeded in gaining an eminence from which, although at a long range,
-they were enabled to keep up an effective fire and inflict considerable
-loss upon the British troops. Captain Woodgate, of Ashanti fame, who had
-been sent to support Major Hackett, together with his lieutenant
-(Strong), here behaved with conspicuous coolness and valour. These three
-officers advancing well in front of their men and waving their swords
-above their heads, showed such an example to their men that the Zulus
-were driven back on that side, the ground intervening being strewed with
-bodies of Zulus. A difficult and brilliantly led flanking attack was now
-effected by the Zulu general, who, having retired a body of his best
-marksmen from his right along his rear, suddenly opened a galling fire
-upon the left flank of the 90th companies, who, having accomplished
-their task, were now ordered to retire. In executing this difficult
-movement Major Hackett was badly hit, and had to be carried out of fire.
-Lieutenant Bright, also of the 90th Light Infantry, was here mortally
-wounded, and shortly afterwards died. Bright was a clever, cheery
-fellow, a capital artist, a good musician, and a most accomplished
-officer. It was in running forward to pick up Hackett that poor Bright
-received his death-wound. Meanwhile, from the lunette on the height,
-Nicholson's two 7-pounders did capital execution. The Zulu main body had
-now come within range, and grape and canister were poured into their
-masses until the slopes over which they were advancing became slippery
-with blood. Standing on the parapet, Nicholson was, field-glass in hand,
-directing the pointing of his guns, when a chance bullet struck him in
-the temple, and he fell upon the weapon he was directing. The loss was
-observed from the laager, and Major Vaughan was at once sent to replace
-this gallant young fellow. Colonel Wood, not to expose unduly the horses
-of the artillery, had retained under the shelter of the laager four guns
-in reserve. These were under charge of Major Tremlett, R.A., who, with
-his subalterns, Lieuts. Bigge and Hughes, waited until the Zulus were
-within a thousand yards, and then making a dash to a small open space of
-rising ground outside the laager, worked his battery with immense
-effect. The guns did not return to the laager, but were shifted from
-time to time as the movements of the enemy warranted, and to their
-splendid service much of the victory was due. The enemy had now varied
-his attack a second time, and nothing could exceed the bravery and
-skilful man[oe]uvring of his regiments. While the 13th and 90th vied
-with each other in noble rivalry, and beat back the hordes of the Zulus
-upon the two most exposed flanks, the mounted men under Buller and
-Russell were occasionally led forward at a gallop by Colonel Wood, who,
-whenever he saw an opening for a charge, swept down and drove the
-skirmishers on to the main body. These brilliant charges became more
-frequent as the day advanced, and their effect upon the savages,
-unaccustomed to cavalry, was beyond all expectation. At three o'clock a
-hot cross-fire was opened upon a company commanded by Captain Woodgate,
-who had been holding a point which was in a measure the key of the
-position, as it commanded the only practicable road to the upper
-lunette, which, as has been explained, was open at the gorge. The enemy
-still held the range which they had occupied during the earlier portion
-of the day, and Woodgate was ordered to retire under cover of the fire
-from two of Tremlett's guns, which had now taken a favourable position
-for shelling the height. After one or two shots had been fired, a shell
-was dropped into the midst of the party holding this position, and this
-had a most useful effect, for the other gun coming into action at the
-same range, drove the enemy's skirmishers to ground much farther off.
-For another hour and a half the troops continued to be hotly engaged
-with the enemy, who, when dislodged from one flank, swept round in the
-most perfect order, and swarmed in masses upon another side. A message
-now arrived from Colonel Gilbert, to the effect that he could spare
-Captain Cox and a company from his flank, as the enemy's fire was
-slackening, and they were gradually extending their line to the right
-rear. Cox had been hit early in the action, but refused to leave his
-men, and led them on gallantly till the day was won.
-
-At half-past four the Zulu general seemed to concentrate his principal
-attention upon the northern side held by the 13th, and some desperate
-rushes were made almost up to the muzzles of the English rifles. Colonel
-Wood rode up, and complimented Colonel Gilbert upon the splendid firing
-of his men, and he was at once greeted with a ringing cheer, which was
-heard by the enemy. All sides of the laager had been in turn attacked,
-and soon after half-past four a simultaneous advance was made on the
-north and north-east face. An enfilade fire, however, was made by a
-couple of Tremlett's guns, and the 7-pounder directed by Bigge did great
-execution at 800 yards. Some of the bodies afterwards examined on the
-north-east face were found to be literally blown to pieces. The Zulus at
-this time were working round from the right-hand hill, and here,
-unfortunately, a few large boulders gave them cover. The soldiers were
-here almost on a line with the enemy, who in other places were below and
-above them. They had therefore to keep a sharp look-out that the enemy
-did not break through the line and penetrate the laager. They therefore
-kept pouring in a heavy cross-fire upon them at 200 and 300 yards, while
-the guns were defilading them on the right. The enemy could not stand
-this treble fire, and, though disputing the ground step by step, began
-reluctantly to retire. Colonel Wood at once sent messengers to the
-lunette, to open upon them as they passed underneath. At this period
-Lieutenants Smith and Lysons, seeing some Zulus advancing to assegai a
-wounded soldier of the 13th, who was lying under fire in the open,
-rushed out, and, led by Captain Woodgate, carried the man under shelter.
-In performing this gallant action Smith was badly wounded, and
-Woodgate's helmet was smashed by a bullet. Surgeons O'Reilly, Brown, and
-their staff, one and all exposed themselves freely in attending to the
-wounded who could not be moved out of fire. Soon after five o'clock it
-became evident that the Zulu fire was beginning to fail, and the English
-commander at once led a company of the 13th to the right rear of the
-cattle laager, where the cattle had been for some time exposed to the
-fire from the hill. A little later on Captains Cox and Persse were taken
-by Colonel Wood to the edge of the krantzes on the right front of the
-cattle laager, where the discomfited and disheartened Zulus were
-retiring from the direct fire. Cox extended his men along the slopes,
-while Persse occupied a higher ridge, and thus a double-banked and
-deadly fire was opened upon the retiring enemy. Having driven the Zulus
-over the edge of the hill, the two companies followed them up in a
-splendid manner; Cox, although suffering greatly from his wound and loss
-of blood, leading on his men in the most gallant style to the best
-points for continuing the fire. Word was now sent to Buller and Russell
-to mount their men and pursue; and the mule battery opened "action
-deft," and played upon the devoted Zulus, the regiment of Macalooroo,
-under Umlinoya, suffering most. Buller's gallant fellows nobly avenged
-their slaughtered comrades of the previous day, and for more than seven
-miles the broken Zulu army was chased like a flock of sheep.
-
-It was subsequently ascertained that the attacking Zulu force consisted
-of nine regiments sent from Ulundi--making a force of 23,000--and of
-Umbelini's mercenaries; together forming a total of not less than
-25,000. Tyangwayo was in chief command, whilst Umbelini held the next
-rank. The latter having retreated in the direction of the Upper Pongolo
-Drift, was subsequently pursued and killed by a patrol under the command
-of Captain Prior, of the 80th Regiment. A wounded prisoner of some
-importance, by name Waishlahla, who was brought into camp on the 2nd,
-pointed out to Colonel Wood the bodies of Mubalawa and Maheitjesa, sons
-of Mnyame, killed on the 29th; and this man said that he knew that
-Mabuna, son of Umbangasita, Makweli, son of Umlandela, Ummensododo, son
-of Umfoonsa, and Tyangwayo, his brother, were also killed on that day,
-together with, according to the Zulu estimate, above 3000 of the king's
-bravest and best men! There is little reason to suppose that these
-figures are exaggerated; for 1500 bodies lay about the vicinity of the
-camp on the night of the 29th, though in the morning many were gone.
-
-The sad duty of burying their own dead and the bodies of the enemies
-occupied the troops nearly the whole of the week following upon the
-attack upon the Kambula camp. During the 1st, 2nd, and 3rd of April
-above 800 Zulus were buried, while others were subsequently found in the
-caves and krantzes near. There were also 326 fire-arms picked up,
-amongst which were recognized one Snider belonging to the Artillery,
-and 16 Martini-Henrys belonging to the 24th and 80th Regiments. Lieut.
-Bright, 90th Light Infantry, Lieut. Nicholson, R.A., Mr. Ferreira,
-interpreter, seven privates 13th Light Infantry, ten privates 90th Light
-Infantry, and one colour-sergeant, two Frontier Light Horse, and one of
-Buller's Horse were interred on the day following the attack, the
-service being read in the most impressive manner by General Wood.
-Wounded Zulus were for some days continually brought into the camp; and
-these men, as soon as they found that their wounds were attended to, and
-that the soldiers were kind to them, became most communicative. They
-said that Cetywayo had sent all his available men, with the exception of
-two of his favourite regiments, retained as a bodyguard. These prisoners
-also all agreed in setting down the Zulu losses on the 28th and 29th at
-3000 men.
-
-When such individual and numerous acts of bravery were exhibited, it
-seems superfluous to pick out any special cases; but it would be wrong
-not to particularly mention the name of Captain Woodgate, whose
-gallantry and _sang-froid_ were the theme of the whole garrison. During
-the whole of the action, and while carrying orders from the camp to the
-fort, he was more exposed than any other officer, and on more than one
-occasion he deliberately risked his life to save wounded men from being
-assegaied. To Colonel Buller also the same praise must be accorded for
-his self-devotion at Zlobani and the heroic manner in which he exposed
-himself in carrying off wounded men from the very midst of the enemy.
-
-The situation being in every way so admirably adapted to military
-requirements, it was now resolved to make a permanent station at the
-Kambula Kop; and new works were day by day added to those already
-completed. Four well-constructed magazines were built in hollow and
-sheltered spots, yet close to the guns. Each magazine was lined with
-wooden frames, with splinter-proof timbers to cover the top, while
-sheeting planks were placed round the sides and passages. These frames
-were all perpendicular to the length of the passage--that is to say,
-across its breadth and about two feet apart. Eight feet thickness of
-earth was placed over the roof of each magazine, while a stout tarpaulin
-was stretched over the splinter-proofs to guard against the wet. Gabions
-were sunk to act in the place of cesspools, and receive the drainage,
-while a small parapet guarded the entrance to the passage, with a small
-hole through which ammunition was handed out. Twenty men, in relays,
-were detailed for this work--that is to say, for each magazine--and
-although they were to a certain extent unskilled labourers, the officers
-taught them in such an excellent manner that the four magazines were
-completed in twenty-four hours. The ditches round the fort were so deep
-that bridges had to be made, part of which was permanent and part
-movable. Four entrances into the fort were left, seven feet wide, so as
-to admit the guns and waggons when supplies arrived. These entrances
-were closed by rifle-proof doors and gates made of strong planks,
-strengthened by cross-beams, and lined inside with thin sheet iron and
-raw bullock hides. These hides formed an admirable substitute for sheet
-iron, as they were quite bullet-proof and not liable to be set on fire.
-Two more ditch _caponnières_ were also added, to give increased flanking
-fire. The _terreplein_ of each of these works was sunk, so that the
-loopholes were within one foot and a half of the level of the ditch.
-This method had many advantages, and provided for the trick adopted by
-the Zulus of lying down in the ditches and counterfeiting death, until
-an opportunity is afforded for rushing at the parapet. A large supply of
-brushwood was usefully employed to improve the drains under the
-parapets, which suffered severely from the continued wet weather. During
-spare hours the men were never idle, and from the brigadier downwards
-every officer was encouraged to employ his leisure in instructing the
-men in every species of field-defence. Gabions for revêtements,
-fascines, hurdles, sandbags, sods, pickets, _chevaux-de-frise_
-palisades, and small shell _fougasses_ occupied the surplus hours not
-devoted to drill, recreation, and rest, and the few engineers belonging
-to the garrison declared that as pupils the volunteers at this work were
-beyond compare.
-
-As in the last action it was found that the enemy were enabled to
-considerably annoy the troops by occupying some neighbouring eminences,
-the interior works were strengthened with considerable skill. The
-parapets were raised, extra traverses erected, and the _terreplein_
-sunk. The faces of the work were also made more nearly perpendicular to
-the enemy's possible fire. Shelter-pits for skirmishers were dug in all
-directions. These trenches being only required upon sudden emergencies
-were not made large, being only two feet wide by a foot and a half deep,
-and with a parapet built so as to reach a height of a foot and a half.
-These gave room and partial shelter to a couple of men, and to each spot
-the best marksmen were told off. Horse trenches were also constructed,
-so that these animals could be sheltered from musketry fire. These were
-twenty-four yards in rear of the line of the infantry trench, and were
-five feet long, three feet wide at top, and two feet wide at bottom,
-with ramps, with a slope of one-half at each end. The parapets of these
-trenches were three feet high, with a thickness of two feet at the top.
-Half a dozen men could make such a trench in half an hour. These
-shelter-trenches were not so neatly dressed as the models to be seen at
-Chatham or Portsmouth, but they were pre-eminently workmanlike. They
-followed the contour of the rather broken ground, and were so made that
-cavalry could easily advance over them. At the intervals for this
-advance each trench overlapped its neighbour.
-
-In contemplation of the removal of the waggons as soon as the advance
-should be made, roughly-built block-houses, made of contiguous logs
-placed vertically and quite bullet-proof, were constructed to substitute
-the shelter afforded by the former. The logs were twelve feet long, and
-three feet of this were buried in the ground, the buried ends being
-spiked into transverse beams; roughly-hewn beams formed the roofs, and
-over these was placed brushwood covered with four feet of earth. Green
-timber, of which there was an undiminished supply, was used, and, when
-necessary, this was covered with raw hides to prevent danger from fire.
-Now, as the enemy had no artillery, and was not likely to understand its
-employment, even if provided with the guns captured at Isandhlwana, no
-defence could be more suitable. An ordinary work could, it was found, be
-often defiladed from a neighbouring height, while a well-made
-blockhouse, with carefully prepared roof, was, in every case,
-impregnable to rifle-fire. The plan for the roofs was as follows:--The
-young trees or branches were placed with the roots and thick ends
-inwards, while the smaller ends, sharpened and shaved down thin, were
-allowed to project over the walls of the building till they reached to
-within three feet of the ground. These boughs, if thin and with smaller
-branches between them, would not allow the means for climbing on the
-roof, should the Zulus attempt it, as they would not bear the weight of
-a crowd of men. In positions where the blockhouse could not be commanded
-by any neighbouring height, the roof was made flat and surrounded with a
-parapet of earth, so as to afford a second tier of fire.
-
-Whilst these works were in progression, and some few days after the
-battles of Zlobani and Kambula, some officers sitting upon a coign of
-vantage at an elevated part of the fort, suddenly descried three dark
-figures with shields and assegais coming at a rapid trot towards their
-southern front, along the hunting-road which leads from the Blood river
-and the Buffalo. At first they seemed steadily progressing, as if
-wishing to make a quick journey, but under no apprehension of pursuit.
-As they moved quickly on they were lost sight of in the bush, and as the
-surrounding country was made up of wooded krantzes and dark ravines, in
-which an army might lie concealed, it was not likely that they would be
-seen again for some time. Away, however, a little to the right of where
-these men had passed, was quickly seen a larger party, consisting of
-about a score of savages, evidently in pursuit of the first-named
-runners. Their shields were flourished aloft, and their assegais waved
-in triumph as they followed the spoor of the first party, who had
-evidently taken to the bush as the most effectual way of escaping the
-keen eyes of their pursuers. Finding no traceable spoor which they could
-with certainty follow, they became suspicious, and commenced retracing
-their steps; and while this was being accomplished the three runners
-were seen to emerge cautiously towards the crest of the left krantz, now
-holding a good start of the pursuing party. While they came steadily on
-in the direction of the camp, however, a keen-sighted scout, who had
-taken the precaution to climb a huge rock which jutted out above the
-gorge, saw the quarry, and announced his success by discharging his
-rifle, and waving the assegai in the direction of the fugitives, whom it
-was now believed were messengers bringing despatches.
-
-The Zulu, it should be borne in mind, is a born athlete; usually until
-forty or fifty, and rich, he is a spare man, with scarcely an ounce of
-superfluous flesh about him, and kept in continual training by constant
-exertion and no excess of food. He can, as a rule, at a moment's notice
-take a letter or small packet and run his eight or ten miles, or even
-walk his seventy or eighty, without breaking down. The ground over which
-the pursued were running was grassy veldt, while that upon which were
-the pursuers was sprinkled with low thorn-bushes, mixed with rocks and
-gravel. The pursuing party, however, were evidently the fresher of the
-two, while the messengers looked like men who were at the tail of a long
-journey. The foremost party came struggling on until they reached some
-clumps of thorn-trees, which, affording cover, were taken advantage of
-to recover breath and observe the enemy's proceedings. The chase was now
-getting most exciting. Both the chased and the chasers were plainly
-visible to those in the camp, while the former only could observe their
-enemies. Noting here and there a footprint, which served to show them
-that they were on the right track, the Zulus in pursuit dashed down the
-ravine and some distance beyond where the three had doubled. The whole
-party went nearly 300 yards before the leaders halted in consequence of
-finding no spoor, and they then spread out like hounds in a fox cover to
-find some signs of their quarry.
-
-It was really wonderful, the rapid and dashing manner in which these
-human bloodhounds strove to hit off the trail, while, having regained
-their wind, the pursued trio moved on, not in great haste, but quietly
-and with a considerable amount of care, that they might not be seen by
-their enemies. For this purpose they now moved with the utmost caution
-over a ridge, and entered the wooded valley which lay at the foot of the
-kop, whereon stood the fort, being there completely out of sight of the
-pursuers, who were still puzzling over the spoor. The messengers--aware
-that they were encountering a double risk, as they knew that the wood
-into which they had gone would probably contain Zulu scouts sent to
-watch the fort, and who might have seen and laid in ambuscade for
-them--therefore trotted quickly across till they came to a somewhat open
-plain, with a line of willow-like trees, evidently denoting the banks of
-a stream. Knowing that the pursuers in rear would be only temporarily
-puzzled by the loss of spoor, they therefore decided that the least risk
-would be incurred by making a final rush across the open road. Waiting
-for a moment to decide for what part of the stream they should make,
-they took a rapid glance around, and then made a sudden bolt for the
-plain. Scarcely 200 yards had been crossed when a terrific yell broke
-out from the pursuers, denoting that the pursued had been discovered by
-the Zulus in rear, who immediately sent a couple of scouts to the
-heights, the better to watch which side of the plain the messengers
-would make for. These scouts at once shouted to the party below, and,
-joining them, the whole body was quickly in pursuit. The messengers had,
-however, almost 500 yards' start, and had obtained their "second wind."
-They knew, therefore, that, if not lamed by a chance shot, they would
-probably get over the river and under the guns of the fort before they
-could be overtaken. How or where to cross the river they seemed not to
-know, as in some places it is deep and wide, and in others shallow, with
-marshy banks and long weed-like grasses. Here and there, also, the
-stream bubbles and boils through deep gorges where only a baboon could
-ascend or descend. Seeing the willow-looking trees, the stout runners
-fortunately concluded that the water would be deep where they grew, and
-they wisely chose another part where low bushes prevailed, and where
-there were indications of a rapid slope in the ground, which would give
-them shelter in crossing. The pursuers were about 350 yards behind when
-the runners reached the bank, which they found steep and rocky, the
-stream itself running rapidly over a stony bed. Although, like most
-Zulus, these messengers could swim well, they could not swim safely
-encumbered with a heavy gun, a bunch of assegais, a shield, and a heavy
-leathern mailbag, nor could they calculate on reaching the opposite bank
-without being shot at while so encumbered. On examining the bed of the
-river, they decided that it could be waded, and that if not, drowning
-was a more preferable death than torture in the king's kraal, which, if
-found with letters upon them, was sure to be their fate. They instantly
-decided, therefore, to cross.
-
-Meanwhile those in the camp had not been idle, for half a dozen of
-Buller's men, known marksmen, were despatched to a point where they
-could command the drift and catch the pursuing party _en flagrant délit_
-if they attempted to follow too closely. A few minutes' interval and a
-smart canter brought eight rifles in all to a favourable spot, where,
-unseen by the enemy, they could watch the proceedings of both friend and
-foe, and materially assist the crossing and escape of the former.
-Quietly dismounting, and placing two men, both as vedettes and in charge
-of the horses, the remainder took up position and waited for the
-_dénouement_ of this somewhat exciting little episode. Not long indeed
-had they to wait. As the quick-scented harrier changes from scent to
-view, and gives melodious tongue as the quarry is in sight, so dashed on
-the pursuing white shields right up to the banks of the stream, and
-looking for a moment at the troubled waters, seemed to hesitate what
-course to pursue, imagining perhaps that some ambush was intended.
-Meanwhile the messengers had effected the crossing in safety, though not
-without difficulty. Taking up more tightly the straps that bound the
-mailbags to their naked bodies, and with their rifles in one hand and
-shields and assegais in the other, they scrambled like cats down the
-bank, selecting those points where most ripples appeared upon the water,
-and managed thus to wade to the opposite bank. The depth was in no part
-greater than to cover them above the waist, although the rush of the
-stream was so rapid as to render a foothold difficult. As soon as they
-found themselves all in the water, they linked arms in some peculiar
-manner and thus opposed a successful barrier to the current, which
-otherwise, and if taken singly, would have been too much for them. Half
-a dozen Zulus who had outstripped their comrades were the first to enter
-the stream in pursuit, which at the point where they took it was not so
-favourable, and about fifty yards in width.
-
-Though magnificent specimens of their race, burly and brawny, of immense
-chest depth and breadth of shoulder, the men in the stream could only
-advance at a slow pace in consequence of the slippery nature of the
-rocks and stones on which they had to tread, and on account of the rapid
-nature of the stream. So entirely were they absorbed in the excitement
-of the chase that they seemed to have no idea of encountering any risks
-as they ventured into the river.
-
-The main body of the pursuers meantime lined the banks, lustily cheering
-on their more adventurous comrades. Suddenly there rang out the
-simultaneous reports of half a dozen rifles, and as the smoke cleared
-away two or three arms raised above the blood-dyed waters of the
-torrent, which whirled the bodies of the baffled Zulus down and away
-from view, testified to the skill of the marksmen. As the surviving
-savages regained the opposite bank they gave a yell of defiance, which
-was answered by a volley which rendered several others _hors de combat_.
-The horsemen then mounted, and rode down to meet the rescued runners,
-who turned out to be messengers from headquarters, and the bearers of
-most welcome despatches from the Commander-in-Chief to General Wood, in
-which his lordship, in the most cordial, kind, and flattering manner,
-sent his congratulations and thanks to the latter, and those under his
-command, for the manner in which his camp had been defended in the last
-attack. A general parade was at once ordered, and the commander having
-formed up the entire force--horse, foot, artillery, and native
-contingent--read out in firm and ringing tones the welcome and
-honourable terms in which his lordship had expressed himself. By
-permission of the commandant three ringing cheers for the Queen were
-then given, followed by three as hearty for the Commander-in-Chief.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER V.
-
- Organization of column for relief of Ekowe--The march--Heliographic
- signals--Camp at Ginghilovo--Disposition of the troops--Zulu
- advance--The battle--English victory--Death of Colonel
- Northey--English losses--Zulu force and loss--Relief of
- Ekowe--Meeting of Pearson and Chelmsford--State of Ekowe
- garrison--Barrow's cavalry raid on Dabulamanzi's kraal--British
- sentry firing on British troops.
-
-
-We must now turn attention to Lord Chelmsford and his plan for the
-relief of Ekowe. Tenedos was the base from which he purposed starting;
-the distance between this and Ekowe, even by the short route discovered
-and improved by Pearson, is a good thirty-three miles. To accomplish
-this distance in wet weather and with almost insuperable difficulties in
-the way of transport was no light task. However, by the 27th of March
-all was ready for a start, and the relieving column set out in the
-following order. The vanguard was composed of the Naval Brigade, formed
-of the seamen and marines of her Majesty's ships "Shah" and
-"Tenedos"--640 men and two Gatlings; the 91st Regiment (ten companies),
-900 men; 99th Regiment (five companies), 400 men; 3rd Buffs (two
-companies), 180 men; Mounted Infantry, 150 men; Mounted Native
-Contingent, 200 men; Native Infantry Contingent, 1600 men--making a
-total of 3720 infantry and 350 cavalry. This leading division was
-commanded by Colonel Law, R.A. The second or rearward division, under
-the command of Colonel Pemberton, was composed of the bluejackets and
-sailors of the "Boadicea," 200 men and one Gatling; 37th Regiment, 900
-men; 3rd battalion 60th Rifles, 900 men; and two troops of mounted
-natives--thus giving a total of 2060 infantry and 190 cavalry--the two
-divisions making a grand aggregate of 6320 men, with 9-pounders and
-rocket-tubes. The convoy was made as small and compact as was compatible
-with the necessary carriage of supplies for the Ekowe garrison, and no
-tents were taken, each man being allowed only a blanket and a waterproof
-sheet. Still the waggons numbered 113, and there were also fifty Scotch
-carts on two wheels, and fifty-six pack-mules. Each waggon was strongly
-spanned, having twenty oxen instead of the usual eighteen. Two hundred
-rounds of ball cartridge per man were issued, each soldier carrying
-seventy rounds in his pouches, and the remaining 130 being carried in
-reserve by the pack-mules. These waggons and pack-animals marched in the
-closest possible order, and were capitally flanked and guarded by
-Nettleton's Native Contingent on the right, and that commanded by Barton
-on the left. In spite of the comparative smallness of the convoy, Lord
-Chelmsford managed to bring with him not only full supplies for the
-fort, but twelve days' complete rations for his own column. Most of the
-baggage was brought across the Tugela on the 28th, and, in spite of the
-flooded state of the river; no casualty occurred. The rain did not cease
-till daybreak on the 29th, when the passage was completed. It must be
-borne in mind that the Tugela at Fort Pearson, where the column
-crossed, is more than 600 yards wide, and it is then possible to
-estimate the difficulties encountered at the outset and before the
-journey could be fairly said to commence. But there were willing hands
-and zealous hearts to carry out Lord Chelmsford's minute and ever
-thoughtful instructions. No detail, even of the smallest, was omitted or
-forgotten by him, and with such men as Commissary-General Strickland,
-Surgeon-Major Tarrant, and his dozen assistant-surgeons, as well as
-Commissary Walton and Transport Officers Lawrence and Findlay, things
-were bound to go well.
-
-The first plan was to force a passage through to Ekowe with all possible
-despatch consistent with the safety of the column and its convoy, and
-then, having exchanged the garrison and having provisioned the brave
-little fortress for a month, to form another and corresponding post on
-the Inyezani hills, leaving the latter munitioned for a similar period.
-
-But this plan was afterwards considerably modified. On the first day's
-march no difficulties as to enemy or transport were experienced, the
-weather had cleared, and the road from the Tugela to Amatikula was far
-better than expected. Giving up all idea of the road by which Pearson
-had originally advanced when he first marched inland, Lord Chelmsford,
-following Colonel Pearson's advice, determined to move by the coast
-road, which crossed much more open country, was far more adapted for
-wheeled transport, and, indeed, for the march of all three arms, while
-it afforded fewer opportunities for the Zulus to attempt surprise. So
-satisfactory was the road on the first day's march that the only wonder
-was that it had not been previously destroyed by the Zulus. In fact, the
-column had made good more than half the distance before any serious
-difficulties began. It will be seen in the map that at the villages of
-Inyoni and Amatikula their respective rivers cross the old road. Now,
-these rivers cross the coast road as well as the main road, flowing from
-west to east, and several halts at these two places are mentioned; it is
-not intended to refer to these villages, but simply to the encampments
-on the banks of the rivers of the same name.
-
-On the arrival of the column at the Inyoni and Amatikula rivers the
-waggons were carefully packed in laager, and a well-made ditch and
-parapet formed around the camp. Sentries were posted at the various
-angles, and outlying piquets thrown well forward. No noise, or even loud
-talking was allowed, and the bivouac, for it could scarcely be called a
-camp, was each night as silent as a grave-yard. Two miles beyond the
-Zulu bank of the Tugela good camping-ground was passed, but the troops
-pushed on without any difficulty to the Inyoni river, finding the road
-very good, although a little heavy for the waggons, from the rains. They
-were so lightly laden, however, that the drivers managed to get the oxen
-along at a fair pace, the waggons marching four, and sometimes six
-abreast. Scarcely any water was met with, but numerous Zulu kraals were
-passed, so streams or wells must have been in the neighbourhood. The
-country through which the column passed was very open, affording no
-cover, except between three miles south of Inyoni and the banks of the
-river, where there is a gully with thick bush, which scouts carefully
-explored before the main body came up. The water of the Inyoni was found
-so brackish that the horses would scarcely drink of it. The Umsundusi
-and Amatikula rivers are very sweet, the latter particularly so.
-
-Leaving the Inyoni, the next river passed is the Umsundusi, which runs
-into the Amatikula, north-west of which lies the thorn country. The road
-thence to Ingesani is good, but there is a mud gully to the south of
-that place almost impassable after heavy rain. The column now marched
-more to their right, where the country was still open, although there
-was considerable cover in places, and kraals were seen around. Near the
-Umkukusi is a hill, which was occupied for a time, but from which
-nothing could be seen in the shape of an enemy. Keeping in a
-north-easterly direction they now reached a lower portion of the
-Inyesani, and then bore westerly for Ginghilovo, where on the afternoon
-of the 1st they encamped. Here a parley was held with the besieged, from
-Pearson's lofty signal-tower at Ekowe, and signals were made warning
-Lord Chelmsford of the impending Zulu attack.
-
-A few words of digression may here be allowed to the system of signals
-which proved of such use to both Pearson and Chelmsford at this
-juncture. When Lord Chelmsford came first to Tenedos and Fort Pearson,
-it became evident to him that Pearson was so completely blockaded that
-runners could rarely get through. It was at the same time most essential
-to his plans that the General should know exactly how the colonel's
-resources were lasting, and the exact time to which his garrison could
-hold out. In this emergency Haynes, of the Engineers, was sent for, and
-asked if he could not do something with the heliograph, and bring the
-rays of the sun into requisition for the transmission of messages. The
-General was at once seen, and although by no means sanguine, he gave
-every facility for the attempt. The difficulties were by no means light.
-In the first place there were no proper mirrors, and a most diminutive
-chamber looking-glass had to be employed. Then again there were no
-skilled or mechanically-trained workers for the improvised apparatus,
-and all appliances were of the most primitive nature. Another and, as
-was feared, the most fatal difficulty was that there was no way of
-attracting the notice of the Ekowe garrison, which from the nearest
-vantage-point, was fully thirty miles as the crow flies. Nothing
-daunted, however, by these obstacles Haynes persevered, and knowing that
-the lives of many gallant soldiers were dependent on success or failure,
-redoubled his exertions, which after long anxiety and delay were crowned
-with success. The most sanguine hopes lay in the fact that the Naval
-Brigade were with Pearson, and that some of them would undoubtedly be
-trained to mirror signalling. After much delay in getting everything
-ready, Haynes chose a bright sunshiny morning and went to the top of a
-hill about five miles from the fort and commenced his flashing, but
-without the smallest success. The church tower at Ekowe could be plainly
-seen, but there was no response, and it was evident that the attempts at
-communication were not noticed, or, if noticed, not understood. Nothing
-discouraged, although a little chaffed by his comrades, the young
-Engineer continued day by day, whenever there was a gleam of sunshine,
-to attend the hill and work his mirror. At length, after a whole week
-had passed before any indication from the garrison at Ekowe had been
-made, another thought struck Haynes, and this was to flash occasional
-whiffs of gunpowder to attract notice. To his intense delight, after a
-few attempts, this plan succeeded, and when a gleam was once flashed
-from the beleaguered fort in return the rest was all plain sailing.
-Another week, however, elapsed before a perfectly intelligible answer
-was received, and then it was found that Haynes's messages had been read
-from the beginning, but that they could not get the Ekowe answers at
-first to work. It is hardly necessary to mention how pleased Lord
-Chelmsford was, and that Haynes was sent for and thanked in the most
-flattering manner for his ingenuity and perseverance.
-
-As has been said, Pearson informed Lord Chelmsford of the imminent Zulu
-attack; he also added that his last raid had been successful and that
-some cattle had been captured; and that the road he had cut under fire
-through the bush southwards would shorten the advance or his sortie by
-at least five miles, and that his people were under no apprehensions of
-famine or assault for some days. He had improved his defences, his
-parapet having a command of six feet, flanked by a couple of well-made
-_caponnières_ on the northern and southern faces, with a loopholed
-building on the north-west and a sunken stockade in the south-west
-angle. His four guns--two Gatlings and two rocket-tubes, in addition to
-his Martini-Henrys--he considered sufficient to render his fort
-impregnable to everything except hunger, and should the latter come on
-through Lord Chelmsford's inability or delay in coming, he purposed
-making a final and desperate sortie for life and liberty. This message
-was committed to writing, and read out to the men, who answered it with
-cheers of delight and enthusiasm.
-
-At four a.m. on the 31st ult., in the early dawn the troops paraded
-outside the laager on the Inyoni. For the first day the march had been
-without impediment or opposition; progress here and there, it is true,
-was slightly impeded by portions of swampy ground; but so eager were the
-men to get forward that the waggons were pushed vigorously through the
-mud by willing hands. The 57th Regiment, which had only lately arrived
-from Ceylon, were a little out of condition, and the fatigue and wet had
-told upon them in a greater degree than the regiments arrived from
-England. After a pleasant march, the Amatikula river was reached, where
-the camp was formed with the waggons as usual in laager, and
-shelter-trenches formed at fifteen paces beyond. The night passed
-without any alarm, and at six the column marched for Ginghilovo.
-
-The drift on the Amatikula was so swollen that a long time was occupied
-in getting the waggons across it, and the result was that on Monday very
-few miles were made. Soon after the troops had crossed, outlying bands
-of Zulus were seen by the scouts hovering on the flanks, but no attack
-was attempted. The largest body of these Zulus kept moving in a line
-parallel with the English march. Towards the afternoon of this day
-Barrow's Horse was directed by Lord Chelmsford to make a reconnaissance
-in the direction of the kraal of Makuendo, another of Cetywayo's
-innumerable brothers, and they returned with the news that they had
-surprised and fired it. On the previous day Barrow had made a
-reconnaissance away to the north-east, at least seven or eight miles
-off, without falling in with any Zulus, whose power of concealment is
-certainly marvellous. At three o'clock on the 1st of April it became
-dark overhead, and a severe thunderstorm broke over the laager, wetting
-nearly every one to the skin. The night of the 1st of April will long be
-remembered by those who were with Lord Chelmsford on that occasion. Not
-a sound was heard in the camp, but outside the howls of the wandering
-jackal and the pariah dog were occasionally echoed by the hoarse scream
-of the foul birds which hover near a probable battle. At intervals were
-to be heard the patrols going their rounds in the fitful gleams of the
-moonlight, which were succeeded by black and rolling masses of cloud
-chasing each other in the sky, still thunder-laden and lurid. The
-whispered "Who goes there?" and the almost inaudible countersign, told,
-however, that the utmost vigilance was awake, and that all felt that
-England's honour was at stake. At two a.m. Lord Chelmsford, with two of
-his personal staff, went quietly round. This tour of inspection lasted
-till three o'clock, as here and there trifling details had to be changed
-and plans to be explained to the various officers who held the most
-important points of defence and danger. In front of the camp, but
-sheltered behind trenches and abattis, were that glorious and
-time-honoured corps, the 60th, who have no colours on which to record
-their proud deeds, but whose escutcheon is emblazoned with some of
-England's hardest-won fields. The General warmly eulogized the neat and
-workmanlike trenches made by his favourite greenjackets, and passed on
-next to Brackenbury, of the "Shah," who, with his "little bulldogs," as
-the bluejackets term the Gatlings, held the right angle of the
-entrenchment.
-
-Next to Brackenbury and his stout fellows came Clarke with his
-detachment of the 57th, and at the second corner were two 9-pounders
-excellently placed and guarded by their watchful gunners, eager as
-greyhounds held back in the leash. Round to the rear, but by no means a
-post of less honour, came the gallant old 91st, whose former Cape
-services have long been their pride and distinction. Four companies of
-this fine corps were here, and although the ranks were made up by drafts
-from many other corps, the men had wonderfully soon assumed the
-peculiarly smart bearing of their new corps. At the next angle were two
-more Gatlings, and prolonging the faces were posted two companies of the
-91st, then three companies of the Buffs, and the 99th. As nearly as
-possible in the left rear face Lieutenant Cane, of the "Shah," had
-charge of the ship's rocket-battery.
-
-Lord Chelmsford expressed himself extremely satisfied at the manner in
-which all his arrangements had been worked out, and the low murmur of
-gratification, which even discipline could not repress, showed how much
-his men were devoted to their chief.
-
-It was as nearly as possible a quarter past four when the welcome news
-was passed from man to man that the Zulus were seen in skirmishing
-order, supported by dense masses, away some miles off on the right
-front. It was nearly six o'clock, however, when the enemy's plan of
-attack appeared to be decided, and this delay, it has since been
-ascertained, arose from the fact that they had heard that the troops
-were about to inspan and march in the early morning, and the Zulu
-general anticipated catching them in all the confusion of starting. At
-six a.m., then, somewhat favoured by the long grass and weeds which want
-of time had not permitted the soldiers to cut down, the Zulu array was
-hurled upon the laager. The regiments which came on in front were the
-Unembomanaba and Unemsilya. These were in extended order, but much
-closer than skirmishing order; in fact, somewhat akin to the Prussian
-infantry first attack. These corps were flanked by the usual horns or
-wings, composed of the Nokene and Nodwen regiments, formed in respective
-columns right and left. In the rear, as the body or heart of the
-formation, were the Monamonosi and a favourite corps of the king's
-called Zwawani. Somapo was in chief command, while his lieutenant was
-Dabulamanzi.
-
-The British front enticed the Zulu force, as easy of attack, as the
-green-coated rifles were lying down in their shallow trenches, and their
-strength could not well be seen by the enemy. Nothing could have fallen
-out more fortunately, as the fire from those deadly tubes was doubly
-fatal in consequence of each man being enabled to have a firm rest for
-his weapon. There could not be a grander sight to a soldier's eye than
-to watch these magnificent specimens of savage pride coming on in their
-mighty strength to sweep the sturdy little riflemen from off the earth.
-Their white and coloured shields, the crests of leopard skin and
-feathers, and the wild oxtails dangling from their necks, gave them a
-terribly unearthly appearance. Every ten or fifteen yards their first
-line would halt, and a shot would be fired, and then, with an unearthly
-yell, they would again rush on with a sort of measured dance, while a
-humming and buzzing sound in time to their movement was kept up. When
-the first line of skirmishers came to within 300 yards, a terrible and
-deadly sheet of flame flashed from the shelter-pits, and a great number
-of the Zulu warriors reeled howling to the earth. This only seemed to
-incite the main body to renewed exertion, for they came up hurling
-themselves through the skirmishers, and not even allowing them to get
-out of their path, but dashing them to the ground in their rage to close
-with the main array. A perfect _feu d'enfer_ was now rained upon the
-denser masses of the Zulu main body, and this was maintained for at
-least twenty minutes, the savages coming on, still fed by columns from
-their rear, which deployed in excellent order as they reinforced the
-first line, and alternately halted, fired, and advanced, beaten back
-some scores of times, and returning as desperately as ever to the front.
-About half-past six this front attack and onward rush was checked by the
-gallant 60th. Lord Chelmsford on several occasions rode along their
-line, giving an occasional kind and complimentary word when a
-particularly good shot was made or an especial coolness was observed. A
-sudden and wonderfully well-executed change of front was now made,
-without the smallest confusion or delay, and the masses of Zulus in
-front faced to their right and ran round in column to the face held by
-the 57th and 91st. Here their courage was, if possible, more pronounced,
-and their welcome was as hot. The 91st had not so many good marksmen in
-their regiment as the colonel could have wished, as many of his best
-shots were taken to supply Indian reliefs; but even the youngest
-soldiers seemed to gain skill and inspiration from what they had seen
-performed by the 60th. The 57th ably fulfilled their share of the duty,
-and the torrent of lead poured upon the enemy from the murderous tubes
-of these seemed to literally plough through the hostile ranks.
-Notwithstanding this deadly hail, the Zulus came on with what was now
-the mute valour of despair. They had ceased to shout and only seemed
-anxious to dash upon the British bayonets. Twice, three times, a fourth,
-they literally swarmed up to the entrenchments, and if one break in the
-ranks had taken place the English loss must have been terrible. At one
-moment, about a quarter before seven, it seemed as though they would
-have forced their way in, and upon several occasions wounded Zulus were
-noticed taking aim from behind the cover of the bodies of their dead
-comrades as they lay in pools of blood in the open. Now that they were
-within easy range from the tops of the waggons, an effective and galling
-fire was opened upon the Zulus by the native contingents, who were not
-allowed in the first line. This double tier of fire was of great help,
-and so far thinned the assailant ranks that the second attack was after
-a time renounced as hopeless. Once more, however, a shorter, more
-desperate, but, as it proved, final rush was made by Cetywayo's doomed
-and devoted troops. This time it was upon the left of the laager that
-they delivered their last and supreme effort. They came up on this
-occasion to within ten or fifteen feet of the muzzles of the men's
-rifles, and, indeed, one or two of their chiefs seized the hot barrels
-with one hand, while they stabbed at the men with their shortened or
-broken assegais. It was curious to remark the three separate lines of
-Zulu corpses which marked the respective ranges at which the
-death-dealing Martini-Henrys had swept their ranks. At 300 yards a thin
-boundary of black bodies and white shields might be traced; at 200 and
-100 yards from our lines their walls of dead were more thick, and even
-up to the trenches wounded men had staggered to receive their _coup de
-grâce_. In spite of all their efforts, the Zulus, however, never
-succeeded in bringing matters to a hand-to-hand struggle, though, if
-they had done so, Lord Chelmsford's admirable formation would have
-doubtless saved the camp, although no doubt with more than treble loss.
-The last attack, and perhaps the boldest--for it was evidently the most
-desperate--was led most heroically by Dabulamanzi in person, who, with
-voice and gesture, came on a dozen yards in front of the leading files,
-as Ney led on his Guard at Waterloo. As on that occasion the French
-horsemen, so now these stalwart warriors could not stand against the
-calm, steady, and unflurried _mitraille_ of English infantry fire, and
-at seven o'clock the flower of Cetywayo's warriors were scattered and
-broken on the plain they had so magnificently fought and drenched with
-their blood. Lord Chelmsford saw the moment had come; Barrow, who had
-already mounted his men in anticipation, scarcely waited for the orderly
-to repeat the permission to dash forth. Away charged the little band of
-sabres, and the mounted infantry came at the flying groups like a
-whirlwind, their sabres flashing bright in the morning sun, but soon
-dyed crimson with the best of the Zulu blood.
-
-During the attack 1200 rounds were fired from the splendidly served
-Gatlings, and about 40 rounds of case and shrapnel from the 9-pounders,
-which subsequently shelled the bush as the Zulus fled for cover. Colonel
-Crealock, military secretary, and Captain Molyneux, of Lord Chelmsford's
-staff, had their chargers shot under them. Poor young Johnstone, of the
-99th, was killed at nearly the commencement of the fight; and Colonel
-Northey was badly hit early in the action. He at first could not be
-induced to leave his men, but at last was reluctantly compelled to do
-so, as he fainted from loss of blood. At the close of the action,
-however, and when he was aroused from his state of insensibility by the
-ringing echoes of the British cheers which proclaimed the flight of the
-enemy, he suddenly raised himself on one hand from under the waggon
-where he was lying, and joined in the shouts of the men, thus bursting
-the bandaged wound and causing violent hemorrhage to recommence. This
-gallant and valued officer subsequently died, on the afternoon of the
-6th, having lingered in considerable pain for four days. The entire
-English loss was wonderfully small, being but 2 officers and 4 privates
-killed, and 3 officers and 34 privates wounded! The Zulu loss, on the
-contrary, cannot altogether be set down at less than 1000; for the
-English troops buried between 700 and 800 Zulu corpses; and about 300
-rifles, which they discarded in their flight, were subsequently picked
-up. Zulu prisoners stated that there were 180 companies present with
-Somapo and Dabulamanzi on the 2nd, and allowing each company to be
-composed of 60 warriors, the actual fighting array must have been about
-11,000. Information was also shortly afterwards received that another
-impi of about the same strength was despatched the day after Dabulamanzi
-marched from the king's kraal at Ulundi, and this latter force, misled
-by erroneous information, was unable to effect the intended junction
-with the force defeated. These prisoners also maintain that neither
-Somapo nor Dabulamanzi was aware of Lord Chelmsford's march for Ekowe
-till the day before he was assailed. Barrow's admirably planned and
-executed reconnaissances and raids on the 30th, 31st, and 1st
-undoubtedly had much to do with hoodwinking the Zulus, and it is
-tolerably certain that the military promenade made by him on the 31st
-towards the Ingoya led them to believe that the whole force was likely
-to operate in that direction.
-
-On the following day, the 57th, 60th, and 91st were formed into a flying
-column, taking with them nothing but some light Scotch carts and three
-days' rations, together with the mounted men and some of the Naval
-Brigade, and started _en route_ by way of the coast road for Ekowe. The
-portions of the Buffs, 99th, and a detachment of the "Shah's" men were
-left behind to garrison Ginghilovo, under the command of Major Walker.
-The heliograph was set to work, and Pearson replied that he should
-certainly come out to meet Lord Chelmsford and his party. At daybreak,
-therefore, Barrow went on with his horsemen to reconnoitre, and to see
-if any remnant or fresh portion of the Zulu army lay between Ekowe and
-its relievers. The line of country to be traversed was known to be more
-difficult than that passed, and it was thought that the Zulus might have
-had sufficient tenacity of purpose to make one more effort to stay the
-general's purpose. The first part of the journey was anything but
-pleasant; swamps, morasses, bogs, watercourses, nullahs, spruits,
-boulders, and all the disagreeable features of South Africa were in
-abundance; progress, consequently, was very much impeded, and at one
-time it was thought the troops would have to encamp on the way, and make
-a two days' march of the journey. Several small but awkward streams had
-to be crossed, and the General very wisely served out an extra ration of
-grog after the passage of these places.
-
-After travelling about five miles, a halt for breakfast was called, and
-here Barrow rode back to report that all was clear in front, and that
-not a single Zulu could be seen, although the plains and bush had been
-most diligently scoured. Barrow reported that in the direction he had
-been, assegais, shields, feathers, ear and head ornaments, skins, furs,
-blankets, and even guns were lying about in profusion, evidently cast
-away in the hurried and headlong flight of the Zulus to their kraals,
-but that no bodies, however, had as yet been seen by the scouts.
-
-The shrill notes of the bugles sounded the halt, and soon after the
-"Prepare to dismount," and "Off-saddle." Although no precaution was
-neglected to guard against surprise, a certain amount of latitude was
-now allowed, which on the previous three days' marches had not been
-sanctioned. Piquets, as usual, were thrown out on the neighbouring
-heights, and a chain of vedettes posted, which commanded ten miles of
-country in every direction. This being effected, the infantry formed up
-and piled arms, the cavalry off-saddled, and the horses, having first
-been allowed their usual roll in the dusty veldt, were turned out, under
-the protection of a guard, to enjoy a short graze, having, of course,
-been previously knee-haltered. This knee-haltering process is universal
-throughout all the Cape Colonies, and is effected in the following
-manner: by simply taking a couple of half-hitches round the horse's
-fore-leg with a strong rein or reim attached to the neck-strap, which
-brings the animal's head towards the ground, and effectually prevents
-his running away. This is the simple precaution adopted by all
-travellers in South Africa. The men now were told off in sections to
-draw water and collect wood to make fires for their morning or midday
-coffee. The officers collected in groups, and compared notes and
-exchanged anecdote and repartee.
-
-After an hour's rest, which men and horses required after their severe
-four days' work, the bugles again summoned all to the ranks, and they
-started anew to complete the journey.
-
-From this halting-place the road had a rather dangerous appearance, and
-every precaution was taken, lest Dabulamanzi should have received any
-reinforcements, which would enable him to attack the somewhat weak
-column at a disadvantage. The road over which they were passing was in
-itself open and fairly easy of transit, but not far to the left, and
-running parallel to the waggon-track, there were patches of bush so
-dense that horsemen could not enter, and they had to be examined with
-the aid of an infantry contingent, a few of whom had fortunately been
-brought in case of an emergency of this sort. Not far from the foot of
-one of the ascents to Ekowe on the left of the column lay the spot where
-Pearson was attacked on the 22nd January, and which, although called the
-battle of Inyazani, is some distance from the banks of that river. Some
-cavalry were taken over by Barrow to explore, but nothing marked the
-locality of the action except a large mound and a roughly carved cross
-where the dead were laid. On this cross were roughly cut the names of
-those who lay at rest below. Leaving at length the bushy country, the
-column now came to some steep and broken ground, and here were seen the
-remains of some of the waggons which had to be abandoned from Ely's
-convoy. Strange to say, some of the contents, tins of provisions and
-other stores, were still intact; but no arms nor ammunition had been
-left behind. Seven miles from Ekowe the troops came to a plain from
-which they were divided by a broad and well-worn watercourse. Here they
-faced the steep and scarped sides of a mountain, and in the distance
-could see a long unbroken range over which the sun was beginning to set.
-At this spot the Zulus had evidently attempted to impede the advance, as
-part of the road had been cut away. Engineers, however, soon remedied
-the damage, and they were enabled to push on; although it was fortunate
-that they had no waggons, as it was not without considerable effort they
-managed to get the two-wheeled carts across. As soon as this spot had
-been passed, the whole character of the landscape changed as if by
-magic; and as the wind freshened and carried away some misty clouds, the
-remnants of the late rains, a splendid prospect was seen, as the column
-wound its slow trail along a steep and rugged kloof leading into a fair
-and fertile valley beyond. Here, however, was a position that might have
-been held for some considerable time had the enemy chosen this spot to
-oppose the march. A sheer precipitous rock frowned on the right, and the
-only possible track lay exactly under its base, where with a few
-resolute savages above, huge boulders and masses of rock could have been
-hurled upon the column as it passed. On the left was a spongy swamp
-perfectly impassable to wheels, and not particularly easy to troops or
-human feet. Here a short way up the mountain farther on were seen the
-remains of a ruined kraal, and of some huts apparently not long vacated.
-These dwellings were formed, as usual, of rudely twined canes wattled
-and filled in with clay, and they had somewhat the appearance of a
-cluster of huge beehives.
-
-As the leading files quitted the low ground, signals were made by the
-advanced patrols that cavalry were in sight, and the General and several
-of his staff at once galloped past the column to the front. All
-anxieties were briefly at an end, for, mounted upon an exceedingly
-handsome charger, and attended by a numerous cavalcade, coming towards
-the column at a smart canter was the gallant soldier who had held his
-inhospitable guard at Ekowe for more than seventy days.
-
-Lord Chelmsford at once spurred forward, and warmly grasped Colonel
-Pearson by the hand, whilst discipline for once gave way, and the
-respectful silence of the General's escort was broken by a cheer such as
-only English throats can give, waking up every echo of the Zulu caves
-and valleys.
-
-Colonel Pearson brought with him, according to his promise, about 500
-men, and his staff, consisting of Colonel Walker and Captains M'Gregor
-and Knight. A long conversation at once took place, and the General
-informed Colonel Pearson that, anticipating the evacuation of the fort,
-he had left part of his force to entrench Ginghilovo, and make it a
-permanent station. The reasons for this were manifold. In the first
-place the approaches to Ekowe were easy to the Zulus, unencumbered with
-baggage or other _impedimenta_, but most difficult and trying to a
-European force. Ginghilovo or its neighbourhood answered every purpose
-as a link in the line of communications, while a site could be chosen
-equally as formidable in a defensive point of view. The column did not
-reach Ekowe fort till nearly eleven p.m. Here the welcome of comrades,
-fellow-messmates, and men of the same ships and corps, was a happy and
-fitting sequel to the _rencontre_ of the reliever and the relieved.
-
-It was a pleasant surprise to the General on arriving at Ekowe to find
-that matters had been made much worse by report than they were in
-reality. No gaunt and famine-stricken faces greeted him, but, on the
-contrary, there was a look of plumpness about most of the privates that
-savoured more of want of exercise than want of beef. In fact, the
-medical officer stated that the meat ration had never been diminished,
-as it was considered just as advisable to kill and consume the trek oxen
-as to see them die for want of forage. Now a trek ox in the best
-condition is not particularly tender, or even when fed upon the best of
-food, but when kept short of fodder, and without proper shelter from the
-sun and rain, he cuts up anything but well for beef. Tobacco was the
-article most wanted by both soldiers and sailors, and the most agreeable
-gift that could be made by the relievers to their lately besieged
-comrades was this luxury in any form or shape. The health of the
-garrison at first was good, but gradually the want of vegetables and
-useful medicines filled the hospitals, and made the cemetery more full.
-Anxiety, doubtless, had much to do with the sick-roll, and until
-communications with St. Andrew's Mission had been established a certain
-amount of uneasiness was felt as to how the war was going. Thirty deaths
-occurred during the seventy days the garrison were shut up, but several
-of these, it must be remembered, were cases of wounded men from the
-fighting at the Inyezani. At Fort Ekowe the hero of the scouting parties
-was undoubtedly young Rowden, of the 99th, who was detailed by Colonel
-Pearson to form a mounted infantry corps similar to Barrow's, from
-volunteers from the Buffs and his own corps. It is no secret that one of
-the great advantages we possess in our service is that we are never at a
-loss, when we can get horses, to find riders. Most of our youngsters in
-the service would rather have a stigma on their morals than on their
-knowledge of horseflesh and of horsemanship, and herein lies the secret
-of our bearing up against our first reverses in Zululand. Every officer,
-serving in South Africa, whether cavalry, infantry, artillery,
-engineers, medical staff, or commissariat, gets rations or allowances
-for horse or horses, according to his rank. This is one of the secrets,
-combined with the sport and shooting, why South African service is so
-popular. Now both the 99th and the Buffs vied with the 13th and 90th in
-their equestrian proclivities, and, in default of regular cavalry, a
-large body of mounted infantry was raised, and in a great measure
-mounted from the horses belonging to the officers of their respective
-regiments, lent or sold to Government for the purpose. Rowden's patrols
-were literally the "eyes and ears" of the garrison, and ably fulfilled
-all the onerous duties of light cavalry. In short the great value of
-their services may be gathered from the frequently and openly stated
-opinions of Colonel Wood and of Colonel Pearson, that all infantry
-regiments serving at the Cape should have at least one Gatling and one
-mounted company.
-
-The great event of the camp life in Ekowe was the discovery of certain
-queer flashes of light on the white walls of the church tower. These,
-after puzzling many of the officers and soldiers, were at length brought
-under the notice of an officer of the naval brigade, whose education in
-the use of the heliograph enabled him at once to explain the apparent
-mystery. Three days of unpleasant suspense, however, elapsed before the
-first message could be clearly made out, and then three more before an
-apparatus could be rendered workable to reply. Fortunately an old mirror
-was found, and this, with an empty wooden cartridge case, sufficed.
-Within the week, therefore, conversation was opened, and its effect on
-the imprisoned garrison was seen by all to be more beneficial than all
-the tonics the hospital could afford. The next great event was,
-perhaps, the construction of the road from the fort to the lower coast
-trek, and the consequent excitement of having to work with the chance of
-feeling an assegai or Zulu bullet whizzing into the party. But the long
-days and longer nights were not at all devoid of recreation. Lawn
-tennis, bowls, ninepins, and quoits were devised. Concerts were
-organized, and dramatic recitals on a modest scale were improvised.
-
-A cavalry raid had been, it will be remembered, made some time back upon
-Dabulamanzi's kraal, which was shelled and burned by Pearson. Some
-cattle and sheep were captured, and a desultory and running fight was
-kept up between the discomfited chief and the English patrols, which
-resulted in no casualty to the troops, while several Zulus were killed.
-This attack did not, however, extend to Dabulamanzi's private
-habitation, as its approaches were considered too far off and too
-difficult of access. No sooner, however, had Lord Chelmsford arrived at
-Ekowe than he determined to complete the blow already commenced. It was
-decided to effect this raid with Barrow's horsemen. The whole affair was
-promptly and admirably organized, and at eight o'clock on the morning
-after Lord Chelmsford's arrival a group of officers might have been seen
-on foot conversing, while their horses were led up and down by the
-attendant orderlies. First of all there was the Commander-in-chief, and
-with him his military secretary, Colonel Crealock, whose recent wound
-did not even place him for one day upon the sick report. Major Barrow
-was there in his workmanlike dress, a Norfolk shirt patched with
-leather, high untanned boots, and a stout sabre at his side. With him
-were John Dunn, Lieutenants Sugden, Rawlins, and Courtenay, Captains
-Addison, M'Lean, and Ganz.
-
-The entire force consisted of 50 mounted infantry under Barrow, 55
-volunteers under Addison, and 120 volunteers under Ganz and M'Lean. At a
-quarter to nine the cavalcade had been inspected by their respective
-commanders, and in sections of fours moved off, amid the smiles and
-congratulations of the garrison. The road was as usual over that
-sweet-smelling and springy turf which makes walking an impossibility,
-and any pace but a canter impossible to man and beast. A little more
-than half an hour, or about a four-mile spurt over the elastic veldt,
-brought them in sight of Dabulamanzi's "great place." A rolling grassy
-plain, leading to some easy and gentle slopes, was presented to view,
-and evidently to the astonishment of most of the party, who had been
-accustomed to the rude and rocky fastnesses in which these kraals are
-usually built. Beyond these smiling and inviting hills the kraal itself
-could scarcely be seen, but its locality was indicated by half a dozen
-Zulus running away with some cattle at full speed. Their measures were
-quickly taken, as their information forbade them to imagine that any
-trap could be laid, and they knew that the chances were ten to one
-against the chief having any force near enough to make a stand against
-them. Lord Chelmsford paid Major Barrow the high compliment of allowing
-him to take an independent command of the whole party, and remained more
-as a spectator than as an active official on the scene. Barrow at once
-detached mounted portions of his men right and left, while he led the
-way direct at a smart canter at the kraal. The combined movement
-answered admirably, and the place was surrounded as if by magic, without
-any resistance or a shot being fired. Rawlins, and a few of Barrow's
-men, were now ordered to dash into the kraal, and as soon as they had
-assured themselves that there were no women or children or sick people
-there, to fire it in various places. They had scarcely galloped off to
-carry out this order when the silence was broken by the well-known
-"ping" of a rifle, sounding from the near vicinity of the kraal; and on
-looking in the direction from which the sound came the General and his
-staff could see a small group of Zulus taking deliberate aim at them.
-The distance was about 1200 yards. But the General still moved on,
-although the bullet had been well aimed, for it whizzed just over the
-head of one of his aides-de-camp; and John Dunn, putting up his glass,
-declared that he recognized Dabulamanzi by his head-dress and peculiar
-method of walking. With the utmost nonchalance John began to load his
-weapon, and remarked to the General, "See what will happen!" One of the
-Zulus at this moment was coolly making a rest for his rifle upon a ledge
-of rock behind which his chief had retired, and Dunn, taking a long and
-careful aim, fired, and evidently wounded his man, who slipped back into
-the arms of a comrade. As the party sent to fire the kraal emerged from
-its outer enclosure, a heavy cloud of smoke betokened that their mission
-was accomplished. This white column hid the horsemen from the natives,
-who finding themselves in danger of being surrounded and captured by
-Sugden and his detached party, made a hasty and somewhat undignified
-retreat. The General now moved round to the right, and found that the
-detached party under Nettleton were coming back with a fine young Zulu,
-whom they had overtaken and captured on the left of the kraal. They had
-secured him with some buffalo-hide girths, and he readily--too readily
-for belief--answered John Dunn's questions, informing him that the
-cattle, women, and children had time to escape from the kraal, as the
-horsemen were discovered cantering across the open. He added that had
-they advanced a little faster they would have captured them. But this
-was not their object, and they were rather glad not to have the
-encumbrance of prisoners, remembering the trouble Oham's wives and
-relations gave at Kambula.
-
-The return to Ekowe was accomplished without further incident. On the
-following day, having destroyed as much of the fortifications at Ekowe
-as time would permit, they started upon the return journey to the camp
-at Ginghilovo. They overtook Pearson in laager after having marched
-about six miles; and while he and his column moved on later in the day
-to his destination on the Lower Tugela, Lord Chelmsford and his division
-halted and laagered camp at about two miles north of Inyezani, and about
-five from Ginghilovo. Here an unfortunate disaster occurred. A young
-sentry of the 91st fancied he saw Zulus in the bush. He at once, without
-challenging, as he should have done, fired. The picket to which he
-belonged at once retired, and as Dunn's scouts were out reconnoitring,
-they ran in upon the next picket to the camp, composed also of young
-soldiers of the 60th, who, mistaking them for Zulus charging upon the
-laager, recklessly opened fire, by which four of their own men were
-wounded and one killed, while nine of the unfortunate scouts were badly
-wounded. The officer commanding the picket did all he could to steady
-his men, and did not even retire with them, so he was quite blameless.
-On the 24th April they reached the entrenchments at Ginghilovo, which
-were about two miles from the former laager, and Lord Chelmsford, having
-given the fullest instructions in regard to strengthening and guarding
-the camp, started on the following day for Fort Tenedos, _en route_ for
-Durban, to reorganize an immediate advance.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER VI.
-
- End of first period of the Zulu war--Organization of fresh
- advance--Reinforcements from England--Scene in
- Durban--Disembarkation of troops--Cavalry camp at Berea--Lord
- Chelmsford's arrival at Durban--His reception--Review of Lancers and
- King's Dragoons at Cato Manor--Plan of new campaign--Composition of
- No. 1 column--Composition of No. 2 column--Cask bridge over
- Amatikula--Forts Crealock and Chelmsford--Wood's reconnaissance to
- Blood River--Description of Blood River and its scenery--Appearance
- of Buller's Light Horse--Removal of Wood's Kambula camp--Grandier's
- capture and escape--His tale--Description of Dabulamanzi and
- Cetywayo--Death of Dabulamanzi.
-
-
-The relief of Ekowe, and the Zulu defeats at Ginghilovo and Kambula,
-mark in a most unmistakable manner the conclusion of the first period of
-the Zulu war. All fear of an invasion of Natal was now completely
-dissipated, and the only task that remained to be accomplished was to
-organize a force to carry an offensive war into the heart of Cetywayo's
-kingdom. Kambula and Ginghilovo had neutralized the disastrous results
-of Isandhlwana--the winning blow was still to be struck. It will be
-remembered that after the fatal field of Isandhlwana no time had been
-lost in applying to England for large reinforcements, and the home
-authorities were in no way slack in acceding to this urgent appeal. Lord
-Chelmsford on his part was no less active in preparing and getting
-these forces to the front, and though to the ordinary observer there
-might seem to be a period of inaction and sloth, since there was indeed
-a necessary lull in active operations, yet in reality no cessation of
-labour really occurred in any of the military departments. Within one
-month seventeen transports brought from England and landed on the shores
-of South Africa more than 9000 troops and 2000 horses, and all the
-munitions and stores, not only for the maintenance of such a force, but
-also for other regiments at the front. As each ship arrived at the outer
-anchorage, she was discharged without difficulty, and in no case were
-the troops kept on board an unnecessary hour, while in no instance was
-any damage, accident, or loss sustained during the process of
-disembarkation. To the enterprise, energy, and forethought of the
-contractors was due this satisfactory result; and the timely engagement
-of all the available steam-tugs by these authorities enabled them to
-carry out their undertaking in a manner beyond the most sanguine
-anticipations. In addition to the employment of the tugs "Union,"
-"Somtsen," "Adonis," and others, the hulls of two fine schooners were
-prepared and specially adapted for the accommodation of horses, and
-these being lashed alongside the transports, with the aid of
-steam-cranes and excellent wharves, the rest was not a matter of
-difficulty. The weather, most fortunately, was generally favourable,
-while the equinoctial gales were so slight that the dreaded bar was
-never quite impassable. There were at this time no less than sixteen
-magnificent steam-transports, some of them the largest afloat, lying at
-the outer anchorage. Twenty-three vessels were in the inner harbour,
-and there were, irrespective of local tenders and tugs, at least thirty
-vessels in the roads. Such a sight had never been seen in the colony,
-and Durban will never again exhibit such a martial aspect. While from
-time to time returns were issued of the reinforcements as they arrived,
-no complete field state was made out till April 16th. It will be well
-here to give a brief _résumé_. In the "Egypt" and "Spain" were embarked
-at Southampton the King's Dragoon Guards, whose muster-roll gave 31
-officers, 622 men, 91 officers' chargers, and 480 troop-horses. In the
-"France" and "England" were the 17th Lancers, numbering 31 officers, 622
-men, 91 officer's chargers, and 480 troop-horses. These embarked at
-Blackwall and Southampton. The "Manora" and "Olympus," from Southampton,
-brought M and N Batteries, 6th Brigade Royal Artillery, with 10
-officers, 536 men, and 161 troop-horses. The "Palmyra," from Chatham,
-came with the 30th company Royal Engineers, composed of 6 officers, 196
-men, 2 officers' chargers, and 44 troop-horses. The "City of Paris,"
-from Queenstown, brought the 21st Royal North British Fusiliers, with 30
-officers, 906 men, and 7 officers' chargers. The "Russia," from
-Portsmouth, embarked the 58th Foot, consisting of 30 officers, 906 men,
-and 7 officers' chargers; while the same vessel brought the 3rd
-battalion 60th Rifles, with 30 officers, 906 men, and 7 officers'
-chargers. From Ceylon came the 57th Foot, which, with drafts from
-England, made up 30 officers, 906 men, and 7 chargers. The "China," from
-Southampton, brought these drafts, calling at Ceylon for the 57th. The
-same fine and roomy ship brought also from Southampton the 94th Foot,
-with 30 officers, 906 men, and 7 chargers. The "City of Venice," from
-Queenstown, brought the 3rd and 4th companies of the Army Service Corps
-(transport branch); while the "Queen Margaret," from Woolwich, brought
-No. 5 company of the same, the whole making up 19 officers, 550 men, and
-480 horses. The "Palmyra," as well as the Engineers from Chatham,
-brought 4 officers and 140 men of the Army Hospital Corps from
-Portsmouth. The numerical strength of these reinforcements was
-therefore, according to return, exactly as follows:--Cavalry, two
-regiments, making 1250 sabres; artillery, two batteries, 12 guns, and
-540 men; engineers, one company, 190 men; infantry, six regiments, 5320
-bayonets; Army Service Corps and drafts, 1200; total, 8500 men and 1871
-horses. The two batteries of artillery were not armed alike, the one
-being equipped with the usual 9-pounder field-gun, and the other having
-the six new 7-pounders similar to those employed in Abyssinia, but
-mounted, owing to the advice of General Sir John Bissett, K.C.B., upon
-the tall and special Kaffrarian carriages recently introduced into the
-service. These carriages are totally different from the small 7-pounder
-carriages with which the Abyssinian guns were fitted, as they are raised
-upon wheels five feet in height, the carriage, although lighter, being
-exactly the same as to size as that used for the 9-pounder of eight cwt.
-These little guns, however, weigh only 200 lb., and have rather a queer
-dwarfed appearance mounted on their long axles, between their tall
-wheels; but the plan was found in many cases successful in this and
-late Kaffir campaigns, owing to the obstacles presented to the dwarfed
-carriage by the long grass so abundant in all parts of the colony. Mules
-had also arrived for these guns from Malta and Gibraltar. Most of the
-regiments brought out their own equipment complete and ready for the
-field--tents, waterproof sheets, cooking utensils, barrack and camp
-stores--which enabled them to be ready at once for the forward movement.
-This arrangement was not fully carried out by the Royal Artillery and
-Army Service Corps, as they had a long train of carriages to take to the
-front; but the company of the Army Service Corps which came in the
-"Queen Margaret" from Woolwich brought 100 splendid waggons, light yet
-of great strength, and others came from Queenstown in the "City of
-Venice." As the transports engaged for the infantry regiments had a
-considerable quantity of spare room for cargo, all the available space
-was utilized for stores, munitions, and supplies. Preserved meats,
-preserved vegetables, and other victualling stores were landed in
-quantities of an almost alarming nature, while about twenty tons of
-7-pounder shells had arrived by the "Donald Currie," "Duart Castle," and
-other hired transports.
-
-Undoubtedly the most interesting event to both civil as well as military
-circles in Durban was the arrival of the two cavalry regiments destined
-for the front. The absence of cavalry was indeed one of the great
-defects in our army, and had there been previously a couple of regiments
-of real light cavalry the progress of the campaign would doubtless have
-taken a far more favourable turn, while some of our misfortunes or
-disasters would never have happened. The value of cavalry was so
-abundantly manifested by the services of Piet Uys, Colonels Russell and
-Buller, Major Barrow, and Captain Rowden, that it would be idle to dwell
-upon the subject. In the expedition, again, to Ekowe, how completely was
-the value of this force shown by Major Barrow's horsemen! This officer
-had not more than 200 sabres with him, while at least half of these were
-natives; but the completeness of the success achieved by General
-Chelmsford was attributed in a great measure by his lordship to the
-services of this contingent, who were literally the eyes and ears of the
-main column. They were, during the march, effectually scouting the
-country around, ahead, and in rear, and so constantly did they perform
-this work that the Zulu spies, who swarmed around, could not by any
-possibility get close enough to learn the real strength of the column.
-Again, until Zlobani, all or nearly all Wood's most brilliant successes
-were gained by his mounted men, and he himself never ceased deploring
-the absence of a stronger body of horsemen. The "Spain" and "Egypt,"
-which brought out the King's Dragoon Guards to their first South African
-service, two as fine-looking vessels as ever floated in African seas,
-both arrived and anchored in the outer roadstead on Sunday morning, the
-13th. The "Spain" made a most successful voyage, having left Southampton
-on the 27th of February, touched at St. Vincent on 16th March, and
-arrived at Capetown on 5th April. She had on board 312 troops and 286
-horses. There was scarcely any sickness at all on board during the
-voyage, and all the horses, both officers' chargers and troopers, were
-landed in a very fair condition. The horses submitted to the slinging,
-almost without an exception, with the greatest docility, and the whole
-of them were landed in a wonderfully short space of time, considering
-the distance and the state of the weather. The whole of the left wing of
-the regiment was on shore by half-past five, and was at once marched to
-the 17th Lancers' encampment at the foot of the Berea. The "Egypt" was a
-trifle less in tonnage than the "Spain," but the difference would not be
-noticed by an unprofessional eye. She had on board 20 officers, 300
-troops, and 300 horses. Her horses were also in excellent condition, and
-were all landed on the 14th. By the 16th the men had quite settled down
-in their new quarters at the cavalry camp at the Berea, and everything
-was in the most admirable order. The ground was admirably chosen for the
-1250 horsemen who were there under canvas, and the considerations of
-water, wood, health, and position were all carefully thought of and
-provided. Each regiment was formed in column of troops, occupying 172
-yards of front and 130 yards of depth. From the centre to centre of
-tents was ten yards, and each horse picketed was allowed four feet by
-twenty feet. In front of the camp was a fine open space of level parade,
-which was employed as a parade-ground for duty, and an agreeable lounge
-and sort of out-door club after stable-hours. The hours for _réveille_
-and tattoo, the time for the promulgation of orders, the arrangements
-for rations and forage, the position of the brigade office, commanding
-officer's tent, headquarters, commissariat depôt, hospital and guards,
-the postal arrangements for letters and telegrams, the arrangements for
-water for men and horses, the police arrangements, the detail for guards
-and pickets, the detail of other duties, and the statement of returns
-required, were all noted in daily orders, and printed for circulation
-amongst men and officers. By this means a system of discipline was
-established as strict and regular as if in presence of an enemy, and
-every officer and non-commissioned officer was made acquainted with the
-usual system of encampment in his branch of the service, and the
-principles which govern such arrangements, in regard particularly to
-quickness of change and means of transport, compactness, and safety from
-an enemy's attack by day or surprise by night. On April 12th General
-Lord Chelmsford and staff arrived back at Durban by special train from
-the Lower Tugela, _viâ_ Jaccharine, at 6.45. With him were Colonel
-Crealock, military secretary, Commodore Richards, and Lieutenant Milne.
-A very large crowd was at the station to greet the General.
-
-Not the least notable figure among the brilliant group who waited to
-receive the Commander-in-chief was that of the Prince Imperial of
-France, whose bright, intelligent face, as he conversed with Sir John
-Bissett, was lit up with the anticipation of a possible campaign.
-
-Besides General Sir John Bissett and the Prince Imperial, there were
-present at the railway station Major-General Newdigate, Major-General
-Marshall, Major-General Clifford, V.C., Colonel Bellairs, D.A.G.,
-Colonel Riley, Major Huskisson, Captain Somerset, Hon. W. Drummond,
-Captain Granville, and many others.
-
-The 19th of April was a day that will long be remembered in Durban; for
-then was seen a sight such as had never before been beheld in that town,
-and probably will never be repeated. On that day Lord Chelmsford
-inspected the two lately arrived regiments of cavalry, the 17th Lancers
-and the King's Dragoon Guards. As each regiment passed before the
-General, it was noticed that its rear squadron had attached to it half a
-company, and its usual complement of store and supply waggons. These
-consisted of four waggons, carrying three days' supplies of food, and
-one day's oats for the horses, four waggons for squadron equipments,
-such as tents, blankets, and cooking utensils, together with one
-headquarter waggon and one quarter-master's stores waggon, making ten
-vehicles in all. Each of these waggons was drawn by four horses, while
-the armourers' forge waggon was drawn by six horses, and the ambulance
-waggon by six fine mules. Both regiments were in full dress, but in the
-lightest possible marching order, but even in this, the men's average
-weight was not less than 18 stone. The regiments were both encamped at
-Cato Manor, which is admirably suited to cavalry purposes, having good
-grass and plenty of wood and water. The column extended a long distance,
-and wound its way along West Street, Abnel Street, Smith Street, past
-the Royal Hotel and the new club, and _viâ_ Field Street back to the
-Manor, where the inspection and march past were held in the presence of
-the General-in-chief. The top of West Street was reached at half-past
-seven, and here the largest crowd was assembled. At the corner of
-Gardner Street the column was joined by Lord Chelmsford, who was loudly
-cheered, while handkerchiefs were waved from every carriage and window.
-Outside the town gardens a number of private carriages were drawn up,
-and each of these was fully occupied by ladies in full toilette, who
-seemed delighted at the novelty of the spectacle. Such a sight as six
-hundred British cavalry seemed to raise the enthusiasm of the
-townspeople to a great pitch, and on all sides expressions of delight
-and gratification at the fine and imposing appearance of the two corps
-were freely vented. The entrance to the picturesque grounds of the manor
-is situated within easy walking distance of the town, but in Natal few
-people ever think of pedestrian exercise, so that the cavalcade was
-supplemented by almost an equal number of mounted spectators of both
-sexes. The cavalry brigade was, as soon as it entered the manor, wheeled
-into line, and after receiving Lord Chelmsford with a general salute,
-was minutely inspected by his lordship, who expressed himself in the
-most flattering terms to both Colonels Lowe and Alexander, remarking
-particularly the excellent condition of the 17th's horses. The Dragoons
-and Lancers quitted Durban for Helpmakaar on April 24th, and every
-precaution was taken by easy marching at first to avoid sore backs and
-girth galls. Lord Chelmsford also left Durban, and proceeded to
-Maritzburg: thence he travelled on to Dundee and Utrecht, and then on to
-Wood's camp at Kambula, where he arrived on May 3rd.
-
-The main features of the plans for the fresh campaign were, roughly
-speaking, as follows.
-
-Two principal forces, operating from separate bases, the one at Utrecht,
-and the other at Durban, were to be held in communication by Wood, with
-a flying column, and by Marshall's cavalry. The common objective of
-these four columns was to be Ulundi, the king's chief kraal. To keep up
-communications with these two flanks, to make occasional raids and
-dashes forward into the enemy's country, and at any favourable moment to
-convert a feigned into a real rush upon Ulundi, Wood was to retain his
-separate and independent command. His force, however, was to be largely
-reinforced, and more troops, if possible cavalry, sent to him. The first
-column, as it was called, under Major-General Hope Crealock, C.B., was
-to advance rapidly by the coast road, having as its respective bases of
-operations Durban, Fort Pearson, and Ginghilovo. The other column, under
-the personal command of Lord Chelmsford, with Utrecht as its principal
-base on the extreme north, was to move also upon Ulundi. Meanwhile Wood,
-who had been strongly reinforced, while nominally forming part of Lord
-Chelmsford's headquarter division, practically retained his independent
-command, and formed a sort of flying column connecting the two flanks
-with each other. No. 1 division, then preparing for advance from the
-Lower Tugela, consisted of three fine brigades. The First Brigade,
-commanded by Colonel Pearson of Ekowe fame, consisted of the 3rd Buffs,
-the 88th Connaught Rangers, and the 99th Foot, each of these corps
-averaging 800 bayonets. The Second Brigade, under the command of Colonel
-Pemberton, had in it the 57th, the 3rd battalion 60th Rifles, and the
-91st Highlanders; while the Third Brigade, under Colonel Law, had a
-battery of Royal Artillery, the Naval Brigade from the "Shah" and
-"Boadicea," at least 800 strong, with four guns and two Gatlings,
-Barrow's Horse, and a Native Contingent. Before the final advance was
-made, it was determined that posts of communication should be
-established at the Amatikula and the Inyezani rivers, over which pontoon
-bridges were to be constructed. Meanwhile for temporary purposes there
-was constructed over the Amatikula stream a cask bridge, by laying two
-slings, with eye splices at one end, parallel to each other, at a
-distance in proportion to the length of the casks. On these ropes were
-placed as many casks as required, bungs uppermost, and side by side.
-Across the upper surface of the barrels balks were laid parallel to each
-other, and the ends of the slings at each end of the row of casks were
-brought up and fastened to the ends of the balks. A small rope with an
-eye at each end was fastened to each sling between each pair of casks.
-These "braces," as they are technically called, were then carried once
-round the nearest balk, and afterwards passed over to the other side,
-carried round the opposite braces, returned to its own side, and finally
-made fast to the standing part of the brace close below the balk by the
-assistance of two half-hitches. Each pier of casks made in this fashion
-can be completed in a marvellously short time by skilled engineers, and
-in a reasonable period by infantry who have been exercised at such work
-under the supervision of their scientific comrades. Transoms or beams
-connect each pier with its neighbour, while chesses and outriggers can
-be laid down as in a regular pontoon bridge. When crossing these cask
-bridges great care, of course, has to be taken by officers in charge of
-waggons and supplies to see that no undue weight is carried beyond what
-must be theoretically allowed by the practical methods of calculating
-the relative buoyancy of the casks. In addition to the redoubts thrown
-up to protect the laagers at Amatikula and Inyezani, _têtes-de-pont_, or
-bridge-heads, were also constructed to form a safeguard for pontoons.
-The position on the Amatikula was admirable. It was not too steep,
-having a hill which formed as it were, a sort of natural glacis, with a
-slope of not more than 10 deg., which is about the most favourable for
-infantry. The post could not be overlooked at any point by the enemy,
-while the ground in front, being duly cleared, gave no cover. The flanks
-rested upon natural obstacles easily strengthened. The post on the
-Inyezani was situated upon an eminence which fell away to the rear, so
-that its second line and reserves could be placed almost entirely under
-cover. A lake on one side and a ravine on the other, both perpendicular
-to the position, gave additional security to the fort, and these were
-strengthened by every means at disposal. In the armament of these works
-the guns were placed _en barbette_, as being more suitable to distant
-fire, and as our antagonists had no artillery with which they could
-reply, no anxiety was entertained as to their being dismounted. Guns, of
-course, which are fired over a parapet instead of through an embrasure
-have a far greater lateral range, and as the Zulu mode of attack
-invariably includes rapid changes of front and frequent flank movements,
-this mode of armament was calculated to prove the most effective, as
-fire could be brought to bear in all directions. A further advantage is
-not to be lost sight of, and this is, that guns fired over a parapet, or
-_en barbette_, are higher, and could therefore plunge into such hollows
-as the Zulus invariably made for when exposed to the rifle fire.
-Gabions and screens of sandbags, to save the men from undue exposure,
-were placed on each side of the guns. While No. 1 column was thus
-employed in fort-building, Lord Chelmsford was moving from Utrecht to
-Kambula and Durnberg, where the following corps were being concentrated,
-to form his column:--General Newdigate's division, a formidable body,
-consisting of the 2nd battalion 21st Fusiliers, the 2nd battalion 24th,
-the 58th and 94th Regiments, with M and N batteries 6th Brigade Royal
-Artillery: Brigadier-General Evelyn Wood, V.C., who had now with him the
-13th and 90th Light Infantry Regiments, Tremlett's battery of Royal
-Artillery, and Buller's Light Horse, strongly augmented. Major-General
-Marshall's cavalry brigade was also attached to Lord Chelmsford's
-command, and was composed of the King's Dragoon Guards, the 17th
-Lancers, and Russell's Horse, lately augmented. Finally Major-General
-the Hon. Hugh Clifford, V.C., C.B., whose former South African services
-go back to 1846, remained in command of the base, depôt, and reserves at
-Durban, with Major T. Butler, C.B., of Red River and Ashanti fame, as
-chief of his staff.
-
-It has been stated that one of the points at which Crealock was to
-concentrate his forces was Ginghilovo; but by the advice of high medical
-authorities, Lord Chelmsford ordered the camp at Ginghilovo to be broken
-up and shifted to a more favourable site near the Inyezani. The
-Ginghilovo camp, as far as strategical position was concerned, was all
-that the most fastidious engineer could desire, but upon sanitary
-grounds it was decidedly defective. It was favourably sheltered in a
-sort of hollow having defensive heights, which were to have been
-entrenched on either side, but want of good water and other reasons
-made it desirable to abandon the idea of converting it into a permanent
-post. Two strong laagers were now, therefore, constructed, the first
-about seven miles beyond Tenedos, and the other on the Inyezani river, a
-few miles from where Pearson's first battle took place. The former of
-these was called Fort Crealock, the latter Fort Chelmsford. As far as
-position, and indeed construction, Fort Chelmsford had many advantages
-not possessed by Fort Crealock. The nature of the soil upon which the
-latter had been built had much to do with this; but there was but little
-choice in the matter, as it was absolutely necessary that a strong post
-should be built in this particular neighbourhood. The soil from which
-most of the works had been thrown up was unfortunately of a light, sandy
-nature, and of that particular unbinding description so disliked by
-engineers. The high winds and rain which prevailed also quickly found
-out the weak points in the armour of the fort, and working parties were
-constantly employed in restoring what had been blown down or washed
-away. Fort Chelmsford, on the contrary, had the advantage of a fine firm
-soil, neither too heavy nor too light, while some quarries which had
-been found within easy distance were of great assistance in supplying
-the revêtements, galleries, and platforms.
-
-The fort itself was situated in a most picturesque part of the country.
-The pass leading into the valley through which the river runs was most
-romantic, winding through a delightful parklike country, crossed by
-rapid streams of clear, ice-cold water, and, as it narrowed became quite
-precipitous, the road dwindling to a mere footpath, so narrow that
-mounted men could not ride more than two abreast. The kloof was flanked
-on the precipice side by loose masses of rock, intermingled with trees
-and bush, and tangled with monkey-ropes and creepers of all kinds. The
-lower side sloped suddenly with a fall of about sixty feet to the bottom
-of the valley, where a rapid mountain stream, gurgling as it rushes over
-its rocky bed, fell soothingly upon the ear with a most dreamy yet
-refreshing sound. The other road to the fort passed through a still more
-beautiful valley, leading to the Inyezani kloof by a path cut in the
-precipitous face of the hill, whose sides were clothed with "spekboem"
-(elephant bush) and all kinds of flowering shrubs. The road looked down
-a declivity of some 200 feet, and was worn in places into a perfect
-staircase of boulders by successive torrents of tropical rain, and would
-be quite impracticable for any other species of vehicle than a Cape
-waggon. The edge facing the precipice had no kind of parapet, and the
-dangerous nature of the pass was brought into still greater prominence
-by the _débris_ of an ox waggon still lying broken up in minute
-particles at the bottom of the valley, where it had evidently gone down
-bodily with its span of oxen. The pass was, however, in spite of its
-danger, very beautiful. Convolvuli ran over the bushes in rich clusters,
-the star-shaped jessamine, with its pink undersides, and the magnificent
-specimens of mesembryanthemums, or fig-marigolds, of which there are
-hundreds of different species, having little transparent pellicles,
-containing pure liquid, scattered over the leaves, giving them the
-appearance of being sprinkled over with ice, and scarlet geraniums,
-attaining a height of ten or twelve feet amidst the thick bush, glowed
-on every side.
-
-Meanwhile General Wood had been no less busy in and around his camp at
-Kambula. On April 17th he made a reconnaissance, at Lord Chelmsford's
-suggestion, to the Blood river, where a site had been chosen for a
-permanently entrenched camp, to serve as a large depôt for the main body
-of the army. The ride was about fifteen miles, and the General and his
-party passed through some beautiful valleys, and through a path cut in
-the precipitous face of a pass whose sides were clothed with "spekboem"
-(elephant bush) and various other flowering shrubs. After four miles'
-cantering, they came to a part of the road which looked down a declivity
-of some 200 feet. The scene was, however, most picturesque. Convolvuli,
-the star-shaped jessamine, and the magnificent Strelitzia Reginae
-flourished around, while scarlet geraniums attained to a height
-unthought of in England. Two excellent sites for outposts were selected,
-by which communication could be kept up with the large depôt and
-Kambula. These had commanding positions, and subsequently stone
-buildings were solidly constructed, square in form, but loopholed and
-flanked by ditch _caponnières_, while each fort contained accommodation
-for mounted men and a detachment of infantry. The Blood river, like most
-South African streams, is subject to great fluctuations. At that period,
-owing to recent rains, it was in flood, and in many places twenty and
-thirty feet deep, running with a powerful current that rendered it most
-dangerous to cross. The banks in most places are dangerously high, and
-the sides are steeply scarped by the force of the stream. Fording-places
-only occur at long intervals, so that when crossing in a flood, it is
-not at all easy to hit them off, while if once carried down by the force
-of the current the traveller has very little chance of escaping an
-accident. The best way of crossing a flooded river, and that which was
-adopted by regulation in Wood's column, is the Kaffir plan of taking off
-some way up the stream, and so making a good allowance for driftage. Old
-settlers and Boers often undress themselves completely before mounting
-their horses, and carry their clothes and arms in a bundle on top of
-their heads, in case of a capsize. The stirrups should, of course, be
-crossed over the pommel of the saddle, and the horse allowed to have his
-head, the rider guiding him by the snaffle, while in difficult cases it
-is better for him to relieve his animal of weight altogether by floating
-alongside and guiding his head in the proper direction. The Blood river
-flows through some fine scenery, bordered, however, at times by
-impenetrable bush and tangled vegetation of all descriptions, again
-winding under lofty mountains of basaltic rock, beautifully variegated
-with foliage, the thickets affording shelter to swarms of animal and
-insect life, giving rise on a still evening to a perfect babel of sound,
-amidst which the plaintive coo of the ringdove, the incessant chirp of
-the cicala, the twittering of many-plumaged birds, and the hoarse
-challenge of the bull-frogs are pre-eminent. Conspicuous among the birds
-are to be noticed especially the little crested kingfisher, showing a
-perfect gem of colour, several varieties of sugarbird--a species
-somewhat allied to the hummingbirds, or "hoverers," which are
-constantly to be seen flying restlessly over the aloe blossom--the
-orange-throated lark, the blue jay, and the Zulu finch, whose black and
-white plumage and red throat are set off by his long, streaming tail,
-the feathers of which are so prolonged that when flying they nearly
-overbalance him. The sandy plain on which the first fort was built was
-covered with stunted karoo bush, and was full of Duyker gries-buck and
-bush-buck, while two kinds of hares frequented the plain, the larger
-kind grey-furred like the English rabbit, and a small red mountain
-species, much better eating than the former, but which is scarcely
-considered fit for the European table, on account of its scavenging
-propensities.
-
-Colonel Buller's Frontier Light Horse was also largely reinforced, its
-last augmentation being Captain Marshall's new troop of eighty
-well-armed and well-mounted men. A corps of Natal Mounted Kaffirs,
-principally recruited from the Edendal Mission-station, had also been
-added to this command, and they were found most trustworthy and
-intelligent. They were armed with the short Martini-Henry carbine, and
-drilled with equal steadiness to the European troopers.
-
-Buller's Light Horse were destined to play so important a part in the
-final advance on Ulundi, that a short description of their appearance
-and equipment will not here be out of place. The first requisite was a
-well-built, sober, and intelligent horseman, who in addition to being
-able to shoot with the Martini-Henry, knew also how to groom, saddle,
-and nurse his horse. This was required to be an animal neither leggy,
-long-tailed, nor showy, but a clever, cobby sort of quadruped, who
-could climb like a cat, and obey its master like a well-broken spaniel,
-endued with a sound constitution, stout and wiry, and with a good turn
-of speed. The saddlery was, as far as possible, of a uniform pattern,
-and selected with considerable judgment and care. The great points were
-that the tree should be wide enough in the fork not to pinch the
-shoulders, but yet not so wide as to let the saddle right down on the
-withers, with the seat long enough to sit in comfortably and to spread
-the weight to some extent over the horse's back. As many of the Cape
-horses are buck-jumpers, slightly-padded flaps were in vogue, although
-not insisted upon. They are a great protection to the knees in riding
-through bush. The saddle, of course, was provided with wallets in front,
-which contained a couple of pairs of socks, one flannel shirt, a
-tooth-brush, towel, and piece of yellow soap. Saddle-bags were worn only
-when going on distant expeditions, but a tin mug, knife, fork, and
-spoon, revolver, and flint and steel formed the invariable equipment of
-these troopers, and with a cloak or blanket _à discrétion_ made up the
-weight carried by the horse. Although the mounted infantry were
-volunteers drawn from various line regiments, there was sufficient
-leaven of the cavalry element to insure efficiency in the mounted
-duties. When the corps was first raised any kind of dress was worn, but
-fashion subsequently exerted its sway, and a rather picturesque "get-up"
-became almost universally adopted. Broad-leaved felt hats, with coloured
-puggarees, brown cord breeches, "baggy" to the last degree, and so
-patched with untanned leather that the original material had almost
-disappeared; a sort of patrol jacket, all over pockets, dyed mimosa
-colour, and also patched with leather of any colour on the shoulders and
-wherever the gun was accustomed to rest, brown laced gaiters, coming
-high up the leg, and even thighs, and a rough coloured flannel shirt,
-entirely open at the neck; such was the most usual costume. The rifles
-were of various patterns--long Martinis, Martini-Henry carbines, some of
-Sharpe's old-pattern Sniders, and Snider carbines. No bucket, however,
-was ever used, as it was considered better that a man unencumbered with
-a long sabre should have his weapon slung to his body, and not to his
-horse.
-
-Another business that had also engaged Wood's time and attention was the
-shifting of his camp. In point of fact, in spite of every precaution
-taken, it was impossible to disguise the unpleasant fact that the very
-air around the Kambula camp was tainted with blood and putridity, while
-in the crevices and amidst the long, dank grasses which concealed the
-bodies of those who after the battle crawled away to die unseen, lurked
-the unmistakable odour of human decay and putrefaction. These were the
-principal reasons which induced our chief to consult with the medical
-authorities upon the advisability of moving away to fresh ground, and
-this determination arrived at, its execution was not delayed for an
-hour. In point of position, the site of our present laager was
-preferable to the one quitted. The move was commenced and finished on
-the same day, the 14th, and there was every reason to be satisfied with
-the change. For beauty of site, as well as strategical considerations,
-the position could scarcely be surpassed. It was as nearly as possible
-a mile and a quarter west from the old camp, and towards the north-west
-the view was indeed splendid. In front, and across the river, lay a
-grassy plain, dotted pleasantly here and there with mimosa and
-camel-thorn. This plain is hemmed in by the Zlobani mountains, on the
-right by the spurs of the Inhlomiga, and away to the left by the
-towering heights of the Makamba, rising to 4000 feet above the sea
-level. The plain narrows backwards between the ranges into a "poort" or
-valley, which, as it recedes away from the fort, presents a gloomy and
-terrific aspect of solitude. Through it, and winding in and out amongst
-tall boulders of rock, and under dangerous precipices, past wild and
-gorgeous hollows, rank with the semi-tropical vegetation so peculiar to
-this part of the country, runs a small footpath, by which, through heavy
-clumps of thorny bush and over naked rock-bound ridges, the explorer
-reaches the fertile valley, over which till lately frowned the
-stronghold of Umbelini. To the north, and trending northwards ten or
-twelve miles, spread the Elandsberg mountains, the lower portion of
-whose sides are clothed with bush, presenting a sombre aspect, but the
-upper portions of which, formed of huge crags and scarped walls of
-granite and porphyry, glitter grandly in the sun, affording a glorious
-and ever-changing panorama, stretching out for miles to where the range
-terminates near the Pongolo river.
-
-The new fort was not so elaborate in its design as the last, though,
-perhaps, as a defensive work more formidable. It was a six-angled
-enclosure, about sixty yards wide, having a wide and deep ditch,
-drawbridge, and platform. From its eastern angles projected two long
-curtain walls, which enclosed a roomy and well-guarded "kraal" for
-cattle and horses. These curtain walls were protected by the fire of the
-angles from which they sprung, and the cattle enclosure did not in the
-least interfere with the _enceinte_, as it had its own gateway and
-drawbridge. At the end of the kraal furthest from the fort was a sort of
-irregular redoubt, with a deep ditch and earthen walls revetted with
-gabions, and defended by a formidable lot of cactus and thorns laid
-along the parapet. This constituted the fort, which was situated on a
-flat plateau overhanging a sharp bend of the river, which, being
-commanded by the guns, afforded a fine supply of water and an excellent
-bathing-place for the officers and men. This change caused a great
-improvement in the health of the division generally, and especially
-amongst the invalids in hospital. The deaths reported up to this period
-were the following: the Hon. Rudolph Gough, from dysentery; Lieut.
-Alderton, drowned; Captain Sandham, of the 90th, and Assistant
-Commissary Phillimore, of fever; Privates Achmuty and Moone, 13th Light
-Infantry, of wounds received at Kambula.
-
-On the 16th April there occurred an event that caused a great sensation
-in the camp, the history of which throws into the shade so many tales of
-romance and fictions of adventures in savage lands, and narrow escapes
-by flood and field, that it deserves to be recorded at length.
-
-Among the fifty horsemen who rode under the command of poor Weatherly
-there were no better soldiers nor more popular comrades in their corps
-than two young Frenchmen, named respectively Ernest Grandier, a
-well-made, athletic, and powerful trooper, and Cramazan Baudoin, a stout
-and equally stalwart fellow. Both these men were natives of Bordeaux,
-and had come out to the colony together about five years before with the
-intention of trying their fortunes in the wine trade. They had both
-served their time in the French army, and when the present war commenced
-could not resist the temptation of seeing service under such a gallant
-commander as Weatherly, whose knowledge of France and the Continent
-generally obtained him many excellent French and German recruits. On the
-day of the Zlobani attack, owing to a thick fog which suddenly came on,
-Colonel Weatherly's troops missed their road and were unable to effect
-the junction with Buller ordered by Colonel Wood. The Zlobani mountain
-was successfully carried by Colonel Buller and his horsemen at daylight
-on the 28th March, and Colonel Wood, who was with Russell's horsemen a
-few miles to the west, pushed forward on the same morning with his usual
-small escort of the 90th mounted men and overtook Weatherly, who had
-been all night trying to find the path. After the summit of the mountain
-had been gained, under a heavy fire, during which Captain Ronald
-Campbell and Mr. Lloyd were killed, Colonel Weatherly was ordered to
-move round to the other flank, and make good his retreat by the eastern
-side of the mountain. In endeavouring to effect this movement they
-became surrounded and cut off by Zulus in front and rear. Weatherly was
-killed in the endeavour to save his son; a few of the troopers managed
-to cut their way, under the most terrible difficulties, through the
-bloodthirsty hordes hemming them in on the far east of the mountain;
-and Grandier and his friend, who had promised to keep together, found
-themselves, with a couple more of their comrades, in the midst of about
-a hundred yelling Zulus, while the bodies of their slaughtered friends
-were being hurled over the rocks on every side. Grandier, although
-slightly wounded in the side and wrist, was still mounted, but Baudoin's
-horse had been shot early in the day, and he was, bruised and blown,
-about to fall into the hands of the pursuers, when his gallant comrade
-sprang off his stout little horse and placed the fugitive upon the
-saddle, intending to mount also as soon as more favourable ground could
-be reached. He saw, besides, that two of his comrades were not far in
-front, and twice called upon them to turn and make a stand.
-Unfortunately, the shouts of the Zulus and the clang of the conflict
-drowned his voice, and they rode on, while Baudoin in the meanwhile was
-compelled by a fresh rush of Zulus to turn up another path. Grandier now
-endeavoured to follow the two horsemen on foot, and being tolerably
-fresh he managed for some little time to keep on his legs. Passing some
-large rocks, however, which jutted out half across the pathway, a large
-piece of stone was hurled at him from above, and felled him to the
-ground, and while half-stunned and insensible, he was overtaken by
-half-a-dozen savages, and after receiving several severe blows from
-knobkerries, was seized and pinioned with thongs. Even as they lifted
-him, he could see in the distance that Baudoin had managed to gain the
-troopers in advance, and the three seemed to have some chance of escape.
-Umbelini's "big place," or kraal, is on the south side of the Zlobani,
-and rather more than half way up from the valley. To this place, with a
-considerable amount of abuse, Grandier was led. Wounded as he was,
-beaten, bruised, and footsore, the prisoner was dragged round the slopes
-of the mountain, and forced by assegais to keep up with his escort, who,
-like all their countrymen, went at a sort of double stride or trot until
-the outskirts of the kraal were reached. The sun was still high over the
-mountain when they reached Umbelini's stronghold, and he was at once
-placed under an escort in one of the Zulu huts, which formed part of the
-outer circle of the defences. It was constructed of strong wickerwork,
-and thatched with reeds and long grass, the door being merely a small
-matted hurdle, which did not so entirely block the doorway as to prevent
-those outside from looking in--an advantage of which the crowd of men,
-women, and children did not fail to avail themselves to the fullest
-extent. The walls were so thin that voices and conversation, even though
-carried on in a moderate tone, could be distinctly heard from hut to
-hut. After having been kept without food or water for some hours,
-Grandier was brought the same evening before the chief, Umbelini, whose
-appearance he described as at the same time villainous and ferocious in
-the extreme. The interview was certainly an interesting one. The name
-and power of the ex-Swazi chief were known and renowned all over
-Zululand. The recent favour shown to him by Cetywayo, and his position
-being now considered as more that of an ally than a vassal, gave to his
-authority and prestige an influence they had never before possessed. So
-blindly did his people believe in him, that it is more than probable
-had further success crowned his efforts, he would have been found a
-dangerous rival for the Zulu throne. Umbelini sat in front of the
-principal hut, surrounded by about fifty of his favourite warriors,
-while large numbers of savages appeared to be leaving the kraal in
-different directions. Masses of natives, evidently belonging to outlying
-tribes, were continually arriving, and reports were brought from time to
-time to the chief, who gave his orders rapidly and without hesitation.
-Upwards of a hundred principal men appeared to be in conference with
-Umbelini, and the number seemed rapidly increasing. Many of these men,
-Grandier had reason to believe, were ambassadors from Cetywayo, and
-officers belonging to the force he sent to assist in Wood's destruction.
-A covering of skins was fastened round the waist of each, and broad
-rings of copper were worn round the ankles and arms of those of the
-highest rank. Plumes of feathers adorned the heads of others who were
-more scantily clad, and who were evidently dressed for battle; while
-others again wore, something after the fashion of a Hungarian pelisse,
-skins of panthers or other striped animals. The array of dusky savages
-was certainly imposing, and it was doubtless arranged with a view to
-effect. Each left hand supported a shield of tanned buffalo hide,
-surmounted with plumes of ostrich feathers. The same hand grasped a long
-bunch of assegais, while the right held the short stabbing-spear. Round
-the necks of those of high rank was usually a necklace, made of some
-wild animal's or possibly human teeth, from which hung a long knife or
-dagger. About half of these warriors carried fire-arms, which were,
-however, of every conceivable make and pattern. The enclosure into which
-the prisoner was conducted, or rather hurled, was formed of the branches
-of the mimosa, strongly and tightly interlaced, and from the height at
-which it stood a splendid view could be obtained. All round were
-situated the huts of the tribe, looking like large-sized beehives, while
-close to each was a little walled space, in which the family wealth,
-consisting of oxen and other cattle, was kept. Umbelini, in spite of the
-sinister and ferocious aspect he wore, was not without a certain savage
-dignity which evidently impressed not only his own people, but also the
-indunas from Cetywayo. Perhaps the consciousness of their presence, and
-the knowledge that this scene would be reported to headquarters, gave an
-increase of grave majesty to his manner, and rendered him less repulsive
-in his action and speech. There was a certain air of thought, and even
-command in his face, which was in striking contrast to those around him.
-His hair was plastered with the usual circlet of red clay, but his
-forehead was encircled with a fillet of young ostrich feathers,
-terminating in a single plume hanging behind. Heavy rings of polished
-metal spanned the thick part of his arms, and lighter ones of the same
-material were round his waist. The neck, thick, massive, and bull-like,
-was adorned with a necklace formed of human teeth, from which hung the
-usual knife, while over the broad black and hairy breast swept a
-splendid ostrich feather. In the right hand he held his only weapon, a
-kind of short but deadly knobkerrie, while his left hand rested upon his
-naked knee. But for the low forehead, the large mouth, and the enormous
-under-hanging animal lip, Umbelini might be described as a fine, indeed
-splendid specimen of the South African warrior.
-
-A chief named Nyamba, who had spoken a few words of English to Grandier,
-now explained to Umbelini who the prisoner was, and under what
-circumstances he had been taken, and at his suggestion a Zulu named
-Nicohlomba, who was known to have once lived in Natal, was brought into
-the enclosure as an interpreter. "What have your English dogs done with
-the traitor Oham?" was the first question asked by the chief. "I hear
-the English are going to make him king in our land." Grandier, with
-composure, replied he knew nothing of Oham or the intentions of
-Government. "What has become of Somtsen (Shepstone)?" was the next
-query, and then, when the prisoner said he was equally ignorant on that
-point, a whispered conversation took place between the two chiefs, who
-ordered Grandier to be taken back out of earshot, while the indunas were
-called up to confer. After five minutes' anxious deliberation, the
-prisoner was again called up, and severely and minutely questioned as to
-the numerical force at Kambula camp, and as to who was in command.
-Through the Zulu interpreter, whose English was not much better than
-that of the younger chief, Grandier explained that he was but a simple
-trooper fighting for his daily pay, and knew little or nothing of the
-questions demanded. Umbelini, who had been hitherto seated, rose up,
-looked round the circle, and all at once poured forth a torrent of
-words, which seemed to have a wonderful effect upon the crowd. He
-seemed, as far as Grandier could glean, from the few Zulu sentences he
-knew, to be a sort of welcome to some honoured arrivals (probably the
-indunas from Ulundi), and when the Swazi chief had finished, a young
-Zulu chief named Umlambongwenya (the Great Alligator) stepped forward
-and warmly congratulated Umbelini on the battle of the previous day,
-and, pointing to the prisoner, added some request. The circle of
-warriors loudly applauded, striking their shields, and this brought a
-large increase of numbers to the enclosure, where the applause became
-almost deafening. Grandier now fancied that his hour was come, and
-prepared to meet his death like a brave man; but to his astonishment, he
-was taken out of the enclosure, and once more bound to a heavy log or
-stump outside the hut, where he was allowed a little milk and a few
-husks of maize. When the next day came, at daybreak, he was again
-brought forth to be examined. A circle was now formed round the
-unfortunate prisoner, who was firmly bound with thongs of raw hide to a
-stout tree in the centre, while round and round the youngest of the
-warriors danced, chanting a melancholy dirge, and keeping time upon his
-naked body with the butt ends of their stabbing assegais. Suddenly these
-proceedings were disturbed by the arrival of a new actor upon the scene.
-A tall and elderly savage, almost a skeleton in attenuation, bounded
-into the inner circle. This creature, who was a sort of witch doctor,
-prophet, and sorcerer, commenced to execute a species of weird dance,
-spinning round the circle like a teetotum, and uttering all the time
-hideous and guttural sounds. All the warriors now remained silent, and
-crouched down, still keeping the circle intact, and kept time to the old
-savage's dance by monotonously beating the hard ground with their
-knobkerries. Again did the wretched prisoner, now almost worn out by
-cold, hunger, and thirst, believe that the torture was about to
-commence, and once more was he agreeably disappointed, for, stopping
-suddenly in the midst of his mad antics, the sorcerer flung himself
-violently at the feet of Umbelini, and breaking as he did so a necklace
-of human bones which he wore, pointed over his head towards the east,
-where the sun was now lighting up the hills and valleys towards Ulundi,
-in which direction, coming across one of the mountains some ten miles
-off, could be seen, so clear was the pure atmosphere, a huge and dusky
-column, marching with a cloud of skirmishers running along the terraces
-of the rocks lower down. These were evidently the advanced guard of the
-impi promised by Cetywayo to Umbelini for the destruction of Wood's
-kraal; and as the troops came nearer and more into the sunlight, the
-principal warriors round Umbelini executed a war-dance round the
-sorcerer and Grandier, who had now given up all hope. The savages
-yelled, leaped, threw themselves bodily into the air, and went through
-all the motions of savage conflict, gesticulating, threatening,
-pursuing, stabbing the fallen, and rehearsing, in fact, the performance
-they soon expected to go through at the expense of the British soldiers.
-
-The advent of the coming reinforcements caused the wildest excitement in
-the camp of Umbelini, and the horror of Grandier's impending death was
-infinitely aggravated by the helplessness he felt in not being able to
-give any warning to his gallant chief and comrades. Still he was in some
-degree consoled by the subsequent reflection that his commander at
-Kambula was a most unlikely man to be caught unawares, and he therefore
-resigned himself calmly to his fate. He was not left long in doubt as to
-his destination, for the chief, Umbelini, considered that it would be a
-compliment to Cetywayo to send him a white prisoner. While waiting,
-however, to be taken to Ulundi, he could not avoid seeing the
-preparations for the forthcoming attack, and, before his departure he
-witnessed the march of Cetywayo's impi towards Kambula. Before
-commencing the journey, his guards carefully stripped him of all his
-clothes, which they divided amongst themselves and wore, and likewise
-compelled him to carry their food. For four days, quite naked, with the
-exception of his hat and a pocket handkerchief, which he had tied round
-his waist, he was compelled by his inhuman escort to keep up with their
-rapid pace. Barefooted, black and blue with bruises, and still suffering
-from exposure and want of nourishment, this brave and devoted soldier
-bore up against his torture. Each night he received a small handful of
-green mealies, and was bound tightly with sharp and cutting thongs to a
-thorn bush; and while he reposed, taking it in turns, one of his guards
-always kept watch over him. Now and then a kraal was passed on the road,
-and here old women and children, the only creatures who seemed left,
-came out and reviled and scratched him. On the fourth day, towards
-sundown, Grandier could tell, from what he overheard, that they were
-drawing near to the king's kraal.
-
-When close to the king's kraal, on the afternoon of the fourth day's
-journey, one of Grandier's escort went forward to announce his arrival;
-and after suffering the usual torment of being tied all night to a tree
-(this time his clothes, now torn to rags, being given to him), on the
-next day at noon he was brought before the king, whom he described as a
-stout, medium-sized man, not so fat, however, or so tall as his brother
-Oham. Almost the same questions were now put to the prisoner as he had
-previously declined to answer at Zlobani, and this time the conversation
-was carried on by means of a man who had the appearance of a mongrel
-Dutchman, who was known to belong to Cetywayo's staff. In speaking of
-his brother Oham the king seemed greatly enraged, and he vowed with many
-emphases that he would mete out a terrible punishment to him and the
-dogs who had dared to invade his country. Grandier, on being pressed,
-saw no reason to deny the strength of General Wood's force or the name
-of its commander, and he set it down at 4000 men, at which the king
-seemed astonished.
-
-Grandier described the king as having frequent interviews with him,
-during which time he would have colonial newspapers, of which there were
-a quantity, translated to him. This fact will probably be taken as the
-means by which he had been able to learn Lord Chelmsford's movements;
-and if he read the contemptuous tone in which our soldiers were spoken
-of by these journals, it would, in a great measure, account for the poor
-opinion he seemed, till Ginghilovo and Kambula, to entertain of our
-commanders. The king made frequent overtures to his prisoner, to induce
-him to join his army, and offered him wives, cattle, and land if he
-could assist his half-caste Portuguese armourer in unspiking the two
-guns taken at Isandula. These interviews continued for several days, and
-finally, when nothing could be obtained by the offered bribes, he was
-relegated to a hut, where, bound each night with painfully tight thongs,
-he was watched by relays of old women--hideous hags, whose amusement was
-to tear out his hair and stick pins into him whenever he endeavoured to
-sleep. In the daytime, during eight days, he was regularly tied to a
-tree, and beaten by assegais by every warrior whose fancy it was to pass
-that way, the offers, however, being daily repeated. At last came a
-messenger with the news of the Kambula battle, the Zulu defeat, and the
-deaths of Umbelini and his brother; and the king's grief first, and rage
-afterwards, exceeded all bounds. Grandier was then ordered to be
-reconducted to Umbelini's kraal, and there to be tortured and put to
-death as a sacrifice to the spirit of Umbelini, and on the following
-morning, at daybreak, he was sent off, fortunately with an escort of
-only two men, each armed with assegais, and one with a muzzle-loading
-rifle. After ten miles' journey, the chief Inyaneme was met returning to
-Ulundi, and he was informed by Grandier's escort of the fate awarded to
-him. About midday on the 13th Grandier, worn out with heat and thirst,
-bleeding and swollen feet, and nearly starved, sank upon the veldt, and
-said he could go no further. He was then severely beaten, so severely
-that he fainted; and his guards, fearing he would die in their hands,
-gave him some water, and took him to a ripe mealy field to eat. Being a
-man of iron constitution, he was soon revived; while, having his wits
-about him, he thought that now or never was his hope of liberty. When he
-had eaten a few mealies he returned to his escort, and found them
-reclining--the most dangerous antagonist, the man with the rifle, being
-in a sort of half-doze, while his comrade, who had just finished his
-midday meal, was employed in packing away the remnants. Pretending to
-totter, Grandier sank upon the ground, as near as possible to the man
-with the gun, and while affecting to sleep, saw that no suspicion was
-aroused. The gun could not be reached, but the assegais were not far,
-and better, he thought, would be a bold struggle for life, even if he
-failed and was killed in the encounter, than the agony of slow torture
-he would otherwise endure. Watching his opportunity, and while the least
-drowsy Zulu was turning his head to take some snuff from the little horn
-usually worn in the ear, Grandier leant silently over, and noiselessly
-removing the stabbing assegai from under the arm of the man with the
-gun, with both his hands, for they were still tied, he nerved himself
-with the courage of despair, and throwing his whole weight into the
-blow, pinned the sleeping Zulu to the ground, while at the same instant
-he seized the gun. The shock was fortunately so great that the thongs
-were burst, and he had time to face the other savage with the loaded
-weapon, and both wrists free. This spectacle so astonished the Zulu,
-that, giving one glance at his impaled comrade, he darted away without
-attempting to fight. Grandier, of course, saw the imprudence of risking
-a shot, so first despoiling the dead man of his ammunition, he crept
-away, and took refuge in the nearest bush. After the excitement of the
-last hour he was not sorry to obtain some rest; accordingly he lay down
-for twenty minutes or half an hour, and then thought he might venture to
-reconnoitre as far as the top of the hill. He saw nothing; so, making
-his way back to the bush, he remained till dark, when he made up his
-mind to travel all night, finding his way luckily by his knowledge of
-the position of the constellations. The next day from a high cliff he
-watched a large body of Zulus quite close to him underneath, driving
-cattle in the direction from which he had come, and he consequently did
-not venture to move out of a cave he had found till they were well out
-of sight. For two nights, and while subsisting on the small store of
-mealies he had taken from the dead Zulu, he travelled, fortunately in
-the right direction, but with more than one narrow escape on nearing
-Zulu kraals. On Wednesday, the 16th of April, just three days after his
-escape from his guards, this brave and resolute man espied, away in the
-distance, what to his practised eye was a European scout. Fortunately he
-was seen. As the remainder of the patrol came up to him he fell,
-bleeding and exhausted, but undaunted, at the feet of some of Ralf's
-Horse, who were exploring, and was by them carried back to Wood's camp,
-where after some days in hospital he was able to resume duty and share
-in the final attack on Ulundi.
-
-A very few days after the battle of Kambula sufficed to clear the
-neighbourhood of Zulus, though occasionally skirmishes kept occurring
-farther off; and the latest news received was that Captain Prior, of the
-80th Foot, proceeding with a mounted patrol from Luneberg in the
-direction of the Upper Pongolo Drift, had fallen in with Umbelini's
-force. Having trotted about ten miles from Luneberg he came up with
-about twenty friendly natives, who informed him that a band of Zulus
-were sweeping horses and cattle from the valley. Guided by these people,
-he made such good use of his time that he soon came within 800 yards of
-the marauders, who were driving away a large quantity of horses and
-cattle. Captain Prior charged into and dispersed them, recapturing
-eighteen horses and a number of cattle, and, leaving these in charge of
-Lieutenant Ussher, he continued the pursuit, killing several of the
-enemy, amongst whom was a younger son of Usirayo. It has since been
-ascertained that Umbelini was of the party, and was so badly wounded in
-the skirmish, that he subsequently died in a cave where he took refuge.
-This Zulu party was subsequently ascertained to be a portion of the
-force that fought at Zlobani, and one of the recaptured horses was
-recognized as belonging to a mounted private of the 80th, attached to
-Russell's Mounted Infantry.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER VII.
-
- Lord Chelmsford with Wood at Kambula--Patrol by Buller--Capture of
- cattle--Scene from Kambula Kop--Zulu attack on patrol--Removal of
- Wood's camp to Mayegwhana--Wood's force--Scarcity of drivers and
- voorlopers--Newdigate at Conference Hill--Fort and depôt at
- Conference Hill--Work of No. 1 column--Exciting incident with a
- convoy--Distribution of troops--Forts on the Tugela, Inyezani, and
- at Ginghilovo--System of guards and precautions against
- surprises--All ready for the advance--Recapitulation of military
- situation--Newdigate's forts at Landsman's Drift--Arrangements for
- garrisons in rear of advance--The Lower Tugela command--Patrol by
- Wood and Buller in direction of Isandhlwana--Second patrol by
- Buller--Zulu attack--The Prince Imperial on patrol--Reconnaissance
- in force to Isandhlwana and burial of the dead.
-
-
-On the morning of May 3rd, Lord Chelmsford, with Prince Louis Napoleon,
-Colonel Crealock, and Captain Molyneux, arrived at Wood's camp at
-Kambula. His lordship went round the camp soon after his arrival, and
-expressed himself uncommonly pleased with all the arrangements for the
-discipline and internal economy of the laager, being particularly struck
-with the quiet and easy way in which all the duties were carried on,
-without noise, excitement, or delay of any kind. The whole force was
-paraded in the afternoon for the General's inspection, and his lordship
-took the opportunity of saying a few well-chosen and appropriate words
-to each corps.
-
-On the following morning (Sunday), after divine service was over, Lord
-Chelmsford suggested to General Wood that it would be advisable to make
-a reconnaissance in the direction of the White Umvolosi valley in view
-of choosing a suitable position for an entrenched camp within easy
-communication of Durnberg and Conference Hill. The day was fine and
-pleasant, and Buller, who had proceeded in advance with a number of his
-scouts, soon signalled back that the patrol were watched by a number of
-Zulus, who now and then exchanged shots with his men from the
-neighbouring hills. After riding about three miles towards the
-south-east in the direction of the Zinguin Neck and Tonguin mountain,
-the party entered a rugged part of the country near where the White
-Umvolosi takes its rise, passing along by a winding road, flanked on
-either side by the usual mimosa thorns, when suddenly was heard the
-"whirr! whirr!" of a couple of leaden messengers, though as yet nothing
-in the shape of an enemy could be seen. In a short time, however, Wood,
-who had cantered on in front, saw with his practised eye sundry
-copper-coloured bodies creeping along in the bushes below about half a
-mile off. They were so intent upon watching Wood and his group of
-horsemen that they did not at first see that about a score of Buller's
-men had gained their flank, and almost cut them off. It was a most
-exciting scene as the mounted scouts were observed looking about for
-something in the shape of a path by which to descend the cliff which
-formed at this part almost a sheer precipice of some 300 feet. They,
-however, managed the descent by a rough cattle-path, sending down
-showers of loose stones and _débris_ before them as their horses half
-slid, half scrambled to the base. All this time the main body were
-crossing a wide plateau dominating the White Umvolosi valley and the
-river, which wound away at the base of the cliff. Looking over the
-precipitous sides, they could perceive a small herd of cattle penned up
-in a kraal in the centre of a little bush-covered flat adjoining the
-stream. As it was thought just possible that they might capture some
-prisoners, and obtain information of what Zulu forces were in the
-neighbourhood, and as cattle-hunting is one of the great ends of Zulu
-warfare, half a dozen of the General's escort were detached to see what
-they could effect. Getting down the cliff as well as they could, and
-then winding through the dense thorns in the valley, they soon found the
-kraal, and, having collected the cattle, began to return. But this was
-certainly a puzzle upon which they had not calculated. To ascend the
-cliff by the way they had come was impossible, whilst on the other side
-ran the river, wide, and apparently very deep. Undoubtedly the only way
-out of the difficulty was to find a ford. They were, therefore, busily
-occupied in searching for one, when they perceived a mounted scout, sent
-by Buller, on the other side of the stream, who was gesticulating very
-excitedly, and trying to warn them of some danger. As it was impossible
-at the distance to hear what he said, one of the mounted men was sent
-down to the bank, and he came back with the news that the bush behind
-was full of Zulus. The warning did not come a moment too soon, for
-within fifty yards of them came a crowd of naked savages, yelling and
-flourishing their assegais and rifles, in evident triumph at the success
-of their stratagem. Shouting, therefore, to the men who were staying
-behind with the cattle, the rest put spurs to their horses and galloped
-along the banks of the river, looking out all the time for any sign of a
-ford by which they might cross. Fortunately this situation was seen by
-that portion of the party who had gone round by the opposite bank, and
-they had come down to meet their comrades, having hit upon a ford higher
-up the stream. It was, however, a close shave, so close indeed that by
-the time they had reached the other side of the river by the ford, which
-was up to the horses' girths, and which they splashed through at a
-gallop, the Zulus had actually reached the bank, and were only prevented
-from capturing the two men left behind with the cattle by some
-well-directed shots. The yells of baffled rage from the disappointed
-Zulus were answered by a ringing cheer of triumph from the little party
-as they rode up the steep which led to the column. The enemy, however,
-still continued to appear at various points along the sides of the
-hills, and in some places appeared to be dropping like monkeys from crag
-to crag, and it was easy to see that had not these scouts been mounted
-they would have been greatly at a disadvantage on such difficult ground.
-In fact, part of the line of scouts was in a valley surrounded by
-mountains, and from which egress, in case of a struggle setting in,
-would be difficult. They, therefore, hurried to get upon ground more
-favourable for cavalry movements. As they did so the rear sections had
-twice to turn and drive off the enemy, who began to come closer to
-their rear. Facing about, one of the sergeants charged right at them
-with half a dozen men, and silenced their fire on the right. Several
-more galloped to the left rear, where the fire was as close as fifty and
-sixty yards, and on this occasion all had some narrow escapes. However,
-in about a quarter of an hour they rejoined the main body, having driven
-off the Zulus. Their horses' heads, however, had hardly cleared the
-bushes when shriller yells than before arose along the mountains in
-front, and they had only commenced riding into the plain when another
-sharp rifle fire began crackling along the ridges of the Zinguin Neck.
-As they steadily advanced this firing ceased, and the scene along the
-hills, which seemed to terminate to the west in a stupendous cliff,
-became more varied and interesting. Signal fire after signal fire of
-grass was lighted, and broad columns of smoke rolled into the air, and
-these being repeated from summit to summit, evidently showed that their
-movements were carefully watched. A party of horsemen was now despatched
-to scour the valley on the left front, and all along the woods, which
-fringed the sides of the steep hills in front, jets of smoke marked
-their downward progress. As the crackling and flashing approached the
-bush where the hills met the plain, individual forms of Zulus could be
-seen, and then coming swiftly towards the main body there broke out from
-the dust and smoke a small mob of cattle, quickly followed by the
-skirmishers galloping in. Three small kraals were found to be in flames,
-fired by the Zulus as they retired with their cattle before the advance
-of the English horsemen. Two mobs of oxen could be seen, numbering some
-hundreds, which were being hurried away to inaccessible places. The
-ground in front of the English force was of a loose and calcareous
-nature, and, occupying as it did the space between mountain and river,
-was torn and cut up in every direction by deep white gullies, by which
-the Zulus were retiring sheltered from attack. The ridges between these
-gullies afforded the enemy additional shelter, being grown over with
-scrubby brush. Half the cavalry were now sent on to secure the
-approaches to the river, and guard against any surprise in that
-direction, and in a quarter of an hour, protected by the horsemen in
-rear, the whole body had passed over in safety.
-
-The General, with his escort, had during the morning's march passed two
-of his old camps on the Kambula, and about twelve miles further on came
-to a piece of elevated rock or hillock, whence they had a capital view
-of White Umvolosi valley, while to the south-west they looked down upon
-the Blood river, Conference Hill, and the dark shadow of the Durnberg
-range beyond. The Zinguin Neck, where the White Umvolosi has its source,
-stretched away at their feet, and farther behind they looked upon the
-southern slopes of Zlobani, rising in ledges or bastions in the
-distance. Just underneath the shoulder of Conference Hill could be seen,
-in the bright sunlight, the white tents of Newdigate's division, and in
-the opposite direction was a magnificent view of the precipitous
-terraced ledges of the Zlobani, down which our brave fellows had been
-driven on the fatal 28th of March. As soon as they reached the top of
-the Zinguin they were met by Buller, whose people were actively engaged
-in harassing a number of Zulus who were keeping up a desultory and
-harmless fire from the krantz in front. The breeze now cleared away the
-mists which hung over the valley, and away to the west could be made out
-what seemed to be a village perched upon a terrace half way up the berg.
-The face of this terrace presented a wild and singular appearance. What
-at a distance had appeared level and almost unbroken was in reality a
-sort of amphitheatre not less than 1000 feet high, crescent shaped, and
-with a terrace fortified by low stone walls springing from rock to rock,
-and intersected by enormous fissures or caves connected with each other,
-and from which cover a dropping fire was kept up. Leaving their horses
-in charge of some few of the men, some twenty riflemen dashed into these
-rocks, where the cover would equally shelter them with the enemy. From
-this moment the ringing of shots was incessant, and it soon became
-evident that the Zulus were in force in a favourable position to annoy
-the column until they were expelled. The face of the crescent seemed as
-if some powerful eruption had flung from the top of the hill on to its
-sides tons of black and jagged rocks and stones, which, piled in wild
-confusion and irregularity on top of each other up the face of the
-position, presented innumerable caves and crannies, from which, as well
-as from stone walls, jets of smoke and bullets were continually issuing.
-The dismounted men, meanwhile, began to swarm up the right and left hand
-ridges, potting away as they advanced, while a few moved up the centre,
-firing when necessary and taking advantage of what cover was afforded.
-Several exciting incidents now occurred. As these sharpshooters gained
-a better and more commanding position for their concerted attack, the
-Zulus, finding the situation rather too hot, one by one began to escape,
-and the moment a dusky form was seen gliding through the thorns half a
-dozen rifles rang out, sometimes succeeded by the crashing sound of the
-body of a huge savage rolling from a high rock to the stones below. It
-was simply wonderful to see in what small crevices these big Zulus had
-squeezed themselves. Sometimes three or four would get together in one
-spot, generally a small cave almost inaccessible from above or below,
-and which could only be approached by working along the sides, under the
-fire of dozens of other caves and loopholes, every one of which seemed
-scooped out for the purpose of creating a cross-fire. As, therefore, to
-force home an attack on such positions was not the present object of
-Lord Chelmsford, whose purpose and that of General Wood had already been
-achieved in the survey they had made, the further retreat of the savages
-was not molested, and the order was given to remount and prepare to
-return to camp. As the mounted men extended to cover the rear of the
-column they were greeted by yells from the few Zulus they had not
-dislodged, and a few parting shots were sent after them as they
-descended the slope.
-
-On the following morning Wood's entire force paraded at daybreak, tents
-were struck, waggons packed, and they bade farewell to Kambula range,
-upon which they had been so long encamped in various positions, and set
-out for Mayegwhana, where a fresh camp was pitched. Mayegwhana, or
-Queen's Kraal, is as nearly as possible three miles north of Bemba's
-Kop, on which some months ago, and before he went on to Kambula, General
-Wood was encamped. In this new camp Wood had with him the following
-troops:--The 13th Light Infantry, under Major England [their colonel,
-Gilbert, having gone into Utrecht on a few days' well-earned sick-leave.
-Of this fine corps Captains Cox and Persse, both rather badly wounded at
-Kambula, were rapidly progressing towards convalescence. Poor Leet, the
-other major, still suffered from his crushed foot, which was caused as
-far back as February, but which accident did not prevent his saving a
-comrade during Zlobani's fatal day, and for which General Wood
-recommended him for the honour of a Victoria Cross]; the 90th Light
-Infantry, under their own commanding officer, Colonel Cherry; the two
-corps making up a compact and admirably homogeneous brigade of 1200. One
-thousand men of Buller's and Russell's Horse, now in better condition
-than ever, and excellently mounted, with a body of Royal Engineers and
-Major Tremlett's battery of mounted guns; a total of 2000 Europeans, and
-about 1200 Native Contingent, or in all about 3200 men. With this force,
-and supported actively from its base, there could be no difficulty or
-danger in pushing on, and it was no secret that the inactivity they were
-forced to endure did not lie at General Wood's door, for he on more than
-one occasion suggested substitutes for waggon transport--the cause of
-the prevailing inaction. Drivers and foreloopers were what could not be
-obtained. One of such is required for each span of oxen, the driver, who
-stands on the front seat of the waggon and wields an enormously long
-whip, and the _voorloper_, who leads in front. Ever since the day of
-Isandhlwana, and on account of the panic which prevailed from that date,
-due to the massacre of the natives then employed, it was found
-impossible to obtain their services in adequate numbers; and even of
-those still in employ numbers were continually deserting, for the
-purpose of returning to their respective homes within the border.
-Meanwhile Wood was not idle, but, day by day, was making the best use of
-the scanty material at his disposal. The few drivers and foreloopers he
-had been able to retain were sent for and paraded before the General,
-who briefly explained to them that in future they should be armed, fully
-organized, receive regular rates of daily and liberal pay, while their
-personal safety should be looked after by the employment of strong
-guards and convoys wherever they had to march. This, it must be allowed,
-was much wanted, and gave some grounds for complaint, as in the earlier
-stages of the campaign the waggons on too many occasions were not only
-allowed to straggle, but were left to shift for themselves. Behind
-General Wood's new camp, about ten miles off, and at right angles to
-Bemba's Kop, was Conference Hill, at which place General Newdigate was
-concentrating the bulk of his command. He had with him at this time the
-King's Dragoon Guards, the left wing of the 17th Lancers, part of the
-21st Fusiliers and 58th Regiments, with N Battery 6th Brigade Royal
-Artillery. Seven miles away from Conference Hill was Doornkop, and here
-were the 94th Regiment, three companies of the 21st, and four of the
-80th. Conference Hill was within a very short time rendered practically
-impregnable by works constructed by the 94th Regiment, who, under
-Colonel Malthus, encamped at this spot; it also became one of the chief
-depôts for the supplies of Newdigate's division. This depôt was formed
-upon a kop, or rising ground, to the east of the larger hill, and was
-protected by three exceedingly well-built forts, constructed _en
-échelon_, so as to afford a mutual and most effectively-planned flanking
-defence. The largest of these forts was a regularly traced bastion of
-polygonal form, with the length of its lines of defence in due
-proportion to the range of the weapons likely to be employed. The
-exterior sides of this work were 150 yards in length, and the parapet
-was sufficiently thick to resist anything but artillery fire. The flanks
-were drawn at right angles to the faces, so as to give a fire which
-could sweep the ditches and ground in front of the bastions. A couple of
-ramps were cut in the prolongation of the ditch of the face, whose
-surface passed through the crests of the flanks and lines drawn parallel
-to the bottom of the counterscarp of the opposite flank, and about two
-feet and a half above them. This fort was garrisoned by the headquarters
-of the 94th, and the other two, of somewhat smaller dimensions, by a
-company each of the Royal Engineers and the 94th. Considerable pains
-were expended in the construction of these works, which did the
-Engineers and the 94th the greatest credit for the workmanlike line and
-scientific character of their tracing and position. The plan of these
-works somewhat resembled that adopted by General Newdigate at Landsman's
-Drift. The cattle laager was composed of waggons formed into square,
-while at each salient angle were small forts--one of which had
-artillery--and the whole were joined corner to corner, so that a
-straight line drawn between their extreme points would pass through the
-centre of each square. By this means a perfect flanking defence was
-obtained, as each fort commanded two faces of the laager. Meanwhile the
-First Division had been by no means idle, in spite of their difficulties
-as to transport and the attacks of camp fever, which had been so much
-more frequent with them than with No. 2 column. From their base at Fort
-Tenedos a convoy was started every eight days to Fort Chelmsford, on the
-Inyezani, and its regular departure did much to expedite the forward
-movement of that force. On the 5th May, however, a somewhat more
-exciting episode took place. A convoy of the usual description was
-paraded on that day for the conveyance of stores and ammunition to the
-Inyezani. Fifty waggons, not too heavily laden, with 3000 barrels on
-each, were detailed under the protection of a convoy, composed of C
-Troop of Lonsdale's Horse, commanded by Captain Hampden Whalley. From
-the foot of the fort whence the convoy started stretches a sandy plain,
-dotted with trees, and containing about 3000 acres. This, as it gets
-narrowed into a gorge between the river and the mountains, becomes
-broken, being intruded upon in every direction by foot-hills and
-watercourses. The fort cattle were grazing upon this plain under the
-charge of some of De Burgh's horsemen, when, as the convoy was passing
-across the first drift over the river, about two miles from the fort,
-but out of sight of the sentries, suddenly there sprang out from gully
-and kloof hundreds of swarthy warriors, who set to work, some shouting
-and firing, to try and drive the cattle away through the pass, whilst
-others, by far the larger portion, made a combined onslaught upon the
-leading and rear waggons of the train. The convoy had, therefore, a
-double duty to perform--to assist De Burgh's men in recovering the
-grazing cattle, and also to beat off the Zulus who were attacking the
-waggons. Their object was to intercept the cattle now being run off at a
-rapid pace, and to secure the waggons in front and rear, which had been
-partly surrounded by the enemy. Whalley at once despatched a messenger
-to the fort for assistance, and remaining himself, as in duty bound, to
-repulse the waggon attack, detached about twenty of his best men, under
-his subaltern, to overtake and bring back the absconding oxen. The
-waggons were soon out of danger; for the men dashed at the Zulus in such
-a determined manner that the attacking party, not very numerous, soon
-bolted into the bush, but the other portion of the skirmishes deserves
-description. After a gallop of a mile the leading troopers in pursuit
-came up with the enemy and the cattle, which were now all in confusion
-and involved in the broken waterworn hills at the foot of the pass, and,
-on looking back, they were astonished and considerably mortified to find
-that they did not appear to be followed by the rest of their party!
-Undauntedly, however, the sergeant in command pushed on, firing steadily
-and with fatal effect from the saddle, and, with his gaze fixed firmly
-upon the leading cattle, worked his way through the frightened oxen to
-the front. He was well and gallantly followed by half a dozen men, who
-had managed to keep up with him in his rapid ride in pursuit, and these
-fine fellows, nothing daunted by the numbers of the enemy, kept potting
-away at every Zulu that showed his head from behind the rocks, to which
-most of them had now retreated. Suddenly the low banks of the ravine, up
-which they were now rushing, swarmed on both sides with the enemy, and
-it was evident that the driving of cattle into this position was one of
-the usual Zulu artifices by which they were so often successful. The
-Zulus kept up a feeble and ill-directed fire from the crevices of rock
-where they had taken cover, and all this time the troopers were employed
-in heading and turning back the cattle, a task which would have been far
-beyond their best energies had not an episode occurred which materially
-changed the aspect of affairs. Alone, in the midst of a score of
-enemies, the sergeant fought steadily on, loading, firing, advancing,
-and driving back the cattle as if he bore a charmed life. The Zulus
-seemed paralyzed, and shunned his vicinity, for when he trotted to where
-a shield or assegai was seen, it immediately disappeared. He had,
-however, great need of help, for he had come to his last cartridge; but
-at that moment he felt a chance of life, as he heard the welcome shout
-of an English cheer, and, looking in the direction whence the sound
-seemed to come, he saw rapidly descending the steep krantz above the
-remaining horsemen of his party, who had chosen another and easier path
-up the ravine, which enabled them to take the Zulus in flank. The affair
-was now over; and although no prisoners were taken, the blood-stains on
-the rocks and boulders around proved that there must have been many
-wounded. The cattle were all recovered, and Whalley's convoy reached its
-destination without further molestation.
-
-Great changes for the better had also been made in the distribution of
-the First Division. The 88th had been shifted from their former
-position on the extreme left front of Fort Tenedos to the commanding
-hill in its immediate front. In like manner they had been advanced _en
-échelon_ to the extreme left front, and the Buffs had been moved in
-laager to the right rear of the 88th; while Lonsdale's Horse held the
-hill formerly occupied by the 99th. The Naval Brigade were in camp
-behind the fort, with Cook's Horse posted in their immediate vicinity,
-and the Mounted Infantry upon a hill immediately below Lonsdale's Horse,
-and a portion of the Artillery were on the old ground of the Engineers,
-with the Native Contingent in their front. The forts also belonging to
-this division on the Tugela, Inyezani, and at Ginghilovo were by this
-time completed, and admirably manned. To guard against any surprise
-pickets were posted in advance and on the flanks of these works, to
-watch every line of approach, and especially those where the country
-afforded cover and concealment. Sentries were placed at the salients of
-all entrenched works, and double sentries at the entrances, while
-whenever a drawbridge had been made it was carefully drawn up at sunset.
-Occasional patrols during the day, and frequent patrols during the night
-and in thick weather were not relaxed, and the result was that the
-Zulus, seeing such activity, scarcely ever molested the working parties.
-In the ditches of the four coast-line forts were placed at intervals
-quantities of dry straw and brushwood, with oil and tar poured on in
-profusion, to fire in case of attack, and trustworthy soldiers were told
-off to fire these on the approach of the enemy. Sandbag loopholes were
-constructed on the tops of each parapet, while large beams, supported
-at intervals by sods of earth, were used for the same purpose.
-Fire-shells were placed in readiness to be rolled into the ditch. The
-distances from each parapet of all conspicuous objects was carefully
-measured and communicated to the garrison, and rods with whitewashed
-tops, so as to be visible at night, were erected, to mark the various
-ranges.
-
-Port Durnford also had been reported practicable, and a fort and depôt
-was being established there.
-
-It was now the end of the third week in May, and all was ready for an
-advance, with the exception of the dearth of transport beasts and
-vehicles. It will be well, therefore, to briefly recapitulate the
-military situation. Crealock, now at Fort Chelmsford, was to connect
-himself with Port Durnford, and then to move along the coast with 10,000
-men, supported and supplied by the Naval Brigade from Port Durnford.
-This was called No. 1, or the First Column. The second division in the
-north under Lord Chelmsford, his immediate subordinates being Generals
-Wood, Newdigate, and Marshall, was to move from Dundee, their advanced
-posts being already Doornkop, Landsman's Drift, Ladismith, Conference
-Hill, and Mayegwhana. General Newdigate was now at Dundee, and had with
-him the King's Dragoon Guards, under Colonel Alexander; the left wing of
-the 17th Lancers, under Major Boulderson; the headquarters 21st
-Fusiliers, the 58th Regiment, with N battery, 6th Brigade, Royal
-Artillery. At Doornkop, about seven miles from Dundee, were three
-companies of the 21st, and four companies of the 80th. Wood occupied the
-most advanced point at the front, at a place called Mayegwhana, or the
-Wolf's Kraal, and had with him the 13th and 90th Light Infantry, 1000 of
-Buller's and Russell's Horse, a strong native contingent, and a battery
-of six 7-pounder mountain guns. Again at Conference Hill were a company
-of Royal Engineers and the 94th Regiment, under their commanding officer
-Colonel Malthus. In addition to Colonel Malthus's regulars there were at
-Conference Hill about 150 Basutos, some volunteers, and a few Natal
-natives, all under Captain Birkett. Dundee and Conference Hill were the
-two most important bases of General Newdigate, and convoys of supplies
-were daily arriving at each. At Landsman's Drift there were three strong
-forts, with an intervening space for cattle. These had been designed by
-General Newdigate himself, and were constructed _en échelon_. They were
-occupied by the 21st, 58th, and five companies of the 2nd battalion
-Natal Native Contingent. These three entrenched field-works were
-admirably constructed, so as to afford each other mutual defence. In
-tracing these works great care had been taken that the angles should be
-directed upon inaccessible ground, such as a krantz, a marsh, or a pond.
-None of the faces were exposed to enfilade, and the longest were so
-traced that they looked towards the ground over which an enemy would
-most likely advance, and which could be swept by the fire of the
-garrisons. These works were all somewhat in the shape of demi-bastions,
-and were constructed on a square or polygon, whose exterior sides were
-about 150 yards. The parapets were only breast high, but unusually
-thick, and, allowing for the penetration of rifle-fire at ten yards
-being twenty-one inches, the parapets had been constructed six feet,
-having a base 3·1, while the interior slopes are maintained by strong
-revêtements. Works of this character have certain advantages, which are,
-that they require less length of parapet than a bastioned fort;
-although, on the other hand, there are these disadvantages, namely, that
-there is on each side one dead re-entering angle, i.e., an angle
-perfectly screened from fire, and that the ditches are not so perfectly
-defended as they should be. Each of the battalions above named built one
-of these demi-bastioned forts, and the tents of the respective corps
-were pitched outside two of the faces, with advanced pickets thrown out
-well to the front. In the interval between the right rear angle of the
-most advanced fort and the left front of the second demi-bastion was the
-cattle laager--a most important matter in Cape warfare. This arrangement
-enabled the fire from the first fort to rake the ground in its front and
-left faces, while the fire from the supporting work could do the same
-duty for the rear and right faces. From this description it will be
-understood that the works spoken of effectually covered the cattle
-laager, as well as afforded perfect cover for their garrisons. These
-three entrenched positions at Landsman's Drift were the delight and the
-pride of the regiments who built them; for although the Royal Engineers
-had been employed in general superintendence, it was well known that the
-actual designs were made by General Newdigate, and the labour carried
-out by the 21st and 58th.
-
-The arrangements for the garrisoning of the posts in the rear of the
-advance were as follows:--Forts Pearson and Tenedos had each assigned to
-them two companies, while a reserve upon which they could draw was
-placed at Stanger. Upon the Lower Drift, down as far as Kranz Kop, the
-river was to be guarded by 2000 of the border natives, under Captain
-Lucas, supported by 130 Natal Volunteers stationed at Thring's Post.
-Thirteen hundred men of the Native Contingent garrisoned Fort Cherry, in
-rear of the abandoned post which formerly covered the ferry drift, while
-the border for seven miles was watched by 2000 natives, under the
-superintendence of Mr. Wheelwright, at Hermanberg. Greytown was held by
-a garrison of two companies. Three thousand natives lined the Umzinga
-border, and Helpmakaar was held by the Natal police and Carabineers. The
-defence of the new entrenchment at Rorke's Drift, now called Fort
-Melville, was entrusted to three companies of the 2-24th, which regiment
-was anything but pleased at the preference which had been given to the
-first battalion, newly arrived from England, by allowing it to
-participate in the active operations, while the second battalion was
-detained in the rear. There were to be four other companies of the
-2-24th, and of these one was to hold Landsman's Drift, while two were to
-be left at Conference Hill. At Balte Spruit two companies, and at
-Burgher's Laager, Utrecht, and Luneberg each one company, formed the
-respective garrisons. It will be observed, therefore, that the line of
-the Tugela was but thinly defended, but, on the other hand, there was a
-strong chain of posts on the advance along the coast. The force at this
-period in the Lower Tugela command may be summarized as follows:--The
-2-3rd Foot, the 57th, the 3-60th Rifles, the 88th, the 91st, the 99th,
-or six battalions of infantry, mustering some 5400 bayonets, with M
-battery 6th Brigade, O battery 6th Brigade, 8th battery 7th Brigade, and
-the 30th company Royal Engineers. To these may be added the Naval
-Contingent, and with the native force the total amounted to quite 10,000
-men.
-
-But before the general advance was commenced there remained one sad duty
-to be performed--the burial of those who were still lying on the fatal
-field of Isandhlwana. It will be asked why this had not been done long
-since? The answer is simple: want of cavalry, want of transport, and
-want of opportunity. Since the day upon which the fatal surprise took
-place, there had rarely been an hour to spare from the trying ordeal of
-official duty, while the task of providing for the living and feeding
-the daily reinforcements had left no time to attend to the dead. The
-moment, however, Marshall's troopers were upon the frontier, it was felt
-that something could be done, and every measure and precaution were
-taken to bring about a satisfactory result. To avoid any chance of a
-mishap or failure, Lord Chelmsford personally consulted General Wood
-when at Kambula, and subsequently at Utrecht, and it was decided that,
-previous to any formidable cavalry patrol being undertaken in force, a
-series of short reconnaissances should be carried out by the
-indefatigable Buller and his ubiquitous horsemen. The purpose of this
-plan was twofold. In the first place, these perpetual scoutings so
-harassed the natives, that the majority, and certainly the wealthier
-majority, heartily wished the war was over; secondly, it was of great
-importance to learn the whereabouts of the two impis which it was well
-known had been for months waiting for the return of English troops to
-Isandhlwana, and this information was effectually obtained by Buller's
-zeal and activity. The first and most important reconnaissance was made
-by General Wood in person, who ordered a night-parade of a selected body
-of horsemen on the 9th May. The force on this occasion consisted of
-sixty Frontier Light Horse, under Captain D'Arcy; thirty Mounted
-Infantry, under Captain Brown; and forty Natal Native Infantry, under
-Captain Woodgate, 4th Regiment, General Wood's staff officer. Their road
-at first was an easy descent into the fertile plain that was spread out
-like a map at their feet; it then wound up in a somewhat zigzag manner
-by the sides of a steep hill, flanked on the one side by a ravine, and
-on the other by a dense bush. Presently a black body was seen by the
-advanced scouts, whom Buller always sent out as "feelers," creeping
-through the bushes on the left, and in our rear came a second. No shot,
-however, was fired, but a Zulu perched high above, and sheltered in the
-bush, hails the passing troops in a jeering manner, and asks them to
-come and see his kraal. Orders had been given to the soldiers not to
-fire unless fired upon, and this act of forbearance seemed to wondrously
-puzzle the native followers, who were with difficulty prevented from
-"potting" the interlocutor. They had made about ten miles, when the sun
-began to shine over the edge of the horizon in all the splendour of an
-African morning. The dew had fallen heavily during the night, and
-consequently the first rays of the sun produced a mist, which hung like
-steam over the valleys. This, however, soon cleared away and left the
-atmosphere clear and transparent, so that the far-off ranges seemed
-within a short distance of the column, whereas they were distant at
-least thirty or forty miles. This clearness of course was now a great
-advantage and aid to the English party, as it enabled the scouts to
-observe far ahead, and rendered surprise less possible than if the mist
-and fog had prevailed. Pushing on now at a canter, they soon came to a
-trek, which led them between two tall hills called Nkandi and Mhundla.
-Here in the kloof were two deep spruits or streams, which, however, were
-avoided by hugging the sides of Mount Mhundla, and it was noticed that
-waggons could be dragged without any considerable difficulty along this
-path. The sun was now well above the horizon, and General Wood decided
-to halt, off-saddle, and let the men have their breakfasts. The place
-selected for the "off-saddle" was a slightly wooded ravine, amidst the
-rocks of which ran a clear stream over a grassy and pebbly bed, while
-behind was a range of rocky hills, the summit of which was crowned by
-huge masses of rock, looking from the distance like vast Titanic slabs
-placed by giant strength in their present position. Before was an
-undulating plain, bounded on the right by a river, and on the far left
-by a dense bush.
-
-After one hour's rest the order was given to mount, and away they went,
-men and horses thoroughly refreshed and eager for the road. The bush was
-gradually getting thicker, and the road wound by a deep descent into a
-thickly-wooded valley. Every one of the party instinctively felt that
-Zulus must be near, and bracing up the body and nerves each man prepared
-for attack. The leader, too, thought the place suspicious, and made his
-dispositions accordingly. Two bodies of horsemen, each a dozen strong,
-were sent out to make a wide détour on either flank, while flankers were
-also sent out on either side of the column. The mounted men who formed
-the advanced guard closed to their centre, while those who had been
-extended in skirmishing order in the rear had orders to close up to the
-column when the defile was approached, ready to dismount, should it be
-found impracticable for horses. It is pretty well known that the most
-frequent point of attack in Zulu warfare is the rear of an enemy's
-column, particularly when the attack can be made in a defile. The head
-of the column is often allowed to pass unmolested by the Zulu general,
-who waits patiently until the main body has gone by, and then commences
-a furious onslaught upon the rear, which will perhaps be followed up for
-miles. So these precautions were not superfluous. Where the column now
-was could be seen the traces of burnt kraals and partly destroyed mealie
-gardens, showing unmistakably that a skirmish had taken place not long
-ago, and Colonel Buller at once recognized the locality as the spot
-where, some ten days before, his scouts had had a skirmish with Zulus,
-on the occasion when an impi was reported as being in the neighbourhood
-of Balte Spruit. The anticipations of attack were soon verified, as a
-couple of shots rang out from the right wall of the defile, and this was
-at once followed by a tremendous shout coming from the rear. The leading
-files of the little party had meanwhile reached the mouth of the gorge
-without any casualty, and General Wood and his escort on hearing the
-firing at once galloped back to the rear, from whence it came, and saw
-in a moment that Zulus were swarming on the sides of the cliff as if to
-attack in rear. The bugle at once sounded the halt, and the word was
-suddenly given for twenty men to wheel about and charge back in full
-force upon the unsuspecting foe, who imagined no doubt that he was going
-to be allowed all the fun of peppering the rear without receiving any
-punishment in return. With a hearty English shout these fellows, led by
-Buller, went straight at the enemy, and bursting over rough ground and
-through the high and tall grass drove the flying Zulus in panic before
-them. Buller's appearance at this moment combined an element of the
-heroic and the terrible with a strong infusion of the ludicrous and
-burlesque. Leading his men on at a swinging canter, with his reins in
-his teeth, a revolver in one hand and a knobkerrie he had snatched from
-a Zulu in the other, his hat blown off in the _mêlée_, and a large
-streak of blood across his face, caused by a splinter of rock from
-above, this gallant horseman seemed a demon incarnate to the flying
-savages, who slunk out of his path as if he had been--as indeed they
-believed him--an evil spirit, whose very look was death. The tables were
-now completely turned; the whole of the column is safely through the
-poort; one or two Zulus are seen limping away, assisted into the bush by
-their comrades, while the rest stand not upon the order of their going,
-but rush pell-mell to gain the shelter of the neighbouring caves. One
-large Zulu is seen to be badly hit, yet he manages to crawl away out of
-sight, and doubtless is assisted to escape by his fellows.
-
-The fun is becoming fast and furious. Buller's men are in their glory.
-They have dashed into the kloof, and are driving the Zulus out of it in
-parties of six or eight at a time. Everybody who an hour ago was as
-silent and sombre as the grave thinks it now necessary to yell with
-excitement. The sun is now at the meridian, and the day fearfully hot.
-The pursuit has been carried through valley and over ridge; by kloof and
-through _bosch_, by _bron_ (spring) and _drift_ (ford), and the whole
-column is scattered in every direction. It is, in fact, a regular
-scramble, and all ranks and uniforms are mixed up together. But the
-chase begins to slacken; the pace is too good to last. The recall
-sounds, and the firing dies away to a few desultory shots, while the
-troopers canter back, dishevelled and puffing like school-boys after a
-hard-won goal at football. As soon as the skirmish was over, and the
-column clear of the kloof, the journey was continued, and they soon
-reached the southern termination of the high valley two or three miles
-farther on, where the mountains and table-land descend to the more level
-and open country beyond, and by a slope which was noted as too steep for
-waggons. The General was the first to set the example of dismounting and
-leading his horse straight down most of the way, while the main body of
-the little column diverged to the crest of the hill to the west, where
-the trek wound gradually away in a spiral manner to the plain. This path
-offered no obstacle whatever to the transit of waggons, and, moreover,
-avoided a deep donga which lies right across the straight course. Here
-General Wood, having an engagement in camp, left Buller and his men with
-his orderly officers and escort, while they continued their
-investigations in a direction almost due south, over a series of rolling
-plains upon the table-land. The mist now most unfortunately came on
-again just as they had prepared their glasses for a good inspection of
-Ibabanango and the Alarm hill, but they could distinctly see on the
-right the high ground before the Khandi and Iheensi hills, and thence
-onwards to the Ingutu mountain, where they were not surprised to see
-that a signal-fire of considerable magnitude had been made by the Zulus
-as soon as they had fairly been discerned in the open and on lower
-ground. About five o'clock they reached the banks of the Unyunyebea
-river, one of the tributaries of the Ityotyosi, which in its turn flows
-eastward into the White Umvolosi. Here, as the locality seemed
-favourable, they off-saddled, and the men cooked their dinners, or
-rather evening meal. Captain Woodgate, with a Zulu who had returned
-lately from Ulundi, and half-a-dozen mounted natives as escort, rode
-away to a kop some three miles on, to reconnoitre. A few Zulus were seen
-on the opposite ridge, evidently watching the party's movements; and as
-they reached the top of the eminence, a messenger was despatched by them
-across the valley at speed to the next mountain, where soon after smoke
-was seen, showing evidently that their advent had been signalled to the
-next post. The remaining Zulus incontinently disappeared up some rocky
-ground to the left, and although one of them was chased by four Natal
-natives, he as well as his comrades escaped without injury. Colonel
-Buller and Captain Woodgate, not having been able to see anything of the
-range of mountains for which they were looking, went back to explore the
-river, but they had scarcely disappeared down the slope when the mist
-cleared off, and there could be distinctly seen the clearly defined
-outlines of a high isolated mountain towards the south-east, and this
-Zulu scouts declared to be Ibabanango, the principal object of their
-search. A number of deserted kraals belonging to Malafchey and his tribe
-were close at hand, and it was found that there was plenty of mealies
-and firewood, and a very comfortable meal was obtained for men and
-horses. As soon as it was sufficiently dark to hide his movements,
-Colonel Buller, who always adopted the plan of never bivouacking where
-he had halted during the day, quietly shifted the column across the
-stream to a spot where a deep donga, sheltered on all sides but one,
-gave protection from any night-surprise. The Natal native cavalry did
-not bivouac with the remainder of the patrol, but were allowed to post
-themselves and lie down without off-saddling at a point indicated to
-their commander, Captain Cochrane, by Colonel Buller. Sentries were
-posted, patrols sent out, and the night passed without incident or
-alarm. The next morning, soon after daybreak, they were again in motion,
-and were far more successful in their observations. Colonel Buller,
-assisted by Captain Woodgate, obtained excellent data referring to the
-position of the two mountains. From the observations and sketches they
-were enabled to make, they came to the conclusion that there would be no
-difficulty in the transport of waggons on either side of the road as
-far as Ibabanango, or in their getting on to the Rorke's Drift road to
-Ulundi. Another, and not the least important, point was noted, namely,
-that although the district they surveyed was not nearly so well watered
-as the Kambula country, the grass improved and became of a better
-quality the more one went into Zululand. It was so thick, and at the
-same time so green, that it would be practically impossible to get it to
-burn for at least another month, so that up to the end of June oxen
-would be tolerably sure of grazing. After carefully reconnoitring for
-some distance further, without being at all molested, although a few
-Zulu scouts were seen here and there, the column returned to camp, which
-they reached about 7.40 p.m., after a most exciting ride of some fifty
-miles and two days' experience of Zulu skirmishing.
-
-Another reconnaissance was organized for the 12th instant. Colonel
-Buller's patrol on this occasion was composed exclusively of picked and
-seasoned men, and consisted of 60 of the Frontier Light Horse, under
-Captain D'Arcy and Lieutenant Blaine; 40 Basutos, under Captain
-Cockerell and Lieutenants Henderson and Rane; and 80 of Baker's Horse,
-together with a few mounted scouts and orderlies, making altogether a
-well-mounted, well-armed, and well-trained band of 200 horsemen. Colonel
-Buller's guests, on this occasion, included the Prince Imperial, whom he
-was to meet at Conference Hill, Mr. Drummond, several officers from
-headquarters, and Lord William Beresford, who had earned the soubriquet
-of "The Ubiquitous." Having received full instructions, and been
-supplied with the usual three days' rations, with the best wishes for
-luck from their comrades, and a cheer from the men and officers, they
-filed out of the camp in the highest of spirits and eager for the road.
-Their first halt was to be Conference Hill, where the Prince Imperial
-was to join them. This post was at that time the most advanced point of
-General Newdigate's division, and from Doornkop the distance is about
-fifteen miles. From Wood's camp at Wolf's Kraal the distance would be
-about seven miles, and this was soon accomplished. They found his
-Imperial Highness waiting for them, with Colonel Malthus, commanding the
-94th, and some other officers, showing the Prince round the defences.
-After duly inspecting all the defences shown to them by Colonel Malthus,
-they made the best of their way to a spot selected for their bivouac,
-about six miles farther on, and where they remained the night, while
-their horses grazed contented in some mealie fields.
-
-Half an hour before dawn on the following morning Colonel Buller was to
-be seen scanning the horizon in all directions, and by sunrise his party
-were all in the saddle, and _en route_. They soon reached the ford at
-the Blood river, which had gone down considerably since Buller had last
-seen it. The country over which they rode was fairly open. They crossed
-the ford without difficulty, and gaining the opposite bank, reached a
-plain, from which they were, however, divided by a broad and well-worn
-watercourse. Here they faced the mountain, a long unbroken range,
-varying in height from 1000 to 1500 feet, which ran down the left of the
-valley. A portion of the mounted men were now sent away to the right,
-with instructions to ride up the kloof, then dismount, scale the rocks,
-and await the result of the advance of the main body. Should natives
-oppose the latter in force, the flanking party were then to drive them
-down the mountain, where it was expected they would fall into the hands
-of the Basutos under Henderson and Rane, who were placed in ambush on
-the left. After half an hour's careful scouting, not a sign of a Zulu
-could be seen, and Colonel Buller then gave the not unwelcome order to
-off-saddle at, or rather close to, a kraal which bore unmistakable
-evidences of recent native occupation. The troopers had no sooner
-off-saddled, however, than the wily savages emerged from the caves and
-crevices where they had been hid, and could be distinctly seen making
-the best of their way with considerable speed up Sirayo's krantz exactly
-opposite to where Buller's men were. They evidently were in some force,
-and two or three men on horseback were observed directing their
-movements as their reinforcements came rapidly in. The force, however,
-they were able to collect was extremely small, and certainly would not
-have numbered more than half Colonel Buller's command. The Prince
-Imperial was excellently mounted upon a handsome and powerful horse, who
-seemed, however a little fidgety under fire. Lieut. Rane was now sent on
-with a few Basutos, to see whether any stand would be made by the enemy;
-and the Prince Imperial immediately galloped after him, to see what he
-could of the fun. When these men arrived at the foot of the mountain,
-they found a much easier ascent than they had expected. A footpath,
-which, however, was quite practicable for horses, was seen winding in a
-devious manner in and out of the tall mimosa-trees which fringed the
-belt of the wood, and along this path dashed Rane and his Basutos,
-closely followed by the Prince, whose impatience to get to the front was
-noticed by all. On reaching the summit, however, not a Zulu or an enemy
-of any kind was to be seen. This was soon accounted for by the fact that
-half way up the krantz on the right were posted a number of
-Zulus--perhaps about 100. While the main body were watching these
-people, to see if they would attempt to cut off from the column the
-Prince and the Basutos, who were surrounding the plateau above, about
-100 savages now suddenly showed themselves, as if to invite combat, on
-the opposite side of the ravine. The object of all these man[oe]uvres
-was now obvious enough. The Zulus who were running away on the plateau
-above were so doing to lure the English force on to follow, when the
-party halfway up the krantz would probably be joined by a number of men
-from the kraals, and endeavour to block them in from the rear. It was
-now noticed that they were about to send messengers away for assistance,
-and this they could not do without running the gauntlet of fire of
-Buller's column. Crouching down, so as to be concealed as much as
-possible from the fire of the English rifles, two of the men belonging
-to the Zulu party ran rapidly away from the native column until they
-were within fifty yards of Buller's position. As they passed, a man
-raised his gun, and made an excellent shot at the leader, who never
-moved after he touched the ground, upon which he fell headlong. The
-remaining man, seeing the fate of his comrade, ran back to his people
-with wonderful activity, sharpened no doubt by the ping and whiz of
-half a dozen rifle-bullets sent after him at about 200 yards. Baker's
-Horse were now sent on to the table-land above, to look after the Prince
-Imperial, Rane, and the Basutos, whom they found in high glee, chasing
-some flying Zulus, who seemed too scared to notice that their assailants
-only numbered eight men.
-
-They now surveyed the surrounding country without further molestation.
-In front lay a broad valley, in the midst of which ran the Blood river,
-now shrunk to a thin silver thread; on the left at some distance off
-could be seen the table-shaped mountain of Mhlatze; and on the right was
-that spot of fatal memories, Isandhlwana, with its huge crag in the
-rear, raising its lion-like crest over the veldt below. After descending
-the mountain and burning the kraals on its south-east slopes, Buller and
-his party returned to camp without any event happening on their homeward
-route.
-
-It was now determined at headquarters that a reconnaissance in force
-should be made under the command of General Marshall, for the double
-purpose of still further pursuing the investigations begun and of
-burying the dead at Isandhlwana. For this purpose a force of no less
-than 2490 men was detailed, and consisted of the 17th Lancers, the
-King's Dragoon Guards, four companies of the second battalion 24th, and
-a number of native auxiliaries. Major Black's experience and knowledge
-of the road were found of great use, and the two cavalry regiments were
-capitally handled by Colonels Drury-Lowe and Alexander. Major Bengough
-had charge of the native battalion. The Natal mounted police were under
-Major Dartnell, and one hundred and fifty Army Service horses were led,
-in order to bring back the waggons. The entire force was gathered
-together at Rorke's Drift one hour before daylight, and carefully
-inspected by the light of the camp lanterns. They marched down to the
-river at daylight, and commenced to ford the stream, which was finally
-crossed by six o'clock. Colonel Drury-Lowe commanded the First Brigade,
-consisting of two squadrons of his own corps and two of the King's, and
-made a détour round the head and crest of the Bashee valley behind
-Sirayo's celebrated mountain, and, without any mishap or molestation,
-effected a junction with the remainder of the column at Isandhlwana.
-Colonel Alexander, with a brigade similarly constituted, marched by the
-direct waggon road straight upon his objective, while he threw out
-strong flanking parties right and left as he advanced. A squadron was
-sent at Colonel Black's suggestion to hold the gorge of the Bashee on
-the right, and a number of vedettes were occupied in patrolling the left
-of the same valley. Bengough's natives, meanwhile, came on at a rapid
-pace, and were thrown out into skirmishing order along the slopes of the
-Ingutu range, where the English troops once had such a tussle with
-Sirayo and his men. In fact, here, it may be said, the first blood in
-the campaign was shed, when they destroyed this cruel chief's
-stronghold.
-
-The manner in which Bengough's well-trained men scoured and scouted was
-most gratifying to observe. Every nook and corner, every crevice and
-cave, were carefully explored, and as the men advanced slowly along the
-valley and slopes of the mountain, every kraal was fired that came in
-their way. These men gradually worked their way round until they came
-along the range to the eastern limit of the valley, where the
-hunting-path trends towards the great kraal of Cetywayo. Meanwhile the
-cavalry were not idle. Crowds of vedettes swarmed along the sides of the
-valley ready to outflank any enemy or take him in reverse should he
-appear. While this was undertaken, the main force moved steadily along
-the front of the valley, and over the brow of the opposite ridge
-Bengough's men swarmed, chanting their war-song in native fashion. Down
-the hillside, to hold the head of the valley, came the four companies of
-the 24th, marching steadily in column of fours. The sun streamed in
-splendour upon the glittering files of cavalry as they wound like a
-brilliant chain along the greensward. Nothing could exceed the
-picturesque _ensemble_ that greeted the eye on all sides; nothing could
-be sadder than the mission upon which they came.
-
-As soon as the entire force was concentrated on the neck, their solemn
-but ghastly duty commenced. Rider and horse, officer and private, boy
-and man, their grim and parchment-looking skins half eaten by the
-carrion birds and half covering the bleaching bones, gave to the scene a
-terrible and weird significance, which can never be forgotten. Many of
-the bodies were easily recognized. Captain Shepstone at once pointed out
-that of Colonel Durnford, which was interred with deep respect in a
-donga near the spot where he fell. Forty-five waggons were brought away
-by the horses and mules, and a quantity of stores still intact was
-carried in them. The staff of the 24th's colours was also recovered; and
-the troops, having fully carried out their sad _devoir_ in the most
-effective manner, returned home with the same precaution with which they
-had moved on to the field.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER VIII.
-
- Advance of the 2nd column--Landsman's Drift to Kopje
- Allein--Description of camp--Plan of campaign--Discovery of Port
- Durnford--It becomes the base of 1st division--Troops composing 1st
- column--Crealock's journey to Durnford.
-
-
-The force thus gathered at Landsman's Drift was now quite ready for an
-immediate advance. It was therefore determined to push on this column
-(2nd) at once. Accordingly, on the 27th May the troops were formed up in
-line of contiguous quarter-columns by eight a.m., and after the General
-and his staff had ridden down the ranks, making a minute and detailed
-inspection, the various columns moved off by fours in succession from
-the right precisely at nine a.m. Newdigate's Division, which led the
-way, consisted of the 21st Fusiliers, the 94th Foot, the 58th Foot, and
-the 2nd battalion 24th Regiment, together with a wing of the King's
-Dragoon Guards, a wing of the 17th Lancers, a battalion of Native
-Contingent, two batteries of Royal Artillery, and a company of
-Engineers. The crossing of the Buffalo at Landsman's Drift was commenced
-at half-past nine, and the rear had crossed by two o'clock. The exact
-distance to Kopje Allein as the crow flies is said to be ten miles, but
-the route taken was somewhat circuitous, so as, for the sake of the
-waggons, to avoid many bad places, swamps, morasses, and mud-holes,
-which abound in this part of the country. The country between the Blood
-river and the Buffalo is tolerably well supplied with water,
-comparatively open, but singularly treeless in its character, though
-there were patches here and there along the road, and the district
-seemed well adapted for cattle posts and grazing purposes. Indeed there
-could be seen a number of large deserted kraals and homesteads, which
-had once evidently been the depôts of pastoral wealth and prosperity.
-These sites of industry had suffered a hard and rough usage in the
-terrible necessities of war. These depredations were largely caused by
-the foraging parties in search of fuel, the great want in all our camps.
-Supplies, indeed, on more than one occasion, were brought even as far as
-from the northern slopes of the Durnberg, a distance of twenty miles.
-Most of the best information in regard to the topographical features of
-this portion of the campaign was furnished by the very excellent reports
-drawn up by Colonel Buller, Lord William Beresford, and, above all, the
-Prince Imperial, whose pen and pencil gave a vivid and life-like idea of
-the physical characteristics of this line of advance.
-
-On the 16th instant Colonel Buller's second patrol returned at noon to
-General Wood's camp at the Wolf's kraal, and had been so successful in
-its reconnoitring operations that its officers were able to report that
-no large bodies of Zulus were within twenty miles of the Blood river,
-or, indeed, anywhere between the White Umvolosi and the Buffalo river.
-The same evening on which the patrol started it bivouacked at Kopje
-Allein, and, indeed, it was owing to the excellent reports made by
-Buller and his staff that the place was chosen as one of the links in
-the line of advance. A few Zulus there were, it is true, hovering about
-in the distance, and attempts were made by feigned attacks and feigned
-retreats to lure the troops into ambush, but Buller was far too old a
-soldier to be taken in by such wiles. When the men had got steadily on
-the summit of the hill they were exploring, the Zulu skirmishers
-disappeared into some of the caves surrounding Sirayo's old kraal, and
-nothing but some huts full of mealies could be found. The patrol that
-night slept on the slopes of the Ingutu mountains, and the following
-morning scouted in a southerly direction in rear of the Ingwe range, as
-far as the White Umvolosi, showing in a tolerably plain manner that the
-country about there was quite denuded of its population, at least
-between the Buffalo river and the White Umvolosi, while to the eastward
-and the northward of the latter river there were plenty of Zulus and
-cattle, but no large or important bodies were assembled north of the
-Isandaka range.
-
-The Prince Imperial had won all hearts during these three days in the
-saddle and night bivouac, and was seen to have considerably improved in
-health since his last visit to the camp.
-
-From the notes and sketches made by the officers above named the
-following data may be adduced:--The key of the road from the Utrecht to
-the Ulundi country is undoubtedly the Inhlazatye mountain, and, although
-this road runs along a narrow ledge with a precipice on the one side and
-with huge boulders on the other, interspersed with thorns and bush, yet
-still it is actually the most direct line of advance upon Ulundi. This
-Inhlazatye mountain covers a vast extent of country, has an immense
-quantity of thorn-bush over it, is very broken and steep, but
-undoubtedly can be turned by an invading force from the north either to
-the east or to the west, probably the latter, where little bush worth
-mentioning would have to be passed through. The most commanding and open
-positions are upon the highlands to the south of the White Umvolosi and
-Umtatoosi rivers, girdling the new capital, Ulundi. These are the
-Emtonjaneni hills (which are called Magnibonium on most maps), near the
-White Umvolosi, and the Tyoe and Entumeni heights in rear of the
-Umtatoosi, all healthy positions, well watered, and with abundant grass
-and wood. From the Emtonjaneni hills, explored by Colonel Buller, who
-estimates them at 200 feet high, the circle of royal kraals on the
-farther side of the White Umvolosi can be seen; three roads lead to the
-rear into the colony, the upper, central, and lower. The Ekowe,
-Entumeni, and Ungoga ranges, from 1500 to 2000 feet above the sea level,
-dominate the valley of the Umtatoosi. Healthy positions suitable for
-cavalry encampments may be found on these heights, well wooded and
-watered, with excellent grass and roads leading to the rear into the
-colony; and here Marshall's cavalry kept open our communications and
-effectually severed connexion between the Zulu's right and left impis.
-These central and coast lines, which are joined by a cross-road, both
-follow the course of the Umtatoosi.
-
-During the march, and whenever the country would admit of such
-formation, the leading corps halted, and the extended line of march was
-curtailed by the succeeding regiment forming upon its left; waggons came
-up in a sort of deployment into line, and certain simple movements were
-practised which would be carried out in case of sudden attack. Lord
-Chelmsford invariably made a great point of concentrating his waggons
-whenever the slightest opportunity offered. General Newdigate and
-General Wood between them had 900 waggons, and it may easily be imagined
-what a column 450 of these would make. Allowing 30 yards to each--and
-that is not much, there being 16 or 18 oxen to each load--each column of
-baggage alone is 15 miles long, but to this distance must be added 5
-yards interval, and this gives 18 miles to defend. Of course, the forage
-for the large cavalry force made one of the greatest strains upon the
-commissariat, and all had to be sacrificed to this necessity. This
-column and Crealock's were in this respect not upon a par, as it had to
-provide for not less than 2000 horses, each receiving 12 lb. of corn
-daily; which gave a total of 24,000 lb. daily, or 3000 lb. per waggon
-load, or 6 waggons daily to supply them. At this rate, therefore, it
-required 120 waggons to carry the oats for the cavalry alone. All Lord
-Chelmsford's and the staff horses were, however, placed upon half
-rations.
-
-Ibabanango, which Lord Chelmsford had selected as an advanced depôt for
-the united forces of his column and that of Wood, is again situated
-about midway between this place (Kopje Allein) and the king's kraal at
-Ulundi. The troops in this camp consisted of a company of Engineers, the
-cavalry brigade, two batteries of Royal Artillery, four line battalions,
-and 800 natives. The encampment was rather extensive, but this upon
-sanitary grounds and the best medical advice. The battalions were
-encamped as at open order, front as in line, with a depth of 116 yards,
-which is unusual, for half the above frontage is the usual encampment,
-and 30 yards were left between each of the four battalions. Each
-regiment of cavalry usually occupies 172 yards of front and 130 yards of
-depth, but its camp can be condensed to 120 yards of front by crossing
-heel-ropes, and this, for defensive reasons, was the plan adopted by
-General Marshall. This could not be done with Cape or Indian remounts,
-as entire horses would fight if so close to each other; but English
-horses are so accustomed to this proximity that it was found they throve
-better when allowed companionship. To each battery of artillery was
-allowed a frontage of 133 yards, with a depth of 114 yards, or 70 yards
-front at close order, while from centre to centre of the tents 10 paces
-were allotted. The kitchens were simple enough, being nothing more than
-a trench to catch the wind and hold the usual pattern of Flanders or
-Torrens kettle--the former, weighing 8-1/2 lbs., holding twelve quarts,
-and cooking for eight men, while the latter weighs 3-1/2 lbs., holds six
-quarts, and cooks for five men. Whenever the ground was too wet for a
-trench, two parallel sod walls answered the same purpose, and two
-trenches, 10 feet long, 9 inches broad, and 12 inches deep were allowed
-for a company of 120 men. The medical arrangements were as elaborate as
-could be made consistent with the limited means of transport, but what
-was deficient in quantity was made up in excellence of detail. Medical
-officers and stretcher-bearers usually moved in front of the camp, and
-the temporary hospital was always placed in the least exposed position
-near at hand, while the field-hospitals were always in rear. One
-medical officer was allotted to each battalion of infantry, regiment of
-cavalry, or battery of artillery--more could not be spared. One bearer
-company and two field-hospitals were allotted to each division. This
-bearer company included 206 men, part natives, 101 mules or horses, and
-30 waggons. The field-hospitals had each 75 men, 52 mules, and 10
-waggons, while each field-hospital had equipment for 200 sick.
-Fortunately the health of the troops was exceptionally good.
-
-Instead of an advance from Rorke's Drift, it was now determined to take
-a line from Kopje Allein to Blood river, across the more northern spurs
-of the Ingutu hills, and endeavour to ultimately strike the road laid
-down in the maps, between the Alarm and the Isipizi hills. This route
-was to be taken by General Wood's flying column in advance, and General
-Newdigate's division, of which actually it was intended to form an
-integral portion. The former consisted of the 13th and 90th Regiments of
-Light Infantry and five companies of the 80th Regiment, all of them in
-splendid and hard-working condition, and devoted to their brilliant
-leader. Wood's cavalry consisted of 900 mounted men belonging to various
-corps, and commanded by the Rupert of South Africa, Redvers Buller,
-whose men were ready to follow him anywhere, and die for him to a man,
-after his splendid self-devotion at Zlobani and elsewhere. Wood, who
-made friends wherever he moved, had some valuable allies in Oham's
-people, who, hating the tyranny of Cetywayo, were invaluable as scouts
-and spies to the flying columns. The arrangements for the line of
-advance were as follows:--Wood's flying column was to keep in advance
-of Newdigate's division by about five miles, while in front of the
-former a veil of cavalry was to keep in advance about ten miles,
-connected by intervening files. Each morning orderlies were to report
-whether the front and rear were perfectly clear, nor was an advance to
-be made until such was known. In case of any enemy attacking Wood, the
-latter was to be at once supported by Marshall, who could circle round
-and take the Zulus in the rear, a principle of strategy they strongly
-object to. Crealock, with the aid of the naval authorities, was at the
-same time to push forward from Fort Chelmsford, and, if the landing at
-Port Durnford was reported practicable, force the Umvolosi and operate
-in conjunction with the 2nd column from his base at Port Durnford.
-
-Lord Chelmsford had long seen that the best method to obviate the almost
-overwhelming difficulties of transport would be to form some seaport on
-the Zulu coast. Delagoa Bay was at first selected; but considerable
-difficulty was found in arranging with the Portuguese Government as to
-our landing a force in the neighbourhood, and that scheme was
-consequently abandoned. It then became evident that if a seaport, or
-even ever so small a landing-place could be provided at the mouth of the
-Umlalasi, it would be at once the nearest and best base of operations
-for any force moving from the Tugela upon Ulundi or Cetywayo's other
-stronghold.
-
-Furthermore, as far back as December, 1877, Sir Theophilus Shepstone
-wrote to Sir Bartle Frere, informing his Excellency that two
-gentlemen--Mr. E. Rathbone and Mr. H. W. Taylor--wished to call
-attention to the fact that, from personal observations they had made,
-they were satisfied that a practicable landing-place on the Zulu coast
-could be found. These gentlemen, it is true, as Sir Theophilus pointed
-out, differed as to the precise spot on the coast, but both agreed that
-it was near the Tugela mouth, and but a very few miles intervene between
-the one place described and the other. This discovery was made
-twenty-seven years ago, in the year 1852, and, so far from being kept a
-secret, was published for general information in the _Natal Mercury_.
-
-H.M. gunboat "Forester" was accordingly despatched to thoroughly explore
-this part of the coast; no less than three minute and careful surveys
-were made, and finally, on May 26th, she returned with the welcome
-intelligence that a fine lagoon existed close to the mouth of the
-Umlalasi, with a sheltered outlet, and that, from the soundings taken
-for five miles on either side of the river, there was no actual obstacle
-to a landing being practicable at all tides and all seasons.
-
-There was, however, at the mouth of the river, a bar on which the surf
-broke heavily; and in bad weather experience proved on more than one
-occasion that this formed an impassable barrier even to the most
-determined attempts to make a landing.
-
-This spot was christened Port Durnford, and steps were immediately taken
-to form there a fort and depôt of supplies for the 1st column, in
-command of which was General Crealock.
-
-To Commodore Sullivan, Major Barrow, and the captain of H.M.S.
-"Forester" principally belong the honours of the discovery; and while
-the sailors worked heartily seaward and along the dangerous and
-difficult coast, Barrow and his riders found out all the roads which led
-to the point selected. It had been arranged that General Crealock, with
-the advanced guard of the 1st division should move down the Umlalasi to
-a point carefully surveyed by Barrow, and which was subsequently, in
-compliment to the gallant young prince, called Fort Napoleon. Thence he
-was to proceed to Port Durnford, to meet the "Forester."
-
-Hitherto the advance had been slow; but when it is remembered that forts
-were constructed at every strategic point of defence--at the Amatikula,
-the Inyezani (respectively Forts Chelmsford and Crealock), and the whole
-of the road between this place and the Tugela had been put into working
-order by fatigue parties and Engineers, it is clear there was no real
-ground for complaint of the delay. Every stream had been bridged, either
-with pontoons, casks, or trestles, and trees had been cut down, rocks
-and boulders blown up, as well as gradients eased and facilities for
-transport carried out. Forts Pearson, Tenedos, Chelmsford, Crealock, and
-Napoleon were garrisoned by the less robust men of the column. Six
-companies of the 88th, with the headquarters, held Fort Chelmsford,
-while a wing of the 99th performed the same office at Fort Crealock. The
-regular communications along this line of advanced forts were placed in
-charge of one of the best men out there, namely, Colonel Hugh Rowlands,
-41st Regiment, whose eye for country, tact, and temper with the natives
-and incessant vigilance eminently qualified him for such a
-responsibility.
-
-At this time the force of the 1st division stood as follows:--General
-Crealock, Brigadiers Bray and Rowlands; two batteries of artillery and
-one ammunition column; Royal Engineers, 30th company and C troop;
-infantry, six battalions, viz.:--the Buffs, 57th, 60th, 88th, 91st, and
-99th Regiments, two squadrons of mounted infantry, the Natal Horse, the
-native scouts; as pretty and compact a little division as any moderately
-ambitious general could wish to command, and it speaks well for the
-chief's admirable temper under difficulties that, chafed as he now was,
-and tied as it were by the leg, by want of transport, he kept working
-incessantly without a murmur at the forts, bridges, fords, roads, and
-other requisites.
-
-In accordance with the above-mentioned arrangement, General Crealock,
-Commodore Richards, and Lord Gifford set forth on the 25th June for Port
-Durnford, taking with them the advance-guard of the 1st division.
-
-At first the road was over a level and sandy plain, with numerous small
-granite hills in different directions, and although there was not much
-vegetation for the first two or three miles of the road, it opened on to
-a more picturesque-looking champaign country, where the soil appeared
-teeming with fertility, and the air was balmy and pure. The country
-here, however, is arid and parched during the dry season, but in the
-rains, which last from November till May, it is well watered, and large
-crops of maize are grown, which by the end of June are usually ripened
-and fit for cutting. Large crops of malama are also grown, and it is
-upon the stalks of this that the cattle are mostly fed in the drought,
-when they appear in good condition, notwithstanding its seeming want of
-nutriment.
-
-Here a halt was made; vedettes were placed, and a meal was partaken of.
-Then, after half an hour's rest, they again pushed on, and soon came to
-an undulating and extremely romantic-looking valley, shut in on either
-side by some huge granite hills. Ascending the highest of these, they
-looked down upon the Indian Ocean, Port Durnford, and the "Forester,"
-standing off about a mile from the shore, and evidently on the look-out.
-From this point to the outlet of the Umlalazi the country was fairly
-open, and the landscape fertile and partly cultivated. The only obstacle
-to progress was a rocky and rather narrow ridge, through which, however,
-ran a fairly open kloof, with a small and tributary stream winding its
-way to the Umlalazi. Here was the road, and another two hours saw them
-through the kloof without question or attack, and they cantered along
-the grassy slopes to the bright and shingly beach, upon which a couple
-of boat's crews, despatched when they were first sighted, were occupied
-in preparing a very excellent dinner of ship's rations for the tired and
-hungry men.
-
-General Crealock highly approved of the position, and a fort and other
-works were at once traced out, thus rendering complete the cordon of
-posts that had been drawn all round the south of Zululand, right from
-the sea to the left attack (or 2nd column), and through which it was
-impossible for Cetywayo to force a way, and which rendered his capture
-or submission a mere question of time.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER IX.
-
- Death of the Prince Imperial--Lieutenant Carey's
- account--Discrepancies in and comments thereon--Feeling in the
- camp--Expedition under General Marshall to search for the
- body--Description of the spot--Recovery of the body--Court-martial
- on Carey.
-
-
-We now come to an event which, though it in no way affected the course
-or result of this war, was nevertheless so deplorably sad in itself, as
-well as to the British army, and was, furthermore, of such world-wide
-interest, altering, as it undoubtedly did, the history of one of the
-mightiest nations of Europe, that no apology is required for a detailed
-narrative.
-
-Ever since the arrival of the Prince Imperial in the colony he had
-continued to win the friendship and esteem of all ranks, and his
-unassuming quietude and modesty, genial humour, and readiness to learn
-the most minute details of the profession he had adopted, made him a
-universal favourite. It has been previously mentioned that the Prince
-had been engaged in several reconnaissances, and only three days before
-his death he had been with Lord Chelmsford upon a patrol extending more
-than twenty miles into the Zulu country. On May the 28th General Wood
-received orders to move parallel to, but slightly in advance, of
-General Newdigate's column, from Kopje Allein, in a south-easterly
-direction towards the Itelezi hill. After three days had been spent in
-carefully exploring the country, General Newdigate moved forward on June
-1st with his division, as nearly as possible 10,000 strong, and with a
-baggage train of 480 waggons. The country had been carefully scouted by
-Buller's Horse for twenty miles round, and no Zulus were reported near.
-On the evening of the 1st the column laagered not far from the Itelezi,
-and on the following day the General moved south-east along a level
-country towards the Inguita range; and the flying column being one march
-ahead, a communication was kept up by the vedettes of General Newdigate
-and General Wood. On Sunday, the 1st, General Wood with a small escort
-reconnoitred in advance of the column, which was about five miles in
-advance of General Newdigate's force. Away on the right and left were
-Buller's horsemen dotting the ridges of the hills on either side. In
-front lay green slopes, which were traversed here and there by
-watercourses, and bounded by the most singularly shaped mountains, flat
-at the summit and crowned with a sort of rocky dome. A good deal of rain
-had fallen in the night, and the morning was as clear and fresh as a May
-day in England. The General and his escort had ridden about six miles,
-when the path suddenly made a bend to the left, skirting a clump of
-trees, which grew near the edge of the stream. Pushing a way through
-thick thorny underwood mingled with date-palms and tall reeds, they at
-length looked down upon the still deep waters of a narrow river, flowing
-across a long red sandbank. A ledge of granite formed a rugged barrier
-eight feet or ten feet high across the river, and down the hollows of
-this the clear water rushed and gurgled in fantastic rills, cascades,
-and rapids, bubbling and eddying among the great masses of rock above,
-in many of which great holes were worn by stones which during the floods
-had settled in small hollows. Traversing a sandstone hill, with a long
-spur stretching away to the eastward, and rising in cliffs of 300 feet
-to the south of the river, they came upon a grove of fan-palms and
-mimosa, where the banks of the stream were covered with golden-blossomed
-acacias. Crossing the river by an easy ford, they had ridden on about
-another mile, when they observed some of the vedettes on the high ground
-to the left signalling that horsemen were approaching. Soon they came
-out upon an immense cultivated flat, terminating to the right in a long,
-dark, and winding gorge, black with bush, and arched by huge precipices
-of sandstone and granite. Into this they turned, and, following a Kaffir
-path marked with tracks made by Buller's men, they came upon a bush of
-about six or seven acres, in the centre of which were the remains of a
-burnt kraal and marks of recent fighting. On the edge of a small stream
-they discovered a path to the extreme right, in fact quite on the
-hillside, and here the surface showed numerous boot-marks, where the
-scouts had evidently been. They had now reached a plain, from which they
-were divided by a broad and well-worn watercourse, and here they were
-joined by three or four vedettes, who came to report that they had
-noticed some horsemen coming at a rapid canter from the direction of the
-Tombalaka and the Iyohgazi rivers, which were about equidistant between
-Wood's late camp and that of General Newdigate. They had not long to
-wait for the solution of the mystery, for, riding in the direction of
-the horsemen, they were met by Colonel Buller and a dozen of his men,
-who was equally anxious with General Wood to discover who the fugitives
-could be. They all rode on together, and rounding the base of the cliff
-came up with Lieutenant Carey and four troopers of Bettington's Horse.
-In a few seconds more the terrible secret was revealed, and Lieutenant
-Carey, whose horse was almost dead beat, and covered with foam, was
-rapidly relating to General Wood the details. "Where is the Prince?"
-exclaimed Wood, as he breasted his horse at some fallen trees which
-intervened, and dashed forward to meet the fugitives. "Speak, sir; what
-has happened?" "The Prince, I fear, is killed, sir," said one of the
-men, Carey being at first unable to speak. "Is that the case? Tell me
-instantly, sir," answered the General. "I fear 'tis so, General," was
-the answer; upon which our chief exclaimed, "And what are you, sir,
-doing here?" A veil must be drawn over the rest of the interview, which
-was of the most painful character. A short despatch was at once written
-while on horseback by the General, and in this a _résumé_ of the fearful
-tragedy was told, how English soldiers had had the unutterable shame of
-seeing an English officer and four English troopers unwounded and
-escaped from a Zulu ambush, in which a gallant young Prince, the guest
-of England and the hope of France, had been barbarously slain. This
-letter was at once despatched by the General to headquarters, where he
-ordered Lieutenant Carey and his party to proceed and make their
-report.
-
-The story elicited from Carey and the four men, in spite of a few
-discrepancies, was in the main as follows:--
-
-On Sunday, the 1st of June, the Prince learnt that a patrol was to be
-sent out in advance of the column, to choose the site for the camp on
-the following day, and his Highness at once applied for and obtained
-permission to accompany it. At six o'clock on Sunday morning the Prince
-Imperial sent for his groom, and consulted him as to what horse he
-should ride, and the man strongly advised him not to take the large grey
-horse, which was eventually one of the causes of his death. This animal
-was not one of those selected for the Prince by Sir John Bissett, who
-had assisted him in the choice of others. He was a big, awkward-looking,
-but very powerful animal, but an inveterate buck-jumper, and, moreover,
-excessively timid under fire, a fault which in a charger is dangerous to
-the last degree. Two of the Prince's horses had died, either on the
-voyage out or soon after landing, and upon the fatal Sunday the grey
-horse was the only steed not lame or upon the sick report, so he had to
-be taken as a case of "Hobson's choice." At seven o'clock a note arrived
-addressed to the Prince, in which he was informed that permission was
-accorded him to go with the patrol about to be sent on to choose next
-day's camping-ground. This note was from Colonel Harrison, the acting
-quarter-master-general, and the Prince at once went over to his tent,
-and received final instructions from him verbally; which it must be
-assumed, were in accordance with the wishes of the Commander-in-chief,
-who expressly stated that the Prince was to be well cared for, to have
-no military responsibility, and yet, at the same time, was not to be
-interfered with, or in any way prevented from seeing the country.
-Lieutenant Carey's account of these matters is somewhat at variance with
-this statement of Colonel Harrison, as he (Carey) says that he was told
-that the Prince was to have the entire charge of the escort and the
-entire duty of selecting the camp. Lieutenant Carey says in his written
-statement, that it was by his express desire that he was named to
-accompany the escort, and he made this request in consequence of his
-knowledge of the country and, in some degree, of the language. Six men
-of Captain Bettington's Horse and the same number of Shepstone's Basutos
-were ordered to parade at half-past eight a.m. as escort, but for some
-hitherto unexplained reason the latter never appeared, and when Carey
-suggested they should wait for them the Prince, with that utter contempt
-for danger for which he was always remarkable, exclaimed, "Oh, no; we
-are quite strong enough!" At nine a.m. all was ready, a frugal breakfast
-of black coffee and biscuit had been partaken of, saddles, carbines,
-swords, revolvers, and accoutrements had been carefully inspected, and
-the word was given to "mount" and "away!" Before leaving the camp,
-however, a message was sent to Captain Shepstone to say that the escort
-would halt and wait for the six Basutos on the ridge between the Incenzi
-and Itelezi hills. A messenger was again sent to hurry on these natives,
-but it seems they never came, and therefore the patrol consisted only of
-the Prince, Lieutenant Carey, six mounted men of Bettington's Horse,
-and one friendly Zulu. This was certainly not a fit escort for such a
-charge, and it seems impossible not to attach a grave responsibility to
-the staff officer who made the detail. All the six Europeans were well
-armed and well mounted, their weapons consisting of the Martini-Henry
-slung across the back, ammunition in bandoleer, and a stout serviceable
-knife, which could be used for meals or on emergency as a weapon at
-close quarters. The Prince and Lieutenant Carey had not rifles, but
-swords and revolvers, and unfortunately the latter were not worn upon
-the person as they invariably should be, but in the holsters. The Prince
-had been on several visits to General Wood's camp, and was an
-enthusiastic admirer of both Wood and Buller, with the latter of whom he
-had become very intimate ever since the last two patrols he had made
-with him. With Lieutenant Carey his Imperial Highness had also an
-intimacy of some standing, and as Carey's skill as a draughtsman was
-well known in the camp, he had been selected on several occasions to
-assist his Highness in surveying operations.
-
-The day had broken on this fated Sunday with all the glory of a real
-South African morning. It had been raining during the night, but this
-only served to give a more delightful perfume to the odorous plants that
-were crushed by the hoofs of the horses belonging to the escort. The
-rain of the previous day and night had refreshed the ground, and filled
-the various pools with water, and the plains were cheerful with the
-animals and birds coming out of the bush to feed. The patrol met with no
-adventure for some time, but continued its course along a valley running
-north-east, and narrowing gradually. The track in some places crossed
-bad spruits, and was undefined, and in parts obliterated by thorn-trees
-and bush. It was also commanded here and there by projecting spurs and
-bluffs, where an enemy could have easily hidden in force, and have
-attacked them at an advantage, but on either side could be seen the
-friendly Basutos scouting in the distance. The watershed of the mountain
-was reached about an hour after the patrol started, and on arriving at
-the ridge the Prince and Lieutenant Carey dismounted, as they wished to
-fix the position of some important hills with their compasses. Here
-Colonel Harrison overtook them, and remarked that the whole of the
-escort was not with them, adding that the patrol had better wait for the
-Basutos to come up. The Prince said, "Oh, we are quite strong enough.
-Besides, we have all our friends around us, and with my glass I can see
-General Marshall's cavalry coming up." Lieutenant Carey, as soon as he
-had finished his sketch, proposed to off-saddle and breakfast; but he
-states that the Prince overruled this suggestion and expressed a wish to
-push on to the river. The patrol accordingly proceeded on for about four
-miles, where for some distance the way was along the bottom of a deep
-sandy nullah with very precipitous sides, which they were forced to take
-as the only practicable place. This at length debouched into an open
-space, from which there appeared to be an entrance to a disused kraal
-some two miles up the ravine. Here the escort found that there was good
-drinking-water in some pools under a large kopje in front, situated in a
-complete amphitheatre of hills, and upon this kopje were some of our
-Basuto skirmishers. After watering the horses, the party advanced for a
-mile and a half along a commanding and rocky range of hills a short
-distance beyond the Ilyotosi river. Here Carey again proposed to
-off-saddle, but the Prince did not approve of the spot, and after some
-more sketching and surveying the country with telescopes and compass,
-the valley was descended as far as an isolated kraal, and the order was
-given to off-saddle. The Prince, who did not appear very strong, now
-complained of being tired, and while coffee was being prepared lay down
-beside the door of a hut.
-
-The place where this halt was made would appear, from the statements of
-Lieutenant Carey and the surviving men of the escort, to be about as
-ill-chosen and suspicious a locality as could be found. The kraal where
-they now were consisted of about half a dozen huts, and was situated
-about three hundred yards from the river Moazani (so called by the Zulu
-who accompanied the party). Between the kraal and the river stretched a
-tall and luxuriant growth of that most dangerous cover, five, six, and
-seven feet in height, Tambookie grass interspersed here and there, as is
-customary, with equally tall mealies and Kaffir corn. The plains beneath
-this spot afforded every temptation to the artistic eye of the Prince,
-and here again another sketch of the panorama was quickly made. The
-bright glowing tints of the foreground, whose colours were lit up by
-green and fresh grass and wide-spreading acacia and flowering shrubs,
-well mellowed away in the middle distance, while far away towards the
-horizon were to be seen the shadowy outlines of the blue Itelezi hills.
-The kraal was not completely surrounded, for in front there was an open
-space where broken cooking utensils and burnt-out embers, bones, and
-other _débris_, showed that the place had not long ago been occupied.
-Some hungry-looking dogs came out and snarled at the intruders. Here the
-fatal order was given to off-saddle, and, in defiance of the most common
-and ordinary precautions, which the merest tyro should have taken, the
-horses were knee-haltered and turned out to graze, while coffee was
-prepared, and not the slightest search made in the cover around.
-
-The friendly Zulu was sent down to the river for water, and also to see
-that the horses did not stray too far. All this time a party of Zulus,
-supposed to have been about thirty or forty, were concealed and watching
-the doomed party, who, utterly unsuspicious of an ambush, were seated
-around, chatting and sipping their coffee. A deep donga lay right across
-the path subsequently taken by the fugitives, and this served to screen
-the enemy as he stealthily crawled to his prey. Stealing noiselessly
-along, hidden by the rank vegetation, and unheard by the unwatchful
-escort, the savages came nearer and nearer to their quarry, but while
-creeping along were descried by the watchful eyes of the Kaffir, who,
-not losing a second, darted back to the Prince, and gave the warning of
-danger. A little delay now occurs, for his Highness fails to understand
-the native, who has to appeal to Corporal Grubb, one of the escort, to
-interpret. The corporal explains to the Prince, who looks at his watch,
-and (we are told) seeing it was ten minutes to four, says, "You can give
-your horses ten minutes more." But this must have been countermanded,
-for the horses were at once collected, and in a few moments were
-prepared to start. The Prince is carefully and calmly examining his bit
-and bridle, and, it is surmised, had not sufficiently tightened his
-girths. His grey horse is a fidgety, troublesome animal to mount, and
-now appears to be nervous and anxious to break away. Meanwhile all the
-escort stand to their horses and await the word, which the Prince now
-gives, "Prepare to mount." But this was the death-signal, for hardly had
-the order escaped the lips that gave it, and that spoke no other word on
-earth, than the fearful traditional "Usulu! Usulu!" awoke the echoes of
-the valley, and a tremendous volley was poured in from the favouring
-cover of the grass and mealies. All the horses swerved instinctively
-with terror, and some broke away. Private Rogers was shot before he
-could mount, and the Prince's tall grey, half mad with fright, became
-impossible to mount. Where is the English iron nerve that is proof
-against the panic of a moment? Where are the guardians of England's
-princely guest? All have lost their courage and their sense of manhood.
-_Sauve qui peut!_ is the craven spirit of those who had they rallied
-back to back could have probably saved a noble life and preserved a
-nation's honour. Not a carbine was loaded, not a sentry placed.
-Surprise, the most unsoldierlike crime, was allowed, and white with fear
-each trooper galloped away to save himself, nor drew bridle-rein till
-miles of country placed safety in his path. Meanwhile, the gallant and
-unfortunate Prince is losing every chance of escape which the slightest
-attempt at succour would have given. One friendly hand to steady the
-scared and ill-broken steed; one carbine, even unloaded, presented at
-the bush--for the savages had not dared to come forth--or one gallant
-heart like Buller, Leet, or Wood to have shown the chivalry of France
-that England's sons were worthy of their ancient fame, and the Prince
-would have been alive to-day. There is, it is true, the testimony of one
-man, borne away by his frightened and possibly wounded horse, who says
-that not being more than half in the saddle, and having no control over
-his mount, he could not stay to aid the Prince. "Dépêchez-vous,
-monsieur!" he cried, as he swept by at a racing gallop, and that was all
-the warning he could give. And then--oh, shame and humiliation!--this
-young lad, schooled to arms with English soldiers' sons, wearing an
-English uniform, and escorted by British soldiers to a bloody grave, was
-left alone to be speared to death, without a sword being drawn or a shot
-fired, even from a distance, in his defence.
-
-The Zulus, seeing only one man unable to mount, burst at length from
-their treacherous cover, and with fiendish yells rush upon the Prince,
-who, holding the stirrup-leather with one hand and the holster-flap with
-the other, must have made one final and desperate attempt to spring into
-the saddle. But all is in vain, the untrustworthy leather gives way in
-his hand; his feet slip from under him; he falls beneath the horse,
-which treads upon his body and gallops away! The last that was seen of
-the Empress's beloved son was, that he was alone and on foot, with some
-dozen Zulus poising their assegais within a few feet from him, and his
-body was afterwards found pierced in front with some eighteen or twenty
-thrusts, and stripped of all but his mother's amulet.
-
-It cannot have escaped the reader that there are some discrepancies and
-anachronisms in the accounts given by Lieutenant Carey and the survivors
-of that fatal and ill-omened day, the 1st of June. These contradictions
-were not unnoticed by General Wood when he took down the report and
-forwarded it to the headquarter camp. In the first place we are told
-that the Prince was too rash and venturesome, and that he nearly lost
-his life on the day when, accompanied by Major Bettington, some of his
-men, and a party of Basutos, he visited a Zulu kraal in the
-neighbourhood of the camp, and was fired upon by the enemy. Now, on this
-as on former occasions, when the Prince went out with Colonel Buller,
-Lord Chelmsford, and other officers in charge of patrols or
-reconnaissances, he was perfectly well aware that he was merely
-incurring the same risk as were other English officers, whose lives to
-the British nation, if not to France, were as valuable as his, and whose
-temerity--if such it can be called--was absolutely necessary to the
-conduct of the campaign. But on the last fatal occasion his Highness was
-allowed to go alone, or virtually alone, for Lieutenant Carey does not
-seem to have taken his honest and proper share of responsibility, or
-looked after the most ordinary precautions which a subaltern of a week's
-standing would have carried out in a time of profound peace. We are told
-that the Prince gave all orders and words of command during the day,
-that he selected, approved of, and disapproved of each halting-place
-that was arrived at, and that when Lieutenant Carey wished the escort to
-muster and leave the deserted kraal at a certain hour the Prince
-demurred, and gave the order to stay much longer. Now this, if
-authentic, indicates a lack of military knowledge which it is difficult
-to understand as appertaining to an officer of Lieutenant Carey's
-standing. The rule of the service is imperative, and no civilian, no
-volunteer, and no guest, whatever his rank, may, can, or should at least
-be allowed to give a word of command when an official authority is
-present. If Lieutenant Carey, out of compliment or out of courtesy,
-allowed the Prince Imperial to choose the halting-places and to give the
-words of command to the troopers, whom he and not his Highness
-commanded, he betrayed an ignorance of the customs, duties, and
-etiquette of his profession which renders him totally unfit for the
-possession of her Majesty's commission. If he did not allow our deplored
-and gallant guest to select these halts, to choose the places for
-"off-saddle," and to give the necessary cautions and words of command in
-regard to mounting, why, then, he is still more to blame, as knowing, as
-he should have known, that he and not the Prince was in command, his
-first and transparently obvious duty was to post vedettes and keep a
-soldierlike look-out on all sides. Lieutenant Carey was specially
-ordered to take half a dozen Basutos with him, in addition to the scanty
-escort allotted by the Quarter-Master-General of six of Bettington's
-Horse. He says that the escort of Basutos never came, and that the
-Prince, when told of their absence, would not wait, but insisted on
-pushing forward. The captain of a ship who, at the instance of an
-impatient passenger, puts to sea with only half his water and provisions
-on board, endangers the lives of those under his command, and for ever
-forfeits his claim to future confidence in his conduct and prudence. We
-are told that as the first division and the flying column of General
-Wood were on converging lines, and were rapidly approaching, and that as
-the ground over which this fatal reconnaissance was made had been
-previously explored by the Prince, Lieutenant Carey was justified in
-arriving at the illogical conclusion that it must be safe from an enemy.
-A more preposterous assertion was never before made to hoodwink and
-blind justice. Why, not a day passed during this unhappy war when the
-troops, in all their camps, were not dogged and followed by parties more
-or less numerous, whose duties were to lie in wait for and cut off any
-imprudent scouts or stragglers from the camp. The officer in command of
-the escort should have been aware of this, and should have known that
-the fact of a particular neighbourhood or kraal having been searched a
-week previously and found deserted afforded no presumption that the
-locality would not be full of Kaffirs some days further on.
-
-After the word "Mount" was given by the Prince, a fact which is to most
-minds somewhat doubtful, we are told that the volley of musketry was
-fired, and that some of the horses broke away, while that of the Prince
-became so frightened that he could not be mounted. "One by one the party
-galloped past the Prince, who was in vain endeavouring to mount." Where
-was the friend and associate of England's guest? Where was the officer
-who had specially applied for this sacred and most honourable duty?
-Where, we want to know, was the English officer in command of the
-"escort"? His place was with his men, not leading them away with their
-backs to the paltry handful of Zulus, which, it is now known, were in
-the mealies, but holding the ground, and covering the body of his
-charge. The captain of a sinking or waterlogged vessel is not the first
-man in the boats, leaving passengers and crew to sink without him. His
-place is upon his deck, trumpet in hand, and even if death-doomed,
-sinking like an Englishman under the shadow of the British flag. Such,
-comparatively, was the place and the _devoir_ of the officer in command
-of the Prince's escort, and had he devoted one brief half-moment to see
-and aid our guest to his saddle he would, even if killed or wounded in
-the act, have earned a name in every English and French household more
-cherished and lustrous than the star of valour which our Queen gives to
-her bravest men.
-
-We now come to the statements of the survivors, and here we are at a
-considerable loss to reconcile the accounts. It is distinctly mentioned
-by one witness that the abandoned Prince was seen vainly endeavouring to
-spring into the saddle by the aid of the holster and the cantle. The
-story must be received with considerable reservation, if not utter
-mistrust. The Prince, it is well-known, was a most accomplished
-horseman, and especially distinguished by his proficiency in all the
-arts and minutiæ of the _manége_, and he therefore would be most
-unlikely to attempt to mount in the way described. Almost the first
-lesson given in the riding-school to a recruit is the one which teaches
-the method of mounting the horse. The merest novice in military
-equitation must be aware that the first motion with the left hand is to
-grasp a lock of the mane, before placing the right hand upon the cantle
-of the saddle, or horse's back if not saddled. The Prince was too
-well-drilled a cavalier to think of mounting by grasping either the
-saddle-flap, holster, or stirrup-leather, either of which would tend to
-turn a loosely-girthed saddle round under the horse. If the witnesses
-had sufficient time to minutely describe the details of the Prince's
-desperate struggle, they undoubtedly had equal time and opportunity to
-have drawn rein and assisted him to mount. From all that can be gleaned
-of a reliable nature, it would appear that the one exception of devotion
-and courage displayed in this otherwise disgraceful affair was exhibited
-by the friendly Zulu who was with the party. He it was who first
-discovered the proximity of the enemy, and who, not being mounted, might
-have had some excuse for trying to save his life by timely flight. But
-he stayed loyally and gallantly with his white comrades, and came back
-with quiet and deliberate consideration to give warning of the concealed
-Zulus. Even then it would appear that he did not attempt to fly, but
-fought with his breast to the foe until overcome by numbers. This poor
-fellow's body was afterwards discovered not far from that of the Prince,
-riddled with wounds, and in a pool of his own and the enemy's blood,
-together with a number of his own assegais broken, but reeking with the
-gore of his assailants. Doubtless, the first and real great error was
-committed by the Prince and his party advancing without the Basutos
-detailed to accompany them. Had these native scouts, whose powers of
-observation and eyesight so far exceed those of any white man, that no
-reconnaissance was considered complete without them, paraded as they had
-been ordered to, it is beyond question that they would have detected
-the vicinity of the concealed Zulus, and a fearful tragedy would have
-been averted.
-
-The sad news thrilled the whole camp. In every tent, and amongst each
-group of old and young soldiers around the bivouac fires, the tidings
-were discussed during the whole of the evening, and late into the night.
-General Newdigate was applied to by General Marshall for permission to
-take out a cavalry patrol, during the night, to recover the body of the
-ill-fated Prince, but the former thought it would be more prudent to
-wait for the daylight. At four a.m., however, two squadrons were paraded
-in front of the camp, and, under General Marshall's command, proceeded
-in the direction of the plateau three miles above the junction of the
-Tombolaka and Ityolyozi rivers--about equidistant between the cavalry
-camp at the Incetu Neck and that of Wood at the Munhla hill, and some
-twelve miles from either. About eight miles from Incetu the horsemen
-came to a bend of the river, and after crossing the spruit, which in the
-rainy season helps to fill the Ityolyozi, they came to the base of one
-of those flat-topped hills which are so common in this country. With
-some considerable difficulty they ascended to the summit of this kop,
-from which was obtained a splendid view of the river below as it wound
-along the valley, and at the further end fell over a ledge of rock by a
-directly perpendicular descent of 150 feet high and fifty feet wide.
-Here the water whirled down into the abyss beneath, and seemed to be
-carried off in a serpentine form through a deep channel between great
-red scarped rocks. In the ascent to the kop several small but
-well-built Zulu kraals were passed, and it was noticed that the huts
-were very neatly built. The wickerwork was made of wattles, light and
-straight, and bent over at regular distances. The kraals were well
-plastered and very neatly thatched, while the doors were made rather
-small, with the flooring hard and smooth. At the upper end there was a
-raised ledge running right across the hut, which served as a cupboard
-where all utensils are placed. Firewood was neatly packed inside between
-two grass copes which were fastened against the wall. The furniture was
-scanty and all of native manufacture, and some large clay pots to hold
-native beer were in several of the huts. Looking down over the ground
-dividing the lower ground from the higher range, a fine view broke upon
-the eye in the foreground. Mount Munhla stood well out of the range upon
-the plain like some huge bastion, while behind it endless grassy slopes
-filled up the foreground of the picture. The hill ascended was one of
-the spots selected by the Prince for his sketches, and here it was that
-the party had made their first halt. Here they could be in no danger of
-surprise, and well would it have been if the party had chosen an equally
-safe position to off-saddle on Sunday. There is no doubt that the
-Prince's talent with the pencil and the pen, combined with his
-remarkable proficiency in military surveying, while making his services
-so valuable to the army, contributed in no inconsiderable manner to the
-risks which on several occasions he ran. From this spot, the Prince,
-when he had finished his sketches, pointed out to Lieutenant Carey the
-kraal at which he had been fired at on a previous occasion. From here
-might be seen the Umbazini, about two miles farther on, and the kraal,
-consisting of five huts, where the Prince was killed. Vedettes were now
-ordered to push along the ridges to right and left, and to signal as
-they advanced, while the main body of horsemen, in sections of fours,
-were led by the General down the north-eastern side of the krantz. It
-was an interesting sight to see the long blue and white line of horsemen
-winding like a huge serpent round the sides of the mountain; the
-steel-topped bamboo lances and fluttering pennons glistening bravely in
-the morning sunlight, while the horses' hoofs, noiseless upon the soft
-and elastic veldt, were in harmony with the silence and sad expression
-that were maintained in the ranks. From the General and all the officers
-to the rear-rank files there was a subdued and solemn determination of
-countenance which was far more eloquent in sympathy for their dead
-comrade than any words could speak, while might be seen, at the same
-time, in every eye and on every lip, a stern resolve of retribution
-should opportunity occur. The cry of "English cowards!" so often hurled
-at our men at Ekowe, at Zlobani, at Kambula, Ginghilovo, and, above all,
-on the fatal Sunday, was rankling in the hearts of our men, as they
-longed to find themselves in the presence of a Zulu force. As they rode
-cautiously yet speedily down the slopes of the mountain and came nearer
-and nearer to the place of blood, low whispers and murmurs in subdued
-accents were heard in the ranks, bronzed and bearded faces seemed to
-grow more ironlike and hard, weapons were grasped with a tighter clutch,
-and every eye scanned and searched the horizon for a hidden enemy. No
-trumpet was sounded, but lance signals were employed to tell the
-vedettes to close in upon the column as it advanced nearer to the kraal.
-Now could be seen the long and luxuriant patches of Tambookie grass and
-mealies intermixed which gave shelter to the foe, and whose proximity
-was so strangely and unaccountably ignored by the escort of the Prince.
-
-In front, with General Marshall and two other officers of the 17th
-Lancers, rode Captain Wyatt-Edgell, their eyes fixed on the donga, where
-the massacre--for it is difficult to give it another name--took place.
-Would the lifeless remains of one whose bright spirit was part of a
-widowed and stricken life, whose pure and Christian nature ennobled the
-profession of strife to which his heart was devoted, be left intact by
-the savages or mutilated by the instincts of their brutal superstition?
-Would the young, calm, and somewhat sad eyes so well remembered by each
-be torn or defaced by the vulture, or his still more repugnant rival the
-common aasvogel (gyps fulvus), and would that lithe and graceful form
-which used to lounge at evening into the homely bell-tent and
-interchange camp gossip and pleasant badinage with glad and devoted
-comrades--would all these be gone to human sight and ken? Were they to
-have the mournful and defeated joy of bearing those poor shorn relics
-back even one stage on the way to a broken-hearted mother's hearth; or
-had the wild dog and the eagle feasted upon all that once was the pride
-and the hope of Imperial Gaul? As they neared the horrible pit, for it
-was nothing more, where the boy so well loved by all had given his
-spirit to Him who gave it, they were startled and horror-stricken at the
-sight of some bearded vultures, hawks, falcons, and secretary-birds,
-which mounted on the wing from the long, dank grasses as the advance was
-made; and they shuddered at the thought of the ghoul-like banquet of
-which they might have partaken. But a deep and impassable kloof had to
-be crossed, and although time was of the greatest importance at that
-moment, General Marshall was too good a _sabreur_ to hazard the lives of
-the living without precaution, in order to recover the relics of the
-dead. Consequently, as it was quite possible that the foes might have
-discovered how valued was the life which had been so carelessly
-squandered, and that a large force might be hidden in other and
-neighbouring ambush, the usual simple but most effectual precautions
-were taken while the advance was continued. Vedettes were again thrown
-out, lance in sling and carbine on thigh. Oh! what a moment of pride for
-Drury-Lowe, for Boulderson, for Edgell, for Cooke, or for "Dick" Boyle
-(had he been there to see). Every trooper's eye gleamed with excitement,
-every thigh pressed the horse's flank, and every heart throbbed with
-unspeakable rapture at the thought that a chance might be gained to dash
-as an _enfant perdu_ at the Golgotha where the dead friends should be,
-even though the living enemies were waiting to wrap and twine them in
-their grim embrace. Twelve men were selected to ride to the right, left,
-and front, and report. They had orders to dash at once into the bush
-should a Zulu appear. To run away in the open before these people is not
-only madness, but almost certain death to those whose misfortune it is
-to be left behind; but the merest tyro in North American, South African,
-or, indeed, any bush warfare, must know that once in the bush the
-assailed well armed is more than a match for the antagonist ill armed.
-But a ravine yet intervened between them and the scene of slaughter, and
-they were compelled to make a somewhat wide détour, during the passage
-of which, however, each eye and ear was on the _qui-vive_ to the
-slightest rustle of branch or bough.
-
-A group of officers were riding in front; but one topic could be
-discussed--a sad and yet a cherished and welcome theme. There is that
-peculiar temperament and idiosyncrasy about the soldier, a mixture of
-sentiment, poetry, and practical common sense, which makes up a
-philosophy all its own, and a measure of life and death, which no man
-who holds not his life in the hollow of his palm can pretend to
-comprehend. "_Dépêchez-vous, s'il vous plait, monsieur_," rang in every
-ear, and seemed to be echoed through the eldritch and ghostlike
-solitudes of the greystones and caverns above. The ravens, disturbed at
-their approach, screamed as they passed on, while the monkeys, nestling
-among the luxuriant clusters of imporotla or peopisi,--fruit whose pods,
-three feet long, full of large broad beans, hanging from the branches
-like cucumbers or sausages, gave a singular, a cultivated, and almost
-civilized aspect to the scene,--seemed as wishing to point out the spot
-where the gallant young Prince was slain.
-
-Some Zulus, about one hundred in number, were now seen hiding in bushes
-and caves; but they were quickly dislodged by a party of dismounted
-Lancers under Adjutant Frith, a smart officer and worthy follower in the
-old traditions of his corps. The line then brought its shoulders sharply
-round to the left, and covered the five huts forming the kraal, while
-the officers in front galloped through the tambookie grass and maize,
-and posted vedettes at each angle of the plantation. Taking open order,
-General Marshall now advanced and surrounded the donga, and, dismounting
-himself, with three other officers, descended the slopes of the worn and
-steep shelter that held what once was a bright and gallant spirit.
-
-A small bank of sand, over which the sparse and struggling wild flowers
-were striving to blossom and flourish, gave a pillow to the young
-Prince, whose body divested of all clothing, and stripped bare save for
-a charm or locket round his neck, lay extended, not in writhed
-contortion, but graceful as in slumber. The face was composed and almost
-smiling, and looked up to the sky towards which the pure and unselfish
-spirit had soared. No trace of a violent and bloody death could be seen
-on the fair and unwrinkled brow, where the lines of thought, care, and
-sorrow, were as yet unploughed. The eyes were open, and seemed to gaze
-up with human sympathy, though one was injured by a cruel wound which
-gashed the lid and eyebrow. The body was not mutilated, and save for the
-eighteen assegai wounds in the chest and front, no desecration of the
-clay had been committed. The left arm lay across the chest as if
-striving to shield the heart from some cruel thrust, while the right
-grasped in deathly rigour a tuft of human hair, which showed in
-conclusive evidence that the boy must have had time to close in the last
-death-struggle with one at least of his assailants. Beyond this fact,
-the ground near where the body lay was trampled and tossed, while here
-and there, in the direction towards which the Zulus fled, dark
-congealed clots of blood were still to be seen. Hence the conclusion
-that the generous and high-souled boy, whom all loved so well, had
-preserved, if not his revolver (which probably was left in his holster),
-at least his sword, and that, accomplished swordsman as he was, even in
-his mortal agony he had been able to sell his life dearly, and strike as
-he fell. Hard-hearted and hard-headed troopers, impervious to danger and
-to hardships, bowed their heads in sorrow and shame to their horses'
-manes, while the fierce light of battle which is to be seen when the
-trumpet sounds the "charge" gleamed through the mist of tears, as these
-honest fellows looked upon the remains of him whose gashed body seemed
-to appeal to them. But the sad duty was but half achieved, and, under
-the kind supervision of General Marshall, a soldier's bier was quickly
-improvised of 17th lances, covered with cut rushes and mealies laid
-above, while a horseman's cloak lay like a shroud to cover the whole.
-Tenderly and reverently as soldiers only can lift was the body lifted to
-its carriage, and it was carried in relays by loving and respectful
-hands back over the long and difficult road to the camp, where, on the
-same day, the whole of the division paraded to do honour to the dead.
-When the camp was nearly reached a messenger was sent on, and General
-Newdigate and his staff came out to meet the sad _cortège_, and when
-inside the lines, a gun-carriage was brought, upon which, decently
-wrapped in linen clothes and covered with the Union Jack, the remains
-were tenderly laid, while the funeral service was impressively performed
-by the Rev. Charles Ballard, the Roman Catholic chaplain, Lord
-Chelmsford, who was deeply affected, being the chief mourner. The same
-evening the corpse was enclosed in a rough deal coffin and conveyed by a
-mule waggon to Maritzburg. It was met bare-headed by the
-Lieutenant-Governor, the Colonial Secretary, General Sir John Bissett,
-and General Clifford, while minute-guns were fired from the fort, and
-all the flags were at half-mast. Here again there was an elaborate and
-impressive funeral, the coffin being carried by the representatives of
-every branch of the service, and followed out of the town by the whole
-of the large garrison, the civic authorities, and the Roman Catholic,
-Protestant, and Dissenting clergy. At Durban, where the remains arrived
-on the 10th inst., the body was received by the Mayor and Corporation.
-The streets leading to the Roman Catholic Church were lined by the
-garrison, leaning on their arms, reversed, and a requiem mass was
-celebrated the same day. The following morning the coffin was received
-on board her Majesty's ship "Boadicea," being escorted to the point of
-embarkation by the naval and military authorities, while the sad boom of
-the minute-guns accompanied the procession. The "Boadicea" then sailed
-for Simon's Bay. Arrived there, the relics were transferred to her
-Majesty's ship "Orontes," and so conveyed to England. After
-identification and lying in state at the Woolwich Arsenal, the body was
-conveyed to the Empress's residence at Chiselhurst; there, with all the
-pomp and pageantry of full military honours, it was laid in the tomb in
-the same chapel, where rest the remains of his loved father, Napoleon
-III., Emperor of France. The utmost sympathy was shown for his bereaved
-mother by the whole English nation, from highest to lowest. The Queen in
-person attended the funeral at Chiselhurst, and amongst the pall-bearers
-were the Prince of Wales, the Duke of Cambridge, the Duke of Connaught,
-the Duke of Edinburgh, and Prince Leopold.
-
-A court-martial was held on Lieutenant Carey, on the charge of having
-behaved in an unsoldierlike manner in face of the foe; but the sentence
-was kept secret, awaiting its confirmation by the Commander-in-chief in
-England. Meanwhile Lieutenant Carey was sent home under arrest. On his
-arrival there the proceedings of the court-martial were declared null
-and void on account of some technical irregularity, and he was ordered
-to resume his duties.[1]
-
-[1] It is untrue that he has since received a high staff appointment.
-
-It was generally understood that the sentence was dismissal from the
-service with ignominy, but that it was not confirmed by the special
-desire of the Empress, who made a personal request to the Queen that
-nothing should be done in the matter.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER X.
-
- March of the 2nd column--Kopje Allein--Climate of the
- locality--Sickness among the troops--Evil effects of Cardwell's
- system--Embassy from Zulu chiefs--Cavalry skirmish--Death of
- Adjutant Frith--Difficulties of transport--Reinforcement of
- Wood--Appointment of Sir Garnet Wolseley--Opinion of the troops
- thereon--Alleged inhumanities--The helioscope.
-
-
-Two special orders were issued by Lord Chelmsford's command in regard to
-this most melancholy affair. The first, dated Pietermaritzburg, June 5,
-was signed by General Clifford:--"The Inspector-General of Lines of
-Communication and Base has received from his Excellency the
-Lieut.-General Commanding official confirmation of the calamity which
-has befallen the forces under his command, by the death, on duty in the
-field, of the late gallant young soldier, the Prince Imperial Louis
-Napoleon, who, having, in his military training, been lately associated
-with the British Army, came out to this country to take part in the Zulu
-campaign. The General feels that he is carrying out the wishes of his
-Excellency the Lieut.-General Commanding now in Zululand, by thus
-recording the feelings of deep sorrow and sympathy, experienced by every
-officer and man whose duty keeps him at his post in the colony with the
-loss thus sustained."
-
-The second order was issued by Major Butler to the troops at Durban,
-and expressed the feeling and sympathy of all the columns:--"In
-following the coffin which holds the body of the late Prince Imperial of
-France, and paying to his ashes the final tribute of sorrow and honour,
-the troops of the garrison will remember that he was the last inheritor
-of a mighty name and great military renown; secondly, that he was the
-son of England's firm allies in dangerous days; and, thirdly, that he
-was the sole child of a widowed Empress, now left throneless and
-childless in exile upon English shores, deepening the profound sorrow
-and solemn reverence to those memories. The troops will also remember
-that the Prince Imperial of France fell fighting as a British soldier."
-
-On the 28th of May the second column or division quitted the camp at
-Landsman's Drift, and proceeded to Kopje Allein, which is near the Blood
-river, being about a mile to the north-east of it, at a point as near as
-possible to the junction of that stream with the Buffalo. The position
-of the camp there was all that could be desired, and the character of
-the country was much more favourable than most of the previously
-selected camps, inasmuch as no enemy could approach without being seen
-for several miles. At Kopje Allein there was a further concentration,
-and several reinforcements were received, the consequence being that the
-whole force amounted to 2500 British infantry, 1100 British cavalry, 300
-Artillery, 100 Engineers, 66 Colonial Horse, 1300 Native Infantry, and
-in all, with Military Train and Hospital Staff, making 5700 men. It was
-found impossible, for sanitary reasons, to form one undivided column,
-and much as General Newdigate objected to straggling, the exigencies of
-war compelled him to send his forces off in detachments. The King's
-Dragoon Guards marched on Monday, the 26th, and these were followed by
-Harness's Battery and a large convoy of stores on the following day,
-Tuesday, the 27th. On the Wednesday the headquarter staff took the road,
-accompanied by the 17th Lancers, Le Grice's Field Battery, the
-field-hospital, and the 24th Regiment. They took with them fifteen days'
-supplies, and to accomplish this General Newdigate wisely cut everything
-down to the lowest possible limit, sixteen men being allotted to each
-tent, and one tent only to six officers. Tents were really superfluous;
-for the climate is simply magnificent, and no man out on a shooting
-expedition would dream of carrying about with him such extra luxury as a
-bell-tent. Of course the climate of this portion of Zululand being
-semi-tropical, the usual precautions to be used in tropical lands must
-be used here. The climate and diseases which prevail along the line,
-from the Tugela, by which Crealock was advancing, are thus alluded to by
-Dr. Jones, district surgeon, one of the most experienced authorities
-upon the subject. He says that at a distance of fifteen miles from the
-sea the fever is not more prevalent than in the interior; that the high
-ground is comparatively safe in his district, and that the type of fever
-is mild, the attack lasting usually from five to twenty days. It begins
-about February, and is always at its worst in March, continuing more or
-less till the end of May, and appearing to be more or less influenced by
-the current of the north-east wind, which would, of course, carry the
-miasma of the St. Lucia swamps in this direction. Dr. Dalzell, an
-equally good authority as Dr. Jones, says that the high lands here are
-remarkably healthy. The same holds good of the tract known as Oham's
-country, situated in the valley of the Black Umvolosi river. It is
-evident that the fever of this country has been greatly exaggerated, and
-that it is merely intensified in localities which are within reach of
-the poisonous malaria borne upon the wind. General Newdigate and General
-Crealock both gave orders, that when the troops had to bivouac, they
-were never on any account to pass the night either on a very low or on a
-very wet situation, on account of fever, or on the hill-tops, on account
-of thunderstorms. The position of the Zulu kraals should invariably be
-noted, and a lesson taken from them in regard to choice of camp; while
-the neighbourhood of a river that has been lately flooded should, if
-possible, be always avoided. It is possible that a white man settling
-here for good would sooner or later be attacked by fever, but white men
-do not settle here, while a rapid march through the country appears to
-injure no one. Dysentery and rheumatism troubled the troops but little,
-and cases of sunstroke were rare. Sickness had prevailed certainly to a
-considerable extent in some corps; but it was, as a rule, confined to
-the young soldiers, unseasoned and of weak physique, who had been lately
-sent out from England. The cause of our failures--and there were several
-of a palpable nature--are not to be found in want of generalship, want
-of organization, or want of transport. They were due undoubtedly to the
-sending out of raw, sickly, unseasoned, and untutored boys, who, being
-the sweepings of half the regiments in her Majesty's service, could not
-possibly have any feeling of communion, or traditional sympathy, with
-the corps into which, before a formidable enemy, they found themselves
-pitchforked. Most of the battalions out there had to draw their
-reinforcements not from its reserve battalion or depôt at home, as was
-the case in former years, but from the army at large, and some
-battalions arrived on the shores of Africa so drenched and diluted with
-outsiders, that they had the appearance of a mongrel pack, unused to
-discipline and useless in the field. That the destruction of the
-regimental system by Lord Cardwell has been the original cause of
-several of our reverses, surprises, and humiliations, there can be
-little hesitation in saying. The men at Isandhlwana were not well
-handled, it must be admitted; but it has since leaked out that many of
-them would not rally round their officers, but attempted safety in
-flight. Dozens of the men, sergeants and other non-commissioned
-officers, have since declared they did not even know the names of their
-company officers, or those of their right or left-hand man.
-
-Another instance of the evil effects of Lord Cardwell's system may be
-given. The 91st recruits in past days were the envy of all
-recruiting-sergeants, and so particular was the colonel, backed up by
-the surgeon of the corps, that a young fellow must have had chest,
-constitution, and stamina--qualities unfortunately not now insisted
-upon--before he could pass the sacred portals of the 91st barrack. Few
-regiments, however, have suffered from the present system more than, or
-so much as, this corps. On receiving its orders for Zululand, it could
-not muster 200 men, so denuded was the regiment of rank and file by the
-drafts it had previously given. The consequence was that to make up the
-900 men which was supposed to be its fighting strength, volunteers and
-drafts had to be obtained from half the regiments at home, and the
-facings of the 91st on parade, until the master tailor had put matters a
-little straight, represented almost all the colours of the rainbow,
-while the men, drawn from all parts, neither knew one another nor the
-officers set over them.
-
-Rumours of negotiations for peace, and the granting of an armistice,
-which were being circulated about this time, arose from the following
-facts:--In the middle of May Zulu messengers, of some position, but not
-of the highest rank, had presented themselves to General Crealock, with
-a desire to know what terms would be granted to Cetywayo in case of his
-wishing to come to terms of peace. The General, finding they had no
-authority or commission from the king, sent them away, but believing
-from their statements that they were sincere, and knowing at the same
-time that Setewango, one of the king's most influential indunas, and
-Samapo and Panato, the indunas who commanded against Pearson at Ekowe,
-were in the neighbourhood of Ginghilovo, let Setewango know that he
-would not object to see him. Setewango admitted that he had no
-commission or authority direct from the king, but added, at the same
-time, that many of the chiefs were sick of fighting, as they considered
-the English too strong. General Crealock then said he had no power to
-treat, but that Lord Chelmsford had, and if Cetywayo were first seen by
-Setewango something might be arranged. After this Setewango went to
-Ulundi, and after great difficulty he and the indunas persuaded the
-king to allow them to visit Lord Chelmsford, at whose camp they arrived
-early in June, having first presented themselves to General Wood. Lord
-Chelmsford saw these men three times, when they were distinctly told
-that before any negotiations could be entered into, as an evidence of
-the King's sincerity the whole of the spoil taken at Isandhlwana,
-especially the two captured 7-pounders, must be restored. With these
-guns were to be sent accredited ambassadors and hostages of the highest
-rank. These Zulu messengers seemed much awed and impressed with the
-appearance of the camp, and particularly with Marshall's cavalry, and
-they left on the 6th instant. They had not long departed when much of
-their story was corroborated by Tongabena and Lampunda, two well-known
-friendly Zulu spies, who had just arrived from Ulundi, where they
-assured us there were few warriors, the men having declined to assemble.
-Dabulamanzi, whose death has been so often reported, was still there,
-and a large number of women, children, stores, and cattle. Umbelini was
-really dead, having been three times severely wounded, and was hit
-mortally in the back through the blade-bone as he was escaping on
-horseback.
-
-On June 5th, Marshall had a very exciting little brush with the Zulus
-not far from Wood's camp on the Nondonini river. In this affair poor
-young Frith, a capital soldier, a good adjutant, and a general
-favourite, was unfortunately killed. He was sitting on his horse
-receiving an order from Colonel Drury-Lowe, when a Martini-Henry bullet
-struck him, probably to the heart, as he never spoke. The patrol was
-brought about by information brought into Wood's camp by the ubiquitous
-and indefatigable Buller, who had been out on the previous day and
-discovered the whereabouts of a large Zulu force. The gallant 17th and
-the smart King's Dragoon Guards were delighted to see themselves in
-orders on the afternoon of the 4th, that they were to parade at four
-a.m. under General Marshall, who was also to take with him Shepstone's
-Basutos and Bettington's cavalry. It was not yet sunrise when they
-arrived at Wood's camp on the Nondonini, and then found that Buller,
-anxious to draw first blood, had already started in the night to scour
-the country and report what he could discover of the enemy. After
-partaking of some excellent coffee, a little beltong, and some well-made
-and well-baked bread done in Wood's field-ovens, they were again in the
-saddle, taking a course towards the south-east, till the summit of a
-wild ridge overlooking a deep kloof was reached. In the plain below was
-a pretty little river, and near its bank a number of Kaffir huts all
-blazing, having been fired early by Buller and his men, who could be
-seen slowly retiring before a number of Zulus, who were keeping up a hot
-fire upon them, as well as from both sides of the valley. The order was
-given to advance, and Buller soon came on to meet them, making his
-report that he had been attacked by these Zulus as soon as he attempted
-to fire the kraal. Frith was the only casualty, and the order was then
-given by General Marshall to retire firing by alternate squadrons. As
-the Zulus were posted in clefts and caves of the ridges on either side,
-it was impossible to get at them, and so the troops were brought
-steadily off without further loss.
-
-Lord Chelmsford had intended having a large depôt formed on a portion of
-the Ibabanango range; but owing to one of the principal staff officers
-losing not only his own way, but his head, his lordship was compelled to
-change the _venue_, and form the principal depôt upon the Upoko river,
-not far from the spot where the Prince met his fate. This was called
-Fort Newdigate, and was held by four companies of infantry, and a
-detachment or two of cavalry to keep up communication with a still more
-advanced depôt afterwards formed at Umsenguini, near the source of the
-Upoko, where the main road from Utrecht and the Transvaal forms a
-junction with that leading through Rorke's Drift and Isandhlwana.
-
-How arduous were the duties of the cavalry in convoying large trains of
-supplies from the bases to the front through the enemy's country may be
-surmised, when it is borne in mind that Lord Chelmsford had to feed 7000
-whites, 2000 natives, 350 English draught-horses, 850 saddle-horses,
-2000 colonial horses and mules, and 10,634 oxen. From these figures also
-may be formed an estimate of the work thrown upon the Commissariat.
-
-In previous wars out in South Africa blame has been, and not unjustly,
-thrown upon the Commissariat for the manner in which stores have been
-wasted and frittered away while the troops have been without rations.
-But in this war it would be impossible to cite any such instance of want
-of management, as the troops were invariably well fed and cared for.
-Want of success, therefore, could in no case be attributed to want of
-supply. Great praise is due to Commissary-General Strickland for the
-excellent manner in which all his plans were laid and executed. Another
-instance of good work may be given. On the 4th instant Lord Chelmsford
-had occasion to send a sudden order to Commissary-General Brownrigg for
-the immediate furnishing and delivery of rations equal to six weeks'
-supply for 9000 Europeans, 2500 natives, 1200 English horses, and 3000
-cattle, and all these were sent in by the 10th.
-
-On June 10th Sir Evelyn Wood's column received a valuable addition to
-its force; viz. 450 men of the 80th Regiment, all old and seasoned
-campaigners in South Africa, together with four splendid Gatling guns.
-On the same day a report was made that Zulus had been seen near the
-Inyezani, and on the following morning a patrol was sent out, consisting
-of twenty Mounted Infantry, thirty Mounted Basutos, and fifty Light
-Horse, under the command of Captain Brown, who had with him Lord William
-Beresford, and Captains Cochrane, D'Arcy, and Berry. A reconnaissance
-for fully twenty miles from the camp was made, and the patrol returned
-about six the same evening, having made several sketches and surveys of
-the country, but without seeing any Zulus.
-
-Meanwhile grumblers and incompetent critics had kept so incessantly
-bringing all sorts of reckless charges against Lord Chelmsford, of
-incapacity as a soldier, that the home government thought it wise to
-give way, and accordingly, to please the _vulgus profanum_, recalled Sir
-Garnet Wolseley from Cyprus, and appointed him Governor of South Africa,
-High Commissioner in Natal and the Transvaal, and Commander-in-chief of
-her Majesty's forces in Africa, thus superseding Lord Chelmsford. This
-news reached the troops actively employed against the Zulus about the
-middle of June, and was received with considerable dissatisfaction by
-both officers and men. It seemed to them unfair that their General
-should be superseded just as a final advance was being made, and just as
-he was about to reap the fruits of all his anxiety and labour. He had at
-that time on the way to Ulundi a perfectly-equipped force of 9364
-Imperial Infantry, 3957 Colonial Infantry, 1190 Imperial Cavalry, 1877
-Colonial Cavalry, 775 Artillery, with a proportionate number of guns
-(36), and 385 Royal Engineers. Generals Crealock and Newdigate had
-received full instructions with regard to the concentration and movement
-of this force, and all the organization had been planned and carried out
-under the personal supervision of Lord Chelmsford, who had worked night
-and day to get matters to a state of efficiency. It seemed, therefore,
-rather hard and disheartening that the new General, who had had none of
-the anxiety or the toil, should appear as the _Deus ex machina_ upon the
-scene, and reap all the credit and glory of the campaign.
-
-A great deal of rubbish was talked about the inhumanity of burning down
-kraals, and accusations of shooting down women and children were not
-unfrequently brought against the troops. Now most people in England do
-not know that there are three distinct species of kraals. The king's or
-royal kraals, the military kraals--i.e., the respective barracks or
-official homes of the different corps--and, finally, the tribal and
-domestic kraal, a sort of village of cabins, built together for
-convenience and safety. Now, Lord Chelmsford and all his lieutenants
-were too good soldiers to allow England's honour to be disgraced by
-wanton cruelty or barbarous conduct even in fighting a barbarous enemy.
-Military kraals, being the fortified depôts of the king's troops, their
-mustering rendezvous and rallying-points, were attacked and destroyed
-without compunction, as they represented the arsenals and strongholds of
-the enemy. The king's royal kraals, on the other hand, were the places
-where Cetywayo got together cattle, mealies, and other commissariat
-supplies, wherewith to tempt or reward his warriors. These were
-destroyed as a matter of course, as one would capture a convoy or
-destroy a hostile magazine.
-
-It has been stated on apparently good authority that the destruction of
-a royal or military kraal was considered by the Zulus as scarcely any
-loss, and that the rebuilding of such was a matter of the greatest ease.
-This is a totally erroneous view, as all the kraals belonging to
-Cetywayo and his great chiefs which had been destroyed were most
-formidable as regards defence, and must have taken great time and
-trouble to construct. All these kraals of the kings, princes, and
-principal chiefs are protected with high wooden stockades, pierced here
-and there with low entrances, large enough to admit only one person at a
-time. The isigodhlo, or inner enclosure, where the chief huts are
-situated, is guarded by zigzags of the same description of stockade work
-very strongly put together. There are altogether about forty military
-villages or kraals scattered through the country, of from 400 to 3000
-huts each, in which for a portion of the year the troops are quartered,
-averaging 2000 men in each. There are, however, other military kraals
-not fortified, and used only as barracks. These consist of a dry stake
-and wattle fence, generally oval in form and about five feet high.
-Inside this fence are the huts of the men in single, double, or treble
-rows, according to the size of the kraal, while inside the huts is
-another fence similar to the one outside, and the central space is
-invariably the cattle-pen. The king's kraal at Ulundi (afterwards
-destroyed) was 800 yards in diameter, and had a normal garrison of 5000
-men. The Umhlabatini plains, upon which it was situated, are fifteen by
-twenty miles in extent, and completely shut in by hills studded with
-thick bush. The White Umvolosi runs through this plain, in which were
-also established the other kraals forming the headquarters of regiments.
-These, too, were subsequently destroyed. Here in these kraals the
-principal regiments were wont to assemble annually at the great national
-military festival held in honour of the king, which is now a tradition
-of the past. Some years ago, when Cetywayo was full of ambition in
-regard to his military power, and anxious in every manner to consolidate
-it, he had a new magazine or depôt of arms built at the junction of the
-Black and White Umvolosi rivers. This magazine and kraal is called
-Amanzekanze, and is surrounded by a dense bush. The Amanzekanze kraal
-had, up to this time, held the reputation of being impregnable, and its
-approaches, it was said, were so difficult that they could only be
-forced at immense loss. The name of the kraal, Amanzekanze, translated
-is "Let the enemy come now."
-
-Coming now to the farming and domestic kraals, it may without fear of
-contradiction be asserted, after minute and careful inquiries, that no
-single instance can be adduced in which her Majesty's troops ever
-attacked or molested such unless first attacked and fired upon.
-
-A few words must here be said concerning the helioscope, which on more
-than one occasion played a prominent part in this war.
-
-One of the great features of the occupation of Port Durnford was the
-establishment of mirror-signals from the "kop" at Port Durnford, and at
-the post on the Inyezani down to the mouth of the Umlalasi. The use of
-mirrors as a means of communication had been so fully demonstrated in
-Afghanistan, that it seemed astonishing that army officers at Natal were
-supremely ignorant of, and, indeed, indifferent to, the system. When it
-is remembered that by this simple process it was found possible to flash
-intelligence and words of sympathy and kindness to the half-famished
-garrison at Ekowe, and that by means of this admirable invention, many
-important items of intelligence were from time to time instantaneously
-and surely communicated from one part of the British force to another,
-which through the position of the enemy it was only possible to send by
-messengers, who were compelled to take the most circuitous routes, thus
-causing great delay and sometimes even failing to reach their
-destination at all, the value of this simple yet grand discovery cannot
-be too highly considered.
-
-Its importance in some respects may indeed be declared to be in advance
-of the electric telegraph, for that necessitates apparatus of delicate
-mechanism and a friendly, or at least non-hostile territory, over which
-the messages are sent. A predatory or hostile tribe may at any time
-sever the line of telegraphic wire, and cut all communications between
-neighbouring columns who are anxious to make their whereabouts and
-intentions known; but this cannot be done to the mirror system, where
-with no more apparatus than a small hand-glass telegraphy is established
-which no mortal agency can interrupt. No invention, no discovery can
-surpass in value this mode of silent yet eloquent communication, and
-only the interruption of the sun's beams by clouds or fogs can interfere
-with the transmission by signals, noiselessly, and in a manner almost
-imperceptible to all save the two interlocutors, who may be distant ten,
-twenty, thirty, or even forty miles.
-
-At Gibraltar messages are by this process constantly sent across the
-Straits; and in Australia, Mauritius, Singapore, and even Canada, the
-invention has obtained for its discoverer the greatest reputation and
-_kudos_.
-
-Some four years ago Lieutenant Parrott, of the Volunteer Engineer Corps
-of New South Wales, conducted a series of very successful operations in
-mirror telegraphy, using discs, about six inches in diameter, of
-polished metal covered with glass. At first the distance separating the
-two mirrors was from six to ten miles, but eventually the system was
-tested from the Kumagong mountain, about 2000 feet above the sea level,
-to the lighthouse at the entrance to Port Jackson, 400 feet above sea
-level, a direct distance of nearly forty miles. Now, when we consider
-that the only apparatus required is a small hand-mirror, and that no
-skill beyond the faculty of reflecting the sun's beam in the required
-direction, and of flashing "dots" and "signals" by means of a simple
-turn of the wrist, in the same way as the Morse telegraph is presented
-by flag-signals, are necessary, we must allow the vast importance of
-this discovery to the soldier and the sailor, more especially in savage
-or uncivilized warfare. Of course the whole method is dependent on the
-presence of sunshine, and, fortunately, Natal is seldom without this
-great boon. In South Africa the sun's beams are more constant than in
-almost any other clime, and they may be counted and depended upon during
-the major portion of the dry season. It is not unworthy of notice that a
-system of sun-signalling, not dissimilar to that established between
-Port Durnford and General Crealock's column, has been known and
-practised for some considerable time among the Nez Percés Indians of
-North America. Mr. F. C. Browne, of Sydney, Australia, however, gives a
-still more remarkable method of signalling, and states that successful
-feats have also been accomplished by moonlight for distances of from
-four to six miles. He considers, and doubtless he is correct, that it
-would be quite possible to supplement this sun-and-moon telegraphy on
-very dark nights by an analogous system of alternately obscuring and
-displaying at longer or shorter intervals a powerfully reflected light.
-
-Lately at Portsmouth some highly successful experiments in
-night-signalling have been made by casting the electric and other
-powerful lights upon columns of steam; a method evidently suggested by
-the helioscope and use of reflecting mirrors.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XI.
-
- Advance of 1st column--Description of route--Forts Crealock and
- Chelmsford--Causes of delay--Sickness of troops and its
- origin--Capture of cattle--Proposals for peace by Umsintwanga--His
- interview with Crealock--Surrender of Umguelumgwizi--Advance of 2nd
- division--Details of troops composing it--A fortified kraal--Fort
- built by Wood on the Umlatoosi--Patrol by Buller--Burning of five
- kraals in the Usipexi district--Amhlabatini--Depôt there
- described--Envoys from Cetywayo--Advance to White Umvolosi--Wood's
- camp--Lord Chelmsford's ultimatum to Cetywayo.
-
-
-The actual advance of the 1st division may be said to have commenced on
-the 17th of June, when the gallant bluejackets and Marines (the Naval
-Brigade), one troop of Lonsdale's Horse, and one troop of Royal
-Engineers effected an important though short movement from Fort Pearson,
-the so-called base, to Fort Chelmsford; while the 57th Foot and Barton's
-Contingent pushed on to Fort Crealock. General Crealock, with his
-headquarters, arrived at Fort Crealock on the following day, and on the
-19th reached Fort Chelmsford.
-
-The road at starting from Fort Pearson led up a steep ascent and across
-a table-land, gradually sloping towards the west, with occasional slight
-undulations, until it came to the steep and almost cliff-like descent
-into the valley of the Amatikula. Here frequent outcrops of sandstone
-and quartz were noticeable to the engineers, whose professional
-enthusiasm was excited at seeing before them the materials for building
-a permanent fort in the district. Crystalline pebbles were plentiful,
-and the soil, which was in some places of a reddish hue, was at other
-points a pure white silver sand, both, however, being covered by a
-considerable layer of vegetable mould.
-
-Many beautiful flowers gladdened the eye on the march, amongst which
-were tiger lilies, convolvuli, primulas of a rich deep yellow, and
-another species having the appearance of a foxglove opened back. In the
-valley of the Amatikula were some thorn-bushes of osier-like growth,
-which the natives use for fencing their kraals, and these bore large
-purple bell-shaped flowers. On the coast grow some of a similar nature,
-and a full mile further on were white primulas, large yellow daisies,
-and small red and blue flowers not unlike forget-me-nots. After this
-came some rough marching, excessively trying to the waggons and oxen,
-over very steep hills, through patches of tiger-grass, and across
-ravines forty and fifty feet deep, with almost precipitous sides, at
-each of which it became necessary to unload the more heavily-laden
-waggons and carry the contents up by hand. All the hills were
-exceedingly rocky, being composed mostly of granite, but in some
-instances of nearly pure quartz, thickly clothed, however, with trees
-whenever the inequalities of the ground and surface allowed the soil to
-accumulate. The greater number of these trees were acacias in full
-bloom, their red, white, and yellow blossoms, and those of other
-flowering trees standing out in rich masses of gorgeous and Turneresque
-colour. Late in the afternoon the column arrived at the camping-ground
-near Fort Crealock, where the works were proceeding rapidly towards
-completion, and every preparation was being made to reconnoitre on to
-the Umlalasi. The laager was formed above a rocky pass, having at the
-bottom pools of water in splendid granite basins. Out of these two small
-streams issued, one running west and the other east, and falling
-ultimately into the Umlalasi and the Umlatoosi. The next day a patrol
-was sent out to explore a deserted kraal five miles distant. Barrow,
-with about 100 horsemen, also went out scouting; but after riding a
-couple of miles found the hills so closed in on either side and the path
-so blocked with bamboo cane grass that his men were compelled to
-dismount and lead their horses. The thick growth also shut out most of
-the view of the hills, the prospect of which, however, when a peep was
-obtainable, was delightful. By the side of the path was a torrent bed
-more than twenty feet deep, with nearly perpendicular sides, and over
-this slope went one of Barrow's men, horse and rider rolling over each
-other until the stream below was reached, luckily without causing any
-injury to the trooper--a Dutchman, whom Barrow congratulated by telling
-him he suffered no injury as he fell upon his head. A little hair rubbed
-off a remarkably sun-browned forehead was all the damage done, while the
-horse had only a few scratches. The latter part of the pass, the same
-afternoon, when the march was continued to Chelmsford, was very slippery
-sandstone and quartz; and at one point, where the waggons had to wind
-round in single file, the hills, clothed to their summits with trees,
-rose to some 300 feet in height. These heights were scouted as the
-troops advanced, but nothing but old women and children were seen.
-
-The valleys through which the column passed were very fertile, with
-pleasing alternations of open wood, jungle, grass, and cultivation. The
-torrents, however, from the hills in the rainy season must do great
-injury to the crops of mealies, and several spruits and streams were
-crossed, flowing knee-deep between thickets of bamboo and tall rushes,
-which, when flooded, would have been impassable.
-
-The second brigade was behind encamped on the Inyezani, and included the
-Buffs, Naval Brigade, 88th, and Sandham's battery, and came on to
-Chelmsford as the first brigade marched into camp at Napoleon hill.
-
-The two main causes of the seemingly protracted delay in the advance of
-General Crealock's division were want of transport beasts, among which a
-severe epidemic had broken out, and the large amount of fort-building
-and road-making requisite in and around Port Durnford. Still, the time
-taken up in regard to this new base was by no means wasted, as it
-sufficed to keep a large and well-armed portion of the Zulu army idle in
-this vicinity, and thus gave Lord Chelmsford immense facilities for
-pushing on his men to the left front, whilst General Crealock was able
-to utilise his force towards the coast while waiting for transport to
-move up into the interior.
-
-The sick-list still continued somewhat heavy, a very large proportion of
-officers and men being _hors de combat_. Much of the malaria, the
-medical authorities considered, arose from the effluvia caused by the
-decomposition of the numerous carcases of oxen and horses which lay all
-along the road, and literally tainted and poisoned the air. These
-carcases lay where the convoys had to pass, and the consequence was that
-whenever a detachment had to come or go to or from the fort, some
-portion, often a large percentage, reported themselves ill with fever.
-The remedy seemed easy, but was not so. The men were worked so hard at
-digging and entrenching, that it was impossible to detail fatigue
-parties to bury or remove the carcases, which, therefore, were left to
-breed pestilence in the camp.
-
-On June 22nd General Crealock decided to make another strong
-reconnaissance towards the sea on the following day, and orders were
-given overnight that the entire cavalry force, consisting of two
-squadrons of mounted infantry, the Natal Horse, and the native Basuto
-scouts, should parade at daybreak with the whole of the 91st
-Highlanders. The General's object was to utilise his stay at Fort
-Napoleon by doing as much to open communications with Port Durnford as
-possible, and particularly to effect what improvements could be made in
-the road between the fort and that place.
-
-The only result of this expedition was that the troops accidentally came
-upon a body of 250 Zulus, driving away a large number of oxen; of which,
-after a sharp skirmish, though without the loss of a man, they captured
-192 fine head, as well as numerous women and children, who came to the
-General imploring protection. This was of course assured to them; and as
-they appeared hungry and half starved, biscuits and mealies were served
-out to them upon the ground. On the homeward march to Fort Napoleon they
-were overtaken by two very good-looking young Zulus, fully armed and
-equipped in war panoply. These men stated that they belonged to Cuzame,
-a powerful Zulu chief, who was now on his way with his wives and head
-men to Fort Napoleon to surrender. On arriving at the fort later on in
-the evening, this was found to be the case. After a long interview with
-General Crealock, in which Cuzame gave some valuable information in
-regard to Cetywayo's army then collecting for the defence of the big
-kraals, the chief was ordered by the General to leave his family and
-some of his warriors, and return to his kraal for his arms and cattle.
-This he expressed himself most willing and anxious to do.
-
-It was now discovered that it was an error to suppose that the Zulus
-were a united nation, all regarding Cetywayo as their supreme autocrat
-and head. On the contrary, there were other chieftains with objects and
-ambitions of their own. Thus, a chief named Umsintwanga (or the "Old
-Fox") came in on the morning of June 26th, with the usual ivory tusk and
-proposals for peace. He and his party were seen at daybreak about two or
-three miles from the camp trying to ford a small stream, tributary to
-the Umlalazi. The vedettes could not quite make out their proceedings,
-as, when halfway across the stream, they turned back, ascended a
-neighbouring kop, and spent a considerable time in reconnoitring the
-position of the fort. This naturally excited the suspicions of the
-patrol, to whom the mounted vedettes reported, and a small mounted body
-of men was sent to make a circuit and cut them off in case they
-attempted to retire. Whether this movement was observed is uncertain,
-but eventually, after considerable delay, and after approaching the
-camp from several different points, the chief and his attendants, four
-in number only, came boldly up to the patrol, and requested to be
-brought into camp, to the presence of the great chief. At eight o'clock,
-Umsintwanga, who is a rather finely built, elderly man, inclined to be
-corpulent, was brought into the presence of General Crealock, who
-treated him with the greatest courtesy and respect. The countenance of
-the chief showed a curious mixture of dogged determination, savage
-cunning, and treachery. His hair was frizzed, and plastered elaborately
-with red clay and grease, while he wore a belt with some foxtails round
-his waist, and a species of garters of smaller tails tied below the
-knee. His mantle seemed to be an old and much-stained horse-blanket, and
-above this was a small tippet of leopard-skin, worn something like a
-herald's tabard. He carried no weapon save a stout knobkerrie, and his
-attendants, who were four splendidly stalwart Zulus, carried the tusk
-with the greatest ease and dignity. Care had been taken that the place
-of conference should be out of sight of the fort, and for this purpose
-the base of a small hollow near the camp had been chosen, where the
-rising ground intervened and prevented any observation of what was going
-on in the trenches and about the lines. The conference was not of long
-duration, for after waiting a reasonable time to allow the chief time to
-collect himself, the general at once and shortly asked what was the
-meaning and purport of his mission, and why he had come into camp. To
-this Umsintwanga, through an interpreter, replied that he was sent by
-the king and his indunas to sue for peace, and in proof of their
-overtures being sincere he desired to present the immemorial symbol of
-peace and friendship, the ivory tusk. He said further, that he was
-deputed to ask the stoppage of the 1st Division, the proceedings of
-which had much grieved and astonished the king, and he, therefore, was
-desired to ask that it should advance no further towards the king's
-kraal, while he, the ambassador, might be allowed to go through our
-division to Natal. Umsintwanga spoke tolerably well, and seemed not to
-have learnt his speech off by heart, as he occasionally hesitated,
-stopped, and now and then exchanged words and phrases for others which
-he thought more suitable. General Crealock, who listened with the utmost
-deference and patience to the somewhat long tirade, then rather abruptly
-said, "Am I to understand you distinctly, and without any reservation,
-that you, Umsintwanga, induna, come direct and with full authority from
-the king?" This query seemed to astonish and somewhat confuse the
-ambassador, who, after some little circumlocution, admitted that he had
-come, if not quite with the king's authority, at least with his
-knowledge and sanction. On being pressed a little more, the old chief
-further admitted that it was principally by the desire of the indunas,
-more than by that of the king, that he had come, and he still most
-positively adhered to the statement that his proposals were official and
-in good faith. Umsintwanga was then informed that he had not come to the
-proper camp with his proposals, that it was to Lord Chelmsford, and no
-other, that he must apply, and that even if he went to Lord Chelmsford
-he would not be listened to unless the demands specified in his
-lordship's ultimatum were complied with to the letter. The whole of the
-interview did not occupy more than a quarter of an hour or twenty
-minutes; and when it was over, it would have been quite impossible to
-have told, from the imperturbable countenances of the induna and his
-suite, whether they were disappointed or not. They seemed to take their
-rebuff as if they expected it, and were then conducted by a circuitous
-route away from our camp, and left, with the tusk, two miles upon their
-road.
-
-It must here be remarked that Lord Chelmsford had throughout the
-campaign shown the greatest suavity and patience to any attempt at
-peaceful proposals, but he had by this time seen the necessity of a
-certain degree of firmness, and General Crealock, although he doubtless
-would have given a similar answer had he not been instructed, had a
-complete understanding with the Commander-in-chief that no proposals
-were to be listened to unless accompanied with the fulfilment of the
-conditions laid down in the chief's message to the last messengers.
-Brigadiers Bray and Rowlands, together with the whole of the General's
-staff, were present at the interview, and the induna and his attendants,
-although unwilling to manifest any surprise, were evidently impressed
-with the quietude and promptitude with which every wish and order of the
-General were carried out. Again on June 21st, General Crealock, then
-engaged in completing the fortifications at Napoleon hill, rode out
-across the Umlalazi river with a small staff and escort, to interview a
-chief named Umguelumgwizi, who had just made friendly overtures and
-expressed a wish to consult the General as to what his future line of
-conduct should be. Umguelumgwizi's kraal was some miles off, but the
-chief said he would come and meet the General; and not more than two
-miles in his direction had been traversed when he was seen coming,
-accompanied by several of his sons and head men. The Zulu chief was
-known to be rich in cattle, and possessed of considerable local
-influence. He was a man apparently about fifty-two or fifty-three years
-of age, and, in spite of a somewhat sinister expression, had a tolerably
-open and apparently honest manner of speaking. He was not by any means
-long in coming to the point, declaring emphatically that he had no
-quarrel with the English, or, for the matter of that, he added, with the
-Dutch. He had heard of and understood the award given by the English
-Commissioners in regard to the Dutch boundary, and he thought "Sompsen"
-and "Bartle" had behaved most generously to Cetywayo. He had been
-obliged to go out to fight on Cetywayo's side, but neither he nor his
-young men wished to go out again. If he refused, he would be accused of
-witchcraft, "smelt out" and "eaten out." What was he under these
-circumstances to do? General Crealock, who had listened very patiently
-to this somewhat long harangue, said he had spoken honestly and well,
-that as a soldier he did not wish to advise any man to desert his king
-or his chief, but that he could not be doing wrong in refusing to fight
-in what he considered an unjust cause. If he chose to come in and
-surrender, with his arms, his cattle, his wives, children, and his
-tribe, all should be protected, and all should be held for him in trust
-till peace was made. The chief, who seemed much pleased with General
-Crealock's kind and manly advice, consulted a few moments with those of
-his advisers who were with him, and then asked the General to give him
-one day for consideration. "Willingly, my friends," said Crealock, "and
-I will meet you on this side of the river to-morrow, when you can tell
-me your decision." Upon the Monday (June 22nd), therefore, directly
-after the General had made his usual tour of inspection among the road
-fatigues, he crossed over, this time with a couple of troops of Barrow's
-men, and met Umguelumgwizi with an immense following, consisting of his
-wives and children. The General, however, explained to the chief that he
-could only accept this surrender in part, and that it would not be
-complete until all his cattle and all his fighting men came in. This the
-chief promised to attend to.
-
-On the 25th the 1st Brigade, under General Rowlands, crossed and moved
-down the river, encamping about six miles from here. The day following
-this brigade moved on to Port Durnford, and reinforced the small force
-there. On the 27th Clarke's Brigade started from this place, and moved
-on to support Rowlands', encamping and laagering up two hills in sight
-of the 1st Brigade. From this encampment a splendid view of Fort
-Durnford can be obtained.
-
-The long ranges of mountains, which completely separate the coast-line
-from the interior, here stand out in magnificent relief, and although
-they are at a distance of fifty to seventy miles, they present a sharply
-defined outline in the morning air, their ravines, watercourses, and
-terraced heights appearing with almost supernatural distinctness. Here
-is a country where the light is rich and brilliant, where the atmosphere
-is surpassingly bright and clear, and the scenery bold, spacious, and
-grand. The characteristic beauty of light in South Africa is not seen
-in its blending with manifold forms of cloud so much as in the full and
-even splendour with which it penetrates the air. Distant objects, that
-in a less brilliant atmosphere fade away in hazy outline, stand out with
-perfect distinctness. Let a spectator place himself at a distance of
-twenty or thirty miles from the Drakenberg, or any of the big ranges of
-this country, and contrast the effect he will obtain with that he would
-experience with Snowdon, Mangerton, or any of our home mountains at a
-similar distance. Small boulders, cavernous hollows in the rocks,
-patches of bush at the head of the kloofs, at an elevation of 2000 or
-3000 feet, are seen with the naked eye without difficulty. A northern
-mountain at home, at either of these elevations, will appear in more or
-less of hazy outline with all details of face and profile obscured, but
-here in the clear atmosphere of Zululand, the very direction of the
-watercourses, the curves of the kloofs, and, indeed, every bold wrinkle
-on the face of the slopes of the mountains can be most clearly
-discerned.
-
-We must now leave Crealock building his forts and making his roads,
-while we turn our attention to the movements of Newdigate and Wood.
-
-Every facility had been given to Crealock's (1st) Division to make the
-first forward movement on the king's kraal. Lord Chelmsford considering
-that after the difficulties General Crealock had encountered it would be
-only fair to him and to those under his command to give him every chance
-of winning first blood in the final attack. However, the coast sickness
-proved so fatal to Crealock's transport train that he was utterly unable
-to take advantage of Lord Chelmsford's generosity, and it was to the
-2nd column that the final honours of Ulundi fell. On Saturday, the 21st
-inst., General Newdigate with this column reached the right bank of the
-Umlatoosi, while Evelyn Wood, with his strong flying column, had
-slightly preceded him, and had encamped a little lower down on the left
-bank. Newdigate's brigadiers were Glynn and Collingwood, with Marshall
-in command of the cavalry; and his corps were two batteries of artillery
-and an ammunition column, the 2nd company of Engineers, the King's
-Dragoon Guards and 17th Lancers, the 21st, the 1-24th, 58th, and 94th
-Regiments, Shepstone's Horse, No. 3 Troop, and the Mounted Natives. This
-force made up 1870 Europeans, 530 Natives, and eight guns. Wood's field
-state of this date gave the Gatling Battery, the Engineers, the 13th,
-90th, and a wing of the 80th Regiment, with Buller's Cavalry, consisting
-of the Mounted Infantry, Frontier Light Horse, Transvaal Rangers, and
-Wood's Irregulars, making a force of 2192 Europeans, and 573 Natives,
-four guns and two Gatlings. These two columns, therefore, gave Lord
-Chelmsford a compact and admirably-welded and homogeneous body of 4062
-Europeans, 1103 Natives, 12 guns, and two Gatlings, and with this force
-he justly considered that he held Ulundi in the hollow of his hand.
-
-On the day following (the 22nd), while Newdigate, whose oxen much
-required it, gave the division a holiday in camp, Wood pushed on about
-four miles, taking care to note every bush, rock, stream, and salient
-point _en route_. The march was through a mixture of jungle, long grass,
-and occasional outcrops of granite, mixed with unpleasant-looking
-boulders of grey sandstone, but which would have been well appreciated
-by an engineer for the construction of a permanent work of defence. Ten
-small streams were passed, besides tributaries of the Umvolosi, and many
-tracks of buffalo and elephant were seen, while some of Wood's
-enthusiastic sportsmen were positive they could at times hear the
-well-known trumpet of the latter in the jungle. The road then led along
-a narrow valley, flanked by rocky hills on either side. On the banks of
-the stream which flowed in this spot some deserted kraals were seen,
-with broken utensils, stone fireplaces, and small pits where mealies
-were stored and still left. The huts which composed these kraals were
-not built in the same way as others they had seen, but seemed
-constructed with more skill and an eye to greater comfort. First of all
-were stout posts planted in the ground, and the interstices filled up
-with clay. The roof, instead of being of the general umbrella shape, was
-flat, and with a slight slope to the front; and the rafters were covered
-either with sheets of bark or with bushes and grass, over which was
-spread a thick coating of earth. Sweet potatoes, cut in slices, pumpkins
-and gourds, and other vegetables of a succulent nature, were laid on
-some of the roofs to dry for the winter's provision. The interior of
-these huts had, instead of one, as is usual in Zululand, two, and
-sometimes three divisions. The first contained a small raised space for
-a bed-place, covered with hides, and here was the almost universal
-African fireplace, consisting of the three cones of clay, which in many
-instances are hollow, and form a most ingenious oven. The only cooking
-utensils were earthen pots, nearly everything in this part of South
-Africa being prepared for eating by boiling. In the next division lambs
-and goats were kept, and the innermost one was used as a granary, where
-corn is stored in "lindo," band-boxes made of bark, with the lids
-carefully luted on with clay. These lindo are sometimes of enormous
-size, and are sufficiently large to contain a dozen or more sacks. Light
-is admitted only through the one door, which also provides the sole
-means for the escape of smoke, and as a consequence the rafters and
-walls are black and shiny, and the cobwebs with which they are festooned
-are loaded with soot. Among the rafters walking-staves, and knobkerries,
-assegais, and other primitive weapons of war, are usually stored, so as
-to get them good and due seasoning by the smoke. The largest of the
-villages was clean and surprisingly well-built, said to be after a model
-one made by the late King Panda. It was surrounded by a stockade, in
-addition to the outer walls of houses, and the part where the chief had
-evidently lived was divided off from the rest of the village, and was
-also the gateway. The gates were heavy slabs of wood, hewn out of the
-solid trunk, and those wanting to enter could only go up to the
-principal gate one at a time, as a wing of palisading projected on
-either side in the form of a long U, with holes to use assegais through,
-so that it would be no pleasant attempt to try to force an entrance
-against the will of the dwellers therein. There were some other smaller
-doorways in the outer walls of the house, forming part of what might be
-termed the _enceinte_, which closed in a sort of portcullis fashion. A
-number of heavy logs had holes in their upper ends, and the wall plate
-was rove through them. When the doorway is open, these logs are triced
-up inwards and out of the way, and when closed the outer sides of the
-lower ends butt, as it were, against a strong fixed log, and are secured
-by a strong movable log inside.
-
-On the 23rd, Brigadier-General Wood halted, still on the left bank of
-the Umlatoosi, for the purpose of building a fort, which was to be held
-by two companies of the 58th, two of Harness's field-guns, and some
-irregular cavalry. The outlines and profiles were soon traced by
-experienced though not professional engineers, and on the evening of the
-same day the place was securely defensible.
-
-The spot chosen by Wood to build the fort is on the Umlatoosi, and in a
-position naturally of great strength, for the river there makes a rapid
-bend and affords a ready means of both banks being swept and commanded
-from the work. A rude and most insecure bridge, formed of a couple of
-huge trees, already existed, but this was now under water, while the
-strength of the current was so great when the survey was being made that
-several of Wood's men were washed off, and only saved themselves by
-catching at bushes on the bank. In the centre of the stream there is an
-island, and upon this an outwork was constructed. This island is
-situated amongst numerous rapids and cascades, breaking out from the
-rocky hillside. The difficulties of getting across seemed at first sight
-almost insuperable, but after a time it was discovered that there were
-places where it was possible to jump from rock to rock, and then to wade
-through the rapids themselves on narrow shelves, holding meanwhile "like
-grim death" by ropes of creepers, stretched from side to side for that
-purpose. It will be, of course, understood that a single false step, or
-the snapping of the creeper-rope, at these points would be fatal, for
-nothing could save the traveller in that case from being dashed to
-pieces amongst the rocks beneath. The stream below this was about fifty
-yards wide, very deep, and running like a sluice. Happily a passage was
-effected without any casualty. Looking back from the other side a most
-striking sight is presented by this mass of water bursting out of the
-precipitous hillside, and broken by the rocks and little bushy islands
-into foaming cascades. Many small streams are passed, which occasionally
-flow for some considerable distance in subterranean channels. They work
-in amongst loose stones, covered with soil and vegetation, the
-underground portions of their course being sometimes not more than forty
-yards of their length, while in other instances they seem to have
-disappeared altogether, and no doubt help to supply those mysterious
-fresh springs which are known to exist even on the beach at Port
-Durnford.
-
-The eastern portion of the Umlatoosi district, and that leading to the
-sea is moderately level, with rocky hills, on the summits of which are
-situated the villages of the chiefs; but as the western portion is
-reached, the country breaks into mountains of every shape and form,
-amongst which the more numerous are needles and cones of granite. In the
-foreground the hills are of red sandstone, crowned with groves of
-magnificent trees, festooned with jasmine and other sweet-scented
-creepers. Many of the rivers appear to have been crossed in former days
-by bridges, constructed either by the Zulus or by the missionaries, or
-possibly by both. Poles were planted in the bed of the stream, and upon
-others lashed at the top smaller poles and branches were laid to form
-the footway. When first constructed these were doubtless secured to the
-cross-pieces by lashings, but by this time they had rotted away, and
-consequently afforded but a very precarious foothold.
-
-Between the 24th and the 26th both columns--that is to say, the
-headquarters and Wood's--advanced but six miles, but Buller was not more
-idle than Wood, as, while the latter was building a fort to hold a
-couple of hundred men in the heart almost of a formidable enemy's
-country, the former had patrolled in almost every direction to the
-front, rear, and both flanks. On the 25th Buller and his "merry men"
-were in the saddle and away more than nine miles to the front, and by
-noon there came an orderly, "bloody with sparring, fiery red with
-haste," who brought news that "Redvers," with his usual good fortune,
-had pounced upon about seventy or eighty Zulus busily engaged in
-grass-burning, to bother the advance in regard to grass for the horses
-and oxen. Buller made extremely short work of these fellows, whose
-surprise was so complete that the whole lot might have been annihilated
-if humanitarian principles had not interposed. As soon as the grass was
-effectually saved, Buller proceeded on a few miles, and, although
-watched here and there, suffered not the slightest molestation. The same
-evening (25th) Buller came back from his own camp to the headquarter
-camp with full information in regard to the five kraals that had been
-observed on the 24th in the district of Usipexi, which he reported were
-guarded by a tolerably formidable Zulu impi. A small and select council
-of war was at once held in General Newdigate's tent, under the
-presidency of the Commander-in-chief. After a very short conference, in
-which Lord Chelmsford, Generals Newdigate and Marshall, and Colonels
-Drury-Lowe and Buller were the principal speakers, it was finally
-decided that an attack in force should be made upon the five kraals, and
-any others that could be discovered at an early hour on the following
-day. At daybreak accordingly the force was drawn up in line for Lord
-Chelmsford's inspection, which, as was usual with him, was, though
-rapid, most carefully minute. On the right were two guns and fifty men
-of Le Grice's admirable battery, and next came two of Drury-Lowe's
-splendid blue-and-white squadrons. These fellows would have won the
-heart of any light cavalry colonel or adjutant, and it seemed almost a
-pity that such glittering panoply of crest and spear and plume should
-have to abide the thrust of a hidden assegai from behind a rock or bush.
-Four hundred and fifty of Buller's best men, though not so smart nor so
-well mounted as Drury-Lowe's gallant fellows, were not despised or
-looked down upon by those who were present, and the more brilliantly
-decked trooper, with his uniform and glittering _apanage_, felt proud to
-ride with the men who had fought so well at Zlobani and conquered so
-grandly at Kambula. Two companies of natives made up the force, which
-perhaps was the largest patrol ever furnished in this war for such a
-duty as the burning of kraals. The guns and part of the cavalry were
-sent by a circuitous path which led to an eminence near the largest
-kraal, and part of Buller's Horse bearing a little to the right, the
-main body advanced along the road by which Buller had yesterday
-returned. They first came to the large kraals of Udugwoosu and of
-Udlumbedlu, which were found deserted, and shelled and burnt without
-opposition; and when this was effected, the cavalry and natives
-descended into the plains, to Uxixipi, which was also destroyed, after
-shelling out about a thousand natives, who were at once pursued by the
-Basutos and Frontier Light Horse. Not many Zulus were killed, as some
-were old men and boys, and strict orders had been given to spare these.
-
-On the 27th the flying column, under Wood, advanced nine miles on the
-road to Ulundi; while the main division, under Newdigate, with
-Brigadiers Glynn and Collingwood, and Marshall in command of the
-cavalry, moved on eleven miles, both columns encamping at a place called
-Amhlabatini, within a mile of each other. They carried no tents, but
-took with them 200 ammunition-waggons, and ten days' full rations, which
-on emergency could have been spun out to double that number. Soon after
-the halt all the brigadiers were assembled by Lord Chelmsford, who
-briefly but succinctly expounded to them his intentions and future
-action. His lordship said the time had now arrived for a final blow to
-be dealt, and he purposed, having first established a base of operations
-by constructing a small depôt laager at Amhlabatini, pushing on at once
-to the attack of Ulundi. Buller would clear the front and mask the
-columns as they advanced, and would do all he could to provoke and
-entice the enemy to attack in the open. The question now was what
-details were to be left at the laager as a garrison, and it was decided
-that these should be furnished by three companies of the 1-24th
-Regiment, and some other contingents, making up 500 men. Soldiers, as a
-rule, must accept all commands without question; but although no open
-word is spoken, there are times when the bitterness of disappointment
-will show itself without speaking. Such was the case when the order-book
-proclaimed the duty detailed for the 24th.
-
-The entrenched laager was most artistically made in an incredibly short
-space of time. Within a radius of 500 yards all trees and bush were cut
-down and cleared away. In the centre a rectangle of waggons was formed,
-with earth thrown up above the axletrees, and at 15 yards' distance from
-these a trench and an embankment three feet high were constructed.
-Again, about 100 yards beyond this, strong and well made abattis were
-placed. These consisted of whole trees and stout branches 12 and 15 feet
-long, felled and placed side by side, with their butts inwards and
-boughs interlaced, while the twigs and small leaves were stripped off
-and the boughs sharply pointed. The butts were strongly picketed down,
-and in some cases fastened by logs laid across several butts. These
-abattis were fully five feet in height, and as green wood--not easy to
-burn--was selected, they made a formidable obstacle. It took 200 men
-only eight hours to construct 200 yards of abattis, and this,
-considering that many of them had never done such work before, was most
-creditable. All the officers were in the highest possible spirits, and
-no inconsiderable amount of banter was carried on between the two
-columns during the visits paid from one to the other. One of the most
-fertile subjects for "chaff" was the increasing weight and sleekness of
-Buller's men as compared with the visibly apparent attenuation of their
-horses, and the joke was to affect to believe that these "African
-Cossacks," as they were called, devoured all the oxen they captured,
-while making their horse-rations into oatmeal cakes for themselves! This
-story, if _ben trovato_, was singularly devoid of fact, for Buller's
-horses presented a most favourable contrast to those of Marshall, as the
-former would eat almost anything, and the latter were only just
-commencing to put up with mealies. The constant work of the former
-animals had naturally kept them devoid of superfluous flesh, but, for
-all this, they were as hard as "nails" and good in their wind.
-
-On the afternoon of the 27th, vedettes signalled the approach of some
-natives, accompanied by a large number of cattle. These proved to be
-further messengers from Cetywayo, bringing 150 of our oxen captured at
-Isandhlwana, together with a pair of elephants' tusks and a letter,
-written in English by a captive dealer. The letter was fairly expressed,
-and said that the king could not comply with all Lord Chelmsford's
-demands, as the arms taken from us at Isandhlwana were not brought to
-him, and that it was beyond his power as a king to order or compel any
-of his regiments to lay down their arms. The letter also said that
-Harness's guns should be sent, and on receipt of the cattle and these
-weapons the English must retire from Zulu territory. Whoever had
-written the letter must have been a bold and plucky fellow, as he had
-added in a corner in pencil a few words of warning, and an intimation
-that Cetywayo had with him at Ulundi and the neighbouring kraals a large
-and picked impi, amounting to 20,000 men. Even without this message Lord
-Chelmsford would have considered these overtures as suspicious; but, as
-it was, increased precaution against surprise or treachery was taken.
-Lord Chelmsford accordingly declined the tusks, and told the messengers
-in the plainest language that, before he thought of retiring, all the
-original conditions must be complied with, more especially as regards
-the formal laying down of arms by the regiment. The messengers were then
-escorted from our column, and later in the day several large bodies of
-Zulus, amounting to some thousands, were noticed moving in a lateral
-direction from the side of Ulundi, and passing along by the left flank.
-The following day was a busy one for all. Lord Chelmsford was so anxious
-to complete the main details of the depôt laager that he deferred his
-march till sundown. Wood, however, moved on in the morning as far as the
-left bank of the White Umvolosi, where he bivouacked and waited for the
-main body. After waiting until all the more prominent and essential
-matters were completed in regard to the garrison left in the depôt, Lord
-Chelmsford ordered the parade for 5.30 in the evening, and they then
-marched on to the next bivouac in a compact and well-organized column.
-It was still daylight when the White Umvolosi was reached, and they saw
-across the river, on the left bank, the flying column and the Lancers
-already bivouacked. The scene as on the right bank of the river was
-most picturesque. On the left bank of the Umvolosi Wood had admirably
-chosen the ground for his bivouac. Here was a firm, wide plateau,
-bounded on the east and north by a hilly country, broken up by knolls
-and tall cone-like eminences, whose slopes here and there were covered
-by patches of dense jungle or bordered by young forests, whose shades
-seemed to invite shelter during the fierce heat of the day. Away in the
-extreme distance the landscape differed materially in aspect from the
-country near. Mountains of loftier altitude, rising peak upon peak, tier
-upon tier, and range upon range, met the eye everywhere. Green trees
-covered their slopes in apparently endless expanse of vegetation.
-Immediately behind the Lancer camp, and sheltering it from the night
-breezes that swept across the plain, was a massive buttress of rock
-covered with richly and delicately-hued velvety mosses, while down the
-hard, steep, rocky beds of granite and sandstone, with here and there
-basalt and porphyry, flint and quartz, foamed sparkling little streams,
-which always seem so refreshing and so tempting on a South African
-march. A deep gaping fissure in a high jutting wall of rock, through
-which bubbled the clear water in volumes; a great towering rock with
-perpendicular walls, to which clung, in spite of apparent impossibility,
-ferns and plants and moss, thick and velvety; and a huge conical hill
-which ambitiously hid its head in the clouds; these were wild and rugged
-forms of nature to be treasured up long after their marching days were
-gone and past. The camp was situated on a wide terrace or shelf of
-ground rising above a body of water, which more resembled a long narrow
-lake than a river. This part of the White Umvolosi, indeed, like many
-other African rivers, loses its current in the dry season, and becomes a
-series of long narrow pools, which in some places may be compared to
-lakes for their length, according to the nature of the ground in which
-depressions are found. If the ground is rocky or of clayey mud the water
-is retained, instead of being absorbed, and here swarm multitudes of
-silurus, or bearded mud-fish. Wherever mud-fish are abundant,
-crocodiles, the great fish-eating reptiles of the African waters, are
-sure to be found, and, singularly enough, wherever crocodiles are found
-one is almost sure to find the hippopotamus--not because crocodiles and
-hippopotami have any affinity for each other, but because the soil which
-retains the water during the hot days of the drought season is almost
-sure to produce in the vicinity of the pools abundance of rich grass and
-tall cane, the favourite food of the hippopotamus. Two miles further in
-the plain Wood's bivouac fires were seen in glittering and regular
-ranks, marking out the exact ground which each regiment or corps would
-occupy in order of parade or march. Far away, but in a line with each
-angle of the bivouac, were the outlying pickets; while, again, beyond
-these were those vigilant and unsleeping patrols which made this column
-so secure and impossible to surprise.
-
-At daybreak on the 29th the main body crossed the river and joined the
-flying column on the left bank. They now were but fifteen miles from
-Ulundi, and all the king's kraals were visible to the naked eye. On the
-far slope of the hills that bound the plain were the two round kraals,
-Likasi and Undabakawazi; next, and built in the shape of a crescent,
-were Unodwengo, Panda's old palace, Ulundi, built by the present king,
-while farthest of all was another, making five, called Umpanibougwena.
-
-On the 30th Lord Chelmsford was ten miles from the Umvolosi; and he sent
-a despatch to Sir Garnet Wolseley, to say that the king's messengers had
-just left with an ultimatum for Cetywayo, to the effect that his
-lordship must advance to a position on the left bank of the river on the
-1st July, but that if no opposition were offered the troops would wait
-there without any hostile movement until twelve at noon on the 3rd,
-when, if the original terms sent to Cetywayo, namely, the delivery of
-the guns taken at Isandhlwana, and the cattle, were complied with, 1000
-captured rifles would be received instead of a regiment laying down its
-arms, and peace negotiations would be entertained. On the following
-morning, accordingly, the main body marched at an early hour, and,
-preceded by the flying column and Buller's men scouring the country in
-front and flank, arrived at the river and took up the position named
-above.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XII.
-
- Raid across the Umvolosi by Buller--Gallant rescue of a sergeant by
- Lord William Beresford--Buller's losses--Umvolosi crossed by the
- main body--Formation of troops into square--Total numbers--Firing of
- kraals--Advance of Zulus from Ulundi--The Zulu attack--Repulse of
- Zulus--Pursuit by cavalry--Death of Wyatt-Edgell--Losses of both
- sides--Withdrawal of English army--Effects of the battle of
- Ulundi--Surrender of 700 Zulus to Crealock--Cause of retreat after
- Ulundi--Resignation of Lord Chelmsford--His farewell parade--Epitome
- of work done by 1st column, and why it was not present at
- Ulundi--Ondini burnt by Barrow.
-
-
-On the morning of the 3rd of July, the last day of grace, so far from
-any compliance with Lord Chelmsford's demands being made, all sorts of
-hostile demonstrations were shown by the Zulus, who were gathered in
-large numbers about eight miles off. All day long, on the 1st and 2nd,
-there had been a dropping fire at long ranges upon our men; and on the
-3rd the enemy, growing bolder, pushed his skirmishers down to some rocks
-on the opposite side of the river, and fired upon the men as they were
-watering their horses in the stream. One horse was killed and several
-men wounded, and then it was that Buller asked and obtained permission
-to make a raid into the enemy's country.
-
-Early in the afternoon Buller was waiting impatiently to cross,
-looking, as was said of Picton, "in a heavenly humour, because some one
-was likely to be killed." A couple of guns were brought into position on
-the banks of the river, to cover Buller's crossing, and, if necessary,
-to assist his retreat if hard pressed on his return. A couple or three
-rounds of shrapnel made short work of a crowd of Zulus who had
-approached on the opposite height in a most impudent manner; and hardly
-were the echoes of these heard along the shores before Buller and
-Beresford, dashing into the stream with a cheer that made the rocks
-resound, were followed over the river by Buller's horsemen, the Mounted
-Infantry, and Baker's Horse. A good billiard or racquet player likes a
-gallery, and if the very dashing rifleman and _beau sabreur_ were at all
-anxious for an audience, they certainly had a large one on this
-occasion. In fact the whole camp--if camp you can call a bivouac without
-tents--turned out literally in its shirt-sleeves to see the fun. The
-fatigue parties stopped their wood-cutting to take a look at the two
-camp favourites as they raced like school-boys at a paper hunt after the
-Zulus, who were scuttling away like prize pedestrians to gain the
-shelter of a friendly kraal. Buller being in command, however, was not
-forgetful of his men; and, though galloping at a steeplechase pace, kept
-them well in hand, and raced with about a score of his fellows at the
-military kraal Dalwayo, on our right front. Beresford, however, being a
-sort of chartered libertine, and having no separate command, "went for"
-the Zulus entirely, as he subsequently expressed it, "on his own hook."
-Meanwhile, by Buller's order, Baker's men, guided by their leader, had
-inclined to the left front, to carry and hold a favourable hillock which
-commanded the best part of the ford. This piece of thoughtful strategy
-proved invaluable at the close of the day, when the horsemen had hard
-work to get back. On galloped Buller's men past Nodwengo, Lord William
-well to the front, now sabring a Zulu, now stopping to aid a wounded
-comrade; while Buller, having picked a hundred of his best-mounted men,
-pushed on with the intention of exploring and, if possible, firing
-Ulundi.
-
-There was nothing impossible in this project. Buller had good
-information that the bulk of the king's army was away upon Lord
-Chelmsford's right flank, and that the kraal would possibly have a
-slender guard. It was well, perhaps, that this somewhat hairbrained
-exploit should not be carried out, and it was stopped as follows:--The
-contour of the ground between this point and the king's kraal was formed
-by a succession of undulating (at rather a steep angle) plains, which in
-the hollows gave admirable cover and concealment to the Zulus. These
-large dongas in two places formed positions where bodies of men could be
-massed at right angles, and so take an incautious enemy on the flank.
-Here the Zulu general, whoever he was, had admirably disposed his
-reserves, and here, but for the steady conduct of all hands, Buller
-might have met his fate. As suddenly as the mountain warriors of
-Roderick appeared above the heather to James Fitz-James, did the tall
-Zulu warriors put in an appearance, and from front and flank a very well
-sustained fire was poured in upon the daring Buller and his men. But
-Buller, with all the dash of a Rupert or a Murat, had much of the
-prescience and caution of a veteran, and invariably adopted the
-principle which may be indifferently expressed as "having two strings to
-your bow," or "not having all your eggs in one basket." He had,
-previously to his daring advance in the enemy's country, ordered
-Commandant Raaf to halt near Nodwengo, with his horsemen as reserve and
-supports. At the imminent moment, therefore, when the Zulus appeared in
-the hollows, these gallant fellows came up and saved the day, and it is
-more than probable many valuable lives. As Buller and his splendid
-marksmen retired by alternate ranks, and as each man fired, dropping his
-man, Raaf and his well-trained fellows covered the slow retreat; Baker's
-Horse also held the hillock of which mention has been before made, and
-did excellent service by the manner in which the Zulus were held in
-check. Tremlett's little battery on the right front of the camp kept
-back the enemy on the left line of retreat, so that the raid into the
-enemy's country, although not productive of any palpable advantage as
-regards booty or prisoners, was eminently well carried out as a
-reconnaissance in force. The Zulus were exceedingly well led, and it was
-impossible not to admire their admirable skirmishing, and the
-magnificent manner in which they charged right down to the river's edge,
-amidst a storm of grape and shrapnel hurled against them to cover the
-retreat. Buller, of course, was wherever hard knocks were most to be
-obtained, while Beresford distinguished himself as much by his capital
-horsemanship, daring valour, and perfect coolness, as by the noble
-chivalry with which he galloped, under a heavy hostile fire, to bring
-off, on his tired and overweighted horse, a wounded sergeant of the
-Mounted Infantry.
-
-It happened thus:--Just after the volley had been poured in by the Zulus
-on either flank, Lord William Beresford, who had literally cut his way
-through about fifty Zulus who had tried to surround him, turned in the
-saddle to see how his men were getting on, and saw upon the ground a
-dismounted and wounded trooper about to be assegaied by half-a-dozen
-Zulus. Wheeling his horse round like lightning, he swept like a
-thunderbolt on the group, knocking three of the savages over with his
-horse's shoulder, and placing the other three _hors de combat_ with a
-front and back-hander of his long, heavy sabre. In another moment
-Beresford had the wounded man safely _en croupe_, and carried off from
-what would have been a cruel death. Commandant D'Arcy, with equal
-gallantry, was not so fortunate, for seeing a wounded man on the ground
-he sought to carry him off, but his horse, being restive, reared and
-fell back, so that the unfortunate trooper was overtaken and assegaied,
-while D'Arcy was so severely bruised by falling on his revolver, that,
-although able to get back safely, he was unable to take part in the next
-day's fight. Three men killed, four wounded, and thirteen horses killed,
-was the total loss to our men.
-
-A little before daybreak on the 4th, Wood, with his flying column,
-crossed the White Umvolosi, leaving the 1-24th Regiment in laager with
-all the heavy baggage and supplies. Lord Chelmsford was so pleased with
-Buller's magnificent reconnaissance, that he determined to advance at
-once upon Ulundi, giving every temptation to the Zulu army to attack,
-upon the plain which had been admirably surveyed two days previously by
-Colonel Buller. Nothing could have been better considered, nothing could
-have been better planned, and nothing could have been better worked out,
-than the details of this splendid action. Every punctilio had been
-observed by Lord Chelmsford as regards his answers and promises to
-Cetywayo. The General had said he would not cross the river, thereby
-placing himself at some considerable disadvantage in a strategic point,
-and yet up to noon of the 3rd instant no act of submission was made. On
-the 4th, therefore, the main body crossed after Wood's column, and
-knowing that the Zulu army were somewhere between the river and Ulundi,
-had good reason to hope that they would show fight. Lord Chelmsford
-therefore advanced boldly, and without any undue show of caution, across
-the plain. They had nothing in the shape of baggage with the exception
-of ammunition and water-carts; but each man carried in his haversack
-biscuit and preserved meat for four days.
-
-The crossing of the river was made without any opposition, although the
-movements of our troops were carefully watched by a body of Zulus from a
-neighbouring hillock on the left, and a more brilliant and picturesque
-sight could not be imagined. The banks of the river were covered with
-tamarinds and acacia, growing right down to the water's edge; while
-creeping plants, such as the convolvulus, the jessamine, and the deadly
-nightshade, were festooned from tree to tree. The wild guava, the
-pomegranate, and many a sweetly-scented bush, pushed upward their
-luxuriant undergrowth, and gave out faint odours as they were crushed by
-the horses' hoofs. Bees were humming among the sweetly-scented
-dholiocs, and the ripple of the stream as it rushed and bubbled over the
-clear pebbles below made a music that seemed out of place with thoughts
-of bloodshed and strife. With Buller scouting far in front, Wood's
-division led the van, Newdigate next, and Drury-Lowe, with his gallant
-Lancers, brought up the rear. The fortified camp on the right bank of
-the Umvolosi had been left with a Gatling gun, 900 Europeans, and 250
-natives, under Colonel Bellairs. As soon as favourable ground had been
-reached, Wood was signalled to halt and wait for the main body; and the
-order was then given to form a large hollow square, with the ammunition,
-two Gatlings, and the entrenching tool-carts and bearers in the centre.
-Inside this square were also two companies of Engineers and some native
-Pioneers attached, under Major Chard and Captain Ainsley, together with
-the _impedimenta_, consisting of water-carts, ambulance-waggons, and
-stretchers. The square, although large, was not unwieldy, and the steady
-marching of the men prevented the slightest noise or confusion. The
-flying column under Wood held the post of honour in the front half of
-the square. Major Tucker, with the 80th Regiment, and Major Owen and two
-Gatlings in the centre, held the front face. On his right flank were two
-7-pounders of Major Tremlett's battery, under Lieutenant Davidson, with
-seven companies of the 13th Light Infantry, under Major England,
-supplemented in continuation of the right face by two more of Tremlett's
-guns, in charge of Captain Brown and Lieutenant Slade; then came one
-9-pounder of Major Le Grice's battery, under Lieutenant Crookenden;
-four fine companies of the 58th making up the remainder of the right
-face. The rear face was composed of one gun of Le Grice's battery, two
-companies of the 21st Fusiliers, under Major Hazlerigg, and three
-companies of the 94th, under Colonel Malthus. On the left or west flank
-were the remaining three companies of the 94th, two 7-pounders of Major
-Harness's battery, under Lieutenant Parsons; eight companies of the
-90th, under Major Rogers; and two guns of Major Le Grice's battery,
-attached _pro tem._ to Major Harness, under Lieutenant Elliott. Buller's
-Cavalry were away scouring the front and flanks, while Colonel
-Drury-Lowe, with two squadrons of the 17th Lancers, and Captain
-Shepstone's Basutos, formed the rear guard. The numbers of all ranks
-were as follows:--Flying Column, 2192 Europeans and 573 natives;
-Newdigate (2nd Division), 1870 Europeans and 530 natives; making a total
-of 5165 men.
-
-Lord Chelmsford and his staff rode in the centre, in rear of the front
-face. He, of course, assumed the chief command; and his clear, sharp,
-soldierlike voice rang out like a trumpet to the men: "The square will
-wheel to the right." This order was taken up by the division as quickly
-and calmly as though by a brigade of Foot Guards at Aldershot or the
-Curragh. After moving on for a few miles they began to approach the
-smaller kraals; and Buller, with his advanced and seemingly ubiquitous
-riders, could be seen dashing here and there in every direction to tempt
-the Zulu columns, which could now be discerned along the horizon towards
-the left front. At the extreme end of the plain the sun glanced down
-upon a long line of white shields marching in a sort of double column,
-with skirmishers thrown out in European fashion in front and on the
-flanks. The square was now halted, while the first kraal was fired.
-This, some of Shepstone's Basutos said, was named Umlambo-Bogivimo, and
-Buller's men having applied their flints and steel to the task, the
-flames and smoke ascended to the sky. Next they came to the great kraal
-of King Panda, called Unodwengo; but although this was at first fired,
-it was found the smoke acted as such a screen to the Zulus that Lord
-Chelmsford ordered its extinction. Strong columns could now be seen
-moving out in quick though good order from Ulundi, and as they seemed
-bearing down upon the right front, the square took ground to the right
-and was halted in a capital position, pointed out to Lord Chelmsford by
-Buller. Our troops were now assailed by a dropping but harmless fire
-from the Ulundi column on the right front, and from a strong Zulu force
-operating in some broken ground from Unodwengo, now on the left. It was
-now half-past eight, and by nine o'clock the Zulu attack was fully
-developed. Buller's men then made a strong demonstration on the left,
-driving the Zulus from the hollow where they were sheltered, back to the
-Unodwengo kraal. This movement was well supported by Shepstone and his
-Basutos, who skirmished splendidly on the left and rear face of the
-kraal. While this, however, was going on, a Zulu on a white horse was
-seen leading strong reinforcements from his proper right to assist in
-the attack upon the cavalry on the left. The scene was now most
-exciting. Buller and his men fought in two ranks, the first mounted and
-ready to dash at a moment upon any weak point in the enemy's line; the
-second, dismounted, and making capital practice at long ranges, with
-their saddles as a rest for the rifle. As soon as the front rank became
-too hardly pressed, they cantered to the rear, dismounted, and relieved
-the second rank. This is the old Dutch mode of fighting the Zulus, and
-it has rarely been found unsuccessful. Colonel Lowe, at this juncture,
-asked Lord Chelmsford's permission to send out a squadron of his
-Lancers, or even a troop; but the general wisely declined, as the ground
-was broken, and the Zulu line too powerful to be charged. Nothing could
-be finer than the way in which Buller and Shepstone retired, bringing
-the Zulu columns and their horns under the deadly hail of our Gatlings
-and Martinis. Now, thought the Zulus, was the time for their grand
-attack. Were not the mounted men, under the terrible Buller, flying
-before the fierce onslaught of the Zulu braves? Still the line of white
-shields came roaring on, like the big white billows that roll on to and
-break into foam upon the South Afric shore. The ridges on the front and
-left were now swarming with Zulus, fierce, stern, and terrible, as with
-fiendish and maniacal shouts they swept over the soft and springy veldt
-to be shattered, bloody and broken in their pride, by the leaden tempest
-that now whistled from all sides of the square. "Steady, my lads; close
-up, fire low, and not so fast!" cried Evelyn Wood, who had his men under
-splendid control. "Are the mounted men all in?" said Lord Chelmsford to
-General Newdigate. "They are, my lord," replied Buller, who was just
-lighting a cigarette. "Then give the enemy a round or two of shrapnel,"
-said the chief. Shells from the right and left were now poured in; but
-still on came the line of white shields. File-firing from the Martinis
-was poured in, but the Zulu columns were deployed, and, regardless of
-the _mitraille_, still came on in half-open order. But, under cover of
-their strong lines of skirmishers, the Zulu attack was now changed and
-further developed on the rear face, where Malthus and Hazlerigg held
-post. Hazlerigg, whose tall and stalwart form was conspicuous above the
-files of his men, made his front rank reserve its fire till the Zulus
-had arrived within sixty yards, and then the word was given to fire low
-and steady. The kraal of Unodwengo was, it has been said, upon the left,
-and it proved rather a thorn in the side. Behind the rising ground from
-which the Basutos had been driven now came a stream of thousands of
-Zulus sweeping round the left flank from Ulundi. Their wild yells and
-unearthly war-cries smote upon the air, and were heard through the ping
-and rattle of the rifle-fire. Under cover of the Unodwengo kraal, and
-sweeping over the ground beyond, this strong body, led by the chief on
-the white horse, formed a hollow square, and after a few moments' pause
-to collect themselves, dashed like a whirlwind upon the right rear angle
-of the square. Now every one knows that the angle of a square, like the
-salient angle of a bastion, is its weakest point, and for a moment it
-seemed a question whether the attack would succeed. The angle was held
-by two of Hazlerigg's companies, and although Le Grice's solitary gun,
-admirably served, poured forth its most deadly shells, and Hazlerigg
-kept his men firing in the most steady manner, at one moment it seemed
-as though it would come to close quarters fighting. But one terrific
-volley from the 21st, the 94th, the 58th, and Royal Engineers, shattered
-their order, their square was broken, and after a moment's pause they
-sought shelter from so terrific a fire. Meanwhile the front attack had
-again developed, and here the gallant 80th were placed at a certain
-disadvantage. That awkward dip in their front enabled the Zulus to make
-their formation for attack out of sight and out of fire, so that Major
-Tucker's men had to reserve their fire until the tops of the enemies'
-heads were seen above the mound. But the 80th behaved so coolly and so
-steadily that the front attack at length slackened, and the Zulu line
-wavered, and finally ceased to fire.
-
-It was now a quarter to ten, and as signs of wavering were remarked in
-every face of the attack, Colonel Drury-Lowe at this juncture had been
-allowed to file his men out from an opening in the rear face, and was
-just forming them in squadrons, when a spent ball knocked him off his
-charger. He was stunned, however, only for a moment, and was again in
-the saddle, smiling at his mishap. Now was the moment for which the
-gallant Lancers had so long waited. Now every man gripped his weapon
-with stiffened sinews and determined heart. "Go at them, colonel, but
-don't pursue too far!" shouted Lord Chelmsford, as he raised his helmet
-to the men. Moving first at a walk to steady his men, Lowe advanced in
-column of troops from the right, and as soon as the ground was
-favourable gave the words in succession, "Trot!" "Form squadrons!" "Form
-line!" "Gallop!" "Charge!" Away across the broad grassy slopes, and
-greeted by a burst of cheering from the square, went the splendid
-blue-and-white line, their pennons fluttering in the morning air, and
-their bright and deadly steel-topped bamboo lances in rest. On they
-went, driving the flying Zulus headlong into a donga, where sweeping
-round it the pursuing squadrons forced the enemy out into the open to
-fly for safety towards the mountains northward. But flanking the donga,
-and hidden by the long grass, half of a Zulu regiment was posted to
-cover the retreat, and as the squadrons of Drury-Lowe's men came on a
-volley was poured in, which emptied several saddles, and was fatal to
-poor young Wyatt-Edgell, who was gallantly leading on his men. His men,
-almost maddened as they saw him fall, spurred more furiously on to take
-immediate and bloody vengeance.
-
-A moment more and the bristling line of steel meets the black and
-shining wall of human flesh, rent, pierced, and gashed by a weapon as
-death-dealing and unsparing as their own assegai. Still, though crushed
-and stabbed by the lances, and though their firm array was scattered
-like sea-foam, the Zulus fought on in stubborn knots, nor cried for
-quarter, stabbing at the horses' bellies as they went down, and trying
-to drag the men off their horses in the _mêlée_. The lance was now
-relegated in most cases to its sling, and the heavy sabres of the
-troopers became red with gore. Never was a cavalry attack better timed
-or more effective, and never did that oft-abused arm, the lance, better
-vindicate its reputation as a weapon of pursuit. But now a troop of the
-King's Dragoon Guards, under Captain Brewster, and some irregular
-cavalry, are let loose from different sides of the square, and, with
-Lord William Beresford full six horse-lengths in advance, charge full
-and fair upon the flying savages, who are cut down in scores until they
-gain the crests of the hill; but even there no safety or rest is found,
-for shrapnel, fired with time-fuzes, scatters them like chaff in the
-wind.
-
-The attacking force consisted of twelve regiments, and could not have
-been less than 23,000; 15,000 surrounding the British square, and 8000
-in reserve. Their loss has been estimated at 1500, but it should
-probably be put down as double, for during the whole of the action they
-could be seen carrying their dead and wounded away. The total loss to
-our troops was not heavy--some dozen killed and about eighty wounded.
-Amongst those killed was one officer, of whom might well be said, "We
-could have better spared a better man." In the gallant white-and-blue
-line of squadrons that swept like a torrent upon the scared and flying
-Zulu hordes, there rode no braver, no more knightly spirit than young,
-gallant Wyatt-Edgell. The scion of a noble house, and a soldier by
-hereditary tradition and birth, he had all the accomplishments and
-chivalrous attributes of his race. His loss was a great blow to all, and
-his premature though glorious death cast a deep gloom not only over his
-own regiment, but over the entire camp in which he had spent so many
-cheerful days, esteemed and loved by officers and men alike, from
-highest to lowest.
-
-After the battle of Ulundi and the destruction of the king's five great
-kraals, Lord Chelmsford marched his division back to Entonyani, where
-they remained some days, having had a storm of rain and thunder lasting
-thirty-six hours. As they had no tents the first night, the state of
-affairs may more easily be imagined than described. The rain came down
-in perfect torrents, sweeping away the bivouac fires and pouring through
-the camp like the overflow of a mighty river. The men behaved admirably,
-taking all the discomforts of their situation with the good humour and
-jocularity of disciplined troops. The horses naturally suffered most,
-although every attempt was made to picket them in a sheltered spot. On
-arriving at Entonyani they found tents waiting for them, and were thus
-enabled to get dry and refit. The nights were exceptionally cold and
-with heavy dews, causing some little sickness amongst the men.
-
-In fully estimating the importance of this battle, we must not forget
-the surroundings, nor the associations of the place. The valley of the
-Umvolosi is essentially the heart of Zululand. It is the richest and
-most fertile portion of the country, and as such was chosen as the royal
-abode. The two branches of the river, named after the district, converge
-through it towards the main stream which flows on to St. Lucia Bay. The
-one by which the king's great kraal but lately stood passes through a
-comparatively open country; and its waters, gleaming clear in the
-sunlight, are called "White," just as the waters of the other branch,
-which run through a more bushy and broken district, are called "Black."
-In the basin drained by this extensive water-system the Zulu nation was
-originally cradled. Thither Dingaan retired after he had slain his
-brother near the Nonoti. There the brave and bustling Dutchman Retief
-and his companions were treacherously murdered in 1838; and there,
-again, Bongore, led into a trap the unsuspecting Boers, who were again
-duped by his representations, they believing that the king was alone at
-Mahlabatini. The valley where this last battle was fought is with the
-Zulus a sacred and historic spot. It is rife with what is most dear to
-the Zulu pride--legends of bloody massacre, treacherous surprise, and
-savage revenge. Dingaan fled from thence; Panda died there; Cetywayo was
-first recognized and crowned there. Could the tall and wooded grey
-cliffs that looked down upon the combat speak, they could tell, in a
-direful tale of tyrannous cruelty and wrong, most of the annals of the
-Zulu nation. Year by year they witnessed the periodical gathering
-together of Cetywayo's legions, and watched the steady outgrowth of the
-savage power whose overthrow, by British troops and British discipline,
-they beheld but a few months since. But signal and satisfactory as this
-victory was, it could not be accepted as final until Cetywayo had
-completely submitted, though some of its effects were immediate and
-important.
-
-The day after the battle of Ulundi, and before the victory was known to
-the troops of the 1st Division, about 700 Zulus, with all their cattle,
-women, and children, came into the camp at Richard's Cove, near Port
-Durnford, to tender submission and to claim protection. There is not the
-slightest doubt but that they had heard of the battle, although there
-was not a whisper of the engagement heard amongst these people. General
-Crealock, to give importance to the ceremony, ordered a general parade
-of the division at midday, and it was impossible not to be struck with
-the attenuated condition of his battalions, although every available man
-was put on parade. Both brigades made up rather a weak division. The
-1st Brigade was made up of the Buffs, two companies of the 88th, two
-companies of the "Shah's" and "Active's" bluejackets, and one of the
-marine artillery; while the 2nd Brigade was composed of the Royal
-Artillery, 57th, 60th Rifles, and 91st--in all twenty companies. At half
-past twelve the General, surrounded by his staff, rode on to the ground,
-and the division was wheeled into line. Then a galloper was sent out to
-the Zulus who were halted on the crest of the neighbouring hills, and
-they were told to advance and lay down their arms. Three hundred
-fine-looking fellows then advanced in good order, and arriving at the
-prescribed distance, made the customary obeisance while they deposited
-assegais and guns, in number about seventy, fire-arms mostly of the old
-pattern.
-
-However, time proved that the results of Lord Chelmsford's engagement
-and victory on the 4th (July) were of far greater importance than had
-been at first imagined. Chiefs and tribes came pouring into the various
-camps, not by dozens or by scores, but literally by hundreds, and the
-only two questions they asked--and these kept invariably recurring--were
-"Why was not the victory of Ulundi followed up vigorously? and why was
-Cetywayo allowed to escape?"
-
-It was this great error of immediately retiring from Ulundi which made
-us again ridiculous, not only in the eyes of Zululand, but also in those
-of military Europe. It was due, not to Lord Chelmsford, nor those under
-his command, but to extraneous influences beyond his control; and public
-opinion never arrived at a more true or just conclusion than in saying
-that the arrival of Lord Chelmsford's successor, no matter how valuable
-or how necessary it might have been, came at a most inopportune time,
-for it was well known that Lord Chelmsford's plans were so perfectly
-matured, that had he been left free to carry out his own designs,
-instead of being hampered and constrained by the orders of the new
-Commander-in-chief, he would have followed up Ulundi with the utmost
-possible activity, and would in all probability have secured the person
-of the king. Terms for the final pacification of the whole of Zululand
-could then have been dictated on the spot, and there would have been an
-end to the entire business.
-
-Under these circumstances therefore Lord Chelmsford determined to resign
-all command; and within three days of the brilliant victory of Ulundi it
-was known to the soldiers throughout the camp that their General was
-about to leave them, and that with him were going Sir Evelyn Wood,
-General Crealock, and Colonel Redvers Buller. Accordingly a grand parade
-of all arms was ordered on the morning of the 8th (July), that the
-General might take a formal leave of his men. At nine a.m. the
-bugle-call for coverers was sounded, the staff officers marked the
-alignment, and the various corps moved like clockwork upon their
-respective pivots. The division was then wheeled into line by General
-Newdigate, and the flanks, bringing forward their right and left
-shoulders, three sides of a large hollow square was formed, with the
-front ranks facing inwards. Lord Chelmsford, his staff, and three
-brigadiers formed the fourth side of the square, and in a few
-warm-hearted, well chosen, and soldierlike sentences the
-Commander-in-chief, under whom the troops had seen so much good hard
-work, honest service, and from whom all ranks had received at various
-times some recognition of their conduct in camp and on the field of
-battle, bade them farewell, and thanked them for the manner in which
-their duty to their Queen and country had been performed. "For the
-courage, the coolness, and the devotion you have all displayed wherever
-I have been with you, I give you my best and my warmest thanks. For the
-unselfish devotion and untiring energy and good-humour with which you
-have encountered hardship, fatigue, and privation I find it hard to
-sufficiently express my gratitude. In all senses you have done your duty
-as English soldiers." Such were the concluding words of a leader whom
-all loved, respected, and all regretted.
-
-On the following day the camp bivouac was broken up, and the cavalry,
-the 2nd Division, and the flying column, marched _en route_ to
-Intanjaneni and Kwamagwasa, thus beyond doubt leading Cetywayo and his
-indunas to suppose that their losses at Ulundi and want of military
-skill caused them to forego the advantages they had won.
-
-Despatches from General Crealock fully demonstrate that his inability to
-effect a junction with the 2nd Division before the action at Ulundi was
-due to no want of energy or organization on his part, but solely to
-those causes which will impede the movements of all bodies of civilized
-troops in uncivilized lands. But although sickness amongst the oxen and
-other impediments to transport caused General Crealock to lose his share
-of the victory gained, his time had not been wasted, for much valuable
-work was done in the nature of road-making and raiding over the enemy's
-country, thus affording a diversion which considerably weakened
-Cetywayo's chances of inflicting a defeat upon the other column. The
-task of establishing the new base of supply at Port Durnford and the
-building of Fort Napoleon was thrown entirely upon the 1st Division, and
-naturally interfered with its rapid advance. The work, however, that
-fell to the coast column was fully and admirably carried out, and a
-pontoon and a trestle-bridge were built over the Tugela, without which
-no important advance could have been made along the coast. The ford over
-the Inyoni was rendered permanently practicable, and can, now that the
-descent is made easy for waggons, be passed at all seasons. The same
-work was effected at the Umsundusi and Amatikula rivers, whose
-approaches were made safe for wheels. The Umkusi and Inyezani hills and
-drifts were also made passable by improvement in the roads. Along the
-Umlatoosi valley numerous small but difficult streams had drifts made
-over them. From the Umlatoosi to St. Paul's Mission Station used to be a
-bad and most difficult road, but all the dangerous places were now
-levelled, and a strong and defensible position was given. Fords were
-secured across the Uvulu, the Entonjaneni, the Umvolosi, and the
-Umlalasi, and there no physical obstacle was allowed to remain to delay
-the march of a European column with its baggage in any part of the coast
-and the south of Zululand, while forts had been completed or erected at
-Tenedos, Pearson, Crealock, Chelmsford, Napoleon, and Durnford.
-
-The result of this was that Sir Garnet Wolseley, in taking over Lord
-Chelmsford's command, found a complete chain of military posts, the
-like of which was never before seen in South Africa, extending along the
-Zulu frontier from the Blood and Buffalo rivers to the Umvolosi mouth
-and Port Durnford, and, in fact, encompassing three out of four sides of
-Cetywayo's kingdom.
-
-In addition to the formation of the new base and the seaward
-communications the later operations of Barrow's cavalry fully vindicated
-the reputation they had obtained for activity. Barrow's Irregular
-Mounted Corps, although not so numerous as those of Buller, were equally
-worthy of praise, alike for their admirable discipline, courage in
-action, and skill in patrolling. They consisted of about fifty enrolled
-volunteers under Captain Addison, forming a body called the "Natal
-Guides," three troops of Lonsdale's Mounted Rifles, three of the Mounted
-Infantry, the Natal Horse, and a very useful contingent of mounted
-natives. These, under such leaders as Colonel Barrow, Major Lord
-Gifford, Captains Barton and Nettleton, were at once the eyes and ears
-of the column. On July 6th Barrow's men made a forced march, during
-which they were thirty hours in the saddle, and, reaching Ondini, the
-king's old kraal, burnt it to the ground. The patrol paraded overnight,
-and started some two hours before daylight, making its way through a
-valley district over fifteen miles in length by three or four in
-breadth, though here and there narrowing in parts to only one mile, over
-lofty spurs and ridges running into it, forming a series of
-densely-wooded and impracticable ravines. The weather was intensely hot,
-and although the men and horses were both distressed at times, the
-troops did their work in a manner which reflected great credit upon all
-present. From this valley the road or trek ran for ten or twelve miles
-through an open but rather broken country, the hills in the distance
-being covered with dense bush. The patrol then turned eastwards over a
-table-land which stretched away for about twenty miles, till the edge of
-the plateau is reached, and the path descends abruptly into the great
-thorn valley to the west of the White Umvolosi; at the edge of this
-plateau the coast road joins. From this point the patrol marched a few
-miles, and halted for off-saddle and breakfast on the right bank of the
-river. The road is fairly good, but passes through thick thorn-bush, and
-the country is very broken and contains a number of small streamlets
-tributary to the Umvolosi. The drift here is good, and is commanded by a
-high stony hill to the north and upon the right of the road, and within
-rifle range of one of the smaller royal kraals. The Ondini kraal was
-reached about noon. It was occupied by some Zulus, who made away as the
-troops advanced at a canter; the place was fired, and in half an hour
-was utterly destroyed. The return to camp was made by another road,
-which was long and tedious; several of the horses were completely
-knocked up, one dying from exhaustion and several having to be abandoned
-on the road.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XIII.
-
- Arrival of Sir Garnet Wolseley--Reception at Durban--Changes made by
- Wolseley--His plans for the future--Attempt to land at Port Durnford
- and its failure--Sir Garnet at St. Paul's--Grand council of Zulu
- chiefs--Resignation of General Crealock--His farewell to his troops
- at Camp Umlalasi--Fêtes in honour of Lord Chelmsford--Wolseley at
- Pietermaritzburg--Disturbances in Pondoland and Transvaal--Wolseley
- at Rorke's Drift--McLeod and the Swazis--Their appearance and
- habits--Wolseley at Intanjaneni--Surrender of guns by
- Mbelebele--Adhesion of various chiefs.
-
-
-It is now time to turn attention to the movements of the new
-Commander-in-chief and Governor. On the 28th of June his Excellency Sir
-Garnet Wolseley and his staff landed at Durban from the C.R.M.S.
-"Dunkeld." The whole town was that day _en fête_, as the Durbanites like
-a sensation, no matter of what nature. At daylight the whole of the
-military and naval authorities were astir, and various coloured bunting
-began to appear all over the town. Crowds of well-to-do shopkeepers and
-farmers went down to the point on horseback, while hundreds went by the
-train. All the ships in the harbour and the bluff were gaily decorated,
-and the men-of-war, transports, and merchant-vessels were gallantly
-dressed in bunting from stem to stern. Sir Garnet brought with him
-many of his old staff, and others joined later on. Colonel Pomeroy
-Colley arrived by the next Zanzibar steamer, and took up the duties of
-chief of the staff, and Captain Lord Gifford joined from his regiment,
-the 57th. Sir Garnet Wolseley was not only to be Governor,
-Commander-in-chief, and High Commissioner in Natal and the Transvaal,
-but also to exercise the functions of the latter office in the countries
-to the north and to the east.
-
-The changes ordered by the new Commander-in-chief were numerous and
-important. In the first place all military operations against Secocoeni
-were to be discontinued. This order gave great dissatisfaction, as
-several highly successful patrols had already been made against this
-chieftain; and Colonel Lanyon, after great delay and difficulty having
-completed his arrangements for the attack, was actually on his way to
-the front, when instructions reached him to stop and send his men to
-Derby, to protect that part of the border from Zulu raids.
-
-The troops were to be immediately consolidated and reduced, and with
-them the expenses of the war.
-
-The landing of the Marines was countermanded, and they were to be sent
-back with all possible speed to Simon's Bay; the Natal Carabineers, the
-Durban Mounted Rifles, Bettington's Horse, and the Frontier Light Horse
-were to be forthwith disbanded: the 1st Division and the Cavalry brigade
-were to be broken up; while the forts along the coast were to be
-abandoned. The following troops were also named for immediate
-embarkation:--1-24th, the 3rd (Buffs), the 99th, the 88th, the 1st
-battalion 13th, and two batteries of artillery, to proceed to England;
-the 17th Lancers to go on to India; Ellaby's and Tremlett's batteries
-to proceed to St. Helena. Lord Chelmsford, Generals Marshall, Wood, and
-Crealock, Colonels Crealock, Downe, Dawney, and Buller, Captains Buller,
-Molyneux, Frere, Milne, Grenfell, Beresford, and Reilly were going home,
-either by order or at their own request. Indeed almost the only officer
-of high position who elected, or was selected, to remain was General
-Clifford, who still retained his post of Inspector-General of the lines
-of communication.
-
-Sir Garnet's plan of operations for the future was as follows: a
-military post at Durnford with 400 men; another at St. Paul's, with a
-brigade; and a third at Intanjaneni with 400 men; a regiment to remain
-on the Umlatoosi, and a battalion of the Native Contingent to guard the
-line of the Tugela. Colonel Baker Russell was to start at once with a
-flying column from St. Paul's and co-operate with Oham in the west.
-Colonel George Villiers was to proceed to join Oham and organize various
-bodies of burghers, Natal natives, and Zulus, to hem in Cetywayo in that
-direction, whilst McLeod (late 74th Regiment) was to raise, equip, and
-command 5000 warriors of the Amaswazis, and, if necessary, lead them
-right into Zululand. Colonel Clarke (57th) meanwhile was to march
-straight on Ulundi, there to await Sir Garnet's arrival, with a force
-consisting of the 57th, 60th, five companies of the 80th, two troops of
-Lonsdale's Horse, one battalion of the Natal Native Contingent, and some
-mounted natives under the chiefs Jemptse and Mafionge, together with a
-battery of Gatlings and the Natal Pioneers. Meanwhile Sir Garnet had
-convened a great council of Zulu chieftains to be held at St. Paul's,
-July 19th, to arrive if possible at some definite arrangement for the
-temporary government of the country. Such were the main features of the
-new commander's programme, and though severe strictures were at first
-passed thereupon by the majority of the colonists and old soldiers
-experienced in Kaffir warfare, time proved that his calculations were
-just and well-founded.
-
-Leaving Durban on the 2nd of July, Sir Garnet and staff embarked on
-board her Majesty's ship "Shah," and proceeded to Durnford, where
-several attempts to land were made, but without success. On the morning
-of the 3rd, the steam-tug "Koodoo" came alongside, and Sir Garnet and
-his staff, including the two Colonels Russell, Captains Buchanan,
-Maurice, Braithwaite, and Baynes, Dr. Russell, and Mr. Herbert (private
-secretary), were with great difficulty and no little risk embarked on
-her and subsequently transferred to a surf-boat or lighter. While towing
-the lighter towards the shore the hawser broke, but most fortunately a
-sail was hoisted at once, and the boat, getting clear of the breakers,
-was again taken in tow by the "Koodoo." After several ineffectual
-attempts to get the lighter made fast to the warp, the recall was fired
-from the "Shah," and Sir Garnet returned to the man-of-war. As the day
-wore on the surf became worse, and towards evening Captain Bradshaw,
-commanding the "Shah," deemed it no longer safe to remain at anchor off
-the bar. Sir Garnet therefore returned to Durban, and hastening on
-overland _viâ_ Forts Chelmsford, Pearson, and Crealock, reached the camp
-of the 1st Division at Richard's Cove, Port Durnford, on July 6th.
-
-On the 14th an advance column, consisting of Buller's Light Horse about
-100, two guns, the 57th Regiment, the whole under Colonel B. Russell,
-C.B., left camp and marched in the direction of St. Paul's, as far as
-the Umlatoosi, where they entrenched themselves on the right bank, the
-cavalry and Dunn's scouts forming an advanced guard on the left. This
-position commands a path about ten miles from the mouth of the river,
-and the site is very picturesque, overlooking the valley to the
-north-west. His Excellency and headquarter staff accompanied the column,
-and the next morning pushed on to St. Paul's with an escort of cavalry,
-where were the headquarters of the 2nd Division. A parade of the troops,
-including the 17th Lancers and some 500 irregular cavalry--the
-celebrated Buller's Horse--was held, and the General, after taking leave
-of Lord Chelmsford, Brigadier General Wood, Colonel Buller, who with
-their staffs were leaving for England, returned to the camp on the
-Umlatoosi. It has been already said that the 19th was fixed by Sir
-Garnet Wolseley for the meeting or durbar of the principal chiefs, all
-of whom were expected to attend. By noon on that day the camp presented
-a curious sight. Outside the General's tent a guard of honour, with the
-Queen's colours, was drawn up, while a large space was railed off for
-the reception of Zulu visitors, who came winding in bands over the
-slopes of the neighbouring hills from an early hour in the morning. As
-each deputation from its respective tribe came into camp, preceded by
-its principal rulers, it was formed up in a sort of column, sixteen or
-eighteen feet deep, in the space set apart for the visitors. The
-gathering was a numerous one, upwards of 250 chiefs and their followers
-having attended, and evidently considering the occasion as one of great
-importance, as each man was attired in his most gorgeous manner. The
-enclosure was at the same time council-chamber and reception-hall, and
-although no seats were required, skins, mats, and canvas were put down
-for the principal chiefs to sit upon. Some of the chiefs had a covering
-of cow's tails and other skins round the waist, while broad rings of
-copper were worn round the arms and ankles of others. Plumes of feathers
-adorned the heads of the principal men, and hanging behind, somewhat
-after the fashion of a Hungarian pelisse, each warrior wore a panther or
-other similar skin. The array of dusky savages looked fairly imposing,
-although none of them were armed save with the knobkerrie of place,
-which as they squatted was laid methodically in front of each man. Upon
-the hills in the distance were a number of boys and women who had
-accompanied the chiefs, but who preferred to remain outside spectators
-of the conference. The enclosure was marked out by branches of the
-mimosa, cut in convenient lengths, and forming a sort of palisade, which
-kept the crowd from intruding. When all were reported present, Sir
-Garnet and his staff, accompanied by Mr. Fynny, border agent, came out
-of his tent, and the guard having presented arms, the proceedings
-commenced. The two principal chiefs were the king's brothers,
-Dabulamanzi and Magwendi, who both replied to Sir Garnet's speech.
-Dabulamanzi was a fine-looking man of large size, apparently in the full
-vigour of his age, and of great muscular development, presenting in this
-regard a striking contrast to his brother Oham, who was simply a large
-fat man. There was an air of considerable thought and command in his
-face, and, unlike the other chiefs, who wore their hair closely cropped,
-except with a black band round the temples, his hair was thrown back and
-his broad forehead was encircled with a fillet of ostrich feathers
-terminating with a single plume behind. Heavy rings of highly polished
-copper spanned the thick part of the arms of Magwendi, a much shorter
-and more common-looking man, and whose neck was adorned with a necklace
-formed of monkey's teeth and small shells. Both these chiefs held in
-their right hands the same kind of short stick carried by their
-warriors, while their left hands rested on their naked knees. Mr. Fynny,
-the well-known border agent, who was considered to know almost as much
-about Zululand and the Zulus as Mr. John Dunn, and that is saying much,
-performed the duties of interpreter with remarkable skill and fluency,
-translating Sir Garnet's speech, sentence by sentence, as it was
-uttered, with due emphasis and point. Sir Garnet Wolseley spoke as
-nearly as possible to the following effect: "I am very pleased to
-welcome you to my camp, because your coming in answer to my invitation
-shows you are as anxious for peace as I am myself, and as is the great
-Queen in whose name I now speak. We came to make war with Cetywayo, not
-with the Zulu people, and to put an end to his cruelties and his
-military system, which with his marriage laws made life and property
-unsafe in your land. We want peace with the Zulus, and that they shall
-be at peace with our people in Natal. We have beaten the king in open
-fight and burnt his kraal, so that he is now a fugitive and shall never
-more reign in Zululand. We might now take all Zululand, but we do not
-want any of it, and we wish that all of you should have your property
-and land. I rode to St. Paul's the other day, and found all the people
-on the way living quietly in their own kraals, and with their cattle in
-them. All may do the same, but all must first give up their arms and the
-king's cattle in token of their submission. The old laws of Zululand
-shall be restored, and you shall be ruled by your own chiefs, whom you
-all know. I shall divide the kingdom into four or five districts, and
-all men shall be free to come and go, to work, to marry, and to become
-rich. The great Queen, who sends me, wishes the Zulus should be happy,
-but those who continue to bear arms, and will not submit, must be given
-up. On the north the Swazis and the Amatongas are only kept by my orders
-from invading Zululand, while Oham and his soldiers are moving upon the
-west. I am going myself to Ulundi on the 10th, where I shall tell the
-Zulu people my arrangements for the future government of the country."
-This address was listened to with great attention, and with the most
-respectful silence, and several of the chiefs replied, one in particular
-making the naive and rather sarcastic remark that he and his friends
-could not see what fault Cetywayo had committed, but as the English
-chiefs had seen it they were satisfied. Dabulamanzi did not speak,
-except to Magwendi, who rose and complained that his cattle had been
-taken from him, and that some of them had been sent in as belonging to
-the king. Redress was at once promised by Sir Garnet. The meeting then
-broke up, the chieftains undertaking to meet Sir Garnet again at Ulundi
-on August 10th, to arrive at a final settlement of affairs.
-
-It has been before mentioned that General Crealock had determined to
-resign his command of the 1st Division; it was in pursuance of this
-resolution that he ordered a general parade on July 21st, on which
-occasion he made a short but appropriate speech to his men.
-
-There were on parade the Buffs, 60th Rifles, 91st, the naval brigade of
-the "Boadicea," one company of Marines, two troops of Lonsdale's Horse,
-one troop of Natal Horse, and a battery of 7-pounders. This little army
-was drawn up on the usual parade-ground, not far from the river, and in
-the midst of a scene of the greatest natural beauty. The banks of the
-stream are thickly wooded, and the valley is the resort of large species
-of game. Crocodiles frequent the river, and make it dangerous to bathe.
-Thick, thorny underwood, mingled with tall reeds and date-palms, grow
-close down to the waters, which reflect the tall green trees that
-overarch above. Trees, with branches bearing bright green leaves and
-yellow fragile flowers, drooped nearly to the ground around the plain.
-Pre-eminent in splendour shone out the brilliant _combretta_, whose
-masses of bloom gleamed like torches amidst the dark green of the
-thickets, whilst the golden sheen of the fruit intensified the marked
-contrast of the tints. At the drinking-place used for the horses the
-water flowed in streamlets over the rocks and along a long red sandbank.
-A ledge of granite forms a rugged barrier eight or ten feet high across
-the river, and down the hollows of this the clear waters rush and ripple
-in rills, cascades, and rapids, bubbling and eddying among the great
-masses of rock below, in many of which, like those of the Zambesi, great
-holes are worn by stones which during the flood perhaps had settled in
-small hollows. Dark lines of trees border the river on the right, and on
-the left there is a fine grove of baobabs with large dark green leaves
-and wide-spreading branches. Crossing a sandstone hill with a spur
-stretching away to the eastward, and adorned with some splendid
-specimens of the encephalartos, or Kaffir bread, and then descending
-into the valley of the Umlalasi, one comes to sandstone and gneiss,
-rising in cliffs of 600 feet on the south of the river, but sloping away
-gradually on the north. The banks are covered with verdant and
-golden-blossomed acacias, some of them with yellow bark and the sweet
-gum, which is said to indicate the presence of the tsetse fly. Away to
-the north are to be seen groves of palm and mimosas, with stems forty
-feet to the lower branches. Far away beyond the plain can be seen the
-purple outlines of the great Lebombo range of mountains. These are to
-the east of the Drakenberg, and intervene between it and the sea.
-Stretching northward from the Pongolo river, this range crosses the
-Oliphant and touches the Limpopo. Its highest elevation is about 2150
-feet high, and at the point at which the Umvolosi passes through the
-range to Delagoa Bay there is a lofty peak which reaches to 1900 feet,
-the river bed being there only 300 feet above sea level. Further north
-the range declines, and is cut through by the Pongolo and the Usuta,
-tributaries of the Maputa; also by the Umvolosi, the Umcomazi, the
-Sabia, and the Oliphant, all of which run into the Indian Ocean. Such
-were the features of the landscape, and such was the background to this
-farewell parade.
-
-After the division had wheeled into line a very creditable march past
-was performed, and the troops then wheeled into a square, and were
-addressed by General Crealock, who told them that, in obedience to
-orders received from Sir Garnet Wolseley, the column was to be broken up
-and dispersed. The General said that he took this opportunity, before
-separating, to thank all hands for their good conduct and constant hard
-work, carried on without a murmur and in the midst of many difficulties.
-The task allotted to the 1st Division was to establish a series of posts
-along the coast of Zululand with an advanced depôt of supplies, to open
-a base of supplies at Port Durnford, from which to feed a force
-operating against Ulundi, and finally to destroy the military kraals and
-clear the district of Zulus. All these instructions were fully carried
-out by the 1st Division by the 5th of July; and the General, in wishing
-them a hearty good-bye and success and prosperity, thanked all for the
-good conduct and zeal which enabled him to do so much.
-
-Lord Chelmsford, who was now on his way home to England, received most
-enthusiastic receptions at Maritzburg, Durban, and Capetown. The banquet
-given in his honour at Pietermaritzburg was, perhaps, the most brilliant
-affair of the kind ever achieved in the colony, but there were those who
-considered the ball in Durban as a still greater, for there were more
-ladies and officers present who had come long distances to assist at the
-festivity. Sir Garnet Wolseley and the Lieutenant Governor, Sir Evelyn
-Wood, and his _Fidus Achates_, Colonel Buller, Major-General Clifford,
-and all the fighting and dancing men within a hundred miles of the place
-responded to the call. Durban never before saw such a display of "rank,
-beauty, and fashion." All the belles of Natal were there to welcome the
-winner of Ulundi, and to sympathize with him in his efforts, under
-adverse criticisms and untoward fortune, to do his duty as a soldier of
-our Queen. The general feeling of the colony may be gathered from the
-mayor's speech, who, in proposing his lordship's health, said that he
-felt doubly proud on the occasion, as he did not speak alone for
-himself, but in the name and with the voice of all Natal. Against
-difficulties which only colonial experience could realize, and against
-bitter and most vituperative criticism, Lord Chelmsford had worked
-steadily and patiently until he accomplished the object he was sent to
-perform. The General, in reply, expressed in a soldierlike and
-impressive manner his deep sense of the kind feelings expressed by the
-mayor, and acknowledged that the reception accorded to him had quite
-overwhelmed him. But in giving his acknowledgments and thanks, his
-lordship made a happy allusion to the devotion and zeal of those who
-commanded and fought under him; and when he came to the mention of
-Evelyn Wood and Redvers Buller--two names which, he said, represented
-all that a soldier could show in loyalty and efficiency--his modest
-eulogium upon these, "his right hand and left hand supports during the
-war," was perhaps the most well received and telling point of his
-address. That Wood's services were appreciated by the colonists may be
-gathered from the fact that he was most warmly solicited by Mr. Gordon
-Sprigg, the Premier, to accept the appointment of Commandant-General of
-the Colonial Forces; and this request was made by the almost unanimous
-wish of the whole ministry. Sir Evelyn, however, did not feel at liberty
-to accept till he had consulted with the authorities at home.
-
-On August 5th, Lord Chelmsford, Sir Evelyn Wood, Colonel Crealock,
-Colonel Buller, Major Grenfell, Captain Molyneux, and Captain Buller,
-embarked on board the Union steamship "German," and sailed for England,
-where they arrived safely and were received with the honours they had so
-worthily deserved.
-
-After the meeting of chiefs on the 19th, at the camp on the Umlatoosi,
-Sir Garnet Wolseley returned to Pietermaritzburg. Here he was engaged in
-arranging matters of detail until July 29th. Disturbances in Pondoland
-and the Transvaal also now claimed his attention. In the former the
-Pondos had attacked the Xesibes, a tribe in alliance with England and
-under British protection. Hither Lieutenant-Colonel Bayley, with a
-detachment of Cape Mounted Rifles, was despatched from Butterworth, and
-soon succeeded in putting an end to this trouble. In the Transvaal the
-Boers were agitating for a repeal of the union, and threatening to
-assert their independence by force of arms. To render matters secure in
-this quarter Sir Garnet sent the headquarters of the King's Dragoon
-Guards, under Colonel Alexander, to Pretoria. On the 30th the Commander
-and his staff moved to Greytown and thence on, with a small escort, to
-the temporary camp at Umsingu. Travelling herefrom with all speed he
-reached Rorke's Drift early the following morning (August 3rd).
-Despatches were waiting here for the Commander-in-chief, and determined
-the next week's movements. Cetywayo was still reported in a kraal in the
-Ngome, while letters were at hand from Villiers giving anything but a
-flattering account of his friend Oham and his promised Burgher and
-native levies. M'Leod also wrote to point out the difficulties under
-which he was labouring with his Swazis, and asking for some European
-troops to be sent to him to keep them under control. Villiers was
-concentrating his heterogeneous gathering of levies at Luneberg, and
-hoped to be ready on or by the 6th; while M'Leod suggested that he
-should merely guard the frontier to prevent Cetywayo's escape, and not
-tempt his savages with the sight of their enemy's kraals or cattle; for
-to allow them to cross the border would be, he wrote, risking murder,
-rapine, and all sorts of atrocities, which, if once begun, it would be
-impossible to stop.
-
-So little is generally known of the Swazis, that a short description of
-their persons and habits may here be acceptable. What are usually called
-Swazis are, in reality, somewhat a mongrel race, being a cross between
-the Zulu and the old race of Swaziland. The Swazis living along the
-borders of the Wakkerstroom, until late owed allegiance to Cetywayo, and
-some of them indeed had fought for him, notably Manyoyaba, a chief
-paramount in the Abakalusian district. But quarrels arose between the
-two races and they became most bitter foes; indeed once the Swazis were
-near extermination at the hands of the Zulus.
-
-The whole tribe possess characteristically broad heads with thick hair,
-which would be as frizzly as that of a negro were it not carefully
-dressed in the Zulu fashion with plaster of grease and red clay. Their
-eyes, almond-shaped and somewhat sloping, are shaded with thick,
-sharply-defined brows, and are of remarkable size and fulness. The wide
-space between them testifies to the unusual width of the skull, and
-contributes a mingled expression of animal ferocity, warlike resolution,
-and, strange to say, ingenuous candour. A flat, square nose, a mouth of
-about the same width as the nose, with very thick lips; a round chin,
-and full, plump cheeks complete the countenance which may be described
-as circular in its general contour. The bodies of the Swazis are
-generally inclined, like those of the Zulus, to be fat, but they are
-seldom wanting in muscular strength. They are fairly well proportioned,
-but the upper part of the figure is somewhat long in proportion to the
-legs, and this peculiarity gives a strange character to their movements,
-although it does not seem any bar to their agility in their war-dances.
-Nothing can be more simple than the ordinary headgear of the women. It
-would, however, be a matter of some difficulty to find any kind of
-plait, tuft, or topknot, which has not been used by the Swazi men. The
-hair is usually parted right down the middle; towards the forehead it
-branches off so as to leave a kind of triangle, and from the fork which
-is thus formed, a tuft is raised and carried back to be fastened behind.
-On either side of this tuft the hair is arranged in rolls, like the
-ridges and crevices of a melon, while over the temples separate rolls
-are gathered up into knots, from which hang more tufts, twisted like a
-cord, that fall in bunches round the neck, three or four of the largest
-tresses being allowed to go free over the breast and shoulders. A
-favourite decoration is formed with the teeth of a dog strung together
-under the hair and hanging along the forehead like a fringe. Another
-ornament not at all uncommon is worn by some, and this is ivory cut in
-imitation of lions' teeth, and arranged in radial fashion round the
-breast, the effect of the white substance in contrast with the dark skin
-being very striking. The weapons of the Swazis are much the same as
-those of the Zulus, but they have more variety in shape and quality of
-the assegai. The shields are smaller, and usually woven of stout reeds
-and then covered with undressed hide. They use also a heavy kind of
-lance which is adapted to the chase of large game.
-
-A favourite amusement is a kind of war-dance, in which a warrior
-describes a conflict in which he was once engaged. Thus a chief may be
-often seen with his assegais in one hand, his woven shield and
-knobkerrie in the other, with his knife in his girdle, and his limbs
-encircled by a skin, to which are attached the tails of the wild cat and
-other animals. Adorned on his breast and on his forehead by strings of
-teeth, the trophies of war or of the chase, his large keen eyes gleaming
-from beneath his heavy brow, his white and pointed teeth shining from
-between his parted lips, he alternately advances and retires before an
-imaginary foe, with a wild yet dramatic grace, which adds life and
-reality to the tale he is telling. In describing these people, it is
-hard to determine how far they should be deemed a race of hunters or of
-agriculturists, the two occupations being apparently equally distributed
-between the sexes. The men most assiduously devote themselves to their
-hunting, and leave the care of the cattle and the culture of the soil to
-be carried on exclusively by the women. Now and then, indeed, the men
-bring home fruits, tubers, and funguses from their excursions in the
-forests, but practically they do nothing for their families beyond
-providing them with game. The agriculture of Swaziland, like that of
-Zululand involves but a small amount of labour. The area of the arable
-land is certainly limited, but the exuberant productiveness of the soil,
-scarcely to be surpassed in any part of the world, makes the cultivation
-of the country supremely easy, and provides the people with all they
-want. The entire land is, besides, pre-eminently rich in spontaneous
-products, animal and vegetable alike, and these conduce to a direct
-maintenance in comparative ease of human life. Manioc, sweet potatoes,
-yams, are cultivated with little trouble, and all yield good crops.
-Plantains are rarely seen. Although the Swazis have a few carefully
-prepared dishes, of which they partake on high feasts and festivals, in
-a general way they exhibit as little nicety or choice in their diet as
-the Amaxosas or the Zulus. They have one dish, however, on which they
-pride themselves, and this most palatable mess is composed of the pulp
-of fresh maize, ground or pounded while the grain is soft and milky,
-cleansed from the bran, and prepared carefully, so that it is not burnt
-to the bottom of the pot. The mode of preparation is ingenious. A little
-water having been put over the fire, until it is just beginning to boil,
-the raw meal, which has previously been rolled into small lumps, is very
-gently shaken in, and, having been allowed to simmer for a time, the
-whole is finally stirred up together. The acme, however, of all earthly
-enjoyments to these people would seem to be meat. "Meat!" is a watchword
-that one hears in all their campaigns, and beyond all doubt the alacrity
-with which these people responded to M'Leod's appeal was caused by the
-anticipations of devouring Cetywayo's cattle. Amongst their other
-accomplishments may be mentioned the art they possess of making from
-malted eleusine a very palatable species of beer. This drink, which by
-the Swazis is prepared from the eleusine, is really capable, from the
-skill with which it is manipulated, of laying a very fair claim to be
-known as beer. It is quite bright, of a reddish pale brown colour, and
-is regularly brewed from the malted grain, without the addition of any
-extraneous ingredient. It has, moreover, a pleasant bitter flavour
-derived from the dark husks, which, if they were mixed in their natural
-condition with the dough, would impart a twang that would be exceedingly
-unpalatable. How large is the proportion of beer consumed by the Swazis
-may be estimated by simply observing the ordinary manner in which they
-store their corn. As a rule there are three granaries allotted to each
-dwelling, of which two are made to suffice for the supply which is to
-contribute the meal necessary for the household, and the other is
-entirely devoted to the grain that has been malted.
-
-On August 4th Sir Garnet Wolseley left Rorke's Drift, and, after
-inspecting the several posts _en route_, reached Intanjaneni on the
-evening of the 6th. Intanjaneni is admirably situated for a central
-rendezvous as well as a depôt of supplies. It is on the left bank of the
-Umlatoosi, or Slater's River, a stream which is constantly confounded
-by careless geographers with the Umlalazi, which is ten miles further to
-the south-west. Hither General Clarke and his column had preceded him;
-messengers also had already come in from Umnyama, Cetywayo's prime
-minister, from Tyengwayo, who was second in command at Isandhlwana, and
-likewise from the headmen Usukame and Umkilebani; all these men said
-they would come in if their lives were spared and their property not
-confiscated. Many other chiefs were also in correspondence and treaty
-with the General, and all had promised to come to Ulundi on the 10th
-August.
-
-On the 7th August messengers came from another chief of importance, by
-name Mbelebele, whose kraal was situated on the eastern bank of the
-Black Umvolosi, about twenty miles N.N.E. of the old kraal at Ondini. A
-party was sent, in accordance with his request, to meet him halfway
-between his kraal and Fort Victoria, the new post near Ulundi. The
-interview, which took place at the foot of the mountain range of the
-Lebombo, was short and satisfactory.
-
-Mbelebele brought with him over 200 guns. He also brought information
-that Mangondo, another chief whose dwelling is near the Inkankla, would
-surrender if assured of safety against the vengeance of the king.
-Mbelebele seems to have been a man much trusted by the other chiefs, as
-he had been in correspondence with the younger brother of Cetywayo,
-Tyami, Usmwelu, Usiteon, and with Sekatewayo, a northern chief, who all
-manifested a wish to come in and surrender their arms, cattle, and
-ammunition, provided life and safety were assured. The chief, in
-speaking of the king, although somewhat reticent on some points, was
-certainly not so on others, and stoutly maintained that Cetywayo had
-doubled upon his pursuers, and so far from being, as was thought, on his
-way westward to Secocoeni, was in all likelihoods heading back towards a
-kraal beyond the Lebombo range, called Mussipulo. This information, of
-course, was at once sent to Lord Gifford and to Colonel Baker Russell.
-
-Sir Garnet Wolseley's next move was on to Fort Victoria, Ulundi, where
-he arrived on August 9th. On the following day he received information
-which eventually led to the capture of Cetywayo; but of this we shall
-speak hereafter.
-
-
-
-
-CHAPTER XIV.
-
- Plans for the capture of Cetywayo--The Jantjis--Vijn's appearance at
- Victoria--His narrative--Its consequences--Despatch of Major Barrow
- and Lord Gifford in pursuit of the king--Their march--Description of
- country traversed--Gifford and Maurice sent on by Barrow--Marches
- and countermarches--Physical characteristics of country; its flora
- and fauna--Visit to kraal of friendly Zulus--Capture of two of the
- king's attendants--Women of the king's household captured--Captain
- and twenty Basutos join Lord Gifford--Gifford's stratagem to obtain
- information of the king's hiding-place--Cetywayo's refuge
- discovered--Forced night-march--Message to Major Marter--His arrival
- on the scene--Capture of the king.
-
-
-Meantime the meshes of the net spread for King Cetywayo's capture were
-being more and more closely woven. Colonel Villiers, who it has been
-before mentioned had been sent to Oham's district, having got together a
-force of 65 Europeans and 3050 natives in a fair state of organization,
-had by August 13th advanced as far as the Assegai river, so as to form a
-junction with M'Leod and his 5000 Swazis, at that time on the banks of
-the Pongolo, and thus complete the chain round that side of the Zulu
-country.
-
-Lord Gifford, with a number of Jantjis, was following up the king,
-whilst 200 of the 57th were also in pursuit, carefully patrolling the
-hills that lay beyond Amansekranze, ably seconded by 500 of Barton's
-natives. The Intanjaneni district, from Middle Drift to Victoria and
-St. Paul's, was laid down with a line of piquets, whose orders were to
-keep strict watch by night and day. The escape of the Zulu monarch
-therefore appeared an impossibility. The Jantjis just spoken of merit a
-few words of description, not only on account of the good services they
-rendered, but also because in some points they differ vastly from other
-South African tribes. The men of this race are fine, active, and well
-made, standing not unusually six feet in height. Their clothing consists
-simply of a blanket, worn in peace time in the manner of a Roman toga,
-but on the war-path invariably discarded for a simple belt of wild-cats'
-tails. Their weapons are the light assegai, or umkhonto, and this spear
-can be thrown by them to the distance of seventy or eighty yards, when
-at that it will have sufficient strength to enter a man's body. Many of
-the men even brought their guns, and showing Lord Gifford how expert
-they were in their use, were allowed to carry and employ them, instead
-of the original native weapon. The Jantjis, like the Kaffirs first, and
-then the Zulus, are beginning to find out that the assegai is not a
-match for a gun; consequently, as they have money, they procure a
-tolerably large number of them. Like most of the Zulu tribes, they build
-wickerwork huts, and thatch these with the long tambookie grass. These
-huts are, as usual, arranged in a circle, and thus form a village, or,
-as we should say, a kraal. The men, unlike the Zulus, are very fond of
-horses, and most of them can ride. This makes them most useful as
-mercenaries and levies. As they ride well, it is a pretty sight to see
-those who are chosen as orderlies dashing along with the letter-bag
-upon the smart little horses given them by Government. They utterly
-disdain the use of a saddle, and always gallop along at full speed, with
-an ostrich feather (if a chief) streaming in the wind, and some wild
-animal's skin worn hussar fashion, and floating behind. Even with their
-long black legs almost touching the ground, there is nothing grotesque
-in their appearance, though doubtless in London such a horseman would
-cause astonishment. Dashing up with a letter or heliographic message
-from Sir Garnet, these fellows bring their horses to a sudden stand, as
-Bedouins do, sending the mould and grit beneath the hoofs flying in the
-air. Saluting then most gracefully, with the spearhead to the earth, the
-messenger springs to the ground, and hands in his _paquet_.
-
-To resume our narrative. On Sunday afternoon (10th August), as Sir
-Garnet Wolseley was walking with an aide-de-camp near the camp at Fort
-Victoria, Ulundi, a man on foot was observed, apparently lame and
-feeble, making the best of his way towards our camp. With glasses it
-could be made out that he came along with difficulty, limping much, and
-occasionally casting a furtive glance behind, as if in danger of being
-pursued. As ponies were ready at hand and saddled, Sir Garnet mounted
-and cantered out of the camp to see who the man was. On coming to close
-quarters he found the wayfarer to be no less a personage than one
-Cornelius Vijn, a Dutch trader of Natal, who was known to have been a
-prisoner for some time at Cetywayo's kraal. His aspect and general
-appearance were, to put it mildly, more those of a badly-dressed
-scarecrow than those of a human being, and his haggard and hungry
-contour, his wearied look, lean and meagre, with eyes deeply sunk in
-their orbits, and his parchment-like cheeks, hollow and cavernous, all
-spoke with an eloquent voice of the ordeal he must have undergone while
-the enforced guest of King Cetywayo. The aide-de-camp, having with him a
-flask and some biscuits, was enabled to somewhat revive the fugitive,
-who then informed them who he was, and how he had managed to escape from
-the king's thrall. As his information was considered highly important,
-Sir Garnet desired Mr. Vijn to narrate briefly his story out of hearing
-of the camp in order that any future operations or measures, consequent
-upon the information given, might not transpire to the outer world. The
-necessity for this precaution had been of late forced upon the General,
-who had had many of his plans and movements made known by those upon
-whose discretion while at headquarters he thought he could vouch for.
-Besides, since his arrival in Natal, Sir Garnet had achieved all his
-successes by striking without warning, and by carefully concealing the
-movements of troops, stores, &c., from all but those actually in command
-where the movement was to be made; and there was but little doubt that
-the Zulus, in the earlier portion of the war, obtained much of their
-information from the Dutch, at least from that section of the Boers who
-thought it their interest to see the English army unsuccessful, and who
-consequently made known to the enemy the British weak points.
-
-Mr. Vijn's narrative, although very long, did not contain many details
-of general interest. He left Natal for trading purposes as far back as
-the 29th of October, 1878, and about the middle of January fell into
-the power of the king, who, however, does not seem to have treated him
-at all rigorously, but allowed him to remain at one of his brother's
-kraals under a sort of friendly supervision. During this detention Mr.
-Vijn appears to have kept a sort of journal, which has a certain value,
-as showing the opinions of the king, his brothers, and the Zulu people
-in regard to the war. As Mr. Vijn's information regarding the movements
-and whereabouts of the king was both authentic and valuable, and as he
-volunteered to return to Cetywayo and persuade him to surrender, Sir
-Garnet decided to avail himself of such offer. His presence near the
-camp was, however, kept entirely secret, and having been allowed to rest
-and refit, he was despatched on his return journey, pledging himself to
-return if possible by Tuesday evening with the king's answer. On the
-following Wednesday Mr. Vijn came back to the camp, and reported that
-his mission had been unsuccessful, as the king had left the kraals where
-Vijn had last seen him, and had fled away to the north towards the Ngome
-forest. As soon as this news was communicated to Sir Garnet,
-instructions were given to Major Barrow to take a troop of the King's
-Dragoon Guards, sixty mounted infantry, some colonial levies and
-natives, making in all a force of 220 whites and eighty natives, and to
-proceed into the territory of those chiefs who were still holding out,
-and where, it was supposed, the king had taken refuge. Major Marter,
-K.D.G., Captain Maurice, Lord Gifford, Captain Hardy, Captain Hay, and
-Mr. Herbert accompanied Major Barrow, and they merely took with them, to
-be in as light marching order as possible, three days' preserved
-rations--their commander wisely assuming that they would find no great
-difficulty in foraging as they went on. Half an hour after the order to
-parade was given they were all in the saddle and ready for the road. Sir
-Garnet, accompanied by Colonel Colley, minutely inspected men, horses,
-equipment, rations, and ammunition, and, after addressing a few private
-words of advice to the officers, bade them "God-speed."
-
-Proceeding north-eastward at starting they soon came to the little river
-Umbellan, which, flowing past the dense bush of the district, ultimately
-joins the Umvolosi. At this time of the year it is about twenty feet
-deep, and murmurs along a channel of from twenty to thirty feet wide,
-now and then forming deep basins, which were found to be full of fish.
-Soon after midnight the junction of the Black Umvolosi was reached, and
-the first night's camp was made near a fine tamarind-tree, which was
-noted as a landmark in case of a return that way. At this season there
-was a rather heavy dew towards daybreak, but the nights were calm, and,
-in comparison with the day, considerably colder than would be expected.
-
-Just as the party was ready and preparing to start, after an early meal
-in the morning, some natives came from a neighbouring kraal with the
-information that on the previous night one of their best oxen, having
-strayed outside the cattle enclosure, had been seized and carried off by
-a lion. It had already been stated by John Dunn that the district
-through which they had to pass had been for some years infested with
-lions, and lately the casualties had been so frequent that the
-inhabitants were commencing to migrate. The Umvolosi at its junction
-with the Umbellan is about the same size as the latter river, and at
-this point makes a most remarkable bend from south-east to north-east,
-but its general direction for some distance in this district is due
-north, the stream flowing between banks twenty or thirty feet in height,
-with an average width of full forty feet and a depth of only three feet.
-The velocity of the current, however, was 120 feet a minute. Leaving
-Amansekranze, they marched about nine miles towards the north-west,
-having on their left the Black Umvolosi, and on their right the huge
-terraces and wood-crowned ravines of the Lebombo mountains. The woods
-came down to the river as it flowed between its rocky banks; and farther
-north-west some wide meadow-like flats were crossed, containing water
-basins almost as large as lakes. Several kinds of antelope of the larger
-sort, waterbucks, and hartebeests appeared, and as the troopers managed
-to wound and ride down several, their nightly bivouac in the forest was
-solaced by a feast of excellent venison. Between the Umvolosi and the
-Lebombo range the previous uniformity of the rocks began to be broken by
-projections of gneiss and by scattered hills. About twelve miles from
-the junction of the rivers at Amansekranze a remarkable illustration of
-this formation was passed, where huge blocks of stone rose in mounds
-from which colossal obelisks could be cut. These elevated places
-alternated with extensive flats as level as a table-top. In keeping with
-this weird and fantastic scenery and eccentric native architecture is
-the peculiarity of the conies or rock rabbits that have their dwelling
-among the crevices of the gneiss. Soon after the sun went down, and just
-before sunrise, they were to be seen all round squatting like natives at
-the entrance of their holes, into which at the slightest noise or sound
-of danger they darted with the most extraordinary snorts and grunts.
-There is, however, a great variety of species--difficult for one who is
-not a skilled naturalist to distinguish the one from the
-other--scattered through the whole of Zululand, each district seeming to
-present its own representative. They appear to feed chiefly on the bark
-of trees, although they will occasionally devour young shoots and grass.
-Distinct from anything in the more civilized parts of South Africa was
-the aspect of the landscape presented to view on the second morning of
-the march. From the heights to which Barrow and his men had ascended,
-and as far as the eye could reach, there extended a wide, grassy plain,
-broken artistically by huge stones of the most fantastic outline and by
-thickets and single trees. Graceful and luxuriant palms of the fan
-species waved above the groves, while the russet autumnal tints gave a
-rich colouring to the scenery; every rock, with its wealth of covering
-parasites, being a picture in itself. In the far north could be seen the
-Mussipulo and the distant portions of the Lebombo, whose purple peaks
-stood out in bold relief in the pale azure of the horizon. In the far
-distance, and in the direction of the Amatongas, the country had the
-deep and luscious blue of a Neapolitan sky, mellowed, however, as it
-came nearer and nearer into the most bewitching tints of grey and a
-golden brown that Titian would have loved to paint. In the foreground
-were the sturdy troopers of Marter's squadron grouped in picturesque
-disorder as the process of saddling went on. These with their bright
-uniforms, and the glint of steel scabbard, spur, and chain, were thrown
-out by the splendid hues of a foliage rich and alternating with the
-varied tints of red, yellow, and olive green, lightened up with the glad
-freshness of the sprouting shrubs, the deep red of the numerous
-ant-hills and the silver grey of the jutting rocks.
-
-After leaving the river, the way at first led over what for horses
-alone, without wheels, was fair trekking ground. They then descended for
-about five miles, coming gradually down the slopes to a sort of rough
-trampled pathway, evidently made by a herd of driven cattle. Here could
-be distinctly traced the spoor, and here the king's cattle had evidently
-been driven. Now dipping into a deep hollow, where the grass grew in
-rank luxuriance, now topping a gentle rise and stopping to listen if
-they could hear the distant horns of the Zulu sounded when they announce
-the proximity of an enemy,--the horsemen neared the forest-land at the
-foot of the steep mountain range. Troops of eland crossed their path now
-and then, and occasionally a herd of koodoo. They now came to the end of
-the plain, and had to pass over a much more difficult country, where
-they could scarcely manage to get along two abreast, and sometimes in
-Indian file. The onward path at one portion of the kloof seemed
-completely barred by a closely set forest of underwood bush of dwarf
-acacia and creepers of the most tangled nature. Indeed it seemed at one
-time impossible to pass, but Lord Gifford, after a search of some
-moments, found the dry bed of a stream, up which, he said, they might
-have a chance of progressing. They had now to dismount and lead their
-horses, and slowly and with the greatest difficulty made their way on,
-sometimes crawling on hands and knees, and having to drag their rifles
-after them, winning way patiently, yard by yard, and almost inch by
-inch. Sometimes they were fairly stopped by huge masses of rock, and
-even compelled to cut a road through the spiky branches of the mimosa,
-which were bound up tightly together with the wild vines and creeping
-cane-like plants. For more than a mile did the column toil on through
-this ravine, their clothes torn, and face and hands bleeding from the
-thorns.
-
-The morning after the first day's march brought them to the kraals where
-the king had been a fortnight previous to his flight, as stated to Sir
-Garnet by the Dutch trader, and it was no surprise to find these kraals
-burnt to the ground, and completely deserted. Therefore, after a brief
-halt, they pushed on, and did not draw rein until it became only too
-evident that the tired horses could go no further. They had been more
-than three and twenty hours in the saddle, and the weight of the
-dragoons had told severely upon Marter's horses, which, after the last
-ten miles under a most burning sun, and over rough and broken ground,
-were nearly all done up. On coming to the next kraal they found they
-were still upon the right track, as they gleaned sufficient intelligence
-to know that the king had slept there on the day preceding. He had,
-however, been warned by scouts and signal-fires,--the latter had been
-noticed as they came along,--and had decamped in time to get a good
-start. At this point Major Barrow decided to leave the King's Dragoon
-Guards behind, and push on with the lighter portion of his mounted men,
-and this arrangement was carried out with the understanding that the
-"King's" should follow as soon as their horses were fit. Once more,
-therefore, Barrow set out, and, as he subsequently found, was upon the
-king's trail for two clear days, having by dint of bribery and threats
-extorted information as to the king's intentions. On Thursday the column
-had a fearfully fatiguing and at the same time disappointing day. They
-reached another kraal at sundown, having travelled over a most difficult
-and hilly country all day. Major Barrow decided to bivouac at this
-kraal, and to start during the night should the moon give sufficient
-light. The moon, however, rose so late that it was really sunrise when
-they were on the move on Friday morning. Lord Gifford was now sent on
-ahead with a few men, and it was subsequently found afterwards that he
-and Captain Hardy chased and nearly caught one of the king's principal
-attendants. This man would have been caught had he not dexterously
-abandoned his horse, and, taking to the jungle, managed to elude further
-pursuit. Meanwhile the main body followed on, and on Saturday came to
-another kraal. One of the king's personal attendants was here captured,
-who having been frightened by a little threatening, showed where the
-king had stayed and slept on Thursday. This fellow's statements were
-somewhat contradictory and improbable. He wished Major Barrow to believe
-that the king meditated changing the direction of his flight and
-endeavouring to gain the Inkhangla bush, which is as nearly as possible
-opposite the Tugela middle drift. But to make this point the king would
-have had to get through the line of posts stationed in this district,
-and this made the story seem improbable. Major Barrow, however, taking
-the remote chance of the man being truthful, and having no better
-information, allowed the Zulu to take him in a retrograde and southerly
-direction, until he met another Zulu messenger, who said he had heard
-nothing of the king along the road he came. Major Barrow therefore
-retraced his steps to the camp of the main body on the Black Umvolosi,
-and sent Lord Gifford and Captain Maurice on with eight men to get some
-cattle from a kraal and obtain what information he could.
-
-The first destination of this party was a kraal with cattle and mealies,
-and this was said to be about seven miles from where they were then
-halted. On reaching the said kraal on Saturday afternoon they surprised
-some Zulu boys, and partly by threats and partly by persuasion induced
-them to come on to another kraal, seven miles off. These boys, after
-some pressing, confessed that on the previous day (Friday), the king had
-endeavoured to double back towards the south, and had slept within a
-mile of where they had bivouacked, and had actually passed the kraal
-where they then were. This intelligence confirmed the story that had
-previously been told by the king's attendant, and the information was at
-once sent back to Major Barrow. On Saturday night they slept in the
-kraal they had reached in the afternoon, having during the day visited a
-number of smaller kraals and villages, in which they captured many
-assegais and other weapons. They thus had made a circuit and were now
-heading almost due south, and though they had now been four clear days
-in the saddle, had managed their three days' supply of rations so well
-that they had still a reserve to fall back upon. This feat of
-commissariat skill was accomplished by obtaining wherever they could
-such simple supplies as the kraals afforded--sour milk, Indian corn
-cakes made of mealies, pumpkin, sweet potatoes, and now and then a
-little Kaffir beer, which after a time, and when the taste is acquired,
-is not such very bad stuff. Sunday, the 17th, was a most eventful day.
-Lord Gifford paraded his men, and they started, as usual, just before
-sunrise, their destination being an important military kraal, which they
-had every reason to believe the king must have visited. The gallant
-leader had on the previous evening induced two Zulu boys to accompany
-his men as guides, for the shortest way was through the forest and
-across country, where it was impossible to find the smallest trace of a
-trek. When they set out, the whole of the wood was veiled in mist, and
-the ground was yet reeking with the early dew. But as the light came on
-they were rewarded by seeing an immense variety of forest shrubs.
-Especially beautiful was the _Encephalartos_, which grew in abundance;
-most noticeable too was a cabbage-shaped _Euphorbia_, as well as a large
-variety of conspicuous shrubs, many of them covered with such fine
-blossoms as to give the wilderness the aspect of an artificial park.
-
-About three miles to the right, and to the south of the ford last
-crossed, rose several thickly-wooded hills, and in the kloofs could be
-seen the smoke of kraals. The guides had by this time become quite
-friendly and confidential, and by their advice more than one of these
-kraals were surrounded, in hope that if they did not see the king they
-might hear of his more recent movements. At three of these kraals they
-captured arms and ammunition, and filled their haversacks with mealies,
-but could gain no tidings of Cetywayo, although they knew he could not
-be far off. In one instance they thought they had discovered their
-prize, as coming out of the forest they saw a portion of open country
-before them and several natives on horseback and on foot about two miles
-away to their right. The scenery they were now approaching towards the
-south-west assumed a character very different to the parklike landscape
-through which they had been passing. For many miles the eye rested upon
-treeless steppes and flats, broken by bamboo and mimosa jungles that
-seemed almost impenetrable, and standing in detached groups, their dark
-olive green contrasted admirably with the bright hue of the grass,
-giving a complete novelty of character to the general aspect. The moment
-the group of natives saw them emerge from the forest they quickened
-their pace, and endeavoured to gain the jungle to their left, while Lord
-Gifford detached three of his men round a small hill to cut them off. A
-most exciting race now commenced, two Basutos joining in the pursuit,
-and taking advantage of every rock and bush to dodge and intercept the
-fugitives. Suddenly the Zulus became aware of the party sent round the
-hill to intercept them, and giving a shout of alarm ran back in the
-direction of the kraal the English troopers had left. This was exactly
-what was required, and galloping right across the plain the troopers
-caught them halfway. These men were found to be Zulus of the
-neighbourhood, and when they were satisfied that their pursuers had no
-hostile intentions they became quite friendly, offering milk and Kaffir
-corn, as well as food for the horses. They professed to be starting on a
-journey to a kraal about ten miles off, belonging to a chief named
-Isnabomlika, who, they said, was anxious for the capture of the king, as
-he had grievously oppressed him. Leaving these men, they continued their
-march, and soon came to a tract of country much better cultivated than
-any they had hitherto seen. Maize-fields (mealies) showed that the
-ground was fertile, and although no cattle was seen, the presence of
-several kraals on the neighbouring hills showed that the district was
-populous.
-
-About midday they reached the large military kraal where it was thought
-probable the king might have stopped. His guides had served him with
-fidelity, and so Lord Gifford promised to reward them at headquarters
-with a present of cattle to each. These lads had made themselves great
-favourites with the men, who seemed quite to fraternize with them. Their
-delight was unbounded when the officers came across and killed with
-their rifles any description of game, and they seemed wonderfully
-impressed with the accuracy of the shooting. They said it had been
-currently reported in their neighbourhood that the king was lame and
-could not travel fast, and that his followers were leaving him every
-day. Just before reaching the kraal one of the lads, an intelligent,
-sharp little fellow, as he was running a few yards in front of the
-horses, pointed out to Lord Gifford the track of cattle leading away to
-the bush on the right. They halted and had a consultation; but it was
-decided not to follow these tracks, but to continue on southwards, their
-object being, if possible, to hem in the king, and drive him on towards
-the pickets of Barrow's party or the scouts of General Clarke, who had
-four companies of infantry, the headquarters of the King's Dragoon
-Guards, and a number of irregulars (cavalry and infantry) encamped at
-the drift of the Black Umvolosi. As they knew that Clarke's patrols were
-scouring the country to the north and east, they had no fear of the
-king's escape in that direction. But little information was gained at
-the big kraal, where they off-saddled for two hours, and fed their
-rather overworked mounts. At three o'clock they again started and now
-made a bend towards Entonjaneni, as by this course it was considered
-they would have the best chance of intercepting the king in his attempt
-to cut through the cordon now drawn around him. The range of hills which
-they now had on their right were the Umyati. They are a continuation of
-the Ngome mountains, which shoot out from the Lebombo towards the west,
-and they form a portion of the ridge bordering the southern or right
-bank of the Black Umvolosi.
-
-On the summit, as far as the eye could reach, there was an extensive
-plateau broken by detached groves and handsome trees, and sloping down
-towards the north to the stream. A few miles on they came to some fine
-tamarinds, under the pleasant shade of which another short halt and
-off-saddle was made. Before reaching the river they had to cross four
-little brooks that flowed in an easterly direction to join it. The
-first of these to the north of the hills was the upper course of the
-Enhlongana, and was full of water in a deep bed enclosed in an avenue of
-trees. A ridge of hills ran parallel to the path on the left, and after
-they had crossed the second brook a mass of red rock, rising to about
-300 feet was observed on the right. The long grass was now very
-troublesome, coming up in some places to the saddle-flaps, and tickling
-the horses in a most unpleasant manner. Towards five o'clock they
-entered the splendid forest of Enhlongana, through which, but ten miles
-to the west, they had passed some ten days before. After the forest came
-an open steppe, with a distant view of the hills in front, which they
-crossed, though more to the west than before. The passage of the
-Enhlongana having been accomplished without mishap, the road began to
-ascend and led through a wood, where the foliage was so dense that it
-was quite impossible to see many steps in front.
-
-It will be observed that there were no less than twelve brooks crossed
-in the interval between the march in the morning and the final bivouac
-on Sunday night. These are all supplied more or less copiously with
-water, even in the dry season; at least so said the guides. Although all
-these streams have their origin quite close to the left bank of the
-Enhlongana, yet they take a very devious course before they actually
-join it; the last five, indeed, do not actually meet the river, but join
-another stream a little to the west called the Ivuma, which unites
-itself with the Black Umvolosi under the Ngome mountain. On this
-watershed bamboo and mimosa jungles extend over an area of many square
-miles. The species of bamboo which is thus found in such masses is not
-so large as that one is accustomed to see in India, Ceylon, or the
-Mauritius; and in the manner of its growth it is not unlike an asparagus
-bed in the summer-time, hundreds of sprouts starting up from a single
-root, and drooping in the most graceful curves over towards the ground.
-In other respects the habit of the plant is similar to the Indian
-bamboo. The night was now coming on; they had ridden at the very least
-thirty-five miles, besides exploring kraals, examining prisoners, and
-galloping after wounded game. All knew and felt instinctively that the
-king was in the toils, that he could not have broken through the network
-spread for him, and that it was a mere question of days as to when he
-would be forced to surrender. The horses were indeed fatigued, but none
-as yet were lame, while the three days' rations of biscuit and preserved
-meats, with which they had started, were almost intact, so well had they
-been husbanded by the men living on what they could shoot or obtain from
-the kraals.
-
-On Sunday night (August 17th) the bivouac was made at the wild mountain
-kraal of Unhlovani; some women, girls, and children were found here, who
-at first were terribly frightened at the approach of the troopers, but
-soon became reassured and friendly. Indeed Lord Gifford had a wonderful
-faculty of ingratiating himself with the native races, and, after a
-little persuasion, made one of the chief's daughters confess that,
-although the king did not pass by this particular kraal, his attendants
-did but two days since. She also added information of great value,
-namely, that there were but two passes over the mountain they had now
-reached, and that three of the king's wives had passed over the eastern
-road the day before, carrying bundles and food. They further learnt that
-this girl had no possible reason for sympathy for or loyalty to
-Cetywayo, inasmuch as an old Zulu, who stated that she was his niece,
-told them that the king, about two years ago, suspecting her father of
-some pretended conspiracy, had had him smelt out and killed, and that
-the children were at Cetywayo's disposal for sale or gift. On the
-following morning (Monday) the horses were tolerably refreshed. They had
-a good amount of forage given them, and a careful examination of each
-animal showed that no back sinews were strained, and that no sore backs
-had come on. A small supply of sweet potatoes, pumpkins, and a quantity
-of mealies were given to them by the chief's daughters, whose hearts
-their leader had won by explaining to them that the king's reign of
-terror was at an end, and that henceforth they could marry any young
-warrior they pleased. Bidding these Zulu friends adieu, the party were
-in the saddle and on the road by five o'clock; and, ascending by a path
-pointed out by some boys of the kraal, they came to a lofty ridge
-dominating the valley below, and along which they pushed at a fast walk
-for about an hour. From this ridge, which they were following as quickly
-as the rugged nature of the narrow ledge would allow, the view was
-magnificently grand. In the foreground, where they were compelled to
-march in single file, and where a halt was made every now and then to
-allow a straggler to come up, was a most inviting grove, with some of
-the most charming types of tropical vegetation--the large-leaved,
-blue-green anona, the purple _Grewia mollis_, and a number of pretty
-little trees of the pine genus, that gave a Swiss character to the
-scene. Having risen in their march to an elevation of 2000 feet, they
-gazed down upon a fine view of the valley and its meandering rivers
-below. The banks of each stream were marked by rows of tall reeds, and
-the morning sun gleamed upon the mirror of the numerous backwaters,
-while the distance revealed a series of woody undulations in the
-direction of the Norwegian mission station of Enhlongana. Turning
-sharply round a curve in the rocky path, they came suddenly upon a kraal
-nestled in a most secluded and difficult spot, and here they found two
-good-looking and very communicative Zulu girls, who fetched for them
-some capital milk, and, after a little coaxing, told them that the
-king's attendants had passed on that way the previous evening. These
-women, as far as could be gleaned from the interpreter, had also
-suffered some wrong and oppression, and whatever might be the political
-feeling or loyal tendencies of Cetywayo's male subjects, it seemed
-tolerably evident that the Zulu women would have no objection to a
-change of government. These women at the kraal having shown them a short
-cut down one side of the ridge, they hastened on in the hope of
-overtaking some of the king's following, and their activity was soon
-rewarded by discovering a couple of figures making their way hurriedly
-along the lower ledge about a mile from them. One of the officers
-volunteered to proceed on foot to cut these people off by a sort of
-goat-path that seemed practicable down the side of the cliff; and,
-accompanied by one trooper, half-sliding, half-falling, and with a
-desperate scramble, the gallant fellow reached the next ledge at a point
-where it was evident the travellers must pass. In ten minutes they came
-up--a tall and stalwart Zulu with a bundle of assegais, accompanied by a
-lad carrying a sort of canvas bag, something in shape like those in
-which cricketers carry a bat and flannel suit. At the word "Halt!"
-accompanied by a presented revolver, the couple of natives came to a
-stand, and on being questioned declared they were messengers from the
-chief Usibibo to a neighbouring kraal. As this story seemed rather
-doubtful, it was determined to search the cricket-bag, and they were not
-long in finding a trophy that almost repaid them for their many weary
-miles of travel. Inside was a very handsome Henry rifle belonging to the
-king, a small leather handbag, a number of cartridges, and a
-hand-mirror! As such articles do not form the travelling appendages of
-the ordinary Zulu, it was at once seen that they were getting hotter and
-hotter on the trail. While these two were thus carefully examining the
-captured spoil, the main party came winding down the kloof, having
-during their absence come suddenly upon and surprised some more of
-Cetywayo's attendants. A halt was immediately ordered, and the whole of
-the prisoners examined one by one.
-
-Some of the people from the friendly kraal had, in the meantime,
-overtaken the English horsemen, and their presence seemed to act as a
-wonderful incentive to truth on the part of the prisoners. "Tell them,"
-said Lord Gifford, "that if they all speak the truth to our questions we
-will do them no harm and let them go free." This had a wonderful effect,
-and, coupled with a private communication of a confidential nature,
-from the Zulus of the kraal, evidently to the effect that the white
-man's intentions were not hostile to them, it caused the prisoners to
-confess at once that they were of the king's following, and that the
-elder was his personal attendant. From further information then obtained
-from these people it was found that a mile further on, and hidden in a
-cave, were a troop of Zulu girls and other attendants with goods and
-chattels of the king. Guided by these not too faithful adherents of
-Cetywayo, the troopers soon came to where these people were, and they
-surrendered at once without any attempt to escape. These latter
-prisoners appeared to have with them all the paraphernalia of the
-monarch's toilet. There were gums, wax, and unguents for the hair and
-face, brushes, combs, tweezers, scissors, and razors, together with old
-pocket-books, almanacks, gaily-coloured pocket-handkerchiefs, and charms
-and medicine, made of ground human teeth, and hair and skins of
-reptiles, reminding one irresistibly of the ingredients of the witches'
-cauldron in Macbeth. A silk pocket-handkerchief was recognized as
-belonging to Colonel Degacher by the name in its corner, and this was
-almost the only article that could not be considered rags or rubbish.
-While Lord Gifford and his party were holding a solemn Court of Inquiry
-over this burlesque of human vanity a loud whistle was heard, and coming
-round the corner of the ledge, they saw Captain Hay and a Basuto
-approaching at a smart canter. Hay, flinging himself from his panting
-mount, and wiping the perspiration from his forehead, announced that he
-was sent on by Major Barrow, to say that, having himself failed in
-obtaining any traces of the king, and deeming it inadvisable to delay
-the others in waiting for him to catch them up, he had decided to
-increase Lord Gifford's little force with twenty Basutos, under their
-leader, Jantzi, and to leave the pursuit of the king in his (Gifford's)
-hands, while he (Barrow) made his way back to Clarke's camp. Meanwhile,
-the arrival of these additions to the English force seemed to exercise a
-marked influence upon the ladies of the king's household, who
-immediately jumped at the conclusion that Cetywayo had fallen into the
-hands of the soldiers. This had a wonderful effect, as they now
-discovered from the women and attendants where the king had actually
-slept the previous day, and armed with this information, they pushed on,
-bivouacked for the night at the nearest kraal, and started before
-daybreak on the following morning. From these prisoners they learnt,
-moreover, several most important and invaluable pieces of information:
-first, that the poor king was almost deserted; secondly, that he had
-been obliged to abandon his horses; and, thirdly, that he was ill and
-footsore.
-
-From Tuesday, the 19th, until Wednesday, the 27th, long marches were
-incessant, and to describe the adventures that befell this small party
-would be merely a repetition of those already told. The arrival of
-Jantzi and the timely reinforcements of Basutos enabled Lord Gifford to
-detach parties and hem in the fugitive monarch in a manner he could not
-have effected with only nine men. It was now almost a point of honour
-with Gifford that his men should succeed in capturing the king after the
-way in which Barrow had entrusted the pursuit to him; and although he
-knew that the king was pursued by Barton's Native Infantry, three
-companies of the 57th, and 150 of Marter's Dragoons, he still felt
-confident that his party alone were upon the right track. Marter he had
-heard had gone back after losing three of his horses by lions in the
-district through which he had passed; and his only fear now was that the
-Mounted Police would take the wind out of his sails by a rapid move from
-the Transvaal, and capture the king should he attempt to escape towards
-the north. This he considered was not improbable, as he had news from
-Villiers up to the 12th, saying that the tribes in his neighbourhood
-were most unfriendly, and anxious to afford help to the king. Indeed
-they had attempted an attack upon the mixed force organized by Villiers,
-but had been easily beaten off. The movements of Gifford's party from
-the 20th (Wednesday) up to the 26th, were not of special interest. They
-marched and countermarched, the king never far in front, but always
-managing to keep thirty or forty miles between himself and them, and
-their information sometimes right and sometimes wrong, according to the
-feelings of the natives whom they questioned.
-
-On the 25th they had tolerably authentic information that the king had
-decided to come in to Lord Gifford, and surrender. Dabulamanzi, however,
-a brave soldier although a double-dyed and scheming traitor, wrote or
-sent to the king, telling him the English would hang or shoot him if he
-surrendered. Dabulamanzi's object was most transparent. He hoped the
-king might be killed or die in the wilds of starvation, as then he might
-possibly be made the English nominee to the throne.
-
-Jumping over the interval between Monday, 18th August, and that day
-week, during which the pursuer's movements merely resembled those of a
-pack of harriers when "pussy" will keep dodging and doubling over the
-same ground, we may come to the incidents which led up to the king's
-capture. On Monday night, 28th August, scouts came in, who kept Gifford
-and his party well in line with the king's refuge, and although their
-horses were nearly dropping from fatigue they marched on Tuesday and on
-through Tuesday night, until at daybreak on Wednesday they came to a
-large kraal situated close to the Ngome forest, where it was known the
-king had passed the previous night. This kraal was situated in a most
-curious and out-of-the-way portion of the land that skirted the forest,
-and, hidden as it was between two high kops, it might have been easily
-passed unobserved had it not been for the information Lord Gifford had
-been enabled to obtain. They approached this kraal at dusk, and found
-that the king had left early in the morning. Some mats, two blankets,
-and a snuff-box were recognized as belonging to the king. A couple of
-lads were caught, who at first would tell nothing, but Lord Gifford,
-assuming a stern air, ordered them both to be blindfolded, and said in
-their own language, "Shoot first one and then the other!" A volley was
-fired, and the ruse succeeded, for one boy had been led away out of
-sight, and the other, thinking he was shot, exclaimed, "They will kill
-me next; I will confess!" He accordingly said, if his life were spared,
-he would conduct Lord Gifford to the king's hiding-place.
-
-What was to be done? The horses had had a terrible ten days'
-"bucketing," the men were tired, hungry, and incapable of great fatigue;
-but when their chief said, "My lads, we must do it to-night!" every
-heart beat high with enthusiasm, and hunger, thirst, and fatigue, were
-at once forgotten. That night-march, conducted by the Zulu boy, was an
-event that will never be forgotten by those engaged therein. Scarcely
-had the sun disappeared below the horizon when the devoted little band
-started on their way, and the novelty of their position in the
-wilderness could hardly be realized by those who were not used to the
-country--the deep hum of hundreds of insect creatures signalling their
-presence to each other, the lizards and poisonous snakes that crawled
-across the path, the grim, gaunt figure of the beast of prey stalking
-near the projecting rock, the yells of the monkeys, and the howl of the
-wild dogs in the plain. Busy, silent, spectral-like forms passed in the
-night, and, with a snort of terror or a growl of anger, moved out of the
-path, scarcely liking to let pass such defenceless creatures as men seem
-to be, yet apparently in awe of a certain presence which the brute
-creation can never thoroughly overcome. Tiny creeping animals crackled
-the crisp leaves as they scampered about in their fastnesses among the
-bushes, and sniffed the scent of the strange intruder, while the
-noiseless flapping of wings attracted for an instant the soldier's sight
-as some ghostlike moving night-bird flew around and examined the strange
-being that intruded in his domain. Having marched all Tuesday night,
-with men and horses almost dead with fatigue, they arrived at daybreak
-within four miles of the kraal where they were told the king was lying.
-He was, they knew, footsore, weary almost unto death, and so despondent
-that he would scarcely speak to those who still continued with him. Lord
-Gifford, knowing the king could go no farther, deemed his capture more
-certain in the dusk, and accordingly sent back a message to Major
-Marter, who was known to be not far off, for him to come up on the
-opposite side to that on which he and his men were posted. Where Lord
-Gifford was posted was a splendid ambush, as they could see without
-being seen, and during the day they noticed that an ox was killed and
-preparations made for a feast. They also saw Marter's men appear on the
-opposite heights, and then they knew that their task was virtually
-accomplished. Gifford's ambush, it may be remarked, was on the
-south-east side, while Marter had posted his men on the north-east.
-
-The king, it was subsequently learnt, saw Marter, but did not see
-Gifford's men, and he considered that the cavalry could not approach
-without his knowing. But Marter had wisely taken off his saddles, and
-made his men leave their steel scabbards, advancing only with numnahs
-and naked swords, and then, disappearing into the bush as if
-disappointed in his quest, the major stole up quietly by a circuitous
-route to the kraal, and surrounded the king's hut. The Native Contingent
-were actually the men first up, as they were on foot, and could move
-more rapidly than the horses. These fellows dashed at the kraal, saying
-to the king's attendants, "The white man is here, you are caught!" Major
-Marter then rode up quietly to the king's hut, inside the kraal, and
-called upon Cetywayo to surrender. The king said, with a certain amount
-of dignity, "Enter into my hut; I am your prisoner!" Major Marter,
-however, declined this invitation, and prudently invited the king again
-to come forth. This was the final picture! A Zulu kraal is, perhaps, a
-refuge with as little of the picturesque or dignified as any known
-habitation, yet the poor king, somewhat bloated in appearance, weak,
-footsore, and evidently sick at heart, came out of his refuge with a
-royal dignity which could not be surpassed, and when a too heedless
-dragoon tried to touch him, said, in grave and majestic tones, "White
-soldier, do not touch me--I surrender to your chief."
-
-Meanwhile Lord Gifford, to whom, beyond all doubt, the capture was due,
-as he alone tracked down the quarry, galloped in, and the king expressly
-said he surrendered to him, and not to Major Marter. With haughty gaze
-and supremely regal though savage dignity, with head erect, and the mien
-of a Roman Emperor, Cetywayo marched between the two lines of the 60th
-Rifles to his tent, while the men, by the order of Lord Gifford,
-presented arms to him as he passed. Such was the final scene of the Zulu
-War.
-
-
-
-
-NOTE I.
-
-NARRATIVE OF CETYWAYO'S WANDERINGS AFTER ULUNDI, TAKEN FROM HIS OWN
-LIPS.
-
-
-The following account of Cetywayo's movements after the battle of Ulundi
-is of great interest as having been taken directly from his lips since
-he has been confined in Capetown:--
-
-"Cetywayo was not present at Ulundi; he was then at the kraal of a chief
-called Umbonambi, which is situated about three miles north of
-Kwamizekanze. One of Cetywayo's brothers, Uziwetu, in company with
-Vijn, the captured German trader, had posted himself on the summit of
-the Uncungi hill, and thus witnessed the conflict. Men, also, had been
-placed on the look-out, and they brought the news of his army's defeat
-to Cetywayo, who, at once crossing the neck of the Ntabankulu mountains,
-retreated into the bush beyond, where he was joined by Umnyama and other
-chiefs. Vijn and Uziwetu came to the king on the following day, but
-after a short interview withdrew to Uziwetu's kraal of Ematina. Cetywayo
-then retired to Ekushu Maileni, a kraal belonging to Umnyama, his prime
-minister, which is on the banks of the river Isiqmeshi. Arriving here
-three days after the engagement, he received news of the retreat of the
-English army; this determined him to remain where he was; so he lived in
-this kraal for nearly three weeks.
-
-"When information of Sir Garnet Wolseley's advance was brought to him,
-Cetywayo despatched three chiefs to meet the General, and tell him that
-the king was getting together his cattle, and would send them on to Sir
-Garnet by his minister Umnyama, who was then personally engaged in
-collecting the royal herds. These messengers, having fallen in with a
-detachment of Clarke's column, were directed by them to Entonjaneni,
-where they met Sir Garnet on his arrival. Vijn, in the meantime, had, by
-the king's command, gone to Fort Victoria bearing a similar message,
-with this addition, that after the cattle had been received by the
-English commander he would give himself up. During Vijn's absence
-Cetywayo moved on to Zonymana's kraal; here he was rejoined by Vijn, who
-told him that the English were thoroughly determined to capture him.
-Hereupon he sent Vijn a second time to Sir Garnet, with no definite
-proposals, but merely a complaint that he could not give himself up to
-any of the patrols, as he was apprehensive that he would be killed out
-of hand. And there was some ground for this fear, as Dabulamanzi had
-sent a message warning him that the English meant to put him to death,
-and so he had better not yield himself up until the cattle had been
-received and Umnyama made terms for him with the English commander. The
-three first messengers, after leaving Entonjaneni, fell in with Umnyama
-and the cattle near Ulundi, whither they betook themselves, in company
-with that chieftain, instead of returning to Cetywayo.
-
-"The morning following that on which Vijn had been despatched on his
-second embassy the king moved on to the river Mona, and slept that night
-in a kraal upon its bank. On the next morning, having crossed the
-stream, he was ascending the hill that rose on the other side when a
-messenger from his brother Uziwetu came to tell him that soldiers on
-horseback had just visited Zonymana's kraal. He therefore concealed
-himself in the bush, and in no long time beheld the white men's scouts
-on the opposite hill; thereupon he descended the ravine into the Mona
-bush. The same evening he travelled as far as the Black Umvolosi, and
-slept there. On the following day they had scarcely finished killing
-and skinning a couple of oxen when scouts came in to say the white
-horsemen were coming through the bush. The king then bade all the women
-to escape as best they could, whilst he, going out of the bush,
-concealed himself in the long grass on the top of a mound just above the
-drift, whence he could clearly watch the patrol as they passed, and,
-indeed, could hear them speak and laugh. As soon as they had passed, he
-and the five or six followers, who were now all the retainers that
-remained with him, journeyed further up the Black Umvolosi, and lived
-for some days in various kraals. Remaining for three days in the same
-kraal, he was joined by one of his wives. Finding the troops still on
-the trail, he now struck off across country into the Ingome forest,
-where news reached him that Umnyama had, instead of making terms for
-him, promised Sir Garnet Wolseley to use his best endeavours to capture
-the king and to deliver him up should he be found in any of the kraals
-of his (Umnyama's) district. Cetywayo was much grieved at this, and
-exclaimed, 'Why does Umnyama do this? Why does he act treacherously
-towards me? Why does he not send a message to tell me to deliver myself
-up?' He then moved on to the kraal of the Ingome, where four more women
-rejoined him. Here he was taken by Lord Gifford and Major Marter, and
-conducted by them back to Ulundi. On the way one of the women escaped
-into the bush."
-
-
-
-
-NOTE II.
-
-FATE OF CETYWAYO AND FINAL SETTLEMENT OF ZULULAND.
-
-
-Cetywayo was first taken to Sir Garnet Wolseley at Ulundi, and thence by
-that General's orders was conveyed, under an escort commanded by Captain
-Poole, R.A., to Capetown, where he still remains in an honourable
-captivity, treated with all the respect and indulgence due to his
-position.
-
-After Cetywayo's capture no further opposition of any sort was
-encountered in Zululand, but the chiefs and people immediately assented
-to the terms of peace proposed by Sir Garnet, by which the country was
-split up into thirteen districts, each subject to its own chief, while
-supreme over all these was placed a British resident. Native laws and
-customs were to be respected, and European immigration was forbidden.
-Mr. Wheelwright, for some considerable time a magistrate of Natal, was
-appointed the first resident.
-
-
-
-
-GILBERT AND RIVINGTON, PRINTERS, ST. JOHN'S SQUARE, LONDON.
-
-
-
-
-
-End of the Project Gutenberg EBook of The Story of the Zulu Campaign, by
-Waller Ashe and E. V. Wyatt-Edgell
-
-*** END OF THIS PROJECT GUTENBERG EBOOK THE STORY OF THE ZULU CAMPAIGN ***
-
-***** This file should be named 42956-8.txt or 42956-8.zip *****
-This and all associated files of various formats will be found in:
- http://www.gutenberg.org/4/2/9/5/42956/
-
-Produced by Steven Gibbs, Stephen Blundell and the Online
-Distributed Proofreading Team at http://www.pgdp.net
-
-
-Updated editions will replace the previous one--the old editions
-will be renamed.
-
-Creating the works from public domain print editions means that no
-one owns a United States copyright in these works, so the Foundation
-(and you!) can copy and distribute it in the United States without
-permission and without paying copyright royalties. Special rules,
-set forth in the General Terms of Use part of this license, apply to
-copying and distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works to
-protect the PROJECT GUTENBERG-tm concept and trademark. Project
-Gutenberg is a registered trademark, and may not be used if you
-charge for the eBooks, unless you receive specific permission. If you
-do not charge anything for copies of this eBook, complying with the
-rules is very easy. You may use this eBook for nearly any purpose
-such as creation of derivative works, reports, performances and
-research. They may be modified and printed and given away--you may do
-practically ANYTHING with public domain eBooks. Redistribution is
-subject to the trademark license, especially commercial
-redistribution.
-
-
-
-*** START: FULL LICENSE ***
-
-THE FULL PROJECT GUTENBERG LICENSE
-PLEASE READ THIS BEFORE YOU DISTRIBUTE OR USE THIS WORK
-
-To protect the Project Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting the free
-distribution of electronic works, by using or distributing this work
-(or any other work associated in any way with the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg"), you agree to comply with all the terms of the Full Project
-Gutenberg-tm License available with this file or online at
- www.gutenberg.org/license.
-
-
-Section 1. General Terms of Use and Redistributing Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic works
-
-1.A. By reading or using any part of this Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic work, you indicate that you have read, understand, agree to
-and accept all the terms of this license and intellectual property
-(trademark/copyright) agreement. If you do not agree to abide by all
-the terms of this agreement, you must cease using and return or destroy
-all copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in your possession.
-If you paid a fee for obtaining a copy of or access to a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work and you do not agree to be bound by the
-terms of this agreement, you may obtain a refund from the person or
-entity to whom you paid the fee as set forth in paragraph 1.E.8.
-
-1.B. "Project Gutenberg" is a registered trademark. It may only be
-used on or associated in any way with an electronic work by people who
-agree to be bound by the terms of this agreement. There are a few
-things that you can do with most Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works
-even without complying with the full terms of this agreement. See
-paragraph 1.C below. There are a lot of things you can do with Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works if you follow the terms of this agreement
-and help preserve free future access to Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
-works. See paragraph 1.E below.
-
-1.C. The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation ("the Foundation"
-or PGLAF), owns a compilation copyright in the collection of Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic works. Nearly all the individual works in the
-collection are in the public domain in the United States. If an
-individual work is in the public domain in the United States and you are
-located in the United States, we do not claim a right to prevent you from
-copying, distributing, performing, displaying or creating derivative
-works based on the work as long as all references to Project Gutenberg
-are removed. Of course, we hope that you will support the Project
-Gutenberg-tm mission of promoting free access to electronic works by
-freely sharing Project Gutenberg-tm works in compliance with the terms of
-this agreement for keeping the Project Gutenberg-tm name associated with
-the work. You can easily comply with the terms of this agreement by
-keeping this work in the same format with its attached full Project
-Gutenberg-tm License when you share it without charge with others.
-
-1.D. The copyright laws of the place where you are located also govern
-what you can do with this work. Copyright laws in most countries are in
-a constant state of change. If you are outside the United States, check
-the laws of your country in addition to the terms of this agreement
-before downloading, copying, displaying, performing, distributing or
-creating derivative works based on this work or any other Project
-Gutenberg-tm work. The Foundation makes no representations concerning
-the copyright status of any work in any country outside the United
-States.
-
-1.E. Unless you have removed all references to Project Gutenberg:
-
-1.E.1. The following sentence, with active links to, or other immediate
-access to, the full Project Gutenberg-tm License must appear prominently
-whenever any copy of a Project Gutenberg-tm work (any work on which the
-phrase "Project Gutenberg" appears, or with which the phrase "Project
-Gutenberg" is associated) is accessed, displayed, performed, viewed,
-copied or distributed:
-
-This eBook is for the use of anyone anywhere at no cost and with
-almost no restrictions whatsoever. You may copy it, give it away or
-re-use it under the terms of the Project Gutenberg License included
-with this eBook or online at www.gutenberg.org
-
-1.E.2. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is derived
-from the public domain (does not contain a notice indicating that it is
-posted with permission of the copyright holder), the work can be copied
-and distributed to anyone in the United States without paying any fees
-or charges. If you are redistributing or providing access to a work
-with the phrase "Project Gutenberg" associated with or appearing on the
-work, you must comply either with the requirements of paragraphs 1.E.1
-through 1.E.7 or obtain permission for the use of the work and the
-Project Gutenberg-tm trademark as set forth in paragraphs 1.E.8 or
-1.E.9.
-
-1.E.3. If an individual Project Gutenberg-tm electronic work is posted
-with the permission of the copyright holder, your use and distribution
-must comply with both paragraphs 1.E.1 through 1.E.7 and any additional
-terms imposed by the copyright holder. Additional terms will be linked
-to the Project Gutenberg-tm License for all works posted with the
-permission of the copyright holder found at the beginning of this work.
-
-1.E.4. Do not unlink or detach or remove the full Project Gutenberg-tm
-License terms from this work, or any files containing a part of this
-work or any other work associated with Project Gutenberg-tm.
-
-1.E.5. Do not copy, display, perform, distribute or redistribute this
-electronic work, or any part of this electronic work, without
-prominently displaying the sentence set forth in paragraph 1.E.1 with
-active links or immediate access to the full terms of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm License.
-
-1.E.6. You may convert to and distribute this work in any binary,
-compressed, marked up, nonproprietary or proprietary form, including any
-word processing or hypertext form. However, if you provide access to or
-distribute copies of a Project Gutenberg-tm work in a format other than
-"Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other format used in the official version
-posted on the official Project Gutenberg-tm web site (www.gutenberg.org),
-you must, at no additional cost, fee or expense to the user, provide a
-copy, a means of exporting a copy, or a means of obtaining a copy upon
-request, of the work in its original "Plain Vanilla ASCII" or other
-form. Any alternate format must include the full Project Gutenberg-tm
-License as specified in paragraph 1.E.1.
-
-1.E.7. Do not charge a fee for access to, viewing, displaying,
-performing, copying or distributing any Project Gutenberg-tm works
-unless you comply with paragraph 1.E.8 or 1.E.9.
-
-1.E.8. You may charge a reasonable fee for copies of or providing
-access to or distributing Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works provided
-that
-
-- You pay a royalty fee of 20% of the gross profits you derive from
- the use of Project Gutenberg-tm works calculated using the method
- you already use to calculate your applicable taxes. The fee is
- owed to the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark, but he
- has agreed to donate royalties under this paragraph to the
- Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation. Royalty payments
- must be paid within 60 days following each date on which you
- prepare (or are legally required to prepare) your periodic tax
- returns. Royalty payments should be clearly marked as such and
- sent to the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation at the
- address specified in Section 4, "Information about donations to
- the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation."
-
-- You provide a full refund of any money paid by a user who notifies
- you in writing (or by e-mail) within 30 days of receipt that s/he
- does not agree to the terms of the full Project Gutenberg-tm
- License. You must require such a user to return or
- destroy all copies of the works possessed in a physical medium
- and discontinue all use of and all access to other copies of
- Project Gutenberg-tm works.
-
-- You provide, in accordance with paragraph 1.F.3, a full refund of any
- money paid for a work or a replacement copy, if a defect in the
- electronic work is discovered and reported to you within 90 days
- of receipt of the work.
-
-- You comply with all other terms of this agreement for free
- distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm works.
-
-1.E.9. If you wish to charge a fee or distribute a Project Gutenberg-tm
-electronic work or group of works on different terms than are set
-forth in this agreement, you must obtain permission in writing from
-both the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation and Michael
-Hart, the owner of the Project Gutenberg-tm trademark. Contact the
-Foundation as set forth in Section 3 below.
-
-1.F.
-
-1.F.1. Project Gutenberg volunteers and employees expend considerable
-effort to identify, do copyright research on, transcribe and proofread
-public domain works in creating the Project Gutenberg-tm
-collection. Despite these efforts, Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
-works, and the medium on which they may be stored, may contain
-"Defects," such as, but not limited to, incomplete, inaccurate or
-corrupt data, transcription errors, a copyright or other intellectual
-property infringement, a defective or damaged disk or other medium, a
-computer virus, or computer codes that damage or cannot be read by
-your equipment.
-
-1.F.2. LIMITED WARRANTY, DISCLAIMER OF DAMAGES - Except for the "Right
-of Replacement or Refund" described in paragraph 1.F.3, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation, the owner of the Project
-Gutenberg-tm trademark, and any other party distributing a Project
-Gutenberg-tm electronic work under this agreement, disclaim all
-liability to you for damages, costs and expenses, including legal
-fees. YOU AGREE THAT YOU HAVE NO REMEDIES FOR NEGLIGENCE, STRICT
-LIABILITY, BREACH OF WARRANTY OR BREACH OF CONTRACT EXCEPT THOSE
-PROVIDED IN PARAGRAPH 1.F.3. YOU AGREE THAT THE FOUNDATION, THE
-TRADEMARK OWNER, AND ANY DISTRIBUTOR UNDER THIS AGREEMENT WILL NOT BE
-LIABLE TO YOU FOR ACTUAL, DIRECT, INDIRECT, CONSEQUENTIAL, PUNITIVE OR
-INCIDENTAL DAMAGES EVEN IF YOU GIVE NOTICE OF THE POSSIBILITY OF SUCH
-DAMAGE.
-
-1.F.3. LIMITED RIGHT OF REPLACEMENT OR REFUND - If you discover a
-defect in this electronic work within 90 days of receiving it, you can
-receive a refund of the money (if any) you paid for it by sending a
-written explanation to the person you received the work from. If you
-received the work on a physical medium, you must return the medium with
-your written explanation. The person or entity that provided you with
-the defective work may elect to provide a replacement copy in lieu of a
-refund. If you received the work electronically, the person or entity
-providing it to you may choose to give you a second opportunity to
-receive the work electronically in lieu of a refund. If the second copy
-is also defective, you may demand a refund in writing without further
-opportunities to fix the problem.
-
-1.F.4. Except for the limited right of replacement or refund set forth
-in paragraph 1.F.3, this work is provided to you 'AS-IS', WITH NO OTHER
-WARRANTIES OF ANY KIND, EXPRESS OR IMPLIED, INCLUDING BUT NOT LIMITED TO
-WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY OR FITNESS FOR ANY PURPOSE.
-
-1.F.5. Some states do not allow disclaimers of certain implied
-warranties or the exclusion or limitation of certain types of damages.
-If any disclaimer or limitation set forth in this agreement violates the
-law of the state applicable to this agreement, the agreement shall be
-interpreted to make the maximum disclaimer or limitation permitted by
-the applicable state law. The invalidity or unenforceability of any
-provision of this agreement shall not void the remaining provisions.
-
-1.F.6. INDEMNITY - You agree to indemnify and hold the Foundation, the
-trademark owner, any agent or employee of the Foundation, anyone
-providing copies of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works in accordance
-with this agreement, and any volunteers associated with the production,
-promotion and distribution of Project Gutenberg-tm electronic works,
-harmless from all liability, costs and expenses, including legal fees,
-that arise directly or indirectly from any of the following which you do
-or cause to occur: (a) distribution of this or any Project Gutenberg-tm
-work, (b) alteration, modification, or additions or deletions to any
-Project Gutenberg-tm work, and (c) any Defect you cause.
-
-
-Section 2. Information about the Mission of Project Gutenberg-tm
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm is synonymous with the free distribution of
-electronic works in formats readable by the widest variety of computers
-including obsolete, old, middle-aged and new computers. It exists
-because of the efforts of hundreds of volunteers and donations from
-people in all walks of life.
-
-Volunteers and financial support to provide volunteers with the
-assistance they need are critical to reaching Project Gutenberg-tm's
-goals and ensuring that the Project Gutenberg-tm collection will
-remain freely available for generations to come. In 2001, the Project
-Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation was created to provide a secure
-and permanent future for Project Gutenberg-tm and future generations.
-To learn more about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation
-and how your efforts and donations can help, see Sections 3 and 4
-and the Foundation information page at www.gutenberg.org
-
-
-Section 3. Information about the Project Gutenberg Literary Archive
-Foundation
-
-The Project Gutenberg Literary Archive Foundation is a non profit
-501(c)(3) educational corporation organized under the laws of the
-state of Mississippi and granted tax exempt status by the Internal
-Revenue Service. The Foundation's EIN or federal tax identification
-number is 64-6221541. Contributions to the Project Gutenberg
-Literary Archive Foundation are tax deductible to the full extent
-permitted by U.S. federal laws and your state's laws.
-
-The Foundation's principal office is located at 4557 Melan Dr. S.
-Fairbanks, AK, 99712., but its volunteers and employees are scattered
-throughout numerous locations. Its business office is located at 809
-North 1500 West, Salt Lake City, UT 84116, (801) 596-1887. Email
-contact links and up to date contact information can be found at the
-Foundation's web site and official page at www.gutenberg.org/contact
-
-For additional contact information:
- Dr. Gregory B. Newby
- Chief Executive and Director
- gbnewby@pglaf.org
-
-Section 4. Information about Donations to the Project Gutenberg
-Literary Archive Foundation
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm depends upon and cannot survive without wide
-spread public support and donations to carry out its mission of
-increasing the number of public domain and licensed works that can be
-freely distributed in machine readable form accessible by the widest
-array of equipment including outdated equipment. Many small donations
-($1 to $5,000) are particularly important to maintaining tax exempt
-status with the IRS.
-
-The Foundation is committed to complying with the laws regulating
-charities and charitable donations in all 50 states of the United
-States. Compliance requirements are not uniform and it takes a
-considerable effort, much paperwork and many fees to meet and keep up
-with these requirements. We do not solicit donations in locations
-where we have not received written confirmation of compliance. To
-SEND DONATIONS or determine the status of compliance for any
-particular state visit www.gutenberg.org/donate
-
-While we cannot and do not solicit contributions from states where we
-have not met the solicitation requirements, we know of no prohibition
-against accepting unsolicited donations from donors in such states who
-approach us with offers to donate.
-
-International donations are gratefully accepted, but we cannot make
-any statements concerning tax treatment of donations received from
-outside the United States. U.S. laws alone swamp our small staff.
-
-Please check the Project Gutenberg Web pages for current donation
-methods and addresses. Donations are accepted in a number of other
-ways including checks, online payments and credit card donations.
-To donate, please visit: www.gutenberg.org/donate
-
-
-Section 5. General Information About Project Gutenberg-tm electronic
-works.
-
-Professor Michael S. Hart was the originator of the Project Gutenberg-tm
-concept of a library of electronic works that could be freely shared
-with anyone. For forty years, he produced and distributed Project
-Gutenberg-tm eBooks with only a loose network of volunteer support.
-
-Project Gutenberg-tm eBooks are often created from several printed
-editions, all of which are confirmed as Public Domain in the U.S.
-unless a copyright notice is included. Thus, we do not necessarily
-keep eBooks in compliance with any particular paper edition.
-
-Most people start at our Web site which has the main PG search facility:
-
- www.gutenberg.org
-
-This Web site includes information about Project Gutenberg-tm,
-including how to make donations to the Project Gutenberg Literary
-Archive Foundation, how to help produce our new eBooks, and how to
-subscribe to our email newsletter to hear about new eBooks.